blob: 455dd424b9de161f7e46922ad8cb3ab650860172 [file] [log] [blame]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001==============================
2LLVM Language Reference Manual
3==============================
4
5.. contents::
6 :local:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00007 :depth: 4
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009Abstract
10========
11
12This document is a reference manual for the LLVM assembly language. LLVM
13is a Static Single Assignment (SSA) based representation that provides
14type safety, low-level operations, flexibility, and the capability of
15representing 'all' high-level languages cleanly. It is the common code
16representation used throughout all phases of the LLVM compilation
17strategy.
18
19Introduction
20============
21
22The LLVM code representation is designed to be used in three different
23forms: as an in-memory compiler IR, as an on-disk bitcode representation
24(suitable for fast loading by a Just-In-Time compiler), and as a human
25readable assembly language representation. This allows LLVM to provide a
26powerful intermediate representation for efficient compiler
27transformations and analysis, while providing a natural means to debug
28and visualize the transformations. The three different forms of LLVM are
29all equivalent. This document describes the human readable
30representation and notation.
31
32The LLVM representation aims to be light-weight and low-level while
33being expressive, typed, and extensible at the same time. It aims to be
34a "universal IR" of sorts, by being at a low enough level that
35high-level ideas may be cleanly mapped to it (similar to how
36microprocessors are "universal IR's", allowing many source languages to
37be mapped to them). By providing type information, LLVM can be used as
38the target of optimizations: for example, through pointer analysis, it
39can be proven that a C automatic variable is never accessed outside of
40the current function, allowing it to be promoted to a simple SSA value
41instead of a memory location.
42
43.. _wellformed:
44
45Well-Formedness
46---------------
47
48It is important to note that this document describes 'well formed' LLVM
49assembly language. There is a difference between what the parser accepts
50and what is considered 'well formed'. For example, the following
51instruction is syntactically okay, but not well formed:
52
53.. code-block:: llvm
54
55 %x = add i32 1, %x
56
57because the definition of ``%x`` does not dominate all of its uses. The
58LLVM infrastructure provides a verification pass that may be used to
59verify that an LLVM module is well formed. This pass is automatically
60run by the parser after parsing input assembly and by the optimizer
61before it outputs bitcode. The violations pointed out by the verifier
62pass indicate bugs in transformation passes or input to the parser.
63
64.. _identifiers:
65
66Identifiers
67===========
68
69LLVM identifiers come in two basic types: global and local. Global
70identifiers (functions, global variables) begin with the ``'@'``
71character. Local identifiers (register names, types) begin with the
72``'%'`` character. Additionally, there are three different formats for
73identifiers, for different purposes:
74
75#. Named values are represented as a string of characters with their
76 prefix. For example, ``%foo``, ``@DivisionByZero``,
77 ``%a.really.long.identifier``. The actual regular expression used is
Sean Silva9d01a5b2015-01-07 21:35:14 +000078 '``[%@][-a-zA-Z$._][-a-zA-Z$._0-9]*``'. Identifiers that require other
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000079 characters in their names can be surrounded with quotes. Special
80 characters may be escaped using ``"\xx"`` where ``xx`` is the ASCII
81 code for the character in hexadecimal. In this way, any character can
Hans Wennborg85e06532014-07-30 20:02:08 +000082 be used in a name value, even quotes themselves. The ``"\01"`` prefix
83 can be used on global variables to suppress mangling.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000084#. Unnamed values are represented as an unsigned numeric value with
85 their prefix. For example, ``%12``, ``@2``, ``%44``.
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000086#. Constants, which are described in the section Constants_ below.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000087
88LLVM requires that values start with a prefix for two reasons: Compilers
89don't need to worry about name clashes with reserved words, and the set
90of reserved words may be expanded in the future without penalty.
91Additionally, unnamed identifiers allow a compiler to quickly come up
92with a temporary variable without having to avoid symbol table
93conflicts.
94
95Reserved words in LLVM are very similar to reserved words in other
96languages. There are keywords for different opcodes ('``add``',
97'``bitcast``', '``ret``', etc...), for primitive type names ('``void``',
98'``i32``', etc...), and others. These reserved words cannot conflict
99with variable names, because none of them start with a prefix character
100(``'%'`` or ``'@'``).
101
102Here is an example of LLVM code to multiply the integer variable
103'``%X``' by 8:
104
105The easy way:
106
107.. code-block:: llvm
108
109 %result = mul i32 %X, 8
110
111After strength reduction:
112
113.. code-block:: llvm
114
Dmitri Gribenko675911d2013-01-26 13:30:13 +0000115 %result = shl i32 %X, 3
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000116
117And the hard way:
118
119.. code-block:: llvm
120
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +0000121 %0 = add i32 %X, %X ; yields i32:%0
122 %1 = add i32 %0, %0 ; yields i32:%1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000123 %result = add i32 %1, %1
124
125This last way of multiplying ``%X`` by 8 illustrates several important
126lexical features of LLVM:
127
128#. Comments are delimited with a '``;``' and go until the end of line.
129#. Unnamed temporaries are created when the result of a computation is
130 not assigned to a named value.
Sean Silva8ca11782013-05-20 23:31:12 +0000131#. Unnamed temporaries are numbered sequentially (using a per-function
Dan Liew2661dfc2014-08-20 15:06:30 +0000132 incrementing counter, starting with 0). Note that basic blocks and unnamed
133 function parameters are included in this numbering. For example, if the
134 entry basic block is not given a label name and all function parameters are
135 named, then it will get number 0.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000136
137It also shows a convention that we follow in this document. When
138demonstrating instructions, we will follow an instruction with a comment
139that defines the type and name of value produced.
140
141High Level Structure
142====================
143
144Module Structure
145----------------
146
147LLVM programs are composed of ``Module``'s, each of which is a
148translation unit of the input programs. Each module consists of
149functions, global variables, and symbol table entries. Modules may be
150combined together with the LLVM linker, which merges function (and
151global variable) definitions, resolves forward declarations, and merges
152symbol table entries. Here is an example of the "hello world" module:
153
154.. code-block:: llvm
155
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +0000156 ; Declare the string constant as a global constant.
157 @.str = private unnamed_addr constant [13 x i8] c"hello world\0A\00"
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000158
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +0000159 ; External declaration of the puts function
160 declare i32 @puts(i8* nocapture) nounwind
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000161
162 ; Definition of main function
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +0000163 define i32 @main() { ; i32()*
George Burgess IVfbc34982017-05-20 04:52:29 +0000164 ; Convert [13 x i8]* to i8*...
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +0000165 %cast210 = getelementptr [13 x i8], [13 x i8]* @.str, i64 0, i64 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000166
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +0000167 ; Call puts function to write out the string to stdout.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000168 call i32 @puts(i8* %cast210)
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +0000169 ret i32 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000170 }
171
172 ; Named metadata
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +0000173 !0 = !{i32 42, null, !"string"}
Nick Lewyckya0de40a2014-08-13 04:54:05 +0000174 !foo = !{!0}
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000175
176This example is made up of a :ref:`global variable <globalvars>` named
177"``.str``", an external declaration of the "``puts``" function, a
178:ref:`function definition <functionstructure>` for "``main``" and
179:ref:`named metadata <namedmetadatastructure>` "``foo``".
180
181In general, a module is made up of a list of global values (where both
182functions and global variables are global values). Global values are
183represented by a pointer to a memory location (in this case, a pointer
184to an array of char, and a pointer to a function), and have one of the
185following :ref:`linkage types <linkage>`.
186
187.. _linkage:
188
189Linkage Types
190-------------
191
192All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following types of
193linkage:
194
195``private``
196 Global values with "``private``" linkage are only directly
197 accessible by objects in the current module. In particular, linking
Sylvestre Ledru0604c5c2017-03-04 14:01:38 +0000198 code into a module with a private global value may cause the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000199 private to be renamed as necessary to avoid collisions. Because the
200 symbol is private to the module, all references can be updated. This
201 doesn't show up in any symbol table in the object file.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000202``internal``
203 Similar to private, but the value shows as a local symbol
204 (``STB_LOCAL`` in the case of ELF) in the object file. This
205 corresponds to the notion of the '``static``' keyword in C.
206``available_externally``
Peter Collingbourne45cd0c32015-12-14 19:22:37 +0000207 Globals with "``available_externally``" linkage are never emitted into
208 the object file corresponding to the LLVM module. From the linker's
209 perspective, an ``available_externally`` global is equivalent to
210 an external declaration. They exist to allow inlining and other
211 optimizations to take place given knowledge of the definition of the
212 global, which is known to be somewhere outside the module. Globals
213 with ``available_externally`` linkage are allowed to be discarded at
214 will, and allow inlining and other optimizations. This linkage type is
215 only allowed on definitions, not declarations.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000216``linkonce``
217 Globals with "``linkonce``" linkage are merged with other globals of
218 the same name when linkage occurs. This can be used to implement
219 some forms of inline functions, templates, or other code which must
220 be generated in each translation unit that uses it, but where the
221 body may be overridden with a more definitive definition later.
222 Unreferenced ``linkonce`` globals are allowed to be discarded. Note
223 that ``linkonce`` linkage does not actually allow the optimizer to
224 inline the body of this function into callers because it doesn't
225 know if this definition of the function is the definitive definition
226 within the program or whether it will be overridden by a stronger
227 definition. To enable inlining and other optimizations, use
228 "``linkonce_odr``" linkage.
229``weak``
230 "``weak``" linkage has the same merging semantics as ``linkonce``
231 linkage, except that unreferenced globals with ``weak`` linkage may
232 not be discarded. This is used for globals that are declared "weak"
233 in C source code.
234``common``
235 "``common``" linkage is most similar to "``weak``" linkage, but they
236 are used for tentative definitions in C, such as "``int X;``" at
237 global scope. Symbols with "``common``" linkage are merged in the
238 same way as ``weak symbols``, and they may not be deleted if
239 unreferenced. ``common`` symbols may not have an explicit section,
240 must have a zero initializer, and may not be marked
241 ':ref:`constant <globalvars>`'. Functions and aliases may not have
242 common linkage.
243
244.. _linkage_appending:
245
246``appending``
247 "``appending``" linkage may only be applied to global variables of
248 pointer to array type. When two global variables with appending
249 linkage are linked together, the two global arrays are appended
250 together. This is the LLVM, typesafe, equivalent of having the
251 system linker append together "sections" with identical names when
252 .o files are linked.
Rafael Espindolae64619c2016-05-16 21:14:24 +0000253
254 Unfortunately this doesn't correspond to any feature in .o files, so it
255 can only be used for variables like ``llvm.global_ctors`` which llvm
256 interprets specially.
257
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000258``extern_weak``
259 The semantics of this linkage follow the ELF object file model: the
260 symbol is weak until linked, if not linked, the symbol becomes null
261 instead of being an undefined reference.
262``linkonce_odr``, ``weak_odr``
263 Some languages allow differing globals to be merged, such as two
264 functions with different semantics. Other languages, such as
265 ``C++``, ensure that only equivalent globals are ever merged (the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000266 "one definition rule" --- "ODR"). Such languages can use the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000267 ``linkonce_odr`` and ``weak_odr`` linkage types to indicate that the
268 global will only be merged with equivalent globals. These linkage
269 types are otherwise the same as their non-``odr`` versions.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000270``external``
271 If none of the above identifiers are used, the global is externally
272 visible, meaning that it participates in linkage and can be used to
273 resolve external symbol references.
274
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000275It is illegal for a function *declaration* to have any linkage type
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000276other than ``external`` or ``extern_weak``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000277
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000278.. _callingconv:
279
280Calling Conventions
281-------------------
282
283LLVM :ref:`functions <functionstructure>`, :ref:`calls <i_call>` and
284:ref:`invokes <i_invoke>` can all have an optional calling convention
285specified for the call. The calling convention of any pair of dynamic
286caller/callee must match, or the behavior of the program is undefined.
287The following calling conventions are supported by LLVM, and more may be
288added in the future:
289
290"``ccc``" - The C calling convention
291 This calling convention (the default if no other calling convention
292 is specified) matches the target C calling conventions. This calling
293 convention supports varargs function calls and tolerates some
294 mismatch in the declared prototype and implemented declaration of
295 the function (as does normal C).
296"``fastcc``" - The fast calling convention
297 This calling convention attempts to make calls as fast as possible
298 (e.g. by passing things in registers). This calling convention
299 allows the target to use whatever tricks it wants to produce fast
300 code for the target, without having to conform to an externally
301 specified ABI (Application Binary Interface). `Tail calls can only
302 be optimized when this, the GHC or the HiPE convention is
303 used. <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ This calling convention does not
304 support varargs and requires the prototype of all callees to exactly
305 match the prototype of the function definition.
306"``coldcc``" - The cold calling convention
307 This calling convention attempts to make code in the caller as
308 efficient as possible under the assumption that the call is not
309 commonly executed. As such, these calls often preserve all registers
310 so that the call does not break any live ranges in the caller side.
311 This calling convention does not support varargs and requires the
312 prototype of all callees to exactly match the prototype of the
Juergen Ributzka5d05ed12014-01-17 22:24:35 +0000313 function definition. Furthermore the inliner doesn't consider such function
314 calls for inlining.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000315"``cc 10``" - GHC convention
316 This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by
317 the `Glasgow Haskell Compiler (GHC) <http://www.haskell.org/ghc>`_.
318 It passes everything in registers, going to extremes to achieve this
319 by disabling callee save registers. This calling convention should
320 not be used lightly but only for specific situations such as an
321 alternative to the *register pinning* performance technique often
322 used when implementing functional programming languages. At the
323 moment only X86 supports this convention and it has the following
324 limitations:
325
326 - On *X86-32* only supports up to 4 bit type parameters. No
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +0000327 floating-point types are supported.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000328 - On *X86-64* only supports up to 10 bit type parameters and 6
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +0000329 floating-point parameters.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000330
331 This calling convention supports `tail call
332 optimization <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ but requires both the
333 caller and callee are using it.
334"``cc 11``" - The HiPE calling convention
335 This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by
336 the `High-Performance Erlang
337 (HiPE) <http://www.it.uu.se/research/group/hipe/>`_ compiler, *the*
338 native code compiler of the `Ericsson's Open Source Erlang/OTP
339 system <http://www.erlang.org/download.shtml>`_. It uses more
340 registers for argument passing than the ordinary C calling
341 convention and defines no callee-saved registers. The calling
342 convention properly supports `tail call
343 optimization <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ but requires that both the
344 caller and the callee use it. It uses a *register pinning*
345 mechanism, similar to GHC's convention, for keeping frequently
346 accessed runtime components pinned to specific hardware registers.
347 At the moment only X86 supports this convention (both 32 and 64
348 bit).
Andrew Trick5e029ce2013-12-24 02:57:25 +0000349"``webkit_jscc``" - WebKit's JavaScript calling convention
350 This calling convention has been implemented for `WebKit FTL JIT
351 <https://trac.webkit.org/wiki/FTLJIT>`_. It passes arguments on the
352 stack right to left (as cdecl does), and returns a value in the
353 platform's customary return register.
354"``anyregcc``" - Dynamic calling convention for code patching
355 This is a special convention that supports patching an arbitrary code
356 sequence in place of a call site. This convention forces the call
Eli Bendersky45324ce2015-04-02 15:20:04 +0000357 arguments into registers but allows them to be dynamically
Andrew Trick5e029ce2013-12-24 02:57:25 +0000358 allocated. This can currently only be used with calls to
359 llvm.experimental.patchpoint because only this intrinsic records
360 the location of its arguments in a side table. See :doc:`StackMaps`.
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000361"``preserve_mostcc``" - The `PreserveMost` calling convention
Eli Bendersky45324ce2015-04-02 15:20:04 +0000362 This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller as
363 unintrusive as possible. This convention behaves identically to the `C`
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000364 calling convention on how arguments and return values are passed, but it
365 uses a different set of caller/callee-saved registers. This alleviates the
366 burden of saving and recovering a large register set before and after the
Juergen Ributzka980f2dc2014-01-30 02:39:00 +0000367 call in the caller. If the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers,
368 then they will be preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn't
369 apply for values returned in callee-saved registers.
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000370
371 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
372 R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Floating-point registers
373 (XMMs/YMMs) are not preserved and need to be saved by the caller.
374
375 The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions
376 that have a hot path and a cold path. The hot path is usually a small piece
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +0000377 of code that doesn't use many registers. The cold path might need to call out to
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000378 another function and therefore only needs to preserve the caller-saved
Juergen Ributzka5d05ed12014-01-17 22:24:35 +0000379 registers, which haven't already been saved by the caller. The
380 `PreserveMost` calling convention is very similar to the `cold` calling
381 convention in terms of caller/callee-saved registers, but they are used for
382 different types of function calls. `coldcc` is for function calls that are
383 rarely executed, whereas `preserve_mostcc` function calls are intended to be
384 on the hot path and definitely executed a lot. Furthermore `preserve_mostcc`
385 doesn't prevent the inliner from inlining the function call.
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000386
387 This calling convention will be used by a future version of the ObjectiveC
388 runtime and should therefore still be considered experimental at this time.
389 Although this convention was created to optimize certain runtime calls to
390 the ObjectiveC runtime, it is not limited to this runtime and might be used
391 by other runtimes in the future too. The current implementation only
392 supports X86-64, but the intention is to support more architectures in the
393 future.
394"``preserve_allcc``" - The `PreserveAll` calling convention
395 This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller even less
396 intrusive than the `PreserveMost` calling convention. This calling
397 convention also behaves identical to the `C` calling convention on how
398 arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of
399 caller/callee-saved registers. This removes the burden of saving and
Juergen Ributzka980f2dc2014-01-30 02:39:00 +0000400 recovering a large register set before and after the call in the caller. If
401 the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers, then they will be
402 preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn't apply for values
403 returned in callee-saved registers.
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000404
405 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
406 R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Furthermore it also preserves
407 all floating-point registers (XMMs/YMMs).
408
409 The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions
410 that don't need to call out to any other functions.
411
412 This calling convention, like the `PreserveMost` calling convention, will be
413 used by a future version of the ObjectiveC runtime and should be considered
414 experimental at this time.
Manman Ren19c7bbe2015-12-04 17:40:13 +0000415"``cxx_fast_tlscc``" - The `CXX_FAST_TLS` calling convention for access functions
Manman Ren17567d22015-12-07 21:40:09 +0000416 Clang generates an access function to access C++-style TLS. The access
417 function generally has an entry block, an exit block and an initialization
418 block that is run at the first time. The entry and exit blocks can access
419 a few TLS IR variables, each access will be lowered to a platform-specific
420 sequence.
421
Manman Ren19c7bbe2015-12-04 17:40:13 +0000422 This calling convention aims to minimize overhead in the caller by
Manman Ren17567d22015-12-07 21:40:09 +0000423 preserving as many registers as possible (all the registers that are
424 perserved on the fast path, composed of the entry and exit blocks).
425
426 This calling convention behaves identical to the `C` calling convention on
427 how arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of
428 caller/callee-saved registers.
429
430 Given that each platform has its own lowering sequence, hence its own set
431 of preserved registers, we can't use the existing `PreserveMost`.
Manman Ren19c7bbe2015-12-04 17:40:13 +0000432
433 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
434 RDI and RAX.
Manman Renf8bdd882016-04-05 22:41:47 +0000435"``swiftcc``" - This calling convention is used for Swift language.
436 - On X86-64 RCX and R8 are available for additional integer returns, and
437 XMM2 and XMM3 are available for additional FP/vector returns.
Manman Ren802cd6f2016-04-05 22:44:44 +0000438 - On iOS platforms, we use AAPCS-VFP calling convention.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000439"``cc <n>``" - Numbered convention
440 Any calling convention may be specified by number, allowing
441 target-specific calling conventions to be used. Target specific
442 calling conventions start at 64.
443
444More calling conventions can be added/defined on an as-needed basis, to
445support Pascal conventions or any other well-known target-independent
446convention.
447
Eli Benderskyfdc529a2013-06-07 19:40:08 +0000448.. _visibilitystyles:
449
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000450Visibility Styles
451-----------------
452
453All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following visibility
454styles:
455
456"``default``" - Default style
457 On targets that use the ELF object file format, default visibility
458 means that the declaration is visible to other modules and, in
459 shared libraries, means that the declared entity may be overridden.
460 On Darwin, default visibility means that the declaration is visible
461 to other modules. Default visibility corresponds to "external
462 linkage" in the language.
463"``hidden``" - Hidden style
464 Two declarations of an object with hidden visibility refer to the
465 same object if they are in the same shared object. Usually, hidden
466 visibility indicates that the symbol will not be placed into the
467 dynamic symbol table, so no other module (executable or shared
468 library) can reference it directly.
469"``protected``" - Protected style
470 On ELF, protected visibility indicates that the symbol will be
471 placed in the dynamic symbol table, but that references within the
472 defining module will bind to the local symbol. That is, the symbol
473 cannot be overridden by another module.
474
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithb80de102014-05-07 22:57:20 +0000475A symbol with ``internal`` or ``private`` linkage must have ``default``
476visibility.
477
Rafael Espindola3bc64d52014-05-26 21:30:40 +0000478.. _dllstorageclass:
Eli Benderskyfdc529a2013-06-07 19:40:08 +0000479
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000480DLL Storage Classes
481-------------------
482
483All Global Variables, Functions and Aliases can have one of the following
484DLL storage class:
485
486``dllimport``
487 "``dllimport``" causes the compiler to reference a function or variable via
488 a global pointer to a pointer that is set up by the DLL exporting the
489 symbol. On Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by
490 combining ``__imp_`` and the function or variable name.
491``dllexport``
492 "``dllexport``" causes the compiler to provide a global pointer to a pointer
493 in a DLL, so that it can be referenced with the ``dllimport`` attribute. On
494 Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by combining
495 ``__imp_`` and the function or variable name. Since this storage class
496 exists for defining a dll interface, the compiler, assembler and linker know
497 it is externally referenced and must refrain from deleting the symbol.
498
Rafael Espindola59f7eba2014-05-28 18:15:43 +0000499.. _tls_model:
500
501Thread Local Storage Models
502---------------------------
503
504A variable may be defined as ``thread_local``, which means that it will
505not be shared by threads (each thread will have a separated copy of the
506variable). Not all targets support thread-local variables. Optionally, a
507TLS model may be specified:
508
509``localdynamic``
510 For variables that are only used within the current shared library.
511``initialexec``
512 For variables in modules that will not be loaded dynamically.
513``localexec``
514 For variables defined in the executable and only used within it.
515
516If no explicit model is given, the "general dynamic" model is used.
517
518The models correspond to the ELF TLS models; see `ELF Handling For
519Thread-Local Storage <http://people.redhat.com/drepper/tls.pdf>`_ for
520more information on under which circumstances the different models may
521be used. The target may choose a different TLS model if the specified
522model is not supported, or if a better choice of model can be made.
523
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +0000524A model can also be specified in an alias, but then it only governs how
Rafael Espindola59f7eba2014-05-28 18:15:43 +0000525the alias is accessed. It will not have any effect in the aliasee.
526
Chih-Hung Hsieh1e859582015-07-28 16:24:05 +0000527For platforms without linker support of ELF TLS model, the -femulated-tls
528flag can be used to generate GCC compatible emulated TLS code.
529
Sean Fertilec70d28b2017-10-26 15:00:26 +0000530.. _runtime_preemption_model:
531
532Runtime Preemption Specifiers
533-----------------------------
534
535Global variables, functions and aliases may have an optional runtime preemption
536specifier. If a preemption specifier isn't given explicitly, then a
537symbol is assumed to be ``dso_preemptable``.
538
539``dso_preemptable``
540 Indicates that the function or variable may be replaced by a symbol from
541 outside the linkage unit at runtime.
542
543``dso_local``
544 The compiler may assume that a function or variable marked as ``dso_local``
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +0000545 will resolve to a symbol within the same linkage unit. Direct access will
Sean Fertilec70d28b2017-10-26 15:00:26 +0000546 be generated even if the definition is not within this compilation unit.
547
Rafael Espindola3bc64d52014-05-26 21:30:40 +0000548.. _namedtypes:
549
Reid Kleckner7c84d1d2014-03-05 02:21:50 +0000550Structure Types
551---------------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000552
Reid Kleckner7c84d1d2014-03-05 02:21:50 +0000553LLVM IR allows you to specify both "identified" and "literal" :ref:`structure
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000554types <t_struct>`. Literal types are uniqued structurally, but identified types
555are never uniqued. An :ref:`opaque structural type <t_opaque>` can also be used
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +0000556to forward declare a type that is not yet available.
Reid Kleckner7c84d1d2014-03-05 02:21:50 +0000557
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +0000558An example of an identified structure specification is:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000559
560.. code-block:: llvm
561
562 %mytype = type { %mytype*, i32 }
563
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000564Prior to the LLVM 3.0 release, identified types were structurally uniqued. Only
Reid Kleckner7c84d1d2014-03-05 02:21:50 +0000565literal types are uniqued in recent versions of LLVM.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000566
Sanjoy Dasc6af5ea2016-07-28 23:43:38 +0000567.. _nointptrtype:
568
569Non-Integral Pointer Type
570-------------------------
571
572Note: non-integral pointer types are a work in progress, and they should be
573considered experimental at this time.
574
575LLVM IR optionally allows the frontend to denote pointers in certain address
Sanjoy Das63752e62016-08-10 21:48:24 +0000576spaces as "non-integral" via the :ref:`datalayout string<langref_datalayout>`.
577Non-integral pointer types represent pointers that have an *unspecified* bitwise
578representation; that is, the integral representation may be target dependent or
579unstable (not backed by a fixed integer).
Sanjoy Dasc6af5ea2016-07-28 23:43:38 +0000580
581``inttoptr`` instructions converting integers to non-integral pointer types are
582ill-typed, and so are ``ptrtoint`` instructions converting values of
583non-integral pointer types to integers. Vector versions of said instructions
584are ill-typed as well.
585
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000586.. _globalvars:
587
588Global Variables
589----------------
590
591Global variables define regions of memory allocated at compilation time
Rafael Espindola5d1b7452013-10-29 13:44:11 +0000592instead of run-time.
593
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +0000594Global variable definitions must be initialized.
Rafael Espindola5d1b7452013-10-29 13:44:11 +0000595
596Global variables in other translation units can also be declared, in which
597case they don't have an initializer.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000598
Bob Wilson85b24f22014-06-12 20:40:33 +0000599Either global variable definitions or declarations may have an explicit section
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +0000600to be placed in and may have an optional explicit alignment specified. If there
601is a mismatch between the explicit or inferred section information for the
602variable declaration and its definition the resulting behavior is undefined.
Bob Wilson85b24f22014-06-12 20:40:33 +0000603
Michael Gottesman006039c2013-01-31 05:48:48 +0000604A variable may be defined as a global ``constant``, which indicates that
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000605the contents of the variable will **never** be modified (enabling better
606optimization, allowing the global data to be placed in the read-only
607section of an executable, etc). Note that variables that need runtime
Michael Gottesman1cffcf742013-01-31 05:44:04 +0000608initialization cannot be marked ``constant`` as there is a store to the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000609variable.
610
611LLVM explicitly allows *declarations* of global variables to be marked
612constant, even if the final definition of the global is not. This
613capability can be used to enable slightly better optimization of the
614program, but requires the language definition to guarantee that
615optimizations based on the 'constantness' are valid for the translation
616units that do not include the definition.
617
618As SSA values, global variables define pointer values that are in scope
619(i.e. they dominate) all basic blocks in the program. Global variables
620always define a pointer to their "content" type because they describe a
621region of memory, and all memory objects in LLVM are accessed through
622pointers.
623
624Global variables can be marked with ``unnamed_addr`` which indicates
625that the address is not significant, only the content. Constants marked
626like this can be merged with other constants if they have the same
627initializer. Note that a constant with significant address *can* be
628merged with a ``unnamed_addr`` constant, the result being a constant
629whose address is significant.
630
Peter Collingbourne96efdd62016-06-14 21:01:22 +0000631If the ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to
632not be significant within the module.
633
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000634A global variable may be declared to reside in a target-specific
635numbered address space. For targets that support them, address spaces
636may affect how optimizations are performed and/or what target
637instructions are used to access the variable. The default address space
638is zero. The address space qualifier must precede any other attributes.
639
640LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for globals. If the
641target supports it, it will emit globals to the section specified.
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000642Additionally, the global can placed in a comdat if the target has the necessary
643support.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000644
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +0000645External declarations may have an explicit section specified. Section
646information is retained in LLVM IR for targets that make use of this
647information. Attaching section information to an external declaration is an
648assertion that its definition is located in the specified section. If the
649definition is located in a different section, the behavior is undefined.
Erich Keane0343ef82017-08-22 15:30:43 +0000650
Michael Gottesmane743a302013-02-04 03:22:00 +0000651By default, global initializers are optimized by assuming that global
Michael Gottesmanef2bc772013-02-03 09:57:15 +0000652variables defined within the module are not modified from their
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000653initial values before the start of the global initializer. This is
Michael Gottesmanef2bc772013-02-03 09:57:15 +0000654true even for variables potentially accessible from outside the
655module, including those with external linkage or appearing in
Yunzhong Gaof5b769e2013-12-05 18:37:54 +0000656``@llvm.used`` or dllexported variables. This assumption may be suppressed
657by marking the variable with ``externally_initialized``.
Michael Gottesmanef2bc772013-02-03 09:57:15 +0000658
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000659An explicit alignment may be specified for a global, which must be a
660power of 2. If not present, or if the alignment is set to zero, the
661alignment of the global is set by the target to whatever it feels
662convenient. If an explicit alignment is specified, the global is forced
663to have exactly that alignment. Targets and optimizers are not allowed
664to over-align the global if the global has an assigned section. In this
665case, the extra alignment could be observable: for example, code could
666assume that the globals are densely packed in their section and try to
667iterate over them as an array, alignment padding would break this
Reid Kleckner15fe7a52014-07-15 01:16:09 +0000668iteration. The maximum alignment is ``1 << 29``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000669
Javed Absarf3d79042017-05-11 12:28:08 +0000670Globals can also have a :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`,
Sean Fertilec70d28b2017-10-26 15:00:26 +0000671an optional :ref:`runtime preemption specifier <runtime_preemption_model>`,
Javed Absarf3d79042017-05-11 12:28:08 +0000672an optional :ref:`global attributes <glattrs>` and
673an optional list of attached :ref:`metadata <metadata>`.
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000674
Peter Collingbourne69ba0162015-02-04 00:42:45 +0000675Variables and aliases can have a
Rafael Espindola59f7eba2014-05-28 18:15:43 +0000676:ref:`Thread Local Storage Model <tls_model>`.
677
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000678Syntax::
679
Sean Fertilec70d28b2017-10-26 15:00:26 +0000680 @<GlobalVarName> = [Linkage] [PreemptionSpecifier] [Visibility]
681 [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal]
Peter Collingbourne96efdd62016-06-14 21:01:22 +0000682 [(unnamed_addr|local_unnamed_addr)] [AddrSpace]
683 [ExternallyInitialized]
Bob Wilson85b24f22014-06-12 20:40:33 +0000684 <global | constant> <Type> [<InitializerConstant>]
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000685 [, section "name"] [, comdat [($name)]]
Peter Collingbournecceae7f2016-05-31 23:01:54 +0000686 [, align <Alignment>] (, !name !N)*
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000687
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000688For example, the following defines a global in a numbered address space
689with an initializer, section, and alignment:
690
691.. code-block:: llvm
692
693 @G = addrspace(5) constant float 1.0, section "foo", align 4
694
Rafael Espindola5d1b7452013-10-29 13:44:11 +0000695The following example just declares a global variable
696
697.. code-block:: llvm
698
699 @G = external global i32
700
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000701The following example defines a thread-local global with the
702``initialexec`` TLS model:
703
704.. code-block:: llvm
705
706 @G = thread_local(initialexec) global i32 0, align 4
707
708.. _functionstructure:
709
710Functions
711---------
712
713LLVM function definitions consist of the "``define``" keyword, an
Sean Fertilec70d28b2017-10-26 15:00:26 +0000714optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional :ref:`runtime preemption
715specifier <runtime_preemption_model>`, an optional :ref:`visibility
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000716style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`,
717an optional :ref:`calling convention <callingconv>`,
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000718an optional ``unnamed_addr`` attribute, a return type, an optional
719:ref:`parameter attribute <paramattrs>` for the return type, a function
720name, a (possibly empty) argument list (each with optional :ref:`parameter
721attributes <paramattrs>`), optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>`,
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000722an optional section, an optional alignment,
723an optional :ref:`comdat <langref_comdats>`,
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +0000724an optional :ref:`garbage collector name <gc>`, an optional :ref:`prefix <prefixdata>`,
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +0000725an optional :ref:`prologue <prologuedata>`,
726an optional :ref:`personality <personalityfn>`,
Peter Collingbourne50108682015-11-06 02:41:02 +0000727an optional list of attached :ref:`metadata <metadata>`,
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +0000728an opening curly brace, a list of basic blocks, and a closing curly brace.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000729
730LLVM function declarations consist of the "``declare``" keyword, an
Peter Collingbourne96efdd62016-06-14 21:01:22 +0000731optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional :ref:`visibility style
732<visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`, an
733optional :ref:`calling convention <callingconv>`, an optional ``unnamed_addr``
734or ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute, a return type, an optional :ref:`parameter
735attribute <paramattrs>` for the return type, a function name, a possibly
736empty list of arguments, an optional alignment, an optional :ref:`garbage
737collector name <gc>`, an optional :ref:`prefix <prefixdata>`, and an optional
738:ref:`prologue <prologuedata>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000739
Bill Wendling6822ecb2013-10-27 05:09:12 +0000740A function definition contains a list of basic blocks, forming the CFG (Control
741Flow Graph) for the function. Each basic block may optionally start with a label
742(giving the basic block a symbol table entry), contains a list of instructions,
743and ends with a :ref:`terminator <terminators>` instruction (such as a branch or
744function return). If an explicit label is not provided, a block is assigned an
745implicit numbered label, using the next value from the same counter as used for
746unnamed temporaries (:ref:`see above<identifiers>`). For example, if a function
747entry block does not have an explicit label, it will be assigned label "%0",
748then the first unnamed temporary in that block will be "%1", etc.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000749
750The first basic block in a function is special in two ways: it is
751immediately executed on entrance to the function, and it is not allowed
752to have predecessor basic blocks (i.e. there can not be any branches to
753the entry block of a function). Because the block can have no
754predecessors, it also cannot have any :ref:`PHI nodes <i_phi>`.
755
756LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for functions. If the
757target supports it, it will emit functions to the section specified.
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +0000758Additionally, the function can be placed in a COMDAT.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000759
760An explicit alignment may be specified for a function. If not present,
761or if the alignment is set to zero, the alignment of the function is set
762by the target to whatever it feels convenient. If an explicit alignment
763is specified, the function is forced to have at least that much
764alignment. All alignments must be a power of 2.
765
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +0000766If the ``unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to not
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000767be significant and two identical functions can be merged.
768
Peter Collingbourne96efdd62016-06-14 21:01:22 +0000769If the ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to
770not be significant within the module.
771
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000772Syntax::
773
Sean Fertilec70d28b2017-10-26 15:00:26 +0000774 define [linkage] [PreemptionSpecifier] [visibility] [DLLStorageClass]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000775 [cconv] [ret attrs]
776 <ResultType> @<FunctionName> ([argument list])
Peter Collingbourne96efdd62016-06-14 21:01:22 +0000777 [(unnamed_addr|local_unnamed_addr)] [fn Attrs] [section "name"]
778 [comdat [($name)]] [align N] [gc] [prefix Constant]
779 [prologue Constant] [personality Constant] (!name !N)* { ... }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000780
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +0000781The argument list is a comma separated sequence of arguments where each
782argument is of the following form:
Dan Liew2661dfc2014-08-20 15:06:30 +0000783
784Syntax::
785
786 <type> [parameter Attrs] [name]
787
788
Eli Benderskyfdc529a2013-06-07 19:40:08 +0000789.. _langref_aliases:
790
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000791Aliases
792-------
793
Rafael Espindola64c1e182014-06-03 02:41:57 +0000794Aliases, unlike function or variables, don't create any new data. They
795are just a new symbol and metadata for an existing position.
796
797Aliases have a name and an aliasee that is either a global value or a
798constant expression.
799
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000800Aliases may have an optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional
Sean Fertilec70d28b2017-10-26 15:00:26 +0000801:ref:`runtime preemption specifier <runtime_preemption_model>`, an optional
Rafael Espindola64c1e182014-06-03 02:41:57 +0000802:ref:`visibility style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class
803<dllstorageclass>` and an optional :ref:`tls model <tls_model>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000804
805Syntax::
806
Sean Fertilec70d28b2017-10-26 15:00:26 +0000807 @<Name> = [Linkage] [PreemptionSpecifier] [Visibility] [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal] [(unnamed_addr|local_unnamed_addr)] alias <AliaseeTy>, <AliaseeTy>* @<Aliasee>
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000808
Rafael Espindola2fb5bc32014-03-13 23:18:37 +0000809The linkage must be one of ``private``, ``internal``, ``linkonce``, ``weak``,
Rafael Espindola716e7402013-11-01 17:09:14 +0000810``linkonce_odr``, ``weak_odr``, ``external``. Note that some system linkers
Rafael Espindola64c1e182014-06-03 02:41:57 +0000811might not correctly handle dropping a weak symbol that is aliased.
Rafael Espindola78527052013-10-06 15:10:43 +0000812
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +0000813Aliases that are not ``unnamed_addr`` are guaranteed to have the same address as
Rafael Espindola42a4c9f2014-06-06 01:20:28 +0000814the aliasee expression. ``unnamed_addr`` ones are only guaranteed to point
815to the same content.
Rafael Espindolaf3336bc2014-03-12 20:15:49 +0000816
Peter Collingbourne96efdd62016-06-14 21:01:22 +0000817If the ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to
818not be significant within the module.
819
Rafael Espindola64c1e182014-06-03 02:41:57 +0000820Since aliases are only a second name, some restrictions apply, of which
821some can only be checked when producing an object file:
Rafael Espindolaf3336bc2014-03-12 20:15:49 +0000822
Rafael Espindola64c1e182014-06-03 02:41:57 +0000823* The expression defining the aliasee must be computable at assembly
824 time. Since it is just a name, no relocations can be used.
825
826* No alias in the expression can be weak as the possibility of the
827 intermediate alias being overridden cannot be represented in an
828 object file.
829
830* No global value in the expression can be a declaration, since that
831 would require a relocation, which is not possible.
Rafael Espindola24a669d2014-03-27 15:26:56 +0000832
Dmitry Polukhina1feff72016-04-07 12:32:19 +0000833.. _langref_ifunc:
834
835IFuncs
836-------
837
838IFuncs, like as aliases, don't create any new data or func. They are just a new
839symbol that dynamic linker resolves at runtime by calling a resolver function.
840
841IFuncs have a name and a resolver that is a function called by dynamic linker
842that returns address of another function associated with the name.
843
844IFunc may have an optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>` and an optional
845:ref:`visibility style <visibility>`.
846
847Syntax::
848
849 @<Name> = [Linkage] [Visibility] ifunc <IFuncTy>, <ResolverTy>* @<Resolver>
850
851
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000852.. _langref_comdats:
853
854Comdats
855-------
856
857Comdat IR provides access to COFF and ELF object file COMDAT functionality.
858
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000859Comdats have a name which represents the COMDAT key. All global objects that
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000860specify this key will only end up in the final object file if the linker chooses
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000861that key over some other key. Aliases are placed in the same COMDAT that their
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000862aliasee computes to, if any.
863
864Comdats have a selection kind to provide input on how the linker should
865choose between keys in two different object files.
866
867Syntax::
868
869 $<Name> = comdat SelectionKind
870
871The selection kind must be one of the following:
872
873``any``
874 The linker may choose any COMDAT key, the choice is arbitrary.
875``exactmatch``
876 The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the
877 same data.
878``largest``
879 The linker will choose the section containing the largest COMDAT key.
880``noduplicates``
881 The linker requires that only section with this COMDAT key exist.
882``samesize``
883 The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the
884 same amount of data.
885
Sam Cleggea7cace2018-01-09 23:43:14 +0000886Note that the Mach-O platform doesn't support COMDATs, and ELF and WebAssembly
887only support ``any`` as a selection kind.
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000888
889Here is an example of a COMDAT group where a function will only be selected if
890the COMDAT key's section is the largest:
891
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +0000892.. code-block:: text
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000893
894 $foo = comdat largest
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000895 @foo = global i32 2, comdat($foo)
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000896
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000897 define void @bar() comdat($foo) {
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000898 ret void
899 }
900
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000901As a syntactic sugar the ``$name`` can be omitted if the name is the same as
902the global name:
903
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +0000904.. code-block:: text
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000905
906 $foo = comdat any
907 @foo = global i32 2, comdat
908
909
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000910In a COFF object file, this will create a COMDAT section with selection kind
911``IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_LARGEST`` containing the contents of the ``@foo`` symbol
912and another COMDAT section with selection kind
913``IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_ASSOCIATIVE`` which is associated with the first COMDAT
Hans Wennborg0def0662014-09-10 17:05:08 +0000914section and contains the contents of the ``@bar`` symbol.
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000915
916There are some restrictions on the properties of the global object.
917It, or an alias to it, must have the same name as the COMDAT group when
918targeting COFF.
919The contents and size of this object may be used during link-time to determine
920which COMDAT groups get selected depending on the selection kind.
921Because the name of the object must match the name of the COMDAT group, the
922linkage of the global object must not be local; local symbols can get renamed
923if a collision occurs in the symbol table.
924
925The combined use of COMDATS and section attributes may yield surprising results.
926For example:
927
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +0000928.. code-block:: text
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000929
930 $foo = comdat any
931 $bar = comdat any
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000932 @g1 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($foo)
933 @g2 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($bar)
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000934
935From the object file perspective, this requires the creation of two sections
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000936with the same name. This is necessary because both globals belong to different
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000937COMDAT groups and COMDATs, at the object file level, are represented by
938sections.
939
Peter Collingbourne1feef2e2015-06-30 19:10:31 +0000940Note that certain IR constructs like global variables and functions may
941create COMDATs in the object file in addition to any which are specified using
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000942COMDAT IR. This arises when the code generator is configured to emit globals
Peter Collingbourne1feef2e2015-06-30 19:10:31 +0000943in individual sections (e.g. when `-data-sections` or `-function-sections`
944is supplied to `llc`).
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000945
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000946.. _namedmetadatastructure:
947
948Named Metadata
949--------------
950
951Named metadata is a collection of metadata. :ref:`Metadata
952nodes <metadata>` (but not metadata strings) are the only valid
953operands for a named metadata.
954
Filipe Cabecinhas62431b12015-06-02 21:25:08 +0000955#. Named metadata are represented as a string of characters with the
956 metadata prefix. The rules for metadata names are the same as for
957 identifiers, but quoted names are not allowed. ``"\xx"`` type escapes
958 are still valid, which allows any character to be part of a name.
959
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000960Syntax::
961
962 ; Some unnamed metadata nodes, which are referenced by the named metadata.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +0000963 !0 = !{!"zero"}
964 !1 = !{!"one"}
965 !2 = !{!"two"}
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000966 ; A named metadata.
967 !name = !{!0, !1, !2}
968
969.. _paramattrs:
970
971Parameter Attributes
972--------------------
973
974The return type and each parameter of a function type may have a set of
975*parameter attributes* associated with them. Parameter attributes are
976used to communicate additional information about the result or
977parameters of a function. Parameter attributes are considered to be part
978of the function, not of the function type, so functions with different
979parameter attributes can have the same function type.
980
981Parameter attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified.
982If multiple parameter attributes are needed, they are space separated.
983For example:
984
985.. code-block:: llvm
986
987 declare i32 @printf(i8* noalias nocapture, ...)
988 declare i32 @atoi(i8 zeroext)
989 declare signext i8 @returns_signed_char()
990
991Note that any attributes for the function result (``nounwind``,
992``readonly``) come immediately after the argument list.
993
994Currently, only the following parameter attributes are defined:
995
996``zeroext``
997 This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return
998 value should be zero-extended to the extent required by the target's
Hans Wennborg850ec6c2016-02-08 19:34:30 +0000999 ABI by the caller (for a parameter) or the callee (for a return value).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001000``signext``
1001 This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return
1002 value should be sign-extended to the extent required by the target's
1003 ABI (which is usually 32-bits) by the caller (for a parameter) or
1004 the callee (for a return value).
1005``inreg``
1006 This indicates that this parameter or return value should be treated
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00001007 in a special target-dependent fashion while emitting code for
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001008 a function call or return (usually, by putting it in a register as
1009 opposed to memory, though some targets use it to distinguish between
1010 two different kinds of registers). Use of this attribute is
1011 target-specific.
1012``byval``
1013 This indicates that the pointer parameter should really be passed by
1014 value to the function. The attribute implies that a hidden copy of
1015 the pointee is made between the caller and the callee, so the callee
1016 is unable to modify the value in the caller. This attribute is only
1017 valid on LLVM pointer arguments. It is generally used to pass
1018 structs and arrays by value, but is also valid on pointers to
1019 scalars. The copy is considered to belong to the caller not the
1020 callee (for example, ``readonly`` functions should not write to
1021 ``byval`` parameters). This is not a valid attribute for return
1022 values.
1023
1024 The byval attribute also supports specifying an alignment with the
1025 align attribute. It indicates the alignment of the stack slot to
1026 form and the known alignment of the pointer specified to the call
1027 site. If the alignment is not specified, then the code generator
1028 makes a target-specific assumption.
1029
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +00001030.. _attr_inalloca:
1031
1032``inalloca``
1033
Reid Kleckner60d3a832014-01-16 22:59:24 +00001034 The ``inalloca`` argument attribute allows the caller to take the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001035 address of outgoing stack arguments. An ``inalloca`` argument must
Reid Kleckner436c42e2014-01-17 23:58:17 +00001036 be a pointer to stack memory produced by an ``alloca`` instruction.
1037 The alloca, or argument allocation, must also be tagged with the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001038 inalloca keyword. Only the last argument may have the ``inalloca``
Reid Kleckner436c42e2014-01-17 23:58:17 +00001039 attribute, and that argument is guaranteed to be passed in memory.
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +00001040
Reid Kleckner436c42e2014-01-17 23:58:17 +00001041 An argument allocation may be used by a call at most once because
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001042 the call may deallocate it. The ``inalloca`` attribute cannot be
Reid Kleckner436c42e2014-01-17 23:58:17 +00001043 used in conjunction with other attributes that affect argument
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001044 storage, like ``inreg``, ``nest``, ``sret``, or ``byval``. The
Reid Klecknerf5b76512014-01-31 23:50:57 +00001045 ``inalloca`` attribute also disables LLVM's implicit lowering of
1046 large aggregate return values, which means that frontend authors
1047 must lower them with ``sret`` pointers.
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +00001048
Reid Kleckner60d3a832014-01-16 22:59:24 +00001049 When the call site is reached, the argument allocation must have
1050 been the most recent stack allocation that is still live, or the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001051 results are undefined. It is possible to allocate additional stack
Reid Kleckner60d3a832014-01-16 22:59:24 +00001052 space after an argument allocation and before its call site, but it
1053 must be cleared off with :ref:`llvm.stackrestore
1054 <int_stackrestore>`.
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +00001055
1056 See :doc:`InAlloca` for more information on how to use this
1057 attribute.
1058
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001059``sret``
1060 This indicates that the pointer parameter specifies the address of a
1061 structure that is the return value of the function in the source
1062 program. This pointer must be guaranteed by the caller to be valid:
Reid Kleckner1361c0c2016-09-08 15:45:27 +00001063 loads and stores to the structure may be assumed by the callee not
1064 to trap and to be properly aligned. This is not a valid attribute
1065 for return values.
Sean Silva1703e702014-04-08 21:06:22 +00001066
Daniel Neilson1e687242018-01-19 17:13:12 +00001067.. _attr_align:
Elena Demikhovsky945b7e52018-02-14 06:58:08 +00001068
Hal Finkelccc70902014-07-22 16:58:55 +00001069``align <n>``
1070 This indicates that the pointer value may be assumed by the optimizer to
1071 have the specified alignment.
1072
1073 Note that this attribute has additional semantics when combined with the
1074 ``byval`` attribute.
1075
Sean Silva1703e702014-04-08 21:06:22 +00001076.. _noalias:
1077
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001078``noalias``
Hal Finkel12d36302014-11-21 02:22:46 +00001079 This indicates that objects accessed via pointer values
1080 :ref:`based <pointeraliasing>` on the argument or return value are not also
1081 accessed, during the execution of the function, via pointer values not
1082 *based* on the argument or return value. The attribute on a return value
1083 also has additional semantics described below. The caller shares the
1084 responsibility with the callee for ensuring that these requirements are met.
1085 For further details, please see the discussion of the NoAlias response in
1086 :ref:`alias analysis <Must, May, or No>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001087
1088 Note that this definition of ``noalias`` is intentionally similar
Hal Finkel12d36302014-11-21 02:22:46 +00001089 to the definition of ``restrict`` in C99 for function arguments.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001090
1091 For function return values, C99's ``restrict`` is not meaningful,
Hal Finkel12d36302014-11-21 02:22:46 +00001092 while LLVM's ``noalias`` is. Furthermore, the semantics of the ``noalias``
1093 attribute on return values are stronger than the semantics of the attribute
1094 when used on function arguments. On function return values, the ``noalias``
1095 attribute indicates that the function acts like a system memory allocation
1096 function, returning a pointer to allocated storage disjoint from the
1097 storage for any other object accessible to the caller.
1098
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001099``nocapture``
1100 This indicates that the callee does not make any copies of the
1101 pointer that outlive the callee itself. This is not a valid
David Majnemer7f324202016-05-26 17:36:22 +00001102 attribute for return values. Addresses used in volatile operations
1103 are considered to be captured.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001104
1105.. _nest:
1106
1107``nest``
1108 This indicates that the pointer parameter can be excised using the
1109 :ref:`trampoline intrinsics <int_trampoline>`. This is not a valid
Stephen Linb8bd2322013-04-20 05:14:40 +00001110 attribute for return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
1111
1112``returned``
Stephen Linfec5b0b2013-06-20 21:55:10 +00001113 This indicates that the function always returns the argument as its return
Hal Finkel3b66caa2016-07-10 21:52:39 +00001114 value. This is a hint to the optimizer and code generator used when
1115 generating the caller, allowing value propagation, tail call optimization,
1116 and omission of register saves and restores in some cases; it is not
1117 checked or enforced when generating the callee. The parameter and the
1118 function return type must be valid operands for the
1119 :ref:`bitcast instruction <i_bitcast>`. This is not a valid attribute for
1120 return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001121
Nick Lewyckyd52b1522014-05-20 01:23:40 +00001122``nonnull``
1123 This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is not null. This
1124 attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. This is not
1125 checked or enforced by LLVM, the caller must ensure that the pointer
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00001126 passed in is non-null, or the callee must ensure that the returned pointer
Nick Lewyckyd52b1522014-05-20 01:23:40 +00001127 is non-null.
1128
Hal Finkelb0407ba2014-07-18 15:51:28 +00001129``dereferenceable(<n>)``
1130 This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is dereferenceable. This
1131 attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. A pointer that
1132 is dereferenceable can be loaded from speculatively without a risk of
1133 trapping. The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable must be provided
1134 in parentheses. It is legal for the number of bytes to be less than the
1135 size of the pointee type. The ``nonnull`` attribute does not imply
1136 dereferenceability (consider a pointer to one element past the end of an
1137 array), however ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` does imply ``nonnull`` in
1138 ``addrspace(0)`` (which is the default address space).
1139
Sanjoy Das31ea6d12015-04-16 20:29:50 +00001140``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)``
1141 This indicates that the parameter or return value isn't both
1142 non-null and non-dereferenceable (up to ``<n>`` bytes) at the same
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001143 time. All non-null pointers tagged with
Sanjoy Das31ea6d12015-04-16 20:29:50 +00001144 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` are ``dereferenceable(<n>)``.
1145 For address space 0 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` implies that
1146 a pointer is exactly one of ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` or ``null``,
1147 and in other address spaces ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)``
1148 implies that a pointer is at least one of ``dereferenceable(<n>)``
1149 or ``null`` (i.e. it may be both ``null`` and
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001150 ``dereferenceable(<n>)``). This attribute may only be applied to
Sanjoy Das31ea6d12015-04-16 20:29:50 +00001151 pointer typed parameters.
1152
Manman Renf46262e2016-03-29 17:37:21 +00001153``swiftself``
1154 This indicates that the parameter is the self/context parameter. This is not
1155 a valid attribute for return values and can only be applied to one
1156 parameter.
1157
Manman Ren9bfd0d02016-04-01 21:41:15 +00001158``swifterror``
1159 This attribute is motivated to model and optimize Swift error handling. It
1160 can be applied to a parameter with pointer to pointer type or a
1161 pointer-sized alloca. At the call site, the actual argument that corresponds
Arnold Schwaighofer6c57f4f2016-09-10 19:42:53 +00001162 to a ``swifterror`` parameter has to come from a ``swifterror`` alloca or
1163 the ``swifterror`` parameter of the caller. A ``swifterror`` value (either
1164 the parameter or the alloca) can only be loaded and stored from, or used as
1165 a ``swifterror`` argument. This is not a valid attribute for return values
1166 and can only be applied to one parameter.
Manman Ren9bfd0d02016-04-01 21:41:15 +00001167
1168 These constraints allow the calling convention to optimize access to
1169 ``swifterror`` variables by associating them with a specific register at
1170 call boundaries rather than placing them in memory. Since this does change
1171 the calling convention, a function which uses the ``swifterror`` attribute
1172 on a parameter is not ABI-compatible with one which does not.
1173
1174 These constraints also allow LLVM to assume that a ``swifterror`` argument
1175 does not alias any other memory visible within a function and that a
1176 ``swifterror`` alloca passed as an argument does not escape.
1177
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001178.. _gc:
1179
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00001180Garbage Collector Strategy Names
1181--------------------------------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001182
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00001183Each function may specify a garbage collector strategy name, which is simply a
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001184string:
1185
1186.. code-block:: llvm
1187
1188 define void @f() gc "name" { ... }
1189
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00001190The supported values of *name* includes those :ref:`built in to LLVM
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001191<builtin-gc-strategies>` and any provided by loaded plugins. Specifying a GC
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00001192strategy will cause the compiler to alter its output in order to support the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001193named garbage collection algorithm. Note that LLVM itself does not contain a
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00001194garbage collector, this functionality is restricted to generating machine code
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00001195which can interoperate with a collector provided externally.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001196
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001197.. _prefixdata:
1198
1199Prefix Data
1200-----------
1201
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001202Prefix data is data associated with a function which the code
1203generator will emit immediately before the function's entrypoint.
1204The purpose of this feature is to allow frontends to associate
1205language-specific runtime metadata with specific functions and make it
1206available through the function pointer while still allowing the
1207function pointer to be called.
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001208
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001209To access the data for a given function, a program may bitcast the
1210function pointer to a pointer to the constant's type and dereference
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001211index -1. This implies that the IR symbol points just past the end of
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001212the prefix data. For instance, take the example of a function annotated
1213with a single ``i32``,
1214
1215.. code-block:: llvm
1216
1217 define void @f() prefix i32 123 { ... }
1218
1219The prefix data can be referenced as,
1220
1221.. code-block:: llvm
1222
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00001223 %0 = bitcast void* () @f to i32*
1224 %a = getelementptr inbounds i32, i32* %0, i32 -1
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00001225 %b = load i32, i32* %a
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001226
1227Prefix data is laid out as if it were an initializer for a global variable
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001228of the prefix data's type. The function will be placed such that the
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001229beginning of the prefix data is aligned. This means that if the size
1230of the prefix data is not a multiple of the alignment size, the
1231function's entrypoint will not be aligned. If alignment of the
1232function's entrypoint is desired, padding must be added to the prefix
1233data.
1234
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001235A function may have prefix data but no body. This has similar semantics
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001236to the ``available_externally`` linkage in that the data may be used by the
1237optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file.
1238
1239.. _prologuedata:
1240
1241Prologue Data
1242-------------
1243
1244The ``prologue`` attribute allows arbitrary code (encoded as bytes) to
1245be inserted prior to the function body. This can be used for enabling
1246function hot-patching and instrumentation.
1247
1248To maintain the semantics of ordinary function calls, the prologue data must
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001249have a particular format. Specifically, it must begin with a sequence of
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001250bytes which decode to a sequence of machine instructions, valid for the
1251module's target, which transfer control to the point immediately succeeding
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001252the prologue data, without performing any other visible action. This allows
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001253the inliner and other passes to reason about the semantics of the function
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001254definition without needing to reason about the prologue data. Obviously this
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001255makes the format of the prologue data highly target dependent.
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001256
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001257A trivial example of valid prologue data for the x86 architecture is ``i8 144``,
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001258which encodes the ``nop`` instruction:
1259
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00001260.. code-block:: text
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001261
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001262 define void @f() prologue i8 144 { ... }
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001263
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001264Generally prologue data can be formed by encoding a relative branch instruction
1265which skips the metadata, as in this example of valid prologue data for the
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001266x86_64 architecture, where the first two bytes encode ``jmp .+10``:
1267
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00001268.. code-block:: text
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001269
1270 %0 = type <{ i8, i8, i8* }>
1271
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001272 define void @f() prologue %0 <{ i8 235, i8 8, i8* @md}> { ... }
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001273
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001274A function may have prologue data but no body. This has similar semantics
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001275to the ``available_externally`` linkage in that the data may be used by the
1276optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file.
1277
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00001278.. _personalityfn:
1279
1280Personality Function
David Majnemerc5ad8a92015-06-17 21:21:16 +00001281--------------------
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00001282
1283The ``personality`` attribute permits functions to specify what function
1284to use for exception handling.
1285
Bill Wendling63b88192013-02-06 06:52:58 +00001286.. _attrgrp:
1287
1288Attribute Groups
1289----------------
1290
1291Attribute groups are groups of attributes that are referenced by objects within
1292the IR. They are important for keeping ``.ll`` files readable, because a lot of
1293functions will use the same set of attributes. In the degenerative case of a
1294``.ll`` file that corresponds to a single ``.c`` file, the single attribute
1295group will capture the important command line flags used to build that file.
1296
1297An attribute group is a module-level object. To use an attribute group, an
1298object references the attribute group's ID (e.g. ``#37``). An object may refer
1299to more than one attribute group. In that situation, the attributes from the
1300different groups are merged.
1301
1302Here is an example of attribute groups for a function that should always be
1303inlined, has a stack alignment of 4, and which shouldn't use SSE instructions:
1304
1305.. code-block:: llvm
1306
1307 ; Target-independent attributes:
Eli Bendersky97ad9242013-04-18 16:11:44 +00001308 attributes #0 = { alwaysinline alignstack=4 }
Bill Wendling63b88192013-02-06 06:52:58 +00001309
1310 ; Target-dependent attributes:
Eli Bendersky97ad9242013-04-18 16:11:44 +00001311 attributes #1 = { "no-sse" }
Bill Wendling63b88192013-02-06 06:52:58 +00001312
1313 ; Function @f has attributes: alwaysinline, alignstack=4, and "no-sse".
1314 define void @f() #0 #1 { ... }
1315
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001316.. _fnattrs:
1317
1318Function Attributes
1319-------------------
1320
1321Function attributes are set to communicate additional information about
1322a function. Function attributes are considered to be part of the
1323function, not of the function type, so functions with different function
1324attributes can have the same function type.
1325
1326Function attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified.
1327If multiple attributes are needed, they are space separated. For
1328example:
1329
1330.. code-block:: llvm
1331
1332 define void @f() noinline { ... }
1333 define void @f() alwaysinline { ... }
1334 define void @f() alwaysinline optsize { ... }
1335 define void @f() optsize { ... }
1336
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001337``alignstack(<n>)``
1338 This attribute indicates that, when emitting the prologue and
1339 epilogue, the backend should forcibly align the stack pointer.
1340 Specify the desired alignment, which must be a power of two, in
1341 parentheses.
George Burgess IV278199f2016-04-12 01:05:35 +00001342``allocsize(<EltSizeParam>[, <NumEltsParam>])``
1343 This attribute indicates that the annotated function will always return at
1344 least a given number of bytes (or null). Its arguments are zero-indexed
1345 parameter numbers; if one argument is provided, then it's assumed that at
1346 least ``CallSite.Args[EltSizeParam]`` bytes will be available at the
1347 returned pointer. If two are provided, then it's assumed that
1348 ``CallSite.Args[EltSizeParam] * CallSite.Args[NumEltsParam]`` bytes are
1349 available. The referenced parameters must be integer types. No assumptions
1350 are made about the contents of the returned block of memory.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001351``alwaysinline``
1352 This attribute indicates that the inliner should attempt to inline
1353 this function into callers whenever possible, ignoring any active
1354 inlining size threshold for this caller.
Michael Gottesman41748d72013-06-27 00:25:01 +00001355``builtin``
1356 This indicates that the callee function at a call site should be
1357 recognized as a built-in function, even though the function's declaration
Michael Gottesman3a6a9672013-07-02 21:32:56 +00001358 uses the ``nobuiltin`` attribute. This is only valid at call sites for
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +00001359 direct calls to functions that are declared with the ``nobuiltin``
Michael Gottesman41748d72013-06-27 00:25:01 +00001360 attribute.
Michael Gottesman296adb82013-06-27 22:48:08 +00001361``cold``
1362 This attribute indicates that this function is rarely called. When
1363 computing edge weights, basic blocks post-dominated by a cold
1364 function call are also considered to be cold; and, thus, given low
1365 weight.
Owen Anderson85fa7d52015-05-26 23:48:40 +00001366``convergent``
Justin Lebard5fb6952016-02-09 23:03:17 +00001367 In some parallel execution models, there exist operations that cannot be
1368 made control-dependent on any additional values. We call such operations
Justin Lebar58535b12016-02-17 17:46:41 +00001369 ``convergent``, and mark them with this attribute.
Justin Lebard5fb6952016-02-09 23:03:17 +00001370
Justin Lebar58535b12016-02-17 17:46:41 +00001371 The ``convergent`` attribute may appear on functions or call/invoke
1372 instructions. When it appears on a function, it indicates that calls to
1373 this function should not be made control-dependent on additional values.
Justin Bognera4635372016-07-06 20:02:45 +00001374 For example, the intrinsic ``llvm.nvvm.barrier0`` is ``convergent``, so
Justin Lebard5fb6952016-02-09 23:03:17 +00001375 calls to this intrinsic cannot be made control-dependent on additional
Justin Lebar58535b12016-02-17 17:46:41 +00001376 values.
Justin Lebard5fb6952016-02-09 23:03:17 +00001377
Justin Lebar58535b12016-02-17 17:46:41 +00001378 When it appears on a call/invoke, the ``convergent`` attribute indicates
1379 that we should treat the call as though we're calling a convergent
1380 function. This is particularly useful on indirect calls; without this we
1381 may treat such calls as though the target is non-convergent.
1382
1383 The optimizer may remove the ``convergent`` attribute on functions when it
1384 can prove that the function does not execute any convergent operations.
1385 Similarly, the optimizer may remove ``convergent`` on calls/invokes when it
1386 can prove that the call/invoke cannot call a convergent function.
Vaivaswatha Nagarajfb3f4902015-12-16 16:16:19 +00001387``inaccessiblememonly``
1388 This attribute indicates that the function may only access memory that
1389 is not accessible by the module being compiled. This is a weaker form
1390 of ``readnone``.
1391``inaccessiblemem_or_argmemonly``
1392 This attribute indicates that the function may only access memory that is
1393 either not accessible by the module being compiled, or is pointed to
1394 by its pointer arguments. This is a weaker form of ``argmemonly``
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001395``inlinehint``
1396 This attribute indicates that the source code contained a hint that
1397 inlining this function is desirable (such as the "inline" keyword in
1398 C/C++). It is just a hint; it imposes no requirements on the
1399 inliner.
Tom Roeder44cb65f2014-06-05 19:29:43 +00001400``jumptable``
1401 This attribute indicates that the function should be added to a
1402 jump-instruction table at code-generation time, and that all address-taken
1403 references to this function should be replaced with a reference to the
1404 appropriate jump-instruction-table function pointer. Note that this creates
1405 a new pointer for the original function, which means that code that depends
1406 on function-pointer identity can break. So, any function annotated with
1407 ``jumptable`` must also be ``unnamed_addr``.
Andrea Di Biagio9b5d23b2013-08-09 18:42:18 +00001408``minsize``
1409 This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator
1410 passes make choices that keep the code size of this function as small
Andrew Trickd4d1d9c2013-10-31 17:18:07 +00001411 as possible and perform optimizations that may sacrifice runtime
Andrea Di Biagio9b5d23b2013-08-09 18:42:18 +00001412 performance in order to minimize the size of the generated code.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001413``naked``
1414 This attribute disables prologue / epilogue emission for the
1415 function. This can have very system-specific consequences.
Sumanth Gundapaneni6af104e2017-07-28 22:26:22 +00001416``no-jump-tables``
1417 When this attribute is set to true, the jump tables and lookup tables that
1418 can be generated from a switch case lowering are disabled.
Eli Bendersky97ad9242013-04-18 16:11:44 +00001419``nobuiltin``
Michael Gottesman41748d72013-06-27 00:25:01 +00001420 This indicates that the callee function at a call site is not recognized as
1421 a built-in function. LLVM will retain the original call and not replace it
1422 with equivalent code based on the semantics of the built-in function, unless
1423 the call site uses the ``builtin`` attribute. This is valid at call sites
1424 and on function declarations and definitions.
Bill Wendlingbf902f12013-02-06 06:22:58 +00001425``noduplicate``
1426 This attribute indicates that calls to the function cannot be
1427 duplicated. A call to a ``noduplicate`` function may be moved
1428 within its parent function, but may not be duplicated within
1429 its parent function.
1430
1431 A function containing a ``noduplicate`` call may still
1432 be an inlining candidate, provided that the call is not
1433 duplicated by inlining. That implies that the function has
1434 internal linkage and only has one call site, so the original
1435 call is dead after inlining.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001436``noimplicitfloat``
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00001437 This attributes disables implicit floating-point instructions.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001438``noinline``
1439 This attribute indicates that the inliner should never inline this
1440 function in any situation. This attribute may not be used together
1441 with the ``alwaysinline`` attribute.
Sean Silva1cbbcf12013-08-06 19:34:37 +00001442``nonlazybind``
1443 This attribute suppresses lazy symbol binding for the function. This
1444 may make calls to the function faster, at the cost of extra program
1445 startup time if the function is not called during program startup.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001446``noredzone``
1447 This attribute indicates that the code generator should not use a
1448 red zone, even if the target-specific ABI normally permits it.
1449``noreturn``
1450 This function attribute indicates that the function never returns
1451 normally. This produces undefined behavior at runtime if the
1452 function ever does dynamically return.
James Molloye6f87ca2015-11-06 10:32:53 +00001453``norecurse``
1454 This function attribute indicates that the function does not call itself
1455 either directly or indirectly down any possible call path. This produces
1456 undefined behavior at runtime if the function ever does recurse.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001457``nounwind``
Reid Kleckner96d01132015-02-11 01:23:16 +00001458 This function attribute indicates that the function never raises an
1459 exception. If the function does raise an exception, its runtime
1460 behavior is undefined. However, functions marked nounwind may still
1461 trap or generate asynchronous exceptions. Exception handling schemes
1462 that are recognized by LLVM to handle asynchronous exceptions, such
1463 as SEH, will still provide their implementation defined semantics.
Matt Morehouse31819412018-03-22 19:50:10 +00001464``optforfuzzing``
1465 This attribute indicates that this function should be optimized
1466 for maximum fuzzing signal.
Andrea Di Biagio377496b2013-08-23 11:53:55 +00001467``optnone``
Paul Robinsona2550a62015-11-30 21:56:16 +00001468 This function attribute indicates that most optimization passes will skip
1469 this function, with the exception of interprocedural optimization passes.
1470 Code generation defaults to the "fast" instruction selector.
Andrea Di Biagio377496b2013-08-23 11:53:55 +00001471 This attribute cannot be used together with the ``alwaysinline``
1472 attribute; this attribute is also incompatible
1473 with the ``minsize`` attribute and the ``optsize`` attribute.
Andrew Trickd4d1d9c2013-10-31 17:18:07 +00001474
Paul Robinsondcbe35b2013-11-18 21:44:03 +00001475 This attribute requires the ``noinline`` attribute to be specified on
1476 the function as well, so the function is never inlined into any caller.
Andrea Di Biagio377496b2013-08-23 11:53:55 +00001477 Only functions with the ``alwaysinline`` attribute are valid
Paul Robinsondcbe35b2013-11-18 21:44:03 +00001478 candidates for inlining into the body of this function.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001479``optsize``
1480 This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator
1481 passes make choices that keep the code size of this function low,
Andrea Di Biagio9b5d23b2013-08-09 18:42:18 +00001482 and otherwise do optimizations specifically to reduce code size as
1483 long as they do not significantly impact runtime performance.
Sanjoy Dasc0441c22016-04-19 05:24:47 +00001484``"patchable-function"``
1485 This attribute tells the code generator that the code
1486 generated for this function needs to follow certain conventions that
1487 make it possible for a runtime function to patch over it later.
1488 The exact effect of this attribute depends on its string value,
Charles Davise9c32c72016-08-08 21:20:15 +00001489 for which there currently is one legal possibility:
Sanjoy Dasc0441c22016-04-19 05:24:47 +00001490
1491 * ``"prologue-short-redirect"`` - This style of patchable
1492 function is intended to support patching a function prologue to
1493 redirect control away from the function in a thread safe
1494 manner. It guarantees that the first instruction of the
1495 function will be large enough to accommodate a short jump
1496 instruction, and will be sufficiently aligned to allow being
1497 fully changed via an atomic compare-and-swap instruction.
1498 While the first requirement can be satisfied by inserting large
1499 enough NOP, LLVM can and will try to re-purpose an existing
1500 instruction (i.e. one that would have to be emitted anyway) as
1501 the patchable instruction larger than a short jump.
1502
1503 ``"prologue-short-redirect"`` is currently only supported on
1504 x86-64.
1505
1506 This attribute by itself does not imply restrictions on
1507 inter-procedural optimizations. All of the semantic effects the
1508 patching may have to be separately conveyed via the linkage type.
whitequarked54b4a2017-06-21 18:46:50 +00001509``"probe-stack"``
1510 This attribute indicates that the function will trigger a guard region
1511 in the end of the stack. It ensures that accesses to the stack must be
1512 no further apart than the size of the guard region to a previous
1513 access of the stack. It takes one required string value, the name of
1514 the stack probing function that will be called.
1515
1516 If a function that has a ``"probe-stack"`` attribute is inlined into
1517 a function with another ``"probe-stack"`` attribute, the resulting
1518 function has the ``"probe-stack"`` attribute of the caller. If a
1519 function that has a ``"probe-stack"`` attribute is inlined into a
1520 function that has no ``"probe-stack"`` attribute at all, the resulting
1521 function has the ``"probe-stack"`` attribute of the callee.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001522``readnone``
Nick Lewyckyc2ec0722013-07-06 00:29:58 +00001523 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function computes its
1524 result (or decides to unwind an exception) based strictly on its arguments,
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001525 without dereferencing any pointer arguments or otherwise accessing
1526 any mutable state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to
1527 caller functions. It does not write through any pointer arguments
1528 (including ``byval`` arguments) and never changes any state visible
Sanjoy Das5be2e842017-02-13 23:19:07 +00001529 to callers. This means while it cannot unwind exceptions by calling
1530 the ``C++`` exception throwing methods (since they write to memory), there may
1531 be non-``C++`` mechanisms that throw exceptions without writing to LLVM
1532 visible memory.
Andrew Trickd4d1d9c2013-10-31 17:18:07 +00001533
Nick Lewyckyc2ec0722013-07-06 00:29:58 +00001534 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not
1535 dereference that pointer argument, even though it may read or write the
Nick Lewyckyefe31f22013-07-06 01:04:47 +00001536 memory that the pointer points to if accessed through other pointers.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001537``readonly``
Nick Lewyckyc2ec0722013-07-06 00:29:58 +00001538 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function does not write
1539 through any pointer arguments (including ``byval`` arguments) or otherwise
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001540 modify any state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to
1541 caller functions. It may dereference pointer arguments and read
1542 state that may be set in the caller. A readonly function always
1543 returns the same value (or unwinds an exception identically) when
Sanjoy Das5be2e842017-02-13 23:19:07 +00001544 called with the same set of arguments and global state. This means while it
1545 cannot unwind exceptions by calling the ``C++`` exception throwing methods
1546 (since they write to memory), there may be non-``C++`` mechanisms that throw
1547 exceptions without writing to LLVM visible memory.
Andrew Trickd4d1d9c2013-10-31 17:18:07 +00001548
Nick Lewyckyc2ec0722013-07-06 00:29:58 +00001549 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not write
1550 through this pointer argument, even though it may write to the memory that
1551 the pointer points to.
whitequark08b20352017-06-22 23:22:36 +00001552``"stack-probe-size"``
1553 This attribute controls the behavior of stack probes: either
1554 the ``"probe-stack"`` attribute, or ABI-required stack probes, if any.
1555 It defines the size of the guard region. It ensures that if the function
1556 may use more stack space than the size of the guard region, stack probing
1557 sequence will be emitted. It takes one required integer value, which
1558 is 4096 by default.
1559
1560 If a function that has a ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute is inlined into
1561 a function with another ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute, the resulting
1562 function has the ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute that has the lower
1563 numeric value. If a function that has a ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute is
1564 inlined into a function that has no ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute
1565 at all, the resulting function has the ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute
1566 of the callee.
Hans Wennborg89c35fc2018-02-23 13:46:25 +00001567``"no-stack-arg-probe"``
1568 This attribute disables ABI-required stack probes, if any.
Nicolai Haehnle84c9f992016-07-04 08:01:29 +00001569``writeonly``
1570 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function may write to but
1571 does not read from memory.
1572
1573 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function may write to but
1574 does not read through this pointer argument (even though it may read from
1575 the memory that the pointer points to).
Igor Laevsky39d662f2015-07-11 10:30:36 +00001576``argmemonly``
1577 This attribute indicates that the only memory accesses inside function are
1578 loads and stores from objects pointed to by its pointer-typed arguments,
1579 with arbitrary offsets. Or in other words, all memory operations in the
1580 function can refer to memory only using pointers based on its function
1581 arguments.
1582 Note that ``argmemonly`` can be used together with ``readonly`` attribute
1583 in order to specify that function reads only from its arguments.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001584``returns_twice``
1585 This attribute indicates that this function can return twice. The C
1586 ``setjmp`` is an example of such a function. The compiler disables
1587 some optimizations (like tail calls) in the caller of these
1588 functions.
Peter Collingbourne82437bf2015-06-15 21:07:11 +00001589``safestack``
1590 This attribute indicates that
1591 `SafeStack <http://clang.llvm.org/docs/SafeStack.html>`_
1592 protection is enabled for this function.
1593
1594 If a function that has a ``safestack`` attribute is inlined into a
1595 function that doesn't have a ``safestack`` attribute or which has an
1596 ``ssp``, ``sspstrong`` or ``sspreq`` attribute, then the resulting
1597 function will have a ``safestack`` attribute.
Kostya Serebryanycf880b92013-02-26 06:58:09 +00001598``sanitize_address``
1599 This attribute indicates that AddressSanitizer checks
1600 (dynamic address safety analysis) are enabled for this function.
1601``sanitize_memory``
1602 This attribute indicates that MemorySanitizer checks (dynamic detection
1603 of accesses to uninitialized memory) are enabled for this function.
1604``sanitize_thread``
1605 This attribute indicates that ThreadSanitizer checks
1606 (dynamic thread safety analysis) are enabled for this function.
Evgeniy Stepanovc667c1f2017-12-09 00:21:41 +00001607``sanitize_hwaddress``
1608 This attribute indicates that HWAddressSanitizer checks
1609 (dynamic address safety analysis based on tagged pointers) are enabled for
1610 this function.
Matt Arsenaultb19b57e2017-04-28 20:25:27 +00001611``speculatable``
1612 This function attribute indicates that the function does not have any
1613 effects besides calculating its result and does not have undefined behavior.
1614 Note that ``speculatable`` is not enough to conclude that along any
Xin Tongc7180202017-05-02 23:24:12 +00001615 particular execution path the number of calls to this function will not be
Matt Arsenaultb19b57e2017-04-28 20:25:27 +00001616 externally observable. This attribute is only valid on functions
1617 and declarations, not on individual call sites. If a function is
1618 incorrectly marked as speculatable and really does exhibit
1619 undefined behavior, the undefined behavior may be observed even
1620 if the call site is dead code.
1621
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001622``ssp``
1623 This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00001624 smashing protector. It is in the form of a "canary" --- a random value
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001625 placed on the stack before the local variables that's checked upon
1626 return from the function to see if it has been overwritten. A
1627 heuristic is used to determine if a function needs stack protectors
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001628 or not. The heuristic used will enable protectors for functions with:
Dmitri Gribenko69b56472013-01-29 23:14:41 +00001629
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001630 - Character arrays larger than ``ssp-buffer-size`` (default 8).
1631 - Aggregates containing character arrays larger than ``ssp-buffer-size``.
1632 - Calls to alloca() with variable sizes or constant sizes greater than
1633 ``ssp-buffer-size``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001634
Josh Magee24c7f062014-02-01 01:36:16 +00001635 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1636 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1637
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001638 If a function that has an ``ssp`` attribute is inlined into a
1639 function that doesn't have an ``ssp`` attribute, then the resulting
1640 function will have an ``ssp`` attribute.
1641``sspreq``
1642 This attribute indicates that the function should *always* emit a
1643 stack smashing protector. This overrides the ``ssp`` function
1644 attribute.
1645
Josh Magee24c7f062014-02-01 01:36:16 +00001646 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1647 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1648 The specific layout rules are:
1649
1650 #. Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
1651 (``>= ssp-buffer-size``) are closest to the stack protector.
1652 #. Small arrays and structures containing small arrays
1653 (``< ssp-buffer-size``) are 2nd closest to the protector.
1654 #. Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the
1655 protector.
1656
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001657 If a function that has an ``sspreq`` attribute is inlined into a
1658 function that doesn't have an ``sspreq`` attribute or which has an
Bill Wendlingd154e2832013-01-23 06:41:41 +00001659 ``ssp`` or ``sspstrong`` attribute, then the resulting function will have
1660 an ``sspreq`` attribute.
1661``sspstrong``
1662 This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack smashing
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001663 protector. This attribute causes a strong heuristic to be used when
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001664 determining if a function needs stack protectors. The strong heuristic
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001665 will enable protectors for functions with:
Dmitri Gribenko69b56472013-01-29 23:14:41 +00001666
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001667 - Arrays of any size and type
1668 - Aggregates containing an array of any size and type.
1669 - Calls to alloca().
1670 - Local variables that have had their address taken.
1671
Josh Magee24c7f062014-02-01 01:36:16 +00001672 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1673 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1674 The specific layout rules are:
1675
1676 #. Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
1677 (``>= ssp-buffer-size``) are closest to the stack protector.
1678 #. Small arrays and structures containing small arrays
1679 (``< ssp-buffer-size``) are 2nd closest to the protector.
1680 #. Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the
1681 protector.
1682
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001683 This overrides the ``ssp`` function attribute.
Bill Wendlingd154e2832013-01-23 06:41:41 +00001684
1685 If a function that has an ``sspstrong`` attribute is inlined into a
1686 function that doesn't have an ``sspstrong`` attribute, then the
1687 resulting function will have an ``sspstrong`` attribute.
Andrew Kaylor53a5fbb2017-08-14 21:15:13 +00001688``strictfp``
1689 This attribute indicates that the function was called from a scope that
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00001690 requires strict floating-point semantics. LLVM will not attempt any
1691 optimizations that require assumptions about the floating-point rounding
1692 mode or that might alter the state of floating-point status flags that
Andrew Kaylor53a5fbb2017-08-14 21:15:13 +00001693 might otherwise be set or cleared by calling this function.
Reid Kleckner5a2ab2b2015-03-04 00:08:56 +00001694``"thunk"``
1695 This attribute indicates that the function will delegate to some other
1696 function with a tail call. The prototype of a thunk should not be used for
1697 optimization purposes. The caller is expected to cast the thunk prototype to
1698 match the thunk target prototype.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001699``uwtable``
1700 This attribute indicates that the ABI being targeted requires that
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00001701 an unwind table entry be produced for this function even if we can
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001702 show that no exceptions passes by it. This is normally the case for
1703 the ELF x86-64 abi, but it can be disabled for some compilation
1704 units.
Oren Ben Simhonfdd72fd2018-03-17 13:29:46 +00001705``nocf_check``
1706 This attribute indicates that no control-flow check will be perfomed on
1707 the attributed entity. It disables -fcf-protection=<> for a specific
1708 entity to fine grain the HW control flow protection mechanism. The flag
1709 is target independant and currently appertains to a function or function
1710 pointer.
Vlad Tsyrklevichd17f61e2018-04-03 20:10:40 +00001711``shadowcallstack``
1712 This attribute indicates that the ShadowCallStack checks are enabled for
1713 the function. The instrumentation checks that the return address for the
1714 function has not changed between the function prolog and eiplog. It is
1715 currently x86_64-specific.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001716
Javed Absarf3d79042017-05-11 12:28:08 +00001717.. _glattrs:
1718
1719Global Attributes
1720-----------------
1721
1722Attributes may be set to communicate additional information about a global variable.
1723Unlike :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>`, attributes on a global variable
1724are grouped into a single :ref:`attribute group <attrgrp>`.
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00001725
1726.. _opbundles:
1727
1728Operand Bundles
1729---------------
1730
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00001731Operand bundles are tagged sets of SSA values that can be associated
Sanjoy Dasb0e9d4a52015-09-25 00:05:40 +00001732with certain LLVM instructions (currently only ``call`` s and
1733``invoke`` s). In a way they are like metadata, but dropping them is
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00001734incorrect and will change program semantics.
1735
1736Syntax::
David Majnemer34cacb42015-10-22 01:46:38 +00001737
Sanjoy Das9f3c1252015-11-21 09:12:07 +00001738 operand bundle set ::= '[' operand bundle (, operand bundle )* ']'
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00001739 operand bundle ::= tag '(' [ bundle operand ] (, bundle operand )* ')'
1740 bundle operand ::= SSA value
1741 tag ::= string constant
1742
1743Operand bundles are **not** part of a function's signature, and a
1744given function may be called from multiple places with different kinds
1745of operand bundles. This reflects the fact that the operand bundles
1746are conceptually a part of the ``call`` (or ``invoke``), not the
1747callee being dispatched to.
1748
1749Operand bundles are a generic mechanism intended to support
1750runtime-introspection-like functionality for managed languages. While
1751the exact semantics of an operand bundle depend on the bundle tag,
1752there are certain limitations to how much the presence of an operand
1753bundle can influence the semantics of a program. These restrictions
1754are described as the semantics of an "unknown" operand bundle. As
1755long as the behavior of an operand bundle is describable within these
1756restrictions, LLVM does not need to have special knowledge of the
1757operand bundle to not miscompile programs containing it.
1758
David Majnemer34cacb42015-10-22 01:46:38 +00001759- The bundle operands for an unknown operand bundle escape in unknown
1760 ways before control is transferred to the callee or invokee.
1761- Calls and invokes with operand bundles have unknown read / write
1762 effect on the heap on entry and exit (even if the call target is
Sylvestre Ledru84666a12016-02-14 20:16:22 +00001763 ``readnone`` or ``readonly``), unless they're overridden with
Sanjoy Das98a341b2015-10-22 03:12:22 +00001764 callsite specific attributes.
1765- An operand bundle at a call site cannot change the implementation
1766 of the called function. Inter-procedural optimizations work as
1767 usual as long as they take into account the first two properties.
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00001768
Sanjoy Dascdafd842015-11-11 21:38:02 +00001769More specific types of operand bundles are described below.
1770
Sanjoy Dasb51325d2016-03-11 19:08:34 +00001771.. _deopt_opbundles:
1772
Sanjoy Dascdafd842015-11-11 21:38:02 +00001773Deoptimization Operand Bundles
1774^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
1775
Sanjoy Das9f3c1252015-11-21 09:12:07 +00001776Deoptimization operand bundles are characterized by the ``"deopt"``
Sanjoy Dascdafd842015-11-11 21:38:02 +00001777operand bundle tag. These operand bundles represent an alternate
1778"safe" continuation for the call site they're attached to, and can be
1779used by a suitable runtime to deoptimize the compiled frame at the
Sanjoy Das9f3c1252015-11-21 09:12:07 +00001780specified call site. There can be at most one ``"deopt"`` operand
1781bundle attached to a call site. Exact details of deoptimization is
1782out of scope for the language reference, but it usually involves
1783rewriting a compiled frame into a set of interpreted frames.
Sanjoy Dascdafd842015-11-11 21:38:02 +00001784
1785From the compiler's perspective, deoptimization operand bundles make
1786the call sites they're attached to at least ``readonly``. They read
1787through all of their pointer typed operands (even if they're not
1788otherwise escaped) and the entire visible heap. Deoptimization
1789operand bundles do not capture their operands except during
1790deoptimization, in which case control will not be returned to the
1791compiled frame.
1792
Sanjoy Das2d161452015-11-18 06:23:38 +00001793The inliner knows how to inline through calls that have deoptimization
1794operand bundles. Just like inlining through a normal call site
1795involves composing the normal and exceptional continuations, inlining
1796through a call site with a deoptimization operand bundle needs to
1797appropriately compose the "safe" deoptimization continuation. The
1798inliner does this by prepending the parent's deoptimization
1799continuation to every deoptimization continuation in the inlined body.
1800E.g. inlining ``@f`` into ``@g`` in the following example
1801
1802.. code-block:: llvm
1803
1804 define void @f() {
1805 call void @x() ;; no deopt state
1806 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 10) ]
1807 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 10), "unknown"(i8* null) ]
1808 ret void
1809 }
1810
1811 define void @g() {
1812 call void @f() [ "deopt"(i32 20) ]
1813 ret void
1814 }
1815
1816will result in
1817
1818.. code-block:: llvm
1819
1820 define void @g() {
1821 call void @x() ;; still no deopt state
1822 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 20, i32 10) ]
1823 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 20, i32 10), "unknown"(i8* null) ]
1824 ret void
1825 }
1826
1827It is the frontend's responsibility to structure or encode the
1828deoptimization state in a way that syntactically prepending the
1829caller's deoptimization state to the callee's deoptimization state is
1830semantically equivalent to composing the caller's deoptimization
1831continuation after the callee's deoptimization continuation.
1832
Joseph Tremoulete28885e2016-01-10 04:28:38 +00001833.. _ob_funclet:
1834
David Majnemer3bb88c02015-12-15 21:27:27 +00001835Funclet Operand Bundles
1836^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
1837
1838Funclet operand bundles are characterized by the ``"funclet"``
1839operand bundle tag. These operand bundles indicate that a call site
1840is within a particular funclet. There can be at most one
1841``"funclet"`` operand bundle attached to a call site and it must have
1842exactly one bundle operand.
1843
Joseph Tremoulete28885e2016-01-10 04:28:38 +00001844If any funclet EH pads have been "entered" but not "exited" (per the
1845`description in the EH doc\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
1846it is undefined behavior to execute a ``call`` or ``invoke`` which:
1847
1848* does not have a ``"funclet"`` bundle and is not a ``call`` to a nounwind
1849 intrinsic, or
1850* has a ``"funclet"`` bundle whose operand is not the most-recently-entered
1851 not-yet-exited funclet EH pad.
1852
1853Similarly, if no funclet EH pads have been entered-but-not-yet-exited,
1854executing a ``call`` or ``invoke`` with a ``"funclet"`` bundle is undefined behavior.
1855
Sanjoy Dasa34ce952016-01-20 19:50:25 +00001856GC Transition Operand Bundles
1857^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
1858
1859GC transition operand bundles are characterized by the
1860``"gc-transition"`` operand bundle tag. These operand bundles mark a
1861call as a transition between a function with one GC strategy to a
1862function with a different GC strategy. If coordinating the transition
1863between GC strategies requires additional code generation at the call
1864site, these bundles may contain any values that are needed by the
1865generated code. For more details, see :ref:`GC Transitions
1866<gc_transition_args>`.
1867
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001868.. _moduleasm:
1869
1870Module-Level Inline Assembly
1871----------------------------
1872
1873Modules may contain "module-level inline asm" blocks, which corresponds
1874to the GCC "file scope inline asm" blocks. These blocks are internally
1875concatenated by LLVM and treated as a single unit, but may be separated
1876in the ``.ll`` file if desired. The syntax is very simple:
1877
1878.. code-block:: llvm
1879
1880 module asm "inline asm code goes here"
1881 module asm "more can go here"
1882
1883The strings can contain any character by escaping non-printable
1884characters. The escape sequence used is simply "\\xx" where "xx" is the
1885two digit hex code for the number.
1886
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00001887Note that the assembly string *must* be parseable by LLVM's integrated assembler
1888(unless it is disabled), even when emitting a ``.s`` file.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001889
Eli Benderskyfdc529a2013-06-07 19:40:08 +00001890.. _langref_datalayout:
1891
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001892Data Layout
1893-----------
1894
1895A module may specify a target specific data layout string that specifies
1896how data is to be laid out in memory. The syntax for the data layout is
1897simply:
1898
1899.. code-block:: llvm
1900
1901 target datalayout = "layout specification"
1902
1903The *layout specification* consists of a list of specifications
1904separated by the minus sign character ('-'). Each specification starts
1905with a letter and may include other information after the letter to
1906define some aspect of the data layout. The specifications accepted are
1907as follows:
1908
1909``E``
1910 Specifies that the target lays out data in big-endian form. That is,
1911 the bits with the most significance have the lowest address
1912 location.
1913``e``
1914 Specifies that the target lays out data in little-endian form. That
1915 is, the bits with the least significance have the lowest address
1916 location.
1917``S<size>``
1918 Specifies the natural alignment of the stack in bits. Alignment
1919 promotion of stack variables is limited to the natural stack
1920 alignment to avoid dynamic stack realignment. The stack alignment
1921 must be a multiple of 8-bits. If omitted, the natural stack
1922 alignment defaults to "unspecified", which does not prevent any
1923 alignment promotions.
Dylan McKayced2fe62018-02-19 09:56:22 +00001924``P<address space>``
1925 Specifies the address space that corresponds to program memory.
1926 Harvard architectures can use this to specify what space LLVM
1927 should place things such as functions into. If omitted, the
1928 program memory space defaults to the default address space of 0,
1929 which corresponds to a Von Neumann architecture that has code
1930 and data in the same space.
Matt Arsenault3c1fc762017-04-10 22:27:50 +00001931``A<address space>``
Dylan McKayced2fe62018-02-19 09:56:22 +00001932 Specifies the address space of objects created by '``alloca``'.
Matt Arsenault3c1fc762017-04-10 22:27:50 +00001933 Defaults to the default address space of 0.
Elena Demikhovsky945b7e52018-02-14 06:58:08 +00001934``p[n]:<size>:<abi>:<pref>:<idx>``
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001935 This specifies the *size* of a pointer and its ``<abi>`` and
Elena Demikhovsky945b7e52018-02-14 06:58:08 +00001936 ``<pref>``\erred alignments for address space ``n``. The fourth parameter
1937 ``<idx>`` is a size of index that used for address calculation. If not
1938 specified, the default index size is equal to the pointer size. All sizes
1939 are in bits. The address space, ``n``, is optional, and if not specified,
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001940 denotes the default address space 0. The value of ``n`` must be
Rafael Espindolaabdd7262014-01-06 21:40:24 +00001941 in the range [1,2^23).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001942``i<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
1943 This specifies the alignment for an integer type of a given bit
1944 ``<size>``. The value of ``<size>`` must be in the range [1,2^23).
1945``v<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
1946 This specifies the alignment for a vector type of a given bit
1947 ``<size>``.
1948``f<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00001949 This specifies the alignment for a floating-point type of a given bit
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001950 ``<size>``. Only values of ``<size>`` that are supported by the target
1951 will work. 32 (float) and 64 (double) are supported on all targets; 80
1952 or 128 (different flavors of long double) are also supported on some
1953 targets.
Rafael Espindolaabdd7262014-01-06 21:40:24 +00001954``a:<abi>:<pref>``
1955 This specifies the alignment for an object of aggregate type.
Rafael Espindola58873562014-01-03 19:21:54 +00001956``m:<mangling>``
Reid Klecknerf8b51c52018-03-16 20:13:32 +00001957 If present, specifies that llvm names are mangled in the output. Symbols
1958 prefixed with the mangling escape character ``\01`` are passed through
1959 directly to the assembler without the escape character. The mangling style
Hans Wennborgd4245ac2014-01-15 02:49:17 +00001960 options are
1961
1962 * ``e``: ELF mangling: Private symbols get a ``.L`` prefix.
1963 * ``m``: Mips mangling: Private symbols get a ``$`` prefix.
1964 * ``o``: Mach-O mangling: Private symbols get ``L`` prefix. Other
1965 symbols get a ``_`` prefix.
Reid Klecknerf8b51c52018-03-16 20:13:32 +00001966 * ``x``: Windows x86 COFF mangling: Private symbols get the usual prefix.
1967 Regular C symbols get a ``_`` prefix. Functions with ``__stdcall``,
1968 ``__fastcall``, and ``__vectorcall`` have custom mangling that appends
1969 ``@N`` where N is the number of bytes used to pass parameters. C++ symbols
1970 starting with ``?`` are not mangled in any way.
1971 * ``w``: Windows COFF mangling: Similar to ``x``, except that normal C
1972 symbols do not receive a ``_`` prefix.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001973``n<size1>:<size2>:<size3>...``
1974 This specifies a set of native integer widths for the target CPU in
1975 bits. For example, it might contain ``n32`` for 32-bit PowerPC,
1976 ``n32:64`` for PowerPC 64, or ``n8:16:32:64`` for X86-64. Elements of
1977 this set are considered to support most general arithmetic operations
1978 efficiently.
Sanjoy Dasc6af5ea2016-07-28 23:43:38 +00001979``ni:<address space0>:<address space1>:<address space2>...``
1980 This specifies pointer types with the specified address spaces
1981 as :ref:`Non-Integral Pointer Type <nointptrtype>` s. The ``0``
1982 address space cannot be specified as non-integral.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001983
Rafael Espindolaabdd7262014-01-06 21:40:24 +00001984On every specification that takes a ``<abi>:<pref>``, specifying the
1985``<pref>`` alignment is optional. If omitted, the preceding ``:``
1986should be omitted too and ``<pref>`` will be equal to ``<abi>``.
1987
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001988When constructing the data layout for a given target, LLVM starts with a
1989default set of specifications which are then (possibly) overridden by
1990the specifications in the ``datalayout`` keyword. The default
1991specifications are given in this list:
1992
1993- ``E`` - big endian
Matt Arsenault24b49c42013-07-31 17:49:08 +00001994- ``p:64:64:64`` - 64-bit pointers with 64-bit alignment.
1995- ``p[n]:64:64:64`` - Other address spaces are assumed to be the
1996 same as the default address space.
Patrik Hagglunda832ab12013-01-30 09:02:06 +00001997- ``S0`` - natural stack alignment is unspecified
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001998- ``i1:8:8`` - i1 is 8-bit (byte) aligned
1999- ``i8:8:8`` - i8 is 8-bit (byte) aligned
2000- ``i16:16:16`` - i16 is 16-bit aligned
2001- ``i32:32:32`` - i32 is 32-bit aligned
2002- ``i64:32:64`` - i64 has ABI alignment of 32-bits but preferred
2003 alignment of 64-bits
Patrik Hagglunda832ab12013-01-30 09:02:06 +00002004- ``f16:16:16`` - half is 16-bit aligned
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002005- ``f32:32:32`` - float is 32-bit aligned
2006- ``f64:64:64`` - double is 64-bit aligned
Patrik Hagglunda832ab12013-01-30 09:02:06 +00002007- ``f128:128:128`` - quad is 128-bit aligned
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002008- ``v64:64:64`` - 64-bit vector is 64-bit aligned
2009- ``v128:128:128`` - 128-bit vector is 128-bit aligned
Rafael Espindolae8f4d582013-12-12 17:21:51 +00002010- ``a:0:64`` - aggregates are 64-bit aligned
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002011
2012When LLVM is determining the alignment for a given type, it uses the
2013following rules:
2014
2015#. If the type sought is an exact match for one of the specifications,
2016 that specification is used.
2017#. If no match is found, and the type sought is an integer type, then
2018 the smallest integer type that is larger than the bitwidth of the
2019 sought type is used. If none of the specifications are larger than
2020 the bitwidth then the largest integer type is used. For example,
2021 given the default specifications above, the i7 type will use the
2022 alignment of i8 (next largest) while both i65 and i256 will use the
2023 alignment of i64 (largest specified).
2024#. If no match is found, and the type sought is a vector type, then the
2025 largest vector type that is smaller than the sought vector type will
2026 be used as a fall back. This happens because <128 x double> can be
2027 implemented in terms of 64 <2 x double>, for example.
2028
2029The function of the data layout string may not be what you expect.
2030Notably, this is not a specification from the frontend of what alignment
2031the code generator should use.
2032
2033Instead, if specified, the target data layout is required to match what
2034the ultimate *code generator* expects. This string is used by the
2035mid-level optimizers to improve code, and this only works if it matches
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00002036what the ultimate code generator uses. There is no way to generate IR
2037that does not embed this target-specific detail into the IR. If you
2038don't specify the string, the default specifications will be used to
2039generate a Data Layout and the optimization phases will operate
2040accordingly and introduce target specificity into the IR with respect to
2041these default specifications.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002042
Bill Wendling5cc90842013-10-18 23:41:25 +00002043.. _langref_triple:
2044
2045Target Triple
2046-------------
2047
2048A module may specify a target triple string that describes the target
2049host. The syntax for the target triple is simply:
2050
2051.. code-block:: llvm
2052
2053 target triple = "x86_64-apple-macosx10.7.0"
2054
2055The *target triple* string consists of a series of identifiers delimited
2056by the minus sign character ('-'). The canonical forms are:
2057
2058::
2059
2060 ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM
2061 ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM-ENVIRONMENT
2062
2063This information is passed along to the backend so that it generates
2064code for the proper architecture. It's possible to override this on the
2065command line with the ``-mtriple`` command line option.
2066
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002067.. _pointeraliasing:
2068
2069Pointer Aliasing Rules
2070----------------------
2071
2072Any memory access must be done through a pointer value associated with
2073an address range of the memory access, otherwise the behavior is
2074undefined. Pointer values are associated with address ranges according
2075to the following rules:
2076
2077- A pointer value is associated with the addresses associated with any
2078 value it is *based* on.
2079- An address of a global variable is associated with the address range
2080 of the variable's storage.
2081- The result value of an allocation instruction is associated with the
2082 address range of the allocated storage.
2083- A null pointer in the default address-space is associated with no
2084 address.
2085- An integer constant other than zero or a pointer value returned from
2086 a function not defined within LLVM may be associated with address
2087 ranges allocated through mechanisms other than those provided by
2088 LLVM. Such ranges shall not overlap with any ranges of addresses
2089 allocated by mechanisms provided by LLVM.
2090
2091A pointer value is *based* on another pointer value according to the
2092following rules:
2093
Sanjoy Das6d489492017-09-13 18:49:22 +00002094- A pointer value formed from a scalar ``getelementptr`` operation is *based* on
2095 the pointer-typed operand of the ``getelementptr``.
2096- The pointer in lane *l* of the result of a vector ``getelementptr`` operation
2097 is *based* on the pointer in lane *l* of the vector-of-pointers-typed operand
2098 of the ``getelementptr``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002099- The result value of a ``bitcast`` is *based* on the operand of the
2100 ``bitcast``.
2101- A pointer value formed by an ``inttoptr`` is *based* on all pointer
2102 values that contribute (directly or indirectly) to the computation of
2103 the pointer's value.
2104- The "*based* on" relationship is transitive.
2105
2106Note that this definition of *"based"* is intentionally similar to the
2107definition of *"based"* in C99, though it is slightly weaker.
2108
2109LLVM IR does not associate types with memory. The result type of a
2110``load`` merely indicates the size and alignment of the memory from
2111which to load, as well as the interpretation of the value. The first
2112operand type of a ``store`` similarly only indicates the size and
2113alignment of the store.
2114
2115Consequently, type-based alias analysis, aka TBAA, aka
2116``-fstrict-aliasing``, is not applicable to general unadorned LLVM IR.
2117:ref:`Metadata <metadata>` may be used to encode additional information
2118which specialized optimization passes may use to implement type-based
2119alias analysis.
2120
2121.. _volatile:
2122
2123Volatile Memory Accesses
2124------------------------
2125
2126Certain memory accesses, such as :ref:`load <i_load>`'s,
2127:ref:`store <i_store>`'s, and :ref:`llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`'s may be
2128marked ``volatile``. The optimizers must not change the number of
2129volatile operations or change their order of execution relative to other
2130volatile operations. The optimizers *may* change the order of volatile
2131operations relative to non-volatile operations. This is not Java's
2132"volatile" and has no cross-thread synchronization behavior.
2133
Andrew Trick89fc5a62013-01-30 21:19:35 +00002134IR-level volatile loads and stores cannot safely be optimized into
2135llvm.memcpy or llvm.memmove intrinsics even when those intrinsics are
2136flagged volatile. Likewise, the backend should never split or merge
2137target-legal volatile load/store instructions.
2138
Andrew Trick7e6f9282013-01-31 00:49:39 +00002139.. admonition:: Rationale
2140
2141 Platforms may rely on volatile loads and stores of natively supported
2142 data width to be executed as single instruction. For example, in C
2143 this holds for an l-value of volatile primitive type with native
2144 hardware support, but not necessarily for aggregate types. The
2145 frontend upholds these expectations, which are intentionally
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00002146 unspecified in the IR. The rules above ensure that IR transformations
Andrew Trick7e6f9282013-01-31 00:49:39 +00002147 do not violate the frontend's contract with the language.
2148
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002149.. _memmodel:
2150
2151Memory Model for Concurrent Operations
2152--------------------------------------
2153
2154The LLVM IR does not define any way to start parallel threads of
2155execution or to register signal handlers. Nonetheless, there are
2156platform-specific ways to create them, and we define LLVM IR's behavior
2157in their presence. This model is inspired by the C++0x memory model.
2158
2159For a more informal introduction to this model, see the :doc:`Atomics`.
2160
2161We define a *happens-before* partial order as the least partial order
2162that
2163
2164- Is a superset of single-thread program order, and
2165- When a *synchronizes-with* ``b``, includes an edge from ``a`` to
2166 ``b``. *Synchronizes-with* pairs are introduced by platform-specific
2167 techniques, like pthread locks, thread creation, thread joining,
2168 etc., and by atomic instructions. (See also :ref:`Atomic Memory Ordering
2169 Constraints <ordering>`).
2170
2171Note that program order does not introduce *happens-before* edges
2172between a thread and signals executing inside that thread.
2173
2174Every (defined) read operation (load instructions, memcpy, atomic
2175loads/read-modify-writes, etc.) R reads a series of bytes written by
2176(defined) write operations (store instructions, atomic
2177stores/read-modify-writes, memcpy, etc.). For the purposes of this
2178section, initialized globals are considered to have a write of the
2179initializer which is atomic and happens before any other read or write
2180of the memory in question. For each byte of a read R, R\ :sub:`byte`
2181may see any write to the same byte, except:
2182
2183- If write\ :sub:`1` happens before write\ :sub:`2`, and
2184 write\ :sub:`2` happens before R\ :sub:`byte`, then
2185 R\ :sub:`byte` does not see write\ :sub:`1`.
2186- If R\ :sub:`byte` happens before write\ :sub:`3`, then
2187 R\ :sub:`byte` does not see write\ :sub:`3`.
2188
2189Given that definition, R\ :sub:`byte` is defined as follows:
2190
2191- If R is volatile, the result is target-dependent. (Volatile is
2192 supposed to give guarantees which can support ``sig_atomic_t`` in
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +00002193 C/C++, and may be used for accesses to addresses that do not behave
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002194 like normal memory. It does not generally provide cross-thread
2195 synchronization.)
2196- Otherwise, if there is no write to the same byte that happens before
2197 R\ :sub:`byte`, R\ :sub:`byte` returns ``undef`` for that byte.
2198- Otherwise, if R\ :sub:`byte` may see exactly one write,
2199 R\ :sub:`byte` returns the value written by that write.
2200- Otherwise, if R is atomic, and all the writes R\ :sub:`byte` may
2201 see are atomic, it chooses one of the values written. See the :ref:`Atomic
2202 Memory Ordering Constraints <ordering>` section for additional
2203 constraints on how the choice is made.
2204- Otherwise R\ :sub:`byte` returns ``undef``.
2205
2206R returns the value composed of the series of bytes it read. This
2207implies that some bytes within the value may be ``undef`` **without**
2208the entire value being ``undef``. Note that this only defines the
2209semantics of the operation; it doesn't mean that targets will emit more
2210than one instruction to read the series of bytes.
2211
2212Note that in cases where none of the atomic intrinsics are used, this
2213model places only one restriction on IR transformations on top of what
2214is required for single-threaded execution: introducing a store to a byte
2215which might not otherwise be stored is not allowed in general.
2216(Specifically, in the case where another thread might write to and read
2217from an address, introducing a store can change a load that may see
2218exactly one write into a load that may see multiple writes.)
2219
2220.. _ordering:
2221
2222Atomic Memory Ordering Constraints
2223----------------------------------
2224
2225Atomic instructions (:ref:`cmpxchg <i_cmpxchg>`,
2226:ref:`atomicrmw <i_atomicrmw>`, :ref:`fence <i_fence>`,
2227:ref:`atomic load <i_load>`, and :ref:`atomic store <i_store>`) take
Tim Northovere94a5182014-03-11 10:48:52 +00002228ordering parameters that determine which other atomic instructions on
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002229the same address they *synchronize with*. These semantics are borrowed
2230from Java and C++0x, but are somewhat more colloquial. If these
2231descriptions aren't precise enough, check those specs (see spec
2232references in the :doc:`atomics guide <Atomics>`).
2233:ref:`fence <i_fence>` instructions treat these orderings somewhat
2234differently since they don't take an address. See that instruction's
2235documentation for details.
2236
2237For a simpler introduction to the ordering constraints, see the
2238:doc:`Atomics`.
2239
2240``unordered``
2241 The set of values that can be read is governed by the happens-before
2242 partial order. A value cannot be read unless some operation wrote
2243 it. This is intended to provide a guarantee strong enough to model
2244 Java's non-volatile shared variables. This ordering cannot be
2245 specified for read-modify-write operations; it is not strong enough
2246 to make them atomic in any interesting way.
2247``monotonic``
2248 In addition to the guarantees of ``unordered``, there is a single
2249 total order for modifications by ``monotonic`` operations on each
2250 address. All modification orders must be compatible with the
2251 happens-before order. There is no guarantee that the modification
2252 orders can be combined to a global total order for the whole program
2253 (and this often will not be possible). The read in an atomic
2254 read-modify-write operation (:ref:`cmpxchg <i_cmpxchg>` and
2255 :ref:`atomicrmw <i_atomicrmw>`) reads the value in the modification
2256 order immediately before the value it writes. If one atomic read
2257 happens before another atomic read of the same address, the later
2258 read must see the same value or a later value in the address's
2259 modification order. This disallows reordering of ``monotonic`` (or
2260 stronger) operations on the same address. If an address is written
2261 ``monotonic``-ally by one thread, and other threads ``monotonic``-ally
2262 read that address repeatedly, the other threads must eventually see
2263 the write. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
2264 ``memory_order_relaxed``.
2265``acquire``
2266 In addition to the guarantees of ``monotonic``, a
2267 *synchronizes-with* edge may be formed with a ``release`` operation.
2268 This is intended to model C++'s ``memory_order_acquire``.
2269``release``
2270 In addition to the guarantees of ``monotonic``, if this operation
2271 writes a value which is subsequently read by an ``acquire``
2272 operation, it *synchronizes-with* that operation. (This isn't a
2273 complete description; see the C++0x definition of a release
2274 sequence.) This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
2275 ``memory_order_release``.
2276``acq_rel`` (acquire+release)
2277 Acts as both an ``acquire`` and ``release`` operation on its
2278 address. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x ``memory_order_acq_rel``.
2279``seq_cst`` (sequentially consistent)
2280 In addition to the guarantees of ``acq_rel`` (``acquire`` for an
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +00002281 operation that only reads, ``release`` for an operation that only
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002282 writes), there is a global total order on all
2283 sequentially-consistent operations on all addresses, which is
2284 consistent with the *happens-before* partial order and with the
2285 modification orders of all the affected addresses. Each
2286 sequentially-consistent read sees the last preceding write to the
2287 same address in this global order. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
2288 ``memory_order_seq_cst`` and Java volatile.
2289
Konstantin Zhuravlyovbb80d3e2017-07-11 22:23:00 +00002290.. _syncscope:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002291
Konstantin Zhuravlyovbb80d3e2017-07-11 22:23:00 +00002292If an atomic operation is marked ``syncscope("singlethread")``, it only
2293*synchronizes with* and only participates in the seq\_cst total orderings of
2294other operations running in the same thread (for example, in signal handlers).
2295
2296If an atomic operation is marked ``syncscope("<target-scope>")``, where
2297``<target-scope>`` is a target specific synchronization scope, then it is target
2298dependent if it *synchronizes with* and participates in the seq\_cst total
2299orderings of other operations.
2300
2301Otherwise, an atomic operation that is not marked ``syncscope("singlethread")``
2302or ``syncscope("<target-scope>")`` *synchronizes with* and participates in the
2303seq\_cst total orderings of other operations that are not marked
2304``syncscope("singlethread")`` or ``syncscope("<target-scope>")``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002305
Sanjay Patel54b161e2018-03-20 16:38:22 +00002306.. _floatenv:
2307
2308Floating-Point Environment
2309--------------------------
2310
2311The default LLVM floating-point environment assumes that floating-point
2312instructions do not have side effects. Results assume the round-to-nearest
2313rounding mode. No floating-point exception state is maintained in this
2314environment. Therefore, there is no attempt to create or preserve invalid
2315operation (SNaN) or division-by-zero exceptions in these examples:
2316
2317.. code-block:: llvm
2318
2319 %A = fdiv 0x7ff0000000000001, %X ; 64-bit SNaN hex value
2320 %B = fdiv %X, 0.0
2321 Safe:
2322 %A = NaN
2323 %B = NaN
2324
2325The benefit of this exception-free assumption is that floating-point
2326operations may be speculated freely without any other fast-math relaxations
2327to the floating-point model.
2328
2329Code that requires different behavior than this should use the
Sanjay Patelec95e0e2018-03-20 17:05:19 +00002330:ref:`Constrained Floating-Point Intrinsics <constrainedfp>`.
Sanjay Patel54b161e2018-03-20 16:38:22 +00002331
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002332.. _fastmath:
2333
2334Fast-Math Flags
2335---------------
2336
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +00002337LLVM IR floating-point operations (:ref:`fadd <i_fadd>`,
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002338:ref:`fsub <i_fsub>`, :ref:`fmul <i_fmul>`, :ref:`fdiv <i_fdiv>`,
Matt Arsenault74b73e52017-01-10 18:06:38 +00002339:ref:`frem <i_frem>`, :ref:`fcmp <i_fcmp>`) and :ref:`call <i_call>`
Elena Demikhovsky945b7e52018-02-14 06:58:08 +00002340may use the following flags to enable otherwise unsafe
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +00002341floating-point transformations.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002342
2343``nnan``
2344 No NaNs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not
2345 NaN. Such optimizations are required to retain defined behavior over
2346 NaNs, but the value of the result is undefined.
2347
2348``ninf``
2349 No Infs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not
2350 +/-Inf. Such optimizations are required to retain defined behavior over
2351 +/-Inf, but the value of the result is undefined.
2352
2353``nsz``
2354 No Signed Zeros - Allow optimizations to treat the sign of a zero
2355 argument or result as insignificant.
2356
2357``arcp``
2358 Allow Reciprocal - Allow optimizations to use the reciprocal of an
2359 argument rather than perform division.
2360
Adam Nemetcd847a82017-03-28 20:11:52 +00002361``contract``
2362 Allow floating-point contraction (e.g. fusing a multiply followed by an
2363 addition into a fused multiply-and-add).
2364
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +00002365``afn``
2366 Approximate functions - Allow substitution of approximate calculations for
Elena Demikhovsky945b7e52018-02-14 06:58:08 +00002367 functions (sin, log, sqrt, etc). See floating-point intrinsic definitions
2368 for places where this can apply to LLVM's intrinsic math functions.
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +00002369
2370``reassoc``
Elena Demikhovsky945b7e52018-02-14 06:58:08 +00002371 Allow reassociation transformations for floating-point instructions.
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00002372 This may dramatically change results in floating-point.
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +00002373
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002374``fast``
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +00002375 This flag implies all of the others.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002376
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith0a448fb2014-08-19 21:30:15 +00002377.. _uselistorder:
2378
2379Use-list Order Directives
2380-------------------------
2381
2382Use-list directives encode the in-memory order of each use-list, allowing the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00002383order to be recreated. ``<order-indexes>`` is a comma-separated list of
2384indexes that are assigned to the referenced value's uses. The referenced
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith0a448fb2014-08-19 21:30:15 +00002385value's use-list is immediately sorted by these indexes.
2386
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00002387Use-list directives may appear at function scope or global scope. They are not
2388instructions, and have no effect on the semantics of the IR. When they're at
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith0a448fb2014-08-19 21:30:15 +00002389function scope, they must appear after the terminator of the final basic block.
2390
2391If basic blocks have their address taken via ``blockaddress()`` expressions,
2392``uselistorder_bb`` can be used to reorder their use-lists from outside their
2393function's scope.
2394
2395:Syntax:
2396
2397::
2398
2399 uselistorder <ty> <value>, { <order-indexes> }
2400 uselistorder_bb @function, %block { <order-indexes> }
2401
2402:Examples:
2403
2404::
2405
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith23046652014-08-19 21:48:04 +00002406 define void @foo(i32 %arg1, i32 %arg2) {
2407 entry:
2408 ; ... instructions ...
2409 bb:
2410 ; ... instructions ...
2411
2412 ; At function scope.
2413 uselistorder i32 %arg1, { 1, 0, 2 }
2414 uselistorder label %bb, { 1, 0 }
2415 }
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith0a448fb2014-08-19 21:30:15 +00002416
2417 ; At global scope.
2418 uselistorder i32* @global, { 1, 2, 0 }
2419 uselistorder i32 7, { 1, 0 }
2420 uselistorder i32 (i32) @bar, { 1, 0 }
2421 uselistorder_bb @foo, %bb, { 5, 1, 3, 2, 0, 4 }
2422
Teresa Johnsonde9b8b42016-04-22 13:09:17 +00002423.. _source_filename:
2424
2425Source Filename
2426---------------
2427
2428The *source filename* string is set to the original module identifier,
2429which will be the name of the compiled source file when compiling from
2430source through the clang front end, for example. It is then preserved through
2431the IR and bitcode.
2432
2433This is currently necessary to generate a consistent unique global
2434identifier for local functions used in profile data, which prepends the
2435source file name to the local function name.
2436
2437The syntax for the source file name is simply:
2438
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00002439.. code-block:: text
Teresa Johnsonde9b8b42016-04-22 13:09:17 +00002440
2441 source_filename = "/path/to/source.c"
2442
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002443.. _typesystem:
2444
2445Type System
2446===========
2447
2448The LLVM type system is one of the most important features of the
2449intermediate representation. Being typed enables a number of
2450optimizations to be performed on the intermediate representation
2451directly, without having to do extra analyses on the side before the
2452transformation. A strong type system makes it easier to read the
2453generated code and enables novel analyses and transformations that are
2454not feasible to perform on normal three address code representations.
2455
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002456.. _t_void:
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00002457
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002458Void Type
2459---------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002460
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002461:Overview:
2462
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002463
2464The void type does not represent any value and has no size.
2465
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002466:Syntax:
2467
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002468
2469::
2470
2471 void
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002472
2473
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002474.. _t_function:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002475
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002476Function Type
2477-------------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002478
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002479:Overview:
2480
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002481
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002482The function type can be thought of as a function signature. It consists of a
2483return type and a list of formal parameter types. The return type of a function
2484type is a void type or first class type --- except for :ref:`label <t_label>`
2485and :ref:`metadata <t_metadata>` types.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002486
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002487:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002488
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002489::
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002490
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002491 <returntype> (<parameter list>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002492
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002493...where '``<parameter list>``' is a comma-separated list of type
2494specifiers. Optionally, the parameter list may include a type ``...``, which
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00002495indicates that the function takes a variable number of arguments. Variable
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002496argument functions can access their arguments with the :ref:`variable argument
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00002497handling intrinsic <int_varargs>` functions. '``<returntype>``' is any type
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002498except :ref:`label <t_label>` and :ref:`metadata <t_metadata>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002499
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002500:Examples:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002501
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002502+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2503| ``i32 (i32)`` | function taking an ``i32``, returning an ``i32`` |
2504+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2505| ``float (i16, i32 *) *`` | :ref:`Pointer <t_pointer>` to a function that takes an ``i16`` and a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to ``i32``, returning ``float``. |
2506+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2507| ``i32 (i8*, ...)`` | A vararg function that takes at least one :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to ``i8`` (char in C), which returns an integer. This is the signature for ``printf`` in LLVM. |
2508+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2509| ``{i32, i32} (i32)`` | A function taking an ``i32``, returning a :ref:`structure <t_struct>` containing two ``i32`` values |
2510+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2511
2512.. _t_firstclass:
2513
2514First Class Types
2515-----------------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002516
2517The :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` types are perhaps the most important.
2518Values of these types are the only ones which can be produced by
2519instructions.
2520
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002521.. _t_single_value:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002522
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002523Single Value Types
2524^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002525
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002526These are the types that are valid in registers from CodeGen's perspective.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002527
2528.. _t_integer:
2529
2530Integer Type
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002531""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002532
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002533:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002534
2535The integer type is a very simple type that simply specifies an
2536arbitrary bit width for the integer type desired. Any bit width from 1
2537bit to 2\ :sup:`23`\ -1 (about 8 million) can be specified.
2538
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002539:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002540
2541::
2542
2543 iN
2544
2545The number of bits the integer will occupy is specified by the ``N``
2546value.
2547
2548Examples:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002549*********
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002550
2551+----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2552| ``i1`` | a single-bit integer. |
2553+----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2554| ``i32`` | a 32-bit integer. |
2555+----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2556| ``i1942652`` | a really big integer of over 1 million bits. |
2557+----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2558
2559.. _t_floating:
2560
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00002561Floating-Point Types
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002562""""""""""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002563
2564.. list-table::
2565 :header-rows: 1
2566
2567 * - Type
2568 - Description
2569
2570 * - ``half``
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00002571 - 16-bit floating-point value
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002572
2573 * - ``float``
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00002574 - 32-bit floating-point value
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002575
2576 * - ``double``
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00002577 - 64-bit floating-point value
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002578
2579 * - ``fp128``
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00002580 - 128-bit floating-point value (112-bit mantissa)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002581
2582 * - ``x86_fp80``
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00002583 - 80-bit floating-point value (X87)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002584
2585 * - ``ppc_fp128``
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00002586 - 128-bit floating-point value (two 64-bits)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002587
Sanjay Patelbab6ce02018-03-21 15:22:09 +00002588The binary format of half, float, double, and fp128 correspond to the
2589IEEE-754-2008 specifications for binary16, binary32, binary64, and binary128
2590respectively.
2591
Reid Kleckner9a16d082014-03-05 02:41:37 +00002592X86_mmx Type
2593""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002594
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002595:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002596
Reid Kleckner9a16d082014-03-05 02:41:37 +00002597The x86_mmx type represents a value held in an MMX register on an x86
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002598machine. The operations allowed on it are quite limited: parameters and
2599return values, load and store, and bitcast. User-specified MMX
2600instructions are represented as intrinsic or asm calls with arguments
2601and/or results of this type. There are no arrays, vectors or constants
2602of this type.
2603
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002604:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002605
2606::
2607
Reid Kleckner9a16d082014-03-05 02:41:37 +00002608 x86_mmx
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002609
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002610
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002611.. _t_pointer:
2612
2613Pointer Type
2614""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002615
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002616:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002617
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002618The pointer type is used to specify memory locations. Pointers are
2619commonly used to reference objects in memory.
2620
2621Pointer types may have an optional address space attribute defining the
2622numbered address space where the pointed-to object resides. The default
2623address space is number zero. The semantics of non-zero address spaces
2624are target-specific.
2625
2626Note that LLVM does not permit pointers to void (``void*``) nor does it
2627permit pointers to labels (``label*``). Use ``i8*`` instead.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002628
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002629:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002630
2631::
2632
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002633 <type> *
2634
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002635:Examples:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002636
2637+-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2638| ``[4 x i32]*`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to :ref:`array <t_array>` of four ``i32`` values. |
2639+-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2640| ``i32 (i32*) *`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to a :ref:`function <t_function>` that takes an ``i32*``, returning an ``i32``. |
2641+-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2642| ``i32 addrspace(5)*`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to an ``i32`` value that resides in address space #5. |
2643+-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2644
2645.. _t_vector:
2646
2647Vector Type
2648"""""""""""
2649
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002650:Overview:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002651
2652A vector type is a simple derived type that represents a vector of
2653elements. Vector types are used when multiple primitive data are
2654operated in parallel using a single instruction (SIMD). A vector type
2655requires a size (number of elements) and an underlying primitive data
2656type. Vector types are considered :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>`.
2657
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002658:Syntax:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002659
2660::
2661
2662 < <# elements> x <elementtype> >
2663
2664The number of elements is a constant integer value larger than 0;
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00002665elementtype may be any integer, floating-point or pointer type. Vectors
Manuel Jacob961f7872014-07-30 12:30:06 +00002666of size zero are not allowed.
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002667
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002668:Examples:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002669
2670+-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2671| ``<4 x i32>`` | Vector of 4 32-bit integer values. |
2672+-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2673| ``<8 x float>`` | Vector of 8 32-bit floating-point values. |
2674+-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2675| ``<2 x i64>`` | Vector of 2 64-bit integer values. |
2676+-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2677| ``<4 x i64*>`` | Vector of 4 pointers to 64-bit integer values. |
2678+-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002679
2680.. _t_label:
2681
2682Label Type
2683^^^^^^^^^^
2684
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002685:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002686
2687The label type represents code labels.
2688
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002689:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002690
2691::
2692
2693 label
2694
David Majnemerb611e3f2015-08-14 05:09:07 +00002695.. _t_token:
2696
2697Token Type
2698^^^^^^^^^^
2699
2700:Overview:
2701
2702The token type is used when a value is associated with an instruction
2703but all uses of the value must not attempt to introspect or obscure it.
2704As such, it is not appropriate to have a :ref:`phi <i_phi>` or
2705:ref:`select <i_select>` of type token.
2706
2707:Syntax:
2708
2709::
2710
2711 token
2712
2713
2714
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002715.. _t_metadata:
2716
2717Metadata Type
2718^^^^^^^^^^^^^
2719
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002720:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002721
2722The metadata type represents embedded metadata. No derived types may be
2723created from metadata except for :ref:`function <t_function>` arguments.
2724
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002725:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002726
2727::
2728
2729 metadata
2730
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002731.. _t_aggregate:
2732
2733Aggregate Types
2734^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
2735
2736Aggregate Types are a subset of derived types that can contain multiple
2737member types. :ref:`Arrays <t_array>` and :ref:`structs <t_struct>` are
2738aggregate types. :ref:`Vectors <t_vector>` are not considered to be
2739aggregate types.
2740
2741.. _t_array:
2742
2743Array Type
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002744""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002745
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002746:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002747
2748The array type is a very simple derived type that arranges elements
2749sequentially in memory. The array type requires a size (number of
2750elements) and an underlying data type.
2751
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002752:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002753
2754::
2755
2756 [<# elements> x <elementtype>]
2757
2758The number of elements is a constant integer value; ``elementtype`` may
2759be any type with a size.
2760
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002761:Examples:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002762
2763+------------------+--------------------------------------+
2764| ``[40 x i32]`` | Array of 40 32-bit integer values. |
2765+------------------+--------------------------------------+
2766| ``[41 x i32]`` | Array of 41 32-bit integer values. |
2767+------------------+--------------------------------------+
2768| ``[4 x i8]`` | Array of 4 8-bit integer values. |
2769+------------------+--------------------------------------+
2770
2771Here are some examples of multidimensional arrays:
2772
2773+-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2774| ``[3 x [4 x i32]]`` | 3x4 array of 32-bit integer values. |
2775+-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00002776| ``[12 x [10 x float]]`` | 12x10 array of single precision floating-point values. |
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002777+-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2778| ``[2 x [3 x [4 x i16]]]`` | 2x3x4 array of 16-bit integer values. |
2779+-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2780
2781There is no restriction on indexing beyond the end of the array implied
2782by a static type (though there are restrictions on indexing beyond the
2783bounds of an allocated object in some cases). This means that
2784single-dimension 'variable sized array' addressing can be implemented in
2785LLVM with a zero length array type. An implementation of 'pascal style
2786arrays' in LLVM could use the type "``{ i32, [0 x float]}``", for
2787example.
2788
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002789.. _t_struct:
2790
2791Structure Type
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002792""""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002793
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002794:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002795
2796The structure type is used to represent a collection of data members
2797together in memory. The elements of a structure may be any type that has
2798a size.
2799
2800Structures in memory are accessed using '``load``' and '``store``' by
2801getting a pointer to a field with the '``getelementptr``' instruction.
2802Structures in registers are accessed using the '``extractvalue``' and
2803'``insertvalue``' instructions.
2804
2805Structures may optionally be "packed" structures, which indicate that
2806the alignment of the struct is one byte, and that there is no padding
2807between the elements. In non-packed structs, padding between field types
2808is inserted as defined by the DataLayout string in the module, which is
2809required to match what the underlying code generator expects.
2810
2811Structures can either be "literal" or "identified". A literal structure
2812is defined inline with other types (e.g. ``{i32, i32}*``) whereas
2813identified types are always defined at the top level with a name.
2814Literal types are uniqued by their contents and can never be recursive
2815or opaque since there is no way to write one. Identified types can be
2816recursive, can be opaqued, and are never uniqued.
2817
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002818:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002819
2820::
2821
2822 %T1 = type { <type list> } ; Identified normal struct type
2823 %T2 = type <{ <type list> }> ; Identified packed struct type
2824
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002825:Examples:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002826
2827+------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2828| ``{ i32, i32, i32 }`` | A triple of three ``i32`` values |
2829+------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00002830| ``{ float, i32 (i32) * }`` | A pair, where the first element is a ``float`` and the second element is a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to a :ref:`function <t_function>` that takes an ``i32``, returning an ``i32``. |
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002831+------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2832| ``<{ i8, i32 }>`` | A packed struct known to be 5 bytes in size. |
2833+------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2834
2835.. _t_opaque:
2836
2837Opaque Structure Types
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002838""""""""""""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002839
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002840:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002841
2842Opaque structure types are used to represent named structure types that
2843do not have a body specified. This corresponds (for example) to the C
2844notion of a forward declared structure.
2845
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002846:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002847
2848::
2849
2850 %X = type opaque
2851 %52 = type opaque
2852
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002853:Examples:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002854
2855+--------------+-------------------+
2856| ``opaque`` | An opaque type. |
2857+--------------+-------------------+
2858
Sean Silva1703e702014-04-08 21:06:22 +00002859.. _constants:
2860
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002861Constants
2862=========
2863
2864LLVM has several different basic types of constants. This section
2865describes them all and their syntax.
2866
2867Simple Constants
2868----------------
2869
2870**Boolean constants**
2871 The two strings '``true``' and '``false``' are both valid constants
2872 of the ``i1`` type.
2873**Integer constants**
2874 Standard integers (such as '4') are constants of the
2875 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. Negative numbers may be used with
2876 integer types.
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00002877**Floating-point constants**
2878 Floating-point constants use standard decimal notation (e.g.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002879 123.421), exponential notation (e.g. 1.23421e+2), or a more precise
2880 hexadecimal notation (see below). The assembler requires the exact
2881 decimal value of a floating-point constant. For example, the
2882 assembler accepts 1.25 but rejects 1.3 because 1.3 is a repeating
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00002883 decimal in binary. Floating-point constants must have a
2884 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002885**Null pointer constants**
2886 The identifier '``null``' is recognized as a null pointer constant
2887 and must be of :ref:`pointer type <t_pointer>`.
David Majnemerf0f224d2015-11-11 21:57:16 +00002888**Token constants**
2889 The identifier '``none``' is recognized as an empty token constant
2890 and must be of :ref:`token type <t_token>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002891
2892The one non-intuitive notation for constants is the hexadecimal form of
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00002893floating-point constants. For example, the form
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002894'``double 0x432ff973cafa8000``' is equivalent to (but harder to read
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00002895than) '``double 4.5e+15``'. The only time hexadecimal floating-point
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002896constants are required (and the only time that they are generated by the
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00002897disassembler) is when a floating-point constant must be emitted but it
2898cannot be represented as a decimal floating-point number in a reasonable
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002899number of digits. For example, NaN's, infinities, and other special
2900values are represented in their IEEE hexadecimal format so that assembly
2901and disassembly do not cause any bits to change in the constants.
2902
2903When using the hexadecimal form, constants of types half, float, and
2904double are represented using the 16-digit form shown above (which
2905matches the IEEE754 representation for double); half and float values
Dmitri Gribenko4dc2ba12013-01-16 23:40:37 +00002906must, however, be exactly representable as IEEE 754 half and single
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002907precision, respectively. Hexadecimal format is always used for long
2908double, and there are three forms of long double. The 80-bit format used
2909by x86 is represented as ``0xK`` followed by 20 hexadecimal digits. The
2910128-bit format used by PowerPC (two adjacent doubles) is represented by
2911``0xM`` followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. The IEEE 128-bit format is
Richard Sandifordae426b42013-05-03 14:32:27 +00002912represented by ``0xL`` followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. Long doubles
2913will only work if they match the long double format on your target.
2914The IEEE 16-bit format (half precision) is represented by ``0xH``
2915followed by 4 hexadecimal digits. All hexadecimal formats are big-endian
2916(sign bit at the left).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002917
Reid Kleckner9a16d082014-03-05 02:41:37 +00002918There are no constants of type x86_mmx.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002919
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00002920.. _complexconstants:
2921
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002922Complex Constants
2923-----------------
2924
2925Complex constants are a (potentially recursive) combination of simple
2926constants and smaller complex constants.
2927
2928**Structure constants**
2929 Structure constants are represented with notation similar to
2930 structure type definitions (a comma separated list of elements,
2931 surrounded by braces (``{}``)). For example:
2932 "``{ i32 4, float 17.0, i32* @G }``", where "``@G``" is declared as
2933 "``@G = external global i32``". Structure constants must have
2934 :ref:`structure type <t_struct>`, and the number and types of elements
2935 must match those specified by the type.
2936**Array constants**
2937 Array constants are represented with notation similar to array type
2938 definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
2939 square brackets (``[]``)). For example:
2940 "``[ i32 42, i32 11, i32 74 ]``". Array constants must have
2941 :ref:`array type <t_array>`, and the number and types of elements must
Daniel Sandersf6051842014-09-11 12:02:59 +00002942 match those specified by the type. As a special case, character array
2943 constants may also be represented as a double-quoted string using the ``c``
2944 prefix. For example: "``c"Hello World\0A\00"``".
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002945**Vector constants**
2946 Vector constants are represented with notation similar to vector
2947 type definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
2948 less-than/greater-than's (``<>``)). For example:
2949 "``< i32 42, i32 11, i32 74, i32 100 >``". Vector constants
2950 must have :ref:`vector type <t_vector>`, and the number and types of
2951 elements must match those specified by the type.
2952**Zero initialization**
2953 The string '``zeroinitializer``' can be used to zero initialize a
2954 value to zero of *any* type, including scalar and
2955 :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` types. This is often used to avoid
2956 having to print large zero initializers (e.g. for large arrays) and
2957 is always exactly equivalent to using explicit zero initializers.
2958**Metadata node**
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00002959 A metadata node is a constant tuple without types. For example:
2960 "``!{!0, !{!2, !0}, !"test"}``". Metadata can reference constant values,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00002961 for example: "``!{!0, i32 0, i8* @global, i64 (i64)* @function, !"str"}``".
2962 Unlike other typed constants that are meant to be interpreted as part of
2963 the instruction stream, metadata is a place to attach additional
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002964 information such as debug info.
2965
2966Global Variable and Function Addresses
2967--------------------------------------
2968
2969The addresses of :ref:`global variables <globalvars>` and
2970:ref:`functions <functionstructure>` are always implicitly valid
2971(link-time) constants. These constants are explicitly referenced when
2972the :ref:`identifier for the global <identifiers>` is used and always have
2973:ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` type. For example, the following is a legal LLVM
2974file:
2975
2976.. code-block:: llvm
2977
2978 @X = global i32 17
2979 @Y = global i32 42
2980 @Z = global [2 x i32*] [ i32* @X, i32* @Y ]
2981
2982.. _undefvalues:
2983
2984Undefined Values
2985----------------
2986
2987The string '``undef``' can be used anywhere a constant is expected, and
2988indicates that the user of the value may receive an unspecified
2989bit-pattern. Undefined values may be of any type (other than '``label``'
2990or '``void``') and be used anywhere a constant is permitted.
2991
2992Undefined values are useful because they indicate to the compiler that
2993the program is well defined no matter what value is used. This gives the
2994compiler more freedom to optimize. Here are some examples of
2995(potentially surprising) transformations that are valid (in pseudo IR):
2996
2997.. code-block:: llvm
2998
2999 %A = add %X, undef
3000 %B = sub %X, undef
3001 %C = xor %X, undef
3002 Safe:
3003 %A = undef
3004 %B = undef
3005 %C = undef
3006
3007This is safe because all of the output bits are affected by the undef
3008bits. Any output bit can have a zero or one depending on the input bits.
3009
3010.. code-block:: llvm
3011
3012 %A = or %X, undef
3013 %B = and %X, undef
3014 Safe:
3015 %A = -1
3016 %B = 0
Sanjoy Das151493a2016-09-15 01:56:58 +00003017 Safe:
3018 %A = %X ;; By choosing undef as 0
3019 %B = %X ;; By choosing undef as -1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003020 Unsafe:
3021 %A = undef
3022 %B = undef
3023
3024These logical operations have bits that are not always affected by the
3025input. For example, if ``%X`` has a zero bit, then the output of the
3026'``and``' operation will always be a zero for that bit, no matter what
3027the corresponding bit from the '``undef``' is. As such, it is unsafe to
3028optimize or assume that the result of the '``and``' is '``undef``'.
3029However, it is safe to assume that all bits of the '``undef``' could be
30300, and optimize the '``and``' to 0. Likewise, it is safe to assume that
3031all the bits of the '``undef``' operand to the '``or``' could be set,
3032allowing the '``or``' to be folded to -1.
3033
3034.. code-block:: llvm
3035
3036 %A = select undef, %X, %Y
3037 %B = select undef, 42, %Y
3038 %C = select %X, %Y, undef
3039 Safe:
3040 %A = %X (or %Y)
3041 %B = 42 (or %Y)
3042 %C = %Y
3043 Unsafe:
3044 %A = undef
3045 %B = undef
3046 %C = undef
3047
3048This set of examples shows that undefined '``select``' (and conditional
3049branch) conditions can go *either way*, but they have to come from one
3050of the two operands. In the ``%A`` example, if ``%X`` and ``%Y`` were
3051both known to have a clear low bit, then ``%A`` would have to have a
3052cleared low bit. However, in the ``%C`` example, the optimizer is
3053allowed to assume that the '``undef``' operand could be the same as
3054``%Y``, allowing the whole '``select``' to be eliminated.
3055
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00003056.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003057
3058 %A = xor undef, undef
3059
3060 %B = undef
3061 %C = xor %B, %B
3062
3063 %D = undef
Jonathan Roelofsec81c0b2014-10-16 19:28:10 +00003064 %E = icmp slt %D, 4
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003065 %F = icmp gte %D, 4
3066
3067 Safe:
3068 %A = undef
3069 %B = undef
3070 %C = undef
3071 %D = undef
3072 %E = undef
3073 %F = undef
3074
3075This example points out that two '``undef``' operands are not
3076necessarily the same. This can be surprising to people (and also matches
3077C semantics) where they assume that "``X^X``" is always zero, even if
3078``X`` is undefined. This isn't true for a number of reasons, but the
3079short answer is that an '``undef``' "variable" can arbitrarily change
3080its value over its "live range". This is true because the variable
3081doesn't actually *have a live range*. Instead, the value is logically
3082read from arbitrary registers that happen to be around when needed, so
3083the value is not necessarily consistent over time. In fact, ``%A`` and
3084``%C`` need to have the same semantics or the core LLVM "replace all
3085uses with" concept would not hold.
3086
3087.. code-block:: llvm
3088
Sanjay Patel3aaf6a02018-03-09 15:27:48 +00003089 %A = sdiv undef, %X
3090 %B = sdiv %X, undef
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003091 Safe:
Sanjay Patel3aaf6a02018-03-09 15:27:48 +00003092 %A = 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003093 b: unreachable
3094
3095These examples show the crucial difference between an *undefined value*
3096and *undefined behavior*. An undefined value (like '``undef``') is
3097allowed to have an arbitrary bit-pattern. This means that the ``%A``
Sanjay Patel3aaf6a02018-03-09 15:27:48 +00003098operation can be constant folded to '``0``', because the '``undef``'
3099could be zero, and zero divided by any value is zero.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003100However, in the second example, we can make a more aggressive
3101assumption: because the ``undef`` is allowed to be an arbitrary value,
3102we are allowed to assume that it could be zero. Since a divide by zero
3103has *undefined behavior*, we are allowed to assume that the operation
3104does not execute at all. This allows us to delete the divide and all
3105code after it. Because the undefined operation "can't happen", the
3106optimizer can assume that it occurs in dead code.
3107
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00003108.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003109
3110 a: store undef -> %X
3111 b: store %X -> undef
3112 Safe:
3113 a: <deleted>
3114 b: unreachable
3115
Sanjay Patel7b722402018-03-07 17:18:22 +00003116A store *of* an undefined value can be assumed to not have any effect;
3117we can assume that the value is overwritten with bits that happen to
3118match what was already there. However, a store *to* an undefined
3119location could clobber arbitrary memory, therefore, it has undefined
3120behavior.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003121
3122.. _poisonvalues:
3123
3124Poison Values
3125-------------
3126
3127Poison values are similar to :ref:`undef values <undefvalues>`, however
3128they also represent the fact that an instruction or constant expression
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +00003129that cannot evoke side effects has nevertheless detected a condition
3130that results in undefined behavior.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003131
3132There is currently no way of representing a poison value in the IR; they
3133only exist when produced by operations such as :ref:`add <i_add>` with
3134the ``nsw`` flag.
3135
3136Poison value behavior is defined in terms of value *dependence*:
3137
3138- Values other than :ref:`phi <i_phi>` nodes depend on their operands.
3139- :ref:`Phi <i_phi>` nodes depend on the operand corresponding to
3140 their dynamic predecessor basic block.
3141- Function arguments depend on the corresponding actual argument values
3142 in the dynamic callers of their functions.
3143- :ref:`Call <i_call>` instructions depend on the :ref:`ret <i_ret>`
3144 instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them.
3145- :ref:`Invoke <i_invoke>` instructions depend on the
3146 :ref:`ret <i_ret>`, :ref:`resume <i_resume>`, or exception-throwing
3147 call instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them.
3148- Non-volatile loads and stores depend on the most recent stores to all
3149 of the referenced memory addresses, following the order in the IR
3150 (including loads and stores implied by intrinsics such as
3151 :ref:`@llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`.)
3152- An instruction with externally visible side effects depends on the
3153 most recent preceding instruction with externally visible side
3154 effects, following the order in the IR. (This includes :ref:`volatile
3155 operations <volatile>`.)
3156- An instruction *control-depends* on a :ref:`terminator
3157 instruction <terminators>` if the terminator instruction has
3158 multiple successors and the instruction is always executed when
3159 control transfers to one of the successors, and may not be executed
3160 when control is transferred to another.
3161- Additionally, an instruction also *control-depends* on a terminator
3162 instruction if the set of instructions it otherwise depends on would
3163 be different if the terminator had transferred control to a different
3164 successor.
3165- Dependence is transitive.
3166
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +00003167Poison values have the same behavior as :ref:`undef values <undefvalues>`,
3168with the additional effect that any instruction that has a *dependence*
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003169on a poison value has undefined behavior.
3170
3171Here are some examples:
3172
3173.. code-block:: llvm
3174
3175 entry:
3176 %poison = sub nuw i32 0, 1 ; Results in a poison value.
3177 %still_poison = and i32 %poison, 0 ; 0, but also poison.
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00003178 %poison_yet_again = getelementptr i32, i32* @h, i32 %still_poison
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003179 store i32 0, i32* %poison_yet_again ; memory at @h[0] is poisoned
3180
3181 store i32 %poison, i32* @g ; Poison value stored to memory.
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00003182 %poison2 = load i32, i32* @g ; Poison value loaded back from memory.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003183
3184 store volatile i32 %poison, i32* @g ; External observation; undefined behavior.
3185
3186 %narrowaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i16*
3187 %wideaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i64*
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00003188 %poison3 = load i16, i16* %narrowaddr ; Returns a poison value.
3189 %poison4 = load i64, i64* %wideaddr ; Returns a poison value.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003190
3191 %cmp = icmp slt i32 %poison, 0 ; Returns a poison value.
3192 br i1 %cmp, label %true, label %end ; Branch to either destination.
3193
3194 true:
3195 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This is control-dependent on %cmp, so
3196 ; it has undefined behavior.
3197 br label %end
3198
3199 end:
3200 %p = phi i32 [ 0, %entry ], [ 1, %true ]
3201 ; Both edges into this PHI are
3202 ; control-dependent on %cmp, so this
3203 ; always results in a poison value.
3204
3205 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This would depend on the store in %true
3206 ; if %cmp is true, or the store in %entry
3207 ; otherwise, so this is undefined behavior.
3208
3209 br i1 %cmp, label %second_true, label %second_end
3210 ; The same branch again, but this time the
3211 ; true block doesn't have side effects.
3212
3213 second_true:
3214 ; No side effects!
3215 ret void
3216
3217 second_end:
3218 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This time, the instruction always depends
3219 ; on the store in %end. Also, it is
3220 ; control-equivalent to %end, so this is
3221 ; well-defined (ignoring earlier undefined
3222 ; behavior in this example).
3223
3224.. _blockaddress:
3225
3226Addresses of Basic Blocks
3227-------------------------
3228
3229``blockaddress(@function, %block)``
3230
3231The '``blockaddress``' constant computes the address of the specified
3232basic block in the specified function, and always has an ``i8*`` type.
3233Taking the address of the entry block is illegal.
3234
3235This value only has defined behavior when used as an operand to the
3236':ref:`indirectbr <i_indirectbr>`' instruction, or for comparisons
3237against null. Pointer equality tests between labels addresses results in
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00003238undefined behavior --- though, again, comparison against null is ok, and
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003239no label is equal to the null pointer. This may be passed around as an
3240opaque pointer sized value as long as the bits are not inspected. This
3241allows ``ptrtoint`` and arithmetic to be performed on these values so
3242long as the original value is reconstituted before the ``indirectbr``
3243instruction.
3244
3245Finally, some targets may provide defined semantics when using the value
3246as the operand to an inline assembly, but that is target specific.
3247
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00003248.. _constantexprs:
3249
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003250Constant Expressions
3251--------------------
3252
3253Constant expressions are used to allow expressions involving other
3254constants to be used as constants. Constant expressions may be of any
3255:ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type and may involve any LLVM operation
3256that does not have side effects (e.g. load and call are not supported).
3257The following is the syntax for constant expressions:
3258
3259``trunc (CST to TYPE)``
Bjorn Petterssone1285e32017-10-24 11:59:20 +00003260 Perform the :ref:`trunc operation <i_trunc>` on constants.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003261``zext (CST to TYPE)``
Bjorn Petterssone1285e32017-10-24 11:59:20 +00003262 Perform the :ref:`zext operation <i_zext>` on constants.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003263``sext (CST to TYPE)``
Bjorn Petterssone1285e32017-10-24 11:59:20 +00003264 Perform the :ref:`sext operation <i_sext>` on constants.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003265``fptrunc (CST to TYPE)``
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00003266 Truncate a floating-point constant to another floating-point type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003267 The size of CST must be larger than the size of TYPE. Both types
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00003268 must be floating-point.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003269``fpext (CST to TYPE)``
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00003270 Floating-point extend a constant to another type. The size of CST
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003271 must be smaller or equal to the size of TYPE. Both types must be
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00003272 floating-point.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003273``fptoui (CST to TYPE)``
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00003274 Convert a floating-point constant to the corresponding unsigned
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003275 integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00003276 must be of scalar or vector floating-point type. Both CST and TYPE
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003277 must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the
3278 value won't fit in the integer type, the results are undefined.
3279``fptosi (CST to TYPE)``
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00003280 Convert a floating-point constant to the corresponding signed
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003281 integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00003282 must be of scalar or vector floating-point type. Both CST and TYPE
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003283 must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the
3284 value won't fit in the integer type, the results are undefined.
3285``uitofp (CST to TYPE)``
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00003286 Convert an unsigned integer constant to the corresponding
3287 floating-point constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating-point
3288 type. CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003289 be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the value
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00003290 won't fit in the floating-point type, the results are undefined.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003291``sitofp (CST to TYPE)``
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00003292 Convert a signed integer constant to the corresponding floating-point
3293 constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating-point type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003294 CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must
3295 be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the value
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00003296 won't fit in the floating-point type, the results are undefined.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003297``ptrtoint (CST to TYPE)``
Bjorn Petterssone1285e32017-10-24 11:59:20 +00003298 Perform the :ref:`ptrtoint operation <i_ptrtoint>` on constants.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003299``inttoptr (CST to TYPE)``
Bjorn Petterssone1285e32017-10-24 11:59:20 +00003300 Perform the :ref:`inttoptr operation <i_inttoptr>` on constants.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003301 This one is *really* dangerous!
3302``bitcast (CST to TYPE)``
Bjorn Petterssone1285e32017-10-24 11:59:20 +00003303 Convert a constant, CST, to another TYPE.
3304 The constraints of the operands are the same as those for the
3305 :ref:`bitcast instruction <i_bitcast>`.
Matt Arsenaultb03bd4d2013-11-15 01:34:59 +00003306``addrspacecast (CST to TYPE)``
3307 Convert a constant pointer or constant vector of pointer, CST, to another
3308 TYPE in a different address space. The constraints of the operands are the
3309 same as those for the :ref:`addrspacecast instruction <i_addrspacecast>`.
David Blaikief72d05b2015-03-13 18:20:45 +00003310``getelementptr (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``, ``getelementptr inbounds (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003311 Perform the :ref:`getelementptr operation <i_getelementptr>` on
3312 constants. As with the :ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`
David Blaikief91b0302017-06-19 05:34:21 +00003313 instruction, the index list may have one or more indexes, which are
David Blaikief72d05b2015-03-13 18:20:45 +00003314 required to make sense for the type of "pointer to TY".
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003315``select (COND, VAL1, VAL2)``
3316 Perform the :ref:`select operation <i_select>` on constants.
3317``icmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)``
Bjorn Petterssone1285e32017-10-24 11:59:20 +00003318 Perform the :ref:`icmp operation <i_icmp>` on constants.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003319``fcmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)``
Bjorn Petterssone1285e32017-10-24 11:59:20 +00003320 Perform the :ref:`fcmp operation <i_fcmp>` on constants.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003321``extractelement (VAL, IDX)``
3322 Perform the :ref:`extractelement operation <i_extractelement>` on
3323 constants.
3324``insertelement (VAL, ELT, IDX)``
3325 Perform the :ref:`insertelement operation <i_insertelement>` on
3326 constants.
3327``shufflevector (VEC1, VEC2, IDXMASK)``
3328 Perform the :ref:`shufflevector operation <i_shufflevector>` on
3329 constants.
3330``extractvalue (VAL, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
3331 Perform the :ref:`extractvalue operation <i_extractvalue>` on
3332 constants. The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as
3333 indices in a ':ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`' operation. At
3334 least one index value must be specified.
3335``insertvalue (VAL, ELT, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
3336 Perform the :ref:`insertvalue operation <i_insertvalue>` on constants.
3337 The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as indices in a
3338 ':ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`' operation. At least one index
3339 value must be specified.
3340``OPCODE (LHS, RHS)``
3341 Perform the specified operation of the LHS and RHS constants. OPCODE
3342 may be any of the :ref:`binary <binaryops>` or :ref:`bitwise
3343 binary <bitwiseops>` operations. The constraints on operands are
3344 the same as those for the corresponding instruction (e.g. no bitwise
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00003345 operations on floating-point values are allowed).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003346
3347Other Values
3348============
3349
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00003350.. _inlineasmexprs:
3351
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003352Inline Assembler Expressions
3353----------------------------
3354
3355LLVM supports inline assembler expressions (as opposed to :ref:`Module-Level
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003356Inline Assembly <moduleasm>`) through the use of a special value. This value
3357represents the inline assembler as a template string (containing the
3358instructions to emit), a list of operand constraints (stored as a string), a
3359flag that indicates whether or not the inline asm expression has side effects,
3360and a flag indicating whether the function containing the asm needs to align its
3361stack conservatively.
3362
3363The template string supports argument substitution of the operands using "``$``"
3364followed by a number, to indicate substitution of the given register/memory
3365location, as specified by the constraint string. "``${NUM:MODIFIER}``" may also
3366be used, where ``MODIFIER`` is a target-specific annotation for how to print the
3367operand (See :ref:`inline-asm-modifiers`).
3368
3369A literal "``$``" may be included by using "``$$``" in the template. To include
3370other special characters into the output, the usual "``\XX``" escapes may be
3371used, just as in other strings. Note that after template substitution, the
3372resulting assembly string is parsed by LLVM's integrated assembler unless it is
3373disabled -- even when emitting a ``.s`` file -- and thus must contain assembly
3374syntax known to LLVM.
3375
Reid Kleckner71cb1642017-02-06 18:08:45 +00003376LLVM also supports a few more substitions useful for writing inline assembly:
3377
3378- ``${:uid}``: Expands to a decimal integer unique to this inline assembly blob.
3379 This substitution is useful when declaring a local label. Many standard
3380 compiler optimizations, such as inlining, may duplicate an inline asm blob.
3381 Adding a blob-unique identifier ensures that the two labels will not conflict
3382 during assembly. This is used to implement `GCC's %= special format
3383 string <https://gcc.gnu.org/onlinedocs/gcc/Extended-Asm.html>`_.
3384- ``${:comment}``: Expands to the comment character of the current target's
3385 assembly dialect. This is usually ``#``, but many targets use other strings,
3386 such as ``;``, ``//``, or ``!``.
3387- ``${:private}``: Expands to the assembler private label prefix. Labels with
3388 this prefix will not appear in the symbol table of the assembled object.
3389 Typically the prefix is ``L``, but targets may use other strings. ``.L`` is
3390 relatively popular.
3391
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003392LLVM's support for inline asm is modeled closely on the requirements of Clang's
3393GCC-compatible inline-asm support. Thus, the feature-set and the constraint and
3394modifier codes listed here are similar or identical to those in GCC's inline asm
3395support. However, to be clear, the syntax of the template and constraint strings
3396described here is *not* the same as the syntax accepted by GCC and Clang, and,
3397while most constraint letters are passed through as-is by Clang, some get
3398translated to other codes when converting from the C source to the LLVM
3399assembly.
3400
3401An example inline assembler expression is:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003402
3403.. code-block:: llvm
3404
3405 i32 (i32) asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"
3406
3407Inline assembler expressions may **only** be used as the callee operand
3408of a :ref:`call <i_call>` or an :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>` instruction.
3409Thus, typically we have:
3410
3411.. code-block:: llvm
3412
3413 %X = call i32 asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"(i32 %Y)
3414
3415Inline asms with side effects not visible in the constraint list must be
3416marked as having side effects. This is done through the use of the
3417'``sideeffect``' keyword, like so:
3418
3419.. code-block:: llvm
3420
3421 call void asm sideeffect "eieio", ""()
3422
3423In some cases inline asms will contain code that will not work unless
3424the stack is aligned in some way, such as calls or SSE instructions on
3425x86, yet will not contain code that does that alignment within the asm.
3426The compiler should make conservative assumptions about what the asm
3427might contain and should generate its usual stack alignment code in the
3428prologue if the '``alignstack``' keyword is present:
3429
3430.. code-block:: llvm
3431
3432 call void asm alignstack "eieio", ""()
3433
3434Inline asms also support using non-standard assembly dialects. The
3435assumed dialect is ATT. When the '``inteldialect``' keyword is present,
3436the inline asm is using the Intel dialect. Currently, ATT and Intel are
3437the only supported dialects. An example is:
3438
3439.. code-block:: llvm
3440
3441 call void asm inteldialect "eieio", ""()
3442
3443If multiple keywords appear the '``sideeffect``' keyword must come
3444first, the '``alignstack``' keyword second and the '``inteldialect``'
3445keyword last.
3446
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003447Inline Asm Constraint String
3448^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3449
3450The constraint list is a comma-separated string, each element containing one or
3451more constraint codes.
3452
3453For each element in the constraint list an appropriate register or memory
3454operand will be chosen, and it will be made available to assembly template
3455string expansion as ``$0`` for the first constraint in the list, ``$1`` for the
3456second, etc.
3457
3458There are three different types of constraints, which are distinguished by a
3459prefix symbol in front of the constraint code: Output, Input, and Clobber. The
3460constraints must always be given in that order: outputs first, then inputs, then
3461clobbers. They cannot be intermingled.
3462
3463There are also three different categories of constraint codes:
3464
3465- Register constraint. This is either a register class, or a fixed physical
3466 register. This kind of constraint will allocate a register, and if necessary,
3467 bitcast the argument or result to the appropriate type.
3468- Memory constraint. This kind of constraint is for use with an instruction
3469 taking a memory operand. Different constraints allow for different addressing
3470 modes used by the target.
3471- Immediate value constraint. This kind of constraint is for an integer or other
3472 immediate value which can be rendered directly into an instruction. The
3473 various target-specific constraints allow the selection of a value in the
3474 proper range for the instruction you wish to use it with.
3475
3476Output constraints
3477""""""""""""""""""
3478
3479Output constraints are specified by an "``=``" prefix (e.g. "``=r``"). This
3480indicates that the assembly will write to this operand, and the operand will
3481then be made available as a return value of the ``asm`` expression. Output
3482constraints do not consume an argument from the call instruction. (Except, see
3483below about indirect outputs).
3484
3485Normally, it is expected that no output locations are written to by the assembly
3486expression until *all* of the inputs have been read. As such, LLVM may assign
3487the same register to an output and an input. If this is not safe (e.g. if the
3488assembly contains two instructions, where the first writes to one output, and
3489the second reads an input and writes to a second output), then the "``&``"
3490modifier must be used (e.g. "``=&r``") to specify that the output is an
Sylvestre Ledru84666a12016-02-14 20:16:22 +00003491"early-clobber" output. Marking an output as "early-clobber" ensures that LLVM
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003492will not use the same register for any inputs (other than an input tied to this
3493output).
3494
3495Input constraints
3496"""""""""""""""""
3497
3498Input constraints do not have a prefix -- just the constraint codes. Each input
3499constraint will consume one argument from the call instruction. It is not
3500permitted for the asm to write to any input register or memory location (unless
3501that input is tied to an output). Note also that multiple inputs may all be
3502assigned to the same register, if LLVM can determine that they necessarily all
3503contain the same value.
3504
3505Instead of providing a Constraint Code, input constraints may also "tie"
3506themselves to an output constraint, by providing an integer as the constraint
3507string. Tied inputs still consume an argument from the call instruction, and
3508take up a position in the asm template numbering as is usual -- they will simply
3509be constrained to always use the same register as the output they've been tied
3510to. For example, a constraint string of "``=r,0``" says to assign a register for
3511output, and use that register as an input as well (it being the 0'th
3512constraint).
3513
3514It is permitted to tie an input to an "early-clobber" output. In that case, no
3515*other* input may share the same register as the input tied to the early-clobber
3516(even when the other input has the same value).
3517
3518You may only tie an input to an output which has a register constraint, not a
3519memory constraint. Only a single input may be tied to an output.
3520
3521There is also an "interesting" feature which deserves a bit of explanation: if a
3522register class constraint allocates a register which is too small for the value
3523type operand provided as input, the input value will be split into multiple
3524registers, and all of them passed to the inline asm.
3525
3526However, this feature is often not as useful as you might think.
3527
3528Firstly, the registers are *not* guaranteed to be consecutive. So, on those
3529architectures that have instructions which operate on multiple consecutive
3530instructions, this is not an appropriate way to support them. (e.g. the 32-bit
3531SparcV8 has a 64-bit load, which instruction takes a single 32-bit register. The
3532hardware then loads into both the named register, and the next register. This
3533feature of inline asm would not be useful to support that.)
3534
3535A few of the targets provide a template string modifier allowing explicit access
3536to the second register of a two-register operand (e.g. MIPS ``L``, ``M``, and
3537``D``). On such an architecture, you can actually access the second allocated
3538register (yet, still, not any subsequent ones). But, in that case, you're still
3539probably better off simply splitting the value into two separate operands, for
3540clarity. (e.g. see the description of the ``A`` constraint on X86, which,
3541despite existing only for use with this feature, is not really a good idea to
3542use)
3543
3544Indirect inputs and outputs
3545"""""""""""""""""""""""""""
3546
3547Indirect output or input constraints can be specified by the "``*``" modifier
3548(which goes after the "``=``" in case of an output). This indicates that the asm
3549will write to or read from the contents of an *address* provided as an input
3550argument. (Note that in this way, indirect outputs act more like an *input* than
3551an output: just like an input, they consume an argument of the call expression,
3552rather than producing a return value. An indirect output constraint is an
3553"output" only in that the asm is expected to write to the contents of the input
3554memory location, instead of just read from it).
3555
3556This is most typically used for memory constraint, e.g. "``=*m``", to pass the
3557address of a variable as a value.
3558
3559It is also possible to use an indirect *register* constraint, but only on output
3560(e.g. "``=*r``"). This will cause LLVM to allocate a register for an output
3561value normally, and then, separately emit a store to the address provided as
3562input, after the provided inline asm. (It's not clear what value this
3563functionality provides, compared to writing the store explicitly after the asm
3564statement, and it can only produce worse code, since it bypasses many
3565optimization passes. I would recommend not using it.)
3566
3567
3568Clobber constraints
3569"""""""""""""""""""
3570
3571A clobber constraint is indicated by a "``~``" prefix. A clobber does not
3572consume an input operand, nor generate an output. Clobbers cannot use any of the
3573general constraint code letters -- they may use only explicit register
3574constraints, e.g. "``~{eax}``". The one exception is that a clobber string of
3575"``~{memory}``" indicates that the assembly writes to arbitrary undeclared
3576memory locations -- not only the memory pointed to by a declared indirect
3577output.
3578
Peter Zotov00257232016-08-30 10:48:31 +00003579Note that clobbering named registers that are also present in output
3580constraints is not legal.
3581
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003582
3583Constraint Codes
3584""""""""""""""""
3585After a potential prefix comes constraint code, or codes.
3586
3587A Constraint Code is either a single letter (e.g. "``r``"), a "``^``" character
3588followed by two letters (e.g. "``^wc``"), or "``{``" register-name "``}``"
3589(e.g. "``{eax}``").
3590
3591The one and two letter constraint codes are typically chosen to be the same as
3592GCC's constraint codes.
3593
3594A single constraint may include one or more than constraint code in it, leaving
3595it up to LLVM to choose which one to use. This is included mainly for
3596compatibility with the translation of GCC inline asm coming from clang.
3597
3598There are two ways to specify alternatives, and either or both may be used in an
3599inline asm constraint list:
3600
36011) Append the codes to each other, making a constraint code set. E.g. "``im``"
3602 or "``{eax}m``". This means "choose any of the options in the set". The
3603 choice of constraint is made independently for each constraint in the
3604 constraint list.
3605
36062) Use "``|``" between constraint code sets, creating alternatives. Every
3607 constraint in the constraint list must have the same number of alternative
3608 sets. With this syntax, the same alternative in *all* of the items in the
3609 constraint list will be chosen together.
3610
3611Putting those together, you might have a two operand constraint string like
3612``"rm|r,ri|rm"``. This indicates that if operand 0 is ``r`` or ``m``, then
3613operand 1 may be one of ``r`` or ``i``. If operand 0 is ``r``, then operand 1
3614may be one of ``r`` or ``m``. But, operand 0 and 1 cannot both be of type m.
3615
3616However, the use of either of the alternatives features is *NOT* recommended, as
3617LLVM is not able to make an intelligent choice about which one to use. (At the
3618point it currently needs to choose, not enough information is available to do so
3619in a smart way.) Thus, it simply tries to make a choice that's most likely to
3620compile, not one that will be optimal performance. (e.g., given "``rm``", it'll
3621always choose to use memory, not registers). And, if given multiple registers,
3622or multiple register classes, it will simply choose the first one. (In fact, it
3623doesn't currently even ensure explicitly specified physical registers are
3624unique, so specifying multiple physical registers as alternatives, like
3625``{r11}{r12},{r11}{r12}``, will assign r11 to both operands, not at all what was
3626intended.)
3627
3628Supported Constraint Code List
3629""""""""""""""""""""""""""""""
3630
3631The constraint codes are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in
3632GCC. LLVM's support is often implemented on an 'as-needed' basis, to support C
3633inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM
3634and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM.
3635
3636Some constraint codes are typically supported by all targets:
3637
3638- ``r``: A register in the target's general purpose register class.
3639- ``m``: A memory address operand. It is target-specific what addressing modes
3640 are supported, typical examples are register, or register + register offset,
3641 or register + immediate offset (of some target-specific size).
3642- ``i``: An integer constant (of target-specific width). Allows either a simple
3643 immediate, or a relocatable value.
3644- ``n``: An integer constant -- *not* including relocatable values.
3645- ``s``: An integer constant, but allowing *only* relocatable values.
3646- ``X``: Allows an operand of any kind, no constraint whatsoever. Typically
3647 useful to pass a label for an asm branch or call.
3648
3649 .. FIXME: but that surely isn't actually okay to jump out of an asm
3650 block without telling llvm about the control transfer???)
3651
3652- ``{register-name}``: Requires exactly the named physical register.
3653
3654Other constraints are target-specific:
3655
3656AArch64:
3657
3658- ``z``: An immediate integer 0. Outputs ``WZR`` or ``XZR``, as appropriate.
3659- ``I``: An immediate integer valid for an ``ADD`` or ``SUB`` instruction,
3660 i.e. 0 to 4095 with optional shift by 12.
3661- ``J``: An immediate integer that, when negated, is valid for an ``ADD`` or
3662 ``SUB`` instruction, i.e. -1 to -4095 with optional left shift by 12.
3663- ``K``: An immediate integer that is valid for the 'bitmask immediate 32' of a
3664 logical instruction like ``AND``, ``EOR``, or ``ORR`` with a 32-bit register.
3665- ``L``: An immediate integer that is valid for the 'bitmask immediate 64' of a
3666 logical instruction like ``AND``, ``EOR``, or ``ORR`` with a 64-bit register.
3667- ``M``: An immediate integer for use with the ``MOV`` assembly alias on a
3668 32-bit register. This is a superset of ``K``: in addition to the bitmask
3669 immediate, also allows immediate integers which can be loaded with a single
3670 ``MOVZ`` or ``MOVL`` instruction.
3671- ``N``: An immediate integer for use with the ``MOV`` assembly alias on a
3672 64-bit register. This is a superset of ``L``.
3673- ``Q``: Memory address operand must be in a single register (no
3674 offsets). (However, LLVM currently does this for the ``m`` constraint as
3675 well.)
3676- ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register (W* or X*).
3677- ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register.
3678- ``x``: A lower 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register (``V0`` to ``V15``).
3679
3680AMDGPU:
3681
3682- ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register.
3683- ``[0-9]v``: The 32-bit VGPR register, number 0-9.
3684- ``[0-9]s``: The 32-bit SGPR register, number 0-9.
3685
3686
3687All ARM modes:
3688
3689- ``Q``, ``Um``, ``Un``, ``Uq``, ``Us``, ``Ut``, ``Uv``, ``Uy``: Memory address
3690 operand. Treated the same as operand ``m``, at the moment.
3691
3692ARM and ARM's Thumb2 mode:
3693
3694- ``j``: An immediate integer between 0 and 65535 (valid for ``MOVW``)
3695- ``I``: An immediate integer valid for a data-processing instruction.
3696- ``J``: An immediate integer between -4095 and 4095.
3697- ``K``: An immediate integer whose bitwise inverse is valid for a
3698 data-processing instruction. (Can be used with template modifier "``B``" to
3699 print the inverted value).
3700- ``L``: An immediate integer whose negation is valid for a data-processing
3701 instruction. (Can be used with template modifier "``n``" to print the negated
3702 value).
3703- ``M``: A power of two or a integer between 0 and 32.
3704- ``N``: Invalid immediate constraint.
3705- ``O``: Invalid immediate constraint.
3706- ``r``: A general-purpose 32-bit integer register (``r0-r15``).
3707- ``l``: In Thumb2 mode, low 32-bit GPR registers (``r0-r7``). In ARM mode, same
3708 as ``r``.
3709- ``h``: In Thumb2 mode, a high 32-bit GPR register (``r8-r15``). In ARM mode,
3710 invalid.
3711- ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``,
3712 ``d0-d31``, or ``q0-q15``.
3713- ``x``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s15``,
3714 ``d0-d7``, or ``q0-q3``.
Pablo Barrioe28cb832018-02-15 14:44:22 +00003715- ``t``: A low floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``, ``d0-d16``, or
3716 ``q0-q8``.
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003717
3718ARM's Thumb1 mode:
3719
3720- ``I``: An immediate integer between 0 and 255.
3721- ``J``: An immediate integer between -255 and -1.
3722- ``K``: An immediate integer between 0 and 255, with optional left-shift by
3723 some amount.
3724- ``L``: An immediate integer between -7 and 7.
3725- ``M``: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between 0 and 1020.
3726- ``N``: An immediate integer between 0 and 31.
3727- ``O``: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between -508 and 508.
3728- ``r``: A low 32-bit GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3729- ``l``: A low 32-bit GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3730- ``h``: A high GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3731- ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``,
3732 ``d0-d31``, or ``q0-q15``.
3733- ``x``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s15``,
3734 ``d0-d7``, or ``q0-q3``.
Pablo Barrioe28cb832018-02-15 14:44:22 +00003735- ``t``: A low floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``, ``d0-d16``, or
3736 ``q0-q8``.
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003737
3738
3739Hexagon:
3740
3741- ``o``, ``v``: A memory address operand, treated the same as constraint ``m``,
3742 at the moment.
3743- ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit register.
3744
3745MSP430:
3746
3747- ``r``: An 8 or 16-bit register.
3748
3749MIPS:
3750
3751- ``I``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3752- ``J``: An immediate integer zero.
3753- ``K``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer.
3754- ``L``: An immediate 32-bit integer, where the lower 16 bits are 0.
3755- ``N``: An immediate integer between -65535 and -1.
3756- ``O``: An immediate signed 15-bit integer.
3757- ``P``: An immediate integer between 1 and 65535.
3758- ``m``: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address
3759 register plus 16-bit immediate offset. In MIPS mode, just a base register.
3760- ``R``: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address
3761 register plus a 9-bit signed offset. In MIPS mode, the same as constraint
3762 ``m``.
3763- ``ZC``: A memory address operand, suitable for use in a ``pref``, ``ll``, or
3764 ``sc`` instruction on the given subtarget (details vary).
3765- ``r``, ``d``, ``y``: A 32 or 64-bit GPR register.
3766- ``f``: A 32 or 64-bit FPU register (``F0-F31``), or a 128-bit MSA register
Daniel Sanders3745e022015-07-13 09:24:21 +00003767 (``W0-W31``). In the case of MSA registers, it is recommended to use the ``w``
3768 argument modifier for compatibility with GCC.
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003769- ``c``: A 32-bit or 64-bit GPR register suitable for indirect jump (always
3770 ``25``).
3771- ``l``: The ``lo`` register, 32 or 64-bit.
3772- ``x``: Invalid.
3773
3774NVPTX:
3775
3776- ``b``: A 1-bit integer register.
3777- ``c`` or ``h``: A 16-bit integer register.
3778- ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3779- ``l`` or ``N``: A 64-bit integer register.
3780- ``f``: A 32-bit float register.
3781- ``d``: A 64-bit float register.
3782
3783
3784PowerPC:
3785
3786- ``I``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3787- ``J``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits.
3788- ``K``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer.
3789- ``L``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits.
3790- ``M``: An immediate integer greater than 31.
3791- ``N``: An immediate integer that is an exact power of 2.
3792- ``O``: The immediate integer constant 0.
3793- ``P``: An immediate integer constant whose negation is a signed 16-bit
3794 constant.
3795- ``es``, ``o``, ``Q``, ``Z``, ``Zy``: A memory address operand, currently
3796 treated the same as ``m``.
3797- ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register.
3798- ``b``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register, excluding ``R0`` (that is:
3799 ``R1-R31``).
3800- ``f``: A 32 or 64-bit float register (``F0-F31``), or when QPX is enabled, a
3801 128 or 256-bit QPX register (``Q0-Q31``; aliases the ``F`` registers).
3802- ``v``: For ``4 x f32`` or ``4 x f64`` types, when QPX is enabled, a
3803 128 or 256-bit QPX register (``Q0-Q31``), otherwise a 128-bit
3804 altivec vector register (``V0-V31``).
3805
3806 .. FIXME: is this a bug that v accepts QPX registers? I think this
3807 is supposed to only use the altivec vector registers?
3808
3809- ``y``: Condition register (``CR0-CR7``).
3810- ``wc``: An individual CR bit in a CR register.
3811- ``wa``, ``wd``, ``wf``: Any 128-bit VSX vector register, from the full VSX
3812 register set (overlapping both the floating-point and vector register files).
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00003813- ``ws``: A 32 or 64-bit floating-point register, from the full VSX register
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003814 set.
3815
3816Sparc:
3817
3818- ``I``: An immediate 13-bit signed integer.
3819- ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00003820- ``f``: Any floating-point register on SparcV8, or a floating-point
James Y Knightd4e1b002017-05-12 15:59:10 +00003821 register in the "low" half of the registers on SparcV9.
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00003822- ``e``: Any floating-point register. (Same as ``f`` on SparcV8.)
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003823
3824SystemZ:
3825
3826- ``I``: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer.
3827- ``J``: An immediate unsigned 12-bit integer.
3828- ``K``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3829- ``L``: An immediate signed 20-bit integer.
3830- ``M``: An immediate integer 0x7fffffff.
Ulrich Weiganddaae87aa2016-06-13 14:24:05 +00003831- ``Q``: A memory address operand with a base address and a 12-bit immediate
3832 unsigned displacement.
3833- ``R``: A memory address operand with a base address, a 12-bit immediate
3834 unsigned displacement, and an index register.
3835- ``S``: A memory address operand with a base address and a 20-bit immediate
3836 signed displacement.
3837- ``T``: A memory address operand with a base address, a 20-bit immediate
3838 signed displacement, and an index register.
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003839- ``r`` or ``d``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer register.
3840- ``a``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer address register (excludes R0, which in an
3841 address context evaluates as zero).
3842- ``h``: A 32-bit value in the high part of a 64bit data register
3843 (LLVM-specific)
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00003844- ``f``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point register.
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003845
3846X86:
3847
3848- ``I``: An immediate integer between 0 and 31.
3849- ``J``: An immediate integer between 0 and 64.
3850- ``K``: An immediate signed 8-bit integer.
3851- ``L``: An immediate integer, 0xff or 0xffff or (in 64-bit mode only)
3852 0xffffffff.
3853- ``M``: An immediate integer between 0 and 3.
3854- ``N``: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer.
3855- ``O``: An immediate integer between 0 and 127.
3856- ``e``: An immediate 32-bit signed integer.
3857- ``Z``: An immediate 32-bit unsigned integer.
3858- ``o``, ``v``: Treated the same as ``m``, at the moment.
3859- ``q``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bit
3860 ``l`` integer register. On X86-32, this is the ``a``, ``b``, ``c``, and ``d``
3861 registers, and on X86-64, it is all of the integer registers.
3862- ``Q``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bit
3863 ``h`` integer register. This is the ``a``, ``b``, ``c``, and ``d`` registers.
3864- ``r`` or ``l``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit integer register.
3865- ``R``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit "legacy" integer register -- one which has
3866 existed since i386, and can be accessed without the REX prefix.
3867- ``f``: A 32, 64, or 80-bit '387 FPU stack pseudo-register.
3868- ``y``: A 64-bit MMX register, if MMX is enabled.
3869- ``x``: If SSE is enabled: a 32 or 64-bit scalar operand, or 128-bit vector
3870 operand in a SSE register. If AVX is also enabled, can also be a 256-bit
3871 vector operand in an AVX register. If AVX-512 is also enabled, can also be a
3872 512-bit vector operand in an AVX512 register, Otherwise, an error.
3873- ``Y``: The same as ``x``, if *SSE2* is enabled, otherwise an error.
3874- ``A``: Special case: allocates EAX first, then EDX, for a single operand (in
3875 32-bit mode, a 64-bit integer operand will get split into two registers). It
3876 is not recommended to use this constraint, as in 64-bit mode, the 64-bit
3877 operand will get allocated only to RAX -- if two 32-bit operands are needed,
3878 you're better off splitting it yourself, before passing it to the asm
3879 statement.
3880
3881XCore:
3882
3883- ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3884
3885
3886.. _inline-asm-modifiers:
3887
3888Asm template argument modifiers
3889^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3890
3891In the asm template string, modifiers can be used on the operand reference, like
3892"``${0:n}``".
3893
3894The modifiers are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in
3895GCC. LLVM's support is often implemented on an 'as-needed' basis, to support C
3896inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM
3897and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM.
3898
3899Target-independent:
3900
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003901- ``c``: Print an immediate integer constant unadorned, without
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003902 the target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
3903- ``n``: Negate and print immediate integer constant unadorned, without the
3904 target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
3905- ``l``: Print as an unadorned label, without the target-specific label
3906 punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
3907
3908AArch64:
3909
3910- ``w``: Print a GPR register with a ``w*`` name instead of ``x*`` name. E.g.,
3911 instead of ``x30``, print ``w30``.
3912- ``x``: Print a GPR register with a ``x*`` name. (this is the default, anyhow).
3913- ``b``, ``h``, ``s``, ``d``, ``q``: Print a floating-point/SIMD register with a
3914 ``b*``, ``h*``, ``s*``, ``d*``, or ``q*`` name, rather than the default of
3915 ``v*``.
3916
3917AMDGPU:
3918
3919- ``r``: No effect.
3920
3921ARM:
3922
3923- ``a``: Print an operand as an address (with ``[`` and ``]`` surrounding a
3924 register).
3925- ``P``: No effect.
3926- ``q``: No effect.
3927- ``y``: Print a VFP single-precision register as an indexed double (e.g. print
3928 as ``d4[1]`` instead of ``s9``)
3929- ``B``: Bitwise invert and print an immediate integer constant without ``#``
3930 prefix.
3931- ``L``: Print the low 16-bits of an immediate integer constant.
3932- ``M``: Print as a register set suitable for ldm/stm. Also prints *all*
3933 register operands subsequent to the specified one (!), so use carefully.
3934- ``Q``: Print the low-order register of a register-pair, or the low-order
3935 register of a two-register operand.
3936- ``R``: Print the high-order register of a register-pair, or the high-order
3937 register of a two-register operand.
3938- ``H``: Print the second register of a register-pair. (On a big-endian system,
3939 ``H`` is equivalent to ``Q``, and on little-endian system, ``H`` is equivalent
3940 to ``R``.)
3941
3942 .. FIXME: H doesn't currently support printing the second register
3943 of a two-register operand.
3944
3945- ``e``: Print the low doubleword register of a NEON quad register.
3946- ``f``: Print the high doubleword register of a NEON quad register.
3947- ``m``: Print the base register of a memory operand without the ``[`` and ``]``
3948 adornment.
3949
3950Hexagon:
3951
3952- ``L``: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it
3953 has been allocated consecutively to the first.
3954
3955 .. FIXME: why is it restricted to consecutive ones? And there's
3956 nothing that ensures that happens, is there?
3957
3958- ``I``: Print the letter 'i' if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise
3959 nothing. Used to print 'addi' vs 'add' instructions.
3960
3961MSP430:
3962
3963No additional modifiers.
3964
3965MIPS:
3966
3967- ``X``: Print an immediate integer as hexadecimal
3968- ``x``: Print the low 16 bits of an immediate integer as hexadecimal.
3969- ``d``: Print an immediate integer as decimal.
3970- ``m``: Subtract one and print an immediate integer as decimal.
3971- ``z``: Print $0 if an immediate zero, otherwise print normally.
3972- ``L``: Print the low-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the
3973 address of the low-order word of a double-word memory operand.
3974
3975 .. FIXME: L seems to be missing memory operand support.
3976
3977- ``M``: Print the high-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the
3978 address of the high-order word of a double-word memory operand.
3979
3980 .. FIXME: M seems to be missing memory operand support.
3981
3982- ``D``: Print the second register of a two-register operand, or prints the
3983 second word of a double-word memory operand. (On a big-endian system, ``D`` is
3984 equivalent to ``L``, and on little-endian system, ``D`` is equivalent to
3985 ``M``.)
Daniel Sanders3745e022015-07-13 09:24:21 +00003986- ``w``: No effect. Provided for compatibility with GCC which requires this
3987 modifier in order to print MSA registers (``W0-W31``) with the ``f``
3988 constraint.
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003989
3990NVPTX:
3991
3992- ``r``: No effect.
3993
3994PowerPC:
3995
3996- ``L``: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it
3997 has been allocated consecutively to the first.
3998
3999 .. FIXME: why is it restricted to consecutive ones? And there's
4000 nothing that ensures that happens, is there?
4001
4002- ``I``: Print the letter 'i' if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise
4003 nothing. Used to print 'addi' vs 'add' instructions.
4004- ``y``: For a memory operand, prints formatter for a two-register X-form
4005 instruction. (Currently always prints ``r0,OPERAND``).
4006- ``U``: Prints 'u' if the memory operand is an update form, and nothing
4007 otherwise. (NOTE: LLVM does not support update form, so this will currently
4008 always print nothing)
4009- ``X``: Prints 'x' if the memory operand is an indexed form. (NOTE: LLVM does
4010 not support indexed form, so this will currently always print nothing)
4011
4012Sparc:
4013
4014- ``r``: No effect.
4015
4016SystemZ:
4017
4018SystemZ implements only ``n``, and does *not* support any of the other
4019target-independent modifiers.
4020
4021X86:
4022
4023- ``c``: Print an unadorned integer or symbol name. (The latter is
4024 target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier).
4025- ``A``: Print a register name with a '``*``' before it.
4026- ``b``: Print an 8-bit register name (e.g. ``al``); do nothing on a memory
4027 operand.
4028- ``h``: Print the upper 8-bit register name (e.g. ``ah``); do nothing on a
4029 memory operand.
4030- ``w``: Print the 16-bit register name (e.g. ``ax``); do nothing on a memory
4031 operand.
4032- ``k``: Print the 32-bit register name (e.g. ``eax``); do nothing on a memory
4033 operand.
4034- ``q``: Print the 64-bit register name (e.g. ``rax``), if 64-bit registers are
4035 available, otherwise the 32-bit register name; do nothing on a memory operand.
4036- ``n``: Negate and print an unadorned integer, or, for operands other than an
4037 immediate integer (e.g. a relocatable symbol expression), print a '-' before
4038 the operand. (The behavior for relocatable symbol expressions is a
4039 target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier)
4040- ``H``: Print a memory reference with additional offset +8.
4041- ``P``: Print a memory reference or operand for use as the argument of a call
4042 instruction. (E.g. omit ``(rip)``, even though it's PC-relative.)
4043
4044XCore:
4045
4046No additional modifiers.
4047
4048
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004049Inline Asm Metadata
4050^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4051
4052The call instructions that wrap inline asm nodes may have a
4053"``!srcloc``" MDNode attached to it that contains a list of constant
4054integers. If present, the code generator will use the integer as the
4055location cookie value when report errors through the ``LLVMContext``
4056error reporting mechanisms. This allows a front-end to correlate backend
4057errors that occur with inline asm back to the source code that produced
4058it. For example:
4059
4060.. code-block:: llvm
4061
4062 call void asm sideeffect "something bad", ""(), !srcloc !42
4063 ...
4064 !42 = !{ i32 1234567 }
4065
4066It is up to the front-end to make sense of the magic numbers it places
4067in the IR. If the MDNode contains multiple constants, the code generator
4068will use the one that corresponds to the line of the asm that the error
4069occurs on.
4070
4071.. _metadata:
4072
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004073Metadata
4074========
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004075
4076LLVM IR allows metadata to be attached to instructions in the program
4077that can convey extra information about the code to the optimizers and
4078code generator. One example application of metadata is source-level
4079debug information. There are two metadata primitives: strings and nodes.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004080
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004081Metadata does not have a type, and is not a value. If referenced from a
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004082``call`` instruction, it uses the ``metadata`` type.
4083
4084All metadata are identified in syntax by a exclamation point ('``!``').
4085
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004086.. _metadata-string:
4087
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004088Metadata Nodes and Metadata Strings
4089-----------------------------------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004090
4091A metadata string is a string surrounded by double quotes. It can
4092contain any character by escaping non-printable characters with
4093"``\xx``" where "``xx``" is the two digit hex code. For example:
4094"``!"test\00"``".
4095
4096Metadata nodes are represented with notation similar to structure
4097constants (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by braces and
4098preceded by an exclamation point). Metadata nodes can have any values as
4099their operand. For example:
4100
4101.. code-block:: llvm
4102
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004103 !{ !"test\00", i32 10}
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004104
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith090a19b2015-01-08 22:38:29 +00004105Metadata nodes that aren't uniqued use the ``distinct`` keyword. For example:
4106
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004107.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith090a19b2015-01-08 22:38:29 +00004108
4109 !0 = distinct !{!"test\00", i32 10}
4110
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith99010342015-01-08 23:50:26 +00004111``distinct`` nodes are useful when nodes shouldn't be merged based on their
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004112content. They can also occur when transformations cause uniquing collisions
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith99010342015-01-08 23:50:26 +00004113when metadata operands change.
4114
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004115A :ref:`named metadata <namedmetadatastructure>` is a collection of
4116metadata nodes, which can be looked up in the module symbol table. For
4117example:
4118
4119.. code-block:: llvm
4120
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004121 !foo = !{!4, !3}
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004122
Adrian Prantl1b842da2017-07-28 20:44:29 +00004123Metadata can be used as function arguments. Here the ``llvm.dbg.value``
4124intrinsic is using three metadata arguments:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004125
4126.. code-block:: llvm
4127
Adrian Prantlabe04752017-07-28 20:21:02 +00004128 call void @llvm.dbg.value(metadata !24, metadata !25, metadata !26)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004129
Peter Collingbourne50108682015-11-06 02:41:02 +00004130Metadata can be attached to an instruction. Here metadata ``!21`` is attached
4131to the ``add`` instruction using the ``!dbg`` identifier:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004132
4133.. code-block:: llvm
4134
4135 %indvar.next = add i64 %indvar, 1, !dbg !21
4136
Peter Collingbourne7b5b7c72017-01-25 21:50:14 +00004137Metadata can also be attached to a function or a global variable. Here metadata
4138``!22`` is attached to the ``f1`` and ``f2 functions, and the globals ``g1``
4139and ``g2`` using the ``!dbg`` identifier:
Peter Collingbourne50108682015-11-06 02:41:02 +00004140
4141.. code-block:: llvm
4142
Peter Collingbourne7b5b7c72017-01-25 21:50:14 +00004143 declare !dbg !22 void @f1()
4144 define void @f2() !dbg !22 {
Peter Collingbourne50108682015-11-06 02:41:02 +00004145 ret void
4146 }
4147
Peter Collingbourne7b5b7c72017-01-25 21:50:14 +00004148 @g1 = global i32 0, !dbg !22
4149 @g2 = external global i32, !dbg !22
4150
4151A transformation is required to drop any metadata attachment that it does not
4152know or know it can't preserve. Currently there is an exception for metadata
4153attachment to globals for ``!type`` and ``!absolute_symbol`` which can't be
4154unconditionally dropped unless the global is itself deleted.
4155
4156Metadata attached to a module using named metadata may not be dropped, with
4157the exception of debug metadata (named metadata with the name ``!llvm.dbg.*``).
4158
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004159More information about specific metadata nodes recognized by the
4160optimizers and code generator is found below.
4161
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004162.. _specialized-metadata:
4163
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith6a484832015-01-13 21:10:44 +00004164Specialized Metadata Nodes
4165^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4166
4167Specialized metadata nodes are custom data structures in metadata (as opposed
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004168to generic tuples). Their fields are labelled, and can be specified in any
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith6a484832015-01-13 21:10:44 +00004169order.
4170
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004171These aren't inherently debug info centric, but currently all the specialized
4172metadata nodes are related to debug info.
4173
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004174.. _DICompileUnit:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004175
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004176DICompileUnit
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004177"""""""""""""
4178
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004179``DICompileUnit`` nodes represent a compile unit. The ``enums:``,
Adrian Prantl6c2497f2017-06-12 23:59:43 +00004180``retainedTypes:``, ``globals:``, ``imports:`` and ``macros:`` fields are tuples
4181containing the debug info to be emitted along with the compile unit, regardless
4182of code optimizations (some nodes are only emitted if there are references to
4183them from instructions). The ``debugInfoForProfiling:`` field is a boolean
4184indicating whether or not line-table discriminators are updated to provide
4185more-accurate debug info for profiling results.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004186
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004187.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004188
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004189 !0 = !DICompileUnit(language: DW_LANG_C99, file: !1, producer: "clang",
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004190 isOptimized: true, flags: "-O2", runtimeVersion: 2,
Adrian Prantlb8089512016-04-01 00:16:49 +00004191 splitDebugFilename: "abc.debug", emissionKind: FullDebug,
Adrian Prantl6c2497f2017-06-12 23:59:43 +00004192 enums: !2, retainedTypes: !3, globals: !4, imports: !5,
4193 macros: !6, dwoId: 0x0abcd)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004194
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004195Compile unit descriptors provide the root scope for objects declared in a
Adrian Prantl6c2497f2017-06-12 23:59:43 +00004196specific compilation unit. File descriptors are defined using this scope. These
4197descriptors are collected by a named metadata node ``!llvm.dbg.cu``. They keep
4198track of global variables, type information, and imported entities (declarations
4199and namespaces).
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004200
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004201.. _DIFile:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004202
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004203DIFile
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004204""""""
4205
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004206``DIFile`` nodes represent files. The ``filename:`` can include slashes.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004207
Aaron Ballmanb3c51512017-01-17 21:48:31 +00004208.. code-block:: none
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004209
Amjad Aboud7faeecc2016-12-25 10:12:09 +00004210 !0 = !DIFile(filename: "path/to/file", directory: "/path/to/dir",
4211 checksumkind: CSK_MD5,
4212 checksum: "000102030405060708090a0b0c0d0e0f")
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004213
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004214Files are sometimes used in ``scope:`` fields, and are the only valid target
4215for ``file:`` fields.
Amjad Aboud7faeecc2016-12-25 10:12:09 +00004216Valid values for ``checksumkind:`` field are: {CSK_None, CSK_MD5, CSK_SHA1}
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004217
Michael Kuperstein605308a2015-05-14 10:58:59 +00004218.. _DIBasicType:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004219
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004220DIBasicType
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004221"""""""""""
4222
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004223``DIBasicType`` nodes represent primitive types, such as ``int``, ``bool`` and
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004224``float``. ``tag:`` defaults to ``DW_TAG_base_type``.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004225
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004226.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004227
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004228 !0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004229 encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004230 !1 = !DIBasicType(tag: DW_TAG_unspecified_type, name: "decltype(nullptr)")
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004231
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004232The ``encoding:`` describes the details of the type. Usually it's one of the
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004233following:
4234
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004235.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004236
4237 DW_ATE_address = 1
4238 DW_ATE_boolean = 2
4239 DW_ATE_float = 4
4240 DW_ATE_signed = 5
4241 DW_ATE_signed_char = 6
4242 DW_ATE_unsigned = 7
4243 DW_ATE_unsigned_char = 8
4244
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004245.. _DISubroutineType:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004246
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004247DISubroutineType
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004248""""""""""""""""
4249
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004250``DISubroutineType`` nodes represent subroutine types. Their ``types:`` field
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004251refers to a tuple; the first operand is the return type, while the rest are the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004252types of the formal arguments in order. If the first operand is ``null``, that
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004253represents a function with no return value (such as ``void foo() {}`` in C++).
4254
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004255.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004256
4257 !0 = !BasicType(name: "int", size: 32, align: 32, DW_ATE_signed)
4258 !1 = !BasicType(name: "char", size: 8, align: 8, DW_ATE_signed_char)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004259 !2 = !DISubroutineType(types: !{null, !0, !1}) ; void (int, char)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004260
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004261.. _DIDerivedType:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004262
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004263DIDerivedType
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004264"""""""""""""
4265
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004266``DIDerivedType`` nodes represent types derived from other types, such as
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004267qualified types.
4268
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004269.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004270
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004271 !0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004272 encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004273 !1 = !DIDerivedType(tag: DW_TAG_pointer_type, baseType: !0, size: 32,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004274 align: 32)
4275
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004276The following ``tag:`` values are valid:
4277
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004278.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004279
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004280 DW_TAG_member = 13
4281 DW_TAG_pointer_type = 15
4282 DW_TAG_reference_type = 16
4283 DW_TAG_typedef = 22
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha3f3de12016-04-16 22:46:47 +00004284 DW_TAG_inheritance = 28
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004285 DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type = 31
4286 DW_TAG_const_type = 38
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha3f3de12016-04-16 22:46:47 +00004287 DW_TAG_friend = 42
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004288 DW_TAG_volatile_type = 53
4289 DW_TAG_restrict_type = 55
Victor Leschuke1156c22016-10-31 19:09:38 +00004290 DW_TAG_atomic_type = 71
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004291
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha59d3e52016-04-23 21:08:00 +00004292.. _DIDerivedTypeMember:
4293
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004294``DW_TAG_member`` is used to define a member of a :ref:`composite type
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith90990cd2016-04-17 00:45:00 +00004295<DICompositeType>`. The type of the member is the ``baseType:``. The
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha59d3e52016-04-23 21:08:00 +00004296``offset:`` is the member's bit offset. If the composite type has an ODR
4297``identifier:`` and does not set ``flags: DIFwdDecl``, then the member is
4298uniqued based only on its ``name:`` and ``scope:``.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004299
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha3f3de12016-04-16 22:46:47 +00004300``DW_TAG_inheritance`` and ``DW_TAG_friend`` are used in the ``elements:``
4301field of :ref:`composite types <DICompositeType>` to describe parents and
4302friends.
4303
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004304``DW_TAG_typedef`` is used to provide a name for the ``baseType:``.
4305
4306``DW_TAG_pointer_type``, ``DW_TAG_reference_type``, ``DW_TAG_const_type``,
Victor Leschuke1156c22016-10-31 19:09:38 +00004307``DW_TAG_volatile_type``, ``DW_TAG_restrict_type`` and ``DW_TAG_atomic_type``
4308are used to qualify the ``baseType:``.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004309
4310Note that the ``void *`` type is expressed as a type derived from NULL.
4311
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004312.. _DICompositeType:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004313
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004314DICompositeType
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004315"""""""""""""""
4316
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004317``DICompositeType`` nodes represent types composed of other types, like
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004318structures and unions. ``elements:`` points to a tuple of the composed types.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004319
4320If the source language supports ODR, the ``identifier:`` field gives the unique
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha59d3e52016-04-23 21:08:00 +00004321identifier used for type merging between modules. When specified,
4322:ref:`subprogram declarations <DISubprogramDeclaration>` and :ref:`member
4323derived types <DIDerivedTypeMember>` that reference the ODR-type in their
4324``scope:`` change uniquing rules.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004325
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith5ab2be02016-04-17 03:58:21 +00004326For a given ``identifier:``, there should only be a single composite type that
4327does not have ``flags: DIFlagFwdDecl`` set. LLVM tools that link modules
4328together will unique such definitions at parse time via the ``identifier:``
4329field, even if the nodes are ``distinct``.
4330
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004331.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004332
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004333 !0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7)
4334 !1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7)
4335 !2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8)
4336 !3 = !DICompositeType(tag: DW_TAG_enumeration_type, name: "Enum", file: !12,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004337 line: 2, size: 32, align: 32, identifier: "_M4Enum",
4338 elements: !{!0, !1, !2})
4339
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004340The following ``tag:`` values are valid:
4341
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004342.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004343
4344 DW_TAG_array_type = 1
4345 DW_TAG_class_type = 2
4346 DW_TAG_enumeration_type = 4
4347 DW_TAG_structure_type = 19
4348 DW_TAG_union_type = 23
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004349
4350For ``DW_TAG_array_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`subrange
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004351descriptors <DISubrange>`, each representing the range of subscripts at that
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004352level of indexing. The ``DIFlagVector`` flag to ``flags:`` indicates that an
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004353array type is a native packed vector.
4354
4355For ``DW_TAG_enumeration_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`enumerator
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004356descriptors <DIEnumerator>`, each representing the definition of an enumeration
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004357value for the set. All enumeration type descriptors are collected in the
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004358``enums:`` field of the :ref:`compile unit <DICompileUnit>`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004359
4360For ``DW_TAG_structure_type``, ``DW_TAG_class_type``, and
4361``DW_TAG_union_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`derived types
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha3f3de12016-04-16 22:46:47 +00004362<DIDerivedType>` with ``tag: DW_TAG_member``, ``tag: DW_TAG_inheritance``, or
4363``tag: DW_TAG_friend``; or :ref:`subprograms <DISubprogram>` with
4364``isDefinition: false``.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004365
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004366.. _DISubrange:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004367
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004368DISubrange
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004369""""""""""
4370
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004371``DISubrange`` nodes are the elements for ``DW_TAG_array_type`` variants of
Sander de Smalen1cb94312018-01-24 10:30:23 +00004372:ref:`DICompositeType`.
4373
4374- ``count: -1`` indicates an empty array.
4375- ``count: !9`` describes the count with a :ref:`DILocalVariable`.
4376- ``count: !11`` describes the count with a :ref:`DIGlobalVariable`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004377
4378.. code-block:: llvm
4379
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004380 !0 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 0) ; array counting from 0
4381 !1 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 1) ; array counting from 1
4382 !2 = !DISubrange(count: -1) ; empty array.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004383
Sander de Smalenfdf40912018-01-24 09:56:07 +00004384 ; Scopes used in rest of example
4385 !6 = !DIFile(filename: "vla.c", directory: "/path/to/file")
4386 !7 = distinct !DICompileUnit(language: DW_LANG_C99, ...
4387 !8 = distinct !DISubprogram(name: "foo", scope: !7, file: !6, line: 5, ...
4388
4389 ; Use of local variable as count value
4390 !9 = !DIBasicType(name: "int", size: 32, encoding: DW_ATE_signed)
4391 !10 = !DILocalVariable(name: "count", scope: !8, file: !6, line: 42, type: !9)
4392 !11 = !DISubrange(count !10, lowerBound: 0)
4393
4394 ; Use of global variable as count value
4395 !12 = !DIGlobalVariable(name: "count", scope: !8, file: !6, line: 22, type: !9)
4396 !13 = !DISubrange(count !12, lowerBound: 0)
4397
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004398.. _DIEnumerator:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004399
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004400DIEnumerator
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004401""""""""""""
4402
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004403``DIEnumerator`` nodes are the elements for ``DW_TAG_enumeration_type``
4404variants of :ref:`DICompositeType`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004405
4406.. code-block:: llvm
4407
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004408 !0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7)
4409 !1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7)
4410 !2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004411
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004412DITemplateTypeParameter
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004413"""""""""""""""""""""""
4414
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004415``DITemplateTypeParameter`` nodes represent type parameters to generic source
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004416language constructs. They are used (optionally) in :ref:`DICompositeType` and
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004417:ref:`DISubprogram` ``templateParams:`` fields.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004418
4419.. code-block:: llvm
4420
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004421 !0 = !DITemplateTypeParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004422
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004423DITemplateValueParameter
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004424""""""""""""""""""""""""
4425
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004426``DITemplateValueParameter`` nodes represent value parameters to generic source
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004427language constructs. ``tag:`` defaults to ``DW_TAG_template_value_parameter``,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004428but if specified can also be set to ``DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param`` or
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004429``DW_TAG_GNU_template_param_pack``. They are used (optionally) in
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004430:ref:`DICompositeType` and :ref:`DISubprogram` ``templateParams:`` fields.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004431
4432.. code-block:: llvm
4433
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004434 !0 = !DITemplateValueParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1, value: i32 7)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004435
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004436DINamespace
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004437"""""""""""
4438
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004439``DINamespace`` nodes represent namespaces in the source language.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004440
4441.. code-block:: llvm
4442
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004443 !0 = !DINamespace(name: "myawesomeproject", scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004444
Sander de Smalen1cb94312018-01-24 10:30:23 +00004445.. _DIGlobalVariable:
4446
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004447DIGlobalVariable
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004448""""""""""""""""
4449
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004450``DIGlobalVariable`` nodes represent global variables in the source language.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004451
4452.. code-block:: llvm
4453
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004454 !0 = !DIGlobalVariable(name: "foo", linkageName: "foo", scope: !1,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004455 file: !2, line: 7, type: !3, isLocal: true,
4456 isDefinition: false, variable: i32* @foo,
4457 declaration: !4)
4458
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004459All global variables should be referenced by the `globals:` field of a
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004460:ref:`compile unit <DICompileUnit>`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004461
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004462.. _DISubprogram:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004463
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004464DISubprogram
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004465""""""""""""
4466
Peter Collingbourne50108682015-11-06 02:41:02 +00004467``DISubprogram`` nodes represent functions from the source language. A
4468``DISubprogram`` may be attached to a function definition using ``!dbg``
4469metadata. The ``variables:`` field points at :ref:`variables <DILocalVariable>`
4470that must be retained, even if their IR counterparts are optimized out of
4471the IR. The ``type:`` field must point at an :ref:`DISubroutineType`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004472
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha59d3e52016-04-23 21:08:00 +00004473.. _DISubprogramDeclaration:
4474
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith05ebfd02016-04-17 02:30:20 +00004475When ``isDefinition: false``, subprograms describe a declaration in the type
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha59d3e52016-04-23 21:08:00 +00004476tree as opposed to a definition of a function. If the scope is a composite
4477type with an ODR ``identifier:`` and that does not set ``flags: DIFwdDecl``,
4478then the subprogram declaration is uniqued based only on its ``linkageName:``
4479and ``scope:``.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith05ebfd02016-04-17 02:30:20 +00004480
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004481.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004482
Peter Collingbourne50108682015-11-06 02:41:02 +00004483 define void @_Z3foov() !dbg !0 {
4484 ...
4485 }
4486
4487 !0 = distinct !DISubprogram(name: "foo", linkageName: "_Zfoov", scope: !1,
4488 file: !2, line: 7, type: !3, isLocal: true,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith05ebfd02016-04-17 02:30:20 +00004489 isDefinition: true, scopeLine: 8,
Peter Collingbourne50108682015-11-06 02:41:02 +00004490 containingType: !4,
4491 virtuality: DW_VIRTUALITY_pure_virtual,
4492 virtualIndex: 10, flags: DIFlagPrototyped,
Adrian Prantl6c2497f2017-06-12 23:59:43 +00004493 isOptimized: true, unit: !5, templateParams: !6,
4494 declaration: !7, variables: !8, thrownTypes: !9)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004495
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004496.. _DILexicalBlock:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004497
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004498DILexicalBlock
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004499""""""""""""""
4500
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004501``DILexicalBlock`` nodes describe nested blocks within a :ref:`subprogram
Bruce Mitchenere9ffb452015-09-12 01:17:08 +00004502<DISubprogram>`. The line number and column numbers are used to distinguish
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004503two lexical blocks at same depth. They are valid targets for ``scope:``
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004504fields.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004505
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004506.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004507
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004508 !0 = distinct !DILexicalBlock(scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7, column: 35)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004509
4510Usually lexical blocks are ``distinct`` to prevent node merging based on
4511operands.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004512
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004513.. _DILexicalBlockFile:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004514
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004515DILexicalBlockFile
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004516""""""""""""""""""
4517
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004518``DILexicalBlockFile`` nodes are used to discriminate between sections of a
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004519:ref:`lexical block <DILexicalBlock>`. The ``file:`` field can be changed to
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004520indicate textual inclusion, or the ``discriminator:`` field can be used to
4521discriminate between control flow within a single block in the source language.
4522
4523.. code-block:: llvm
4524
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004525 !0 = !DILexicalBlock(scope: !3, file: !4, line: 7, column: 35)
4526 !1 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 0)
4527 !2 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 1)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004528
Michael Kuperstein605308a2015-05-14 10:58:59 +00004529.. _DILocation:
4530
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004531DILocation
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith6a484832015-01-13 21:10:44 +00004532""""""""""
4533
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004534``DILocation`` nodes represent source debug locations. The ``scope:`` field is
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004535mandatory, and points at an :ref:`DILexicalBlockFile`, an
4536:ref:`DILexicalBlock`, or an :ref:`DISubprogram`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith6a484832015-01-13 21:10:44 +00004537
4538.. code-block:: llvm
4539
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004540 !0 = !DILocation(line: 2900, column: 42, scope: !1, inlinedAt: !2)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith6a484832015-01-13 21:10:44 +00004541
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004542.. _DILocalVariable:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004543
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004544DILocalVariable
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004545"""""""""""""""
4546
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004547``DILocalVariable`` nodes represent local variables in the source language. If
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithed013cd2015-07-31 18:58:39 +00004548the ``arg:`` field is set to non-zero, then this variable is a subprogram
4549parameter, and it will be included in the ``variables:`` field of its
4550:ref:`DISubprogram`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004551
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004552.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004553
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithed013cd2015-07-31 18:58:39 +00004554 !0 = !DILocalVariable(name: "this", arg: 1, scope: !3, file: !2, line: 7,
4555 type: !3, flags: DIFlagArtificial)
4556 !1 = !DILocalVariable(name: "x", arg: 2, scope: !4, file: !2, line: 7,
4557 type: !3)
4558 !2 = !DILocalVariable(name: "y", scope: !5, file: !2, line: 7, type: !3)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004559
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004560DIExpression
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004561""""""""""""
4562
Adrian Prantlb44c7762017-03-22 18:01:01 +00004563``DIExpression`` nodes represent expressions that are inspired by the DWARF
4564expression language. They are used in :ref:`debug intrinsics<dbg_intrinsics>`
4565(such as ``llvm.dbg.declare`` and ``llvm.dbg.value``) to describe how the
4566referenced LLVM variable relates to the source language variable.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004567
4568The current supported vocabulary is limited:
4569
Adrian Prantl6825fb62017-04-18 01:21:53 +00004570- ``DW_OP_deref`` dereferences the top of the expression stack.
Florian Hahnffc498d2017-06-14 13:14:38 +00004571- ``DW_OP_plus`` pops the last two entries from the expression stack, adds
4572 them together and appends the result to the expression stack.
4573- ``DW_OP_minus`` pops the last two entries from the expression stack, subtracts
4574 the last entry from the second last entry and appends the result to the
4575 expression stack.
Florian Hahnc9c403c2017-06-13 16:54:44 +00004576- ``DW_OP_plus_uconst, 93`` adds ``93`` to the working expression.
Adrian Prantlb44c7762017-03-22 18:01:01 +00004577- ``DW_OP_LLVM_fragment, 16, 8`` specifies the offset and size (``16`` and ``8``
4578 here, respectively) of the variable fragment from the working expression. Note
Hiroshi Inoue760c0c92018-01-16 13:19:48 +00004579 that contrary to DW_OP_bit_piece, the offset is describing the location
Adrian Prantlb44c7762017-03-22 18:01:01 +00004580 within the described source variable.
Konstantin Zhuravlyovf9b41cd2017-03-08 00:28:57 +00004581- ``DW_OP_swap`` swaps top two stack entries.
4582- ``DW_OP_xderef`` provides extended dereference mechanism. The entry at the top
4583 of the stack is treated as an address. The second stack entry is treated as an
4584 address space identifier.
Adrian Prantlb44c7762017-03-22 18:01:01 +00004585- ``DW_OP_stack_value`` marks a constant value.
4586
Adrian Prantl6825fb62017-04-18 01:21:53 +00004587DWARF specifies three kinds of simple location descriptions: Register, memory,
4588and implicit location descriptions. Register and memory location descriptions
4589describe the *location* of a source variable (in the sense that a debugger might
4590modify its value), whereas implicit locations describe merely the *value* of a
4591source variable. DIExpressions also follow this model: A DIExpression that
4592doesn't have a trailing ``DW_OP_stack_value`` will describe an *address* when
4593combined with a concrete location.
4594
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +00004595.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004596
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004597 !0 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref)
Florian Hahnc9c403c2017-06-13 16:54:44 +00004598 !1 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_plus_uconst, 3)
Florian Hahnffc498d2017-06-14 13:14:38 +00004599 !1 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_constu, 3, DW_OP_plus)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004600 !2 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_bit_piece, 3, 7)
Florian Hahnffc498d2017-06-14 13:14:38 +00004601 !3 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref, DW_OP_constu, 3, DW_OP_plus, DW_OP_LLVM_fragment, 3, 7)
Konstantin Zhuravlyovf9b41cd2017-03-08 00:28:57 +00004602 !4 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_constu, 2, DW_OP_swap, DW_OP_xderef)
Adrian Prantlb44c7762017-03-22 18:01:01 +00004603 !5 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_constu, 42, DW_OP_stack_value)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004604
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004605DIObjCProperty
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004606""""""""""""""
4607
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004608``DIObjCProperty`` nodes represent Objective-C property nodes.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004609
4610.. code-block:: llvm
4611
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004612 !3 = !DIObjCProperty(name: "foo", file: !1, line: 7, setter: "setFoo",
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004613 getter: "getFoo", attributes: 7, type: !2)
4614
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004615DIImportedEntity
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004616""""""""""""""""
4617
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004618``DIImportedEntity`` nodes represent entities (such as modules) imported into a
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004619compile unit.
4620
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004621.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004622
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004623 !2 = !DIImportedEntity(tag: DW_TAG_imported_module, name: "foo", scope: !0,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004624 entity: !1, line: 7)
4625
Amjad Abouda9bcf162015-12-10 12:56:35 +00004626DIMacro
4627"""""""
4628
4629``DIMacro`` nodes represent definition or undefinition of a macro identifiers.
4630The ``name:`` field is the macro identifier, followed by macro parameters when
Sylvestre Ledru7d540502016-07-02 19:28:40 +00004631defining a function-like macro, and the ``value`` field is the token-string
Amjad Abouda9bcf162015-12-10 12:56:35 +00004632used to expand the macro identifier.
4633
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004634.. code-block:: text
Amjad Abouda9bcf162015-12-10 12:56:35 +00004635
4636 !2 = !DIMacro(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_define, line: 7, name: "foo(x)",
4637 value: "((x) + 1)")
4638 !3 = !DIMacro(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_undef, line: 30, name: "foo")
4639
4640DIMacroFile
4641"""""""""""
4642
4643``DIMacroFile`` nodes represent inclusion of source files.
4644The ``nodes:`` field is a list of ``DIMacro`` and ``DIMacroFile`` nodes that
4645appear in the included source file.
4646
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004647.. code-block:: text
Amjad Abouda9bcf162015-12-10 12:56:35 +00004648
4649 !2 = !DIMacroFile(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_start_file, line: 7, file: !2,
4650 nodes: !3)
4651
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004652'``tbaa``' Metadata
4653^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4654
4655In LLVM IR, memory does not have types, so LLVM's own type system is not
Sanjoy Dasa3ff9942017-02-13 23:14:03 +00004656suitable for doing type based alias analysis (TBAA). Instead, metadata is
4657added to the IR to describe a type system of a higher level language. This
4658can be used to implement C/C++ strict type aliasing rules, but it can also
4659be used to implement custom alias analysis behavior for other languages.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004660
Sanjoy Dasa3ff9942017-02-13 23:14:03 +00004661This description of LLVM's TBAA system is broken into two parts:
4662:ref:`Semantics<tbaa_node_semantics>` talks about high level issues, and
4663:ref:`Representation<tbaa_node_representation>` talks about the metadata
4664encoding of various entities.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004665
Sanjoy Dasa3ff9942017-02-13 23:14:03 +00004666It is always possible to trace any TBAA node to a "root" TBAA node (details
4667in the :ref:`Representation<tbaa_node_representation>` section). TBAA
4668nodes with different roots have an unknown aliasing relationship, and LLVM
4669conservatively infers ``MayAlias`` between them. The rules mentioned in
4670this section only pertain to TBAA nodes living under the same root.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004671
Sanjoy Dasa3ff9942017-02-13 23:14:03 +00004672.. _tbaa_node_semantics:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004673
Sanjoy Dasa3ff9942017-02-13 23:14:03 +00004674Semantics
4675"""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004676
Sanjoy Dasa3ff9942017-02-13 23:14:03 +00004677The TBAA metadata system, referred to as "struct path TBAA" (not to be
4678confused with ``tbaa.struct``), consists of the following high level
4679concepts: *Type Descriptors*, further subdivided into scalar type
4680descriptors and struct type descriptors; and *Access Tags*.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004681
Sanjoy Dasa3ff9942017-02-13 23:14:03 +00004682**Type descriptors** describe the type system of the higher level language
4683being compiled. **Scalar type descriptors** describe types that do not
4684contain other types. Each scalar type has a parent type, which must also
4685be a scalar type or the TBAA root. Via this parent relation, scalar types
4686within a TBAA root form a tree. **Struct type descriptors** denote types
4687that contain a sequence of other type descriptors, at known offsets. These
4688contained type descriptors can either be struct type descriptors themselves
4689or scalar type descriptors.
4690
4691**Access tags** are metadata nodes attached to load and store instructions.
4692Access tags use type descriptors to describe the *location* being accessed
4693in terms of the type system of the higher level language. Access tags are
4694tuples consisting of a base type, an access type and an offset. The base
4695type is a scalar type descriptor or a struct type descriptor, the access
4696type is a scalar type descriptor, and the offset is a constant integer.
4697
4698The access tag ``(BaseTy, AccessTy, Offset)`` can describe one of two
4699things:
4700
4701 * If ``BaseTy`` is a struct type, the tag describes a memory access (load
4702 or store) of a value of type ``AccessTy`` contained in the struct type
4703 ``BaseTy`` at offset ``Offset``.
4704
4705 * If ``BaseTy`` is a scalar type, ``Offset`` must be 0 and ``BaseTy`` and
4706 ``AccessTy`` must be the same; and the access tag describes a scalar
4707 access with scalar type ``AccessTy``.
4708
4709We first define an ``ImmediateParent`` relation on ``(BaseTy, Offset)``
4710tuples this way:
4711
4712 * If ``BaseTy`` is a scalar type then ``ImmediateParent(BaseTy, 0)`` is
4713 ``(ParentTy, 0)`` where ``ParentTy`` is the parent of the scalar type as
4714 described in the TBAA metadata. ``ImmediateParent(BaseTy, Offset)`` is
4715 undefined if ``Offset`` is non-zero.
4716
4717 * If ``BaseTy`` is a struct type then ``ImmediateParent(BaseTy, Offset)``
4718 is ``(NewTy, NewOffset)`` where ``NewTy`` is the type contained in
4719 ``BaseTy`` at offset ``Offset`` and ``NewOffset`` is ``Offset`` adjusted
4720 to be relative within that inner type.
4721
4722A memory access with an access tag ``(BaseTy1, AccessTy1, Offset1)``
4723aliases a memory access with an access tag ``(BaseTy2, AccessTy2,
4724Offset2)`` if either ``(BaseTy1, Offset1)`` is reachable from ``(Base2,
4725Offset2)`` via the ``Parent`` relation or vice versa.
4726
4727As a concrete example, the type descriptor graph for the following program
4728
4729.. code-block:: c
4730
4731 struct Inner {
4732 int i; // offset 0
4733 float f; // offset 4
4734 };
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +00004735
Sanjoy Dasa3ff9942017-02-13 23:14:03 +00004736 struct Outer {
4737 float f; // offset 0
4738 double d; // offset 4
4739 struct Inner inner_a; // offset 12
4740 };
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +00004741
Sanjoy Dasa3ff9942017-02-13 23:14:03 +00004742 void f(struct Outer* outer, struct Inner* inner, float* f, int* i, char* c) {
4743 outer->f = 0; // tag0: (OuterStructTy, FloatScalarTy, 0)
4744 outer->inner_a.i = 0; // tag1: (OuterStructTy, IntScalarTy, 12)
4745 outer->inner_a.f = 0.0; // tag2: (OuterStructTy, IntScalarTy, 16)
4746 *f = 0.0; // tag3: (FloatScalarTy, FloatScalarTy, 0)
4747 }
4748
4749is (note that in C and C++, ``char`` can be used to access any arbitrary
4750type):
4751
4752.. code-block:: text
4753
4754 Root = "TBAA Root"
4755 CharScalarTy = ("char", Root, 0)
4756 FloatScalarTy = ("float", CharScalarTy, 0)
4757 DoubleScalarTy = ("double", CharScalarTy, 0)
4758 IntScalarTy = ("int", CharScalarTy, 0)
4759 InnerStructTy = {"Inner" (IntScalarTy, 0), (FloatScalarTy, 4)}
4760 OuterStructTy = {"Outer", (FloatScalarTy, 0), (DoubleScalarTy, 4),
4761 (InnerStructTy, 12)}
4762
4763
4764with (e.g.) ``ImmediateParent(OuterStructTy, 12)`` = ``(InnerStructTy,
47650)``, ``ImmediateParent(InnerStructTy, 0)`` = ``(IntScalarTy, 0)``, and
4766``ImmediateParent(IntScalarTy, 0)`` = ``(CharScalarTy, 0)``.
4767
4768.. _tbaa_node_representation:
4769
4770Representation
4771""""""""""""""
4772
4773The root node of a TBAA type hierarchy is an ``MDNode`` with 0 operands or
4774with exactly one ``MDString`` operand.
4775
4776Scalar type descriptors are represented as an ``MDNode`` s with two
4777operands. The first operand is an ``MDString`` denoting the name of the
4778struct type. LLVM does not assign meaning to the value of this operand, it
4779only cares about it being an ``MDString``. The second operand is an
4780``MDNode`` which points to the parent for said scalar type descriptor,
4781which is either another scalar type descriptor or the TBAA root. Scalar
4782type descriptors can have an optional third argument, but that must be the
4783constant integer zero.
4784
4785Struct type descriptors are represented as ``MDNode`` s with an odd number
4786of operands greater than 1. The first operand is an ``MDString`` denoting
4787the name of the struct type. Like in scalar type descriptors the actual
4788value of this name operand is irrelevant to LLVM. After the name operand,
4789the struct type descriptors have a sequence of alternating ``MDNode`` and
4790``ConstantInt`` operands. With N starting from 1, the 2N - 1 th operand,
4791an ``MDNode``, denotes a contained field, and the 2N th operand, a
4792``ConstantInt``, is the offset of the said contained field. The offsets
4793must be in non-decreasing order.
4794
4795Access tags are represented as ``MDNode`` s with either 3 or 4 operands.
4796The first operand is an ``MDNode`` pointing to the node representing the
4797base type. The second operand is an ``MDNode`` pointing to the node
4798representing the access type. The third operand is a ``ConstantInt`` that
4799states the offset of the access. If a fourth field is present, it must be
4800a ``ConstantInt`` valued at 0 or 1. If it is 1 then the access tag states
4801that the location being accessed is "constant" (meaning
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004802``pointsToConstantMemory`` should return true; see `other useful
Sanjoy Dasa3ff9942017-02-13 23:14:03 +00004803AliasAnalysis methods <AliasAnalysis.html#OtherItfs>`_). The TBAA root of
4804the access type and the base type of an access tag must be the same, and
4805that is the TBAA root of the access tag.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004806
4807'``tbaa.struct``' Metadata
4808^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4809
4810The :ref:`llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>` is often used to implement
4811aggregate assignment operations in C and similar languages, however it
4812is defined to copy a contiguous region of memory, which is more than
4813strictly necessary for aggregate types which contain holes due to
4814padding. Also, it doesn't contain any TBAA information about the fields
4815of the aggregate.
4816
4817``!tbaa.struct`` metadata can describe which memory subregions in a
4818memcpy are padding and what the TBAA tags of the struct are.
4819
4820The current metadata format is very simple. ``!tbaa.struct`` metadata
4821nodes are a list of operands which are in conceptual groups of three.
4822For each group of three, the first operand gives the byte offset of a
4823field in bytes, the second gives its size in bytes, and the third gives
4824its tbaa tag. e.g.:
4825
4826.. code-block:: llvm
4827
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004828 !4 = !{ i64 0, i64 4, !1, i64 8, i64 4, !2 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004829
4830This describes a struct with two fields. The first is at offset 0 bytes
4831with size 4 bytes, and has tbaa tag !1. The second is at offset 8 bytes
4832and has size 4 bytes and has tbaa tag !2.
4833
4834Note that the fields need not be contiguous. In this example, there is a
48354 byte gap between the two fields. This gap represents padding which
4836does not carry useful data and need not be preserved.
4837
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004838'``noalias``' and '``alias.scope``' Metadata
Dan Liewbafdcba2014-07-28 13:33:51 +00004839^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004840
4841``noalias`` and ``alias.scope`` metadata provide the ability to specify generic
4842noalias memory-access sets. This means that some collection of memory access
4843instructions (loads, stores, memory-accessing calls, etc.) that carry
4844``noalias`` metadata can specifically be specified not to alias with some other
4845collection of memory access instructions that carry ``alias.scope`` metadata.
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004846Each type of metadata specifies a list of scopes where each scope has an id and
Adam Nemet569a5b32016-04-27 00:52:48 +00004847a domain.
4848
4849When evaluating an aliasing query, if for some domain, the set
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004850of scopes with that domain in one instruction's ``alias.scope`` list is a
Arch D. Robison96cf7ab2015-02-24 20:11:49 +00004851subset of (or equal to) the set of scopes for that domain in another
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004852instruction's ``noalias`` list, then the two memory accesses are assumed not to
4853alias.
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004854
Adam Nemet569a5b32016-04-27 00:52:48 +00004855Because scopes in one domain don't affect scopes in other domains, separate
4856domains can be used to compose multiple independent noalias sets. This is
4857used for example during inlining. As the noalias function parameters are
4858turned into noalias scope metadata, a new domain is used every time the
4859function is inlined.
4860
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004861The metadata identifying each domain is itself a list containing one or two
4862entries. The first entry is the name of the domain. Note that if the name is a
Bruce Mitchenere9ffb452015-09-12 01:17:08 +00004863string then it can be combined across functions and translation units. A
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004864self-reference can be used to create globally unique domain names. A
4865descriptive string may optionally be provided as a second list entry.
4866
4867The metadata identifying each scope is also itself a list containing two or
4868three entries. The first entry is the name of the scope. Note that if the name
Bruce Mitchenere9ffb452015-09-12 01:17:08 +00004869is a string then it can be combined across functions and translation units. A
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004870self-reference can be used to create globally unique scope names. A metadata
4871reference to the scope's domain is the second entry. A descriptive string may
4872optionally be provided as a third list entry.
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004873
4874For example,
4875
4876.. code-block:: llvm
4877
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004878 ; Two scope domains:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004879 !0 = !{!0}
4880 !1 = !{!1}
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004881
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004882 ; Some scopes in these domains:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004883 !2 = !{!2, !0}
4884 !3 = !{!3, !0}
4885 !4 = !{!4, !1}
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004886
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004887 ; Some scope lists:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004888 !5 = !{!4} ; A list containing only scope !4
4889 !6 = !{!4, !3, !2}
4890 !7 = !{!3}
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004891
4892 ; These two instructions don't alias:
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004893 %0 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004894 store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !5
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004895
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004896 ; These two instructions also don't alias (for domain !1, the set of scopes
4897 ; in the !alias.scope equals that in the !noalias list):
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004898 %2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004899 store float %2, float* %arrayidx.i2, align 4, !noalias !6
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004900
Adam Nemet0a8416f2015-05-11 08:30:28 +00004901 ; These two instructions may alias (for domain !0, the set of scopes in
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004902 ; the !noalias list is not a superset of, or equal to, the scopes in the
4903 ; !alias.scope list):
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004904 %2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !6
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004905 store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !7
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004906
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004907'``fpmath``' Metadata
4908^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4909
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00004910``fpmath`` metadata may be attached to any instruction of floating-point
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004911type. It can be used to express the maximum acceptable error in the
4912result of that instruction, in ULPs, thus potentially allowing the
4913compiler to use a more efficient but less accurate method of computing
4914it. ULP is defined as follows:
4915
4916 If ``x`` is a real number that lies between two finite consecutive
4917 floating-point numbers ``a`` and ``b``, without being equal to one
4918 of them, then ``ulp(x) = |b - a|``, otherwise ``ulp(x)`` is the
4919 distance between the two non-equal finite floating-point numbers
4920 nearest ``x``. Moreover, ``ulp(NaN)`` is ``NaN``.
4921
Matt Arsenault82f41512016-06-27 19:43:15 +00004922The metadata node shall consist of a single positive float type number
4923representing the maximum relative error, for example:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004924
4925.. code-block:: llvm
4926
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004927 !0 = !{ float 2.5 } ; maximum acceptable inaccuracy is 2.5 ULPs
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004928
Philip Reamesf8bf9dd2015-02-27 23:14:50 +00004929.. _range-metadata:
4930
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004931'``range``' Metadata
4932^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4933
Jingyue Wu37fcb592014-06-19 16:50:16 +00004934``range`` metadata may be attached only to ``load``, ``call`` and ``invoke`` of
4935integer types. It expresses the possible ranges the loaded value or the value
4936returned by the called function at this call site is in. The ranges are
4937represented with a flattened list of integers. The loaded value or the value
4938returned is known to be in the union of the ranges defined by each consecutive
4939pair. Each pair has the following properties:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004940
4941- The type must match the type loaded by the instruction.
4942- The pair ``a,b`` represents the range ``[a,b)``.
4943- Both ``a`` and ``b`` are constants.
4944- The range is allowed to wrap.
4945- The range should not represent the full or empty set. That is,
4946 ``a!=b``.
4947
4948In addition, the pairs must be in signed order of the lower bound and
4949they must be non-contiguous.
4950
4951Examples:
4952
4953.. code-block:: llvm
4954
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004955 %a = load i8, i8* %x, align 1, !range !0 ; Can only be 0 or 1
4956 %b = load i8, i8* %y, align 1, !range !1 ; Can only be 255 (-1), 0 or 1
Jingyue Wu37fcb592014-06-19 16:50:16 +00004957 %c = call i8 @foo(), !range !2 ; Can only be 0, 1, 3, 4 or 5
4958 %d = invoke i8 @bar() to label %cont
4959 unwind label %lpad, !range !3 ; Can only be -2, -1, 3, 4 or 5
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004960 ...
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004961 !0 = !{ i8 0, i8 2 }
4962 !1 = !{ i8 255, i8 2 }
4963 !2 = !{ i8 0, i8 2, i8 3, i8 6 }
4964 !3 = !{ i8 -2, i8 0, i8 3, i8 6 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004965
Peter Collingbourne235c2752016-12-08 19:01:00 +00004966'``absolute_symbol``' Metadata
4967^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4968
4969``absolute_symbol`` metadata may be attached to a global variable
4970declaration. It marks the declaration as a reference to an absolute symbol,
4971which causes the backend to use absolute relocations for the symbol even
4972in position independent code, and expresses the possible ranges that the
4973global variable's *address* (not its value) is in, in the same format as
Peter Collingbourned88f9282017-01-20 21:56:37 +00004974``range`` metadata, with the extension that the pair ``all-ones,all-ones``
4975may be used to represent the full set.
Peter Collingbourne235c2752016-12-08 19:01:00 +00004976
Peter Collingbourned88f9282017-01-20 21:56:37 +00004977Example (assuming 64-bit pointers):
Peter Collingbourne235c2752016-12-08 19:01:00 +00004978
4979.. code-block:: llvm
4980
4981 @a = external global i8, !absolute_symbol !0 ; Absolute symbol in range [0,256)
Peter Collingbourned88f9282017-01-20 21:56:37 +00004982 @b = external global i8, !absolute_symbol !1 ; Absolute symbol in range [0,2^64)
Peter Collingbourne235c2752016-12-08 19:01:00 +00004983
4984 ...
4985 !0 = !{ i64 0, i64 256 }
Peter Collingbourned88f9282017-01-20 21:56:37 +00004986 !1 = !{ i64 -1, i64 -1 }
Peter Collingbourne235c2752016-12-08 19:01:00 +00004987
Matthew Simpson36bbc8c2017-10-16 22:22:11 +00004988'``callees``' Metadata
4989^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4990
4991``callees`` metadata may be attached to indirect call sites. If ``callees``
4992metadata is attached to a call site, and any callee is not among the set of
4993functions provided by the metadata, the behavior is undefined. The intent of
4994this metadata is to facilitate optimizations such as indirect-call promotion.
4995For example, in the code below, the call instruction may only target the
4996``add`` or ``sub`` functions:
4997
4998.. code-block:: llvm
4999
5000 %result = call i64 %binop(i64 %x, i64 %y), !callees !0
5001
5002 ...
5003 !0 = !{i64 (i64, i64)* @add, i64 (i64, i64)* @sub}
5004
Sanjay Patela99ab1f2015-09-02 19:06:43 +00005005'``unpredictable``' Metadata
Sanjay Patel1f12b342015-09-02 19:35:31 +00005006^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Sanjay Patela99ab1f2015-09-02 19:06:43 +00005007
5008``unpredictable`` metadata may be attached to any branch or switch
5009instruction. It can be used to express the unpredictability of control
5010flow. Similar to the llvm.expect intrinsic, it may be used to alter
5011optimizations related to compare and branch instructions. The metadata
5012is treated as a boolean value; if it exists, it signals that the branch
5013or switch that it is attached to is completely unpredictable.
5014
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00005015'``llvm.loop``'
5016^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5017
5018It is sometimes useful to attach information to loop constructs. Currently,
5019loop metadata is implemented as metadata attached to the branch instruction
5020in the loop latch block. This type of metadata refer to a metadata node that is
Matt Arsenault24b49c42013-07-31 17:49:08 +00005021guaranteed to be separate for each loop. The loop identifier metadata is
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00005022specified with the name ``llvm.loop``.
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00005023
5024The loop identifier metadata is implemented using a metadata that refers to
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +00005025itself to avoid merging it with any other identifier metadata, e.g.,
5026during module linkage or function inlining. That is, each loop should refer
5027to their own identification metadata even if they reside in separate functions.
5028The following example contains loop identifier metadata for two separate loop
Pekka Jaaskelainen119a2b62013-02-22 12:03:07 +00005029constructs:
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00005030
5031.. code-block:: llvm
Paul Redmondeaaed3b2013-02-21 17:20:45 +00005032
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00005033 !0 = !{!0}
5034 !1 = !{!1}
Pekka Jaaskelainen119a2b62013-02-22 12:03:07 +00005035
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00005036The loop identifier metadata can be used to specify additional
5037per-loop metadata. Any operands after the first operand can be treated
5038as user-defined metadata. For example the ``llvm.loop.unroll.count``
5039suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller:
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00005040
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00005041.. code-block:: llvm
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00005042
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00005043 br i1 %exitcond, label %._crit_edge, label %.lr.ph, !llvm.loop !0
5044 ...
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00005045 !0 = !{!0, !1}
5046 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4}
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00005047
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00005048'``llvm.loop.vectorize``' and '``llvm.loop.interleave``'
5049^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00005050
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00005051Metadata prefixed with ``llvm.loop.vectorize`` or ``llvm.loop.interleave`` are
5052used to control per-loop vectorization and interleaving parameters such as
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00005053vectorization width and interleave count. These metadata should be used in
5054conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop identification metadata. The
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00005055``llvm.loop.vectorize`` and ``llvm.loop.interleave`` metadata are only
5056optimization hints and the optimizer will only interleave and vectorize loops if
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00005057it believes it is safe to do so. The ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00005058which contains information about loop-carried memory dependencies can be helpful
5059in determining the safety of these transformations.
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00005060
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00005061'``llvm.loop.interleave.count``' Metadata
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00005062^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5063
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00005064This metadata suggests an interleave count to the loop interleaver.
5065The first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` and the
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00005066second operand is an integer specifying the interleave count. For
5067example:
5068
5069.. code-block:: llvm
5070
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00005071 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.interleave.count", i32 4}
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00005072
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00005073Note that setting ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` to 1 disables interleaving
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00005074multiple iterations of the loop. If ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` is set to 0
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00005075then the interleave count will be determined automatically.
5076
5077'``llvm.loop.vectorize.enable``' Metadata
Dan Liew9a1829d2014-07-22 14:59:38 +00005078^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00005079
5080This metadata selectively enables or disables vectorization for the loop. The
5081first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.vectorize.enable`` and the second operand
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00005082is a bit. If the bit operand value is 1 vectorization is enabled. A value of
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +000050830 disables vectorization:
5084
5085.. code-block:: llvm
5086
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00005087 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 0}
5088 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 1}
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00005089
5090'``llvm.loop.vectorize.width``' Metadata
5091^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5092
5093This metadata sets the target width of the vectorizer. The first
5094operand is the string ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` and the second
5095operand is an integer specifying the width. For example:
5096
5097.. code-block:: llvm
5098
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00005099 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.width", i32 4}
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00005100
5101Note that setting ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` to 1 disables
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00005102vectorization of the loop. If ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` is set to
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +000051030 or if the loop does not have this metadata the width will be
5104determined automatically.
5105
5106'``llvm.loop.unroll``'
5107^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5108
5109Metadata prefixed with ``llvm.loop.unroll`` are loop unrolling
5110optimization hints such as the unroll factor. ``llvm.loop.unroll``
5111metadata should be used in conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop
5112identification metadata. The ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata are only
5113optimization hints and the unrolling will only be performed if the
5114optimizer believes it is safe to do so.
5115
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00005116'``llvm.loop.unroll.count``' Metadata
5117^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5118
5119This metadata suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller. The
5120first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.count`` and the second
5121operand is a positive integer specifying the unroll factor. For
5122example:
5123
5124.. code-block:: llvm
5125
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00005126 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4}
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00005127
5128If the trip count of the loop is less than the unroll count the loop
5129will be partially unrolled.
5130
Mark Heffernane6b4ba12014-07-23 17:31:37 +00005131'``llvm.loop.unroll.disable``' Metadata
5132^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5133
Mark Heffernan3e32a4e2015-06-30 22:48:51 +00005134This metadata disables loop unrolling. The metadata has a single operand
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00005135which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.disable``. For example:
Mark Heffernane6b4ba12014-07-23 17:31:37 +00005136
5137.. code-block:: llvm
5138
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00005139 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.disable"}
Mark Heffernane6b4ba12014-07-23 17:31:37 +00005140
Kevin Qin715b01e2015-03-09 06:14:18 +00005141'``llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable``' Metadata
Dan Liew868b0742015-03-11 13:34:49 +00005142^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Kevin Qin715b01e2015-03-09 06:14:18 +00005143
Mark Heffernan3e32a4e2015-06-30 22:48:51 +00005144This metadata disables runtime loop unrolling. The metadata has a single
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00005145operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable``. For example:
Kevin Qin715b01e2015-03-09 06:14:18 +00005146
5147.. code-block:: llvm
5148
5149 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable"}
5150
Mark Heffernan89391542015-08-10 17:28:08 +00005151'``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``' Metadata
5152^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5153
5154This metadata suggests that the loop should be fully unrolled if the trip count
5155is known at compile time and partially unrolled if the trip count is not known
5156at compile time. The metadata has a single operand which is the string
5157``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``. For example:
5158
5159.. code-block:: llvm
5160
5161 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.enable"}
5162
Mark Heffernane6b4ba12014-07-23 17:31:37 +00005163'``llvm.loop.unroll.full``' Metadata
5164^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5165
Mark Heffernan3e32a4e2015-06-30 22:48:51 +00005166This metadata suggests that the loop should be unrolled fully. The
5167metadata has a single operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.full``.
Mark Heffernane6b4ba12014-07-23 17:31:37 +00005168For example:
5169
5170.. code-block:: llvm
5171
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00005172 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.full"}
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00005173
Ashutosh Nemadf6763a2016-02-06 07:47:48 +00005174'``llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable``' Metadata
Ashutosh Nema5f0e4722016-02-06 09:24:37 +00005175^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Ashutosh Nemadf6763a2016-02-06 07:47:48 +00005176
5177This metadata indicates that the loop should not be versioned for the purpose
5178of enabling loop-invariant code motion (LICM). The metadata has a single operand
5179which is the string ``llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable``. For example:
5180
5181.. code-block:: llvm
5182
5183 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable"}
5184
Adam Nemetd2fa4142016-04-27 05:28:18 +00005185'``llvm.loop.distribute.enable``' Metadata
Adam Nemet55dc0af2016-04-27 05:59:51 +00005186^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Adam Nemetd2fa4142016-04-27 05:28:18 +00005187
5188Loop distribution allows splitting a loop into multiple loops. Currently,
5189this is only performed if the entire loop cannot be vectorized due to unsafe
Hiroshi Inoueb93daec2017-07-02 12:44:27 +00005190memory dependencies. The transformation will attempt to isolate the unsafe
Adam Nemetd2fa4142016-04-27 05:28:18 +00005191dependencies into their own loop.
5192
5193This metadata can be used to selectively enable or disable distribution of the
5194loop. The first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.distribute.enable`` and the
5195second operand is a bit. If the bit operand value is 1 distribution is
5196enabled. A value of 0 disables distribution:
5197
5198.. code-block:: llvm
5199
5200 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.distribute.enable", i1 0}
5201 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.distribute.enable", i1 1}
5202
5203This metadata should be used in conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop
5204identification metadata.
5205
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00005206'``llvm.mem``'
5207^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5208
5209Metadata types used to annotate memory accesses with information helpful
5210for optimizations are prefixed with ``llvm.mem``.
5211
5212'``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access``' Metadata
5213^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5214
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00005215The ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata refers to a loop identifier,
5216or metadata containing a list of loop identifiers for nested loops.
5217The metadata is attached to memory accessing instructions and denotes that
5218no loop carried memory dependence exist between it and other instructions denoted
Hal Finkel411d31a2016-04-26 02:00:36 +00005219with the same loop identifier. The metadata on memory reads also implies that
5220if conversion (i.e. speculative execution within a loop iteration) is safe.
Pekka Jaaskelainen23b222cc2014-05-23 11:35:46 +00005221
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00005222Precisely, given two instructions ``m1`` and ``m2`` that both have the
5223``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata, with ``L1`` and ``L2`` being the
5224set of loops associated with that metadata, respectively, then there is no loop
5225carried dependence between ``m1`` and ``m2`` for loops in both ``L1`` and
Pekka Jaaskelainen23b222cc2014-05-23 11:35:46 +00005226``L2``.
5227
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00005228As a special case, if all memory accessing instructions in a loop have
5229``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata that refers to that loop, then the
5230loop has no loop carried memory dependences and is considered to be a parallel
5231loop.
Pekka Jaaskelainen23b222cc2014-05-23 11:35:46 +00005232
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00005233Note that if not all memory access instructions have such metadata referring to
5234the loop, then the loop is considered not being trivially parallel. Additional
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00005235memory dependence analysis is required to make that determination. As a fail
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00005236safe mechanism, this causes loops that were originally parallel to be considered
5237sequential (if optimization passes that are unaware of the parallel semantics
Pekka Jaaskelainen23b222cc2014-05-23 11:35:46 +00005238insert new memory instructions into the loop body).
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00005239
5240Example of a loop that is considered parallel due to its correct use of
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00005241both ``llvm.loop`` and ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access``
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00005242metadata types that refer to the same loop identifier metadata.
5243
5244.. code-block:: llvm
5245
5246 for.body:
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00005247 ...
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00005248 %val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00005249 ...
Tobias Grosserfbe95dc2014-03-05 13:36:04 +00005250 store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00005251 ...
5252 br i1 %exitcond, label %for.end, label %for.body, !llvm.loop !0
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00005253
5254 for.end:
5255 ...
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00005256 !0 = !{!0}
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00005257
5258It is also possible to have nested parallel loops. In that case the
5259memory accesses refer to a list of loop identifier metadata nodes instead of
5260the loop identifier metadata node directly:
5261
5262.. code-block:: llvm
5263
5264 outer.for.body:
Tobias Grosserfbe95dc2014-03-05 13:36:04 +00005265 ...
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00005266 %val1 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx3, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !2
Tobias Grosserfbe95dc2014-03-05 13:36:04 +00005267 ...
5268 br label %inner.for.body
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00005269
5270 inner.for.body:
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00005271 ...
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00005272 %val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00005273 ...
Tobias Grosserfbe95dc2014-03-05 13:36:04 +00005274 store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx2, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00005275 ...
5276 br i1 %exitcond, label %inner.for.end, label %inner.for.body, !llvm.loop !1
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00005277
5278 inner.for.end:
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00005279 ...
Tobias Grosserfbe95dc2014-03-05 13:36:04 +00005280 store i32 %val1, i32* %arrayidx4, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !2
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00005281 ...
5282 br i1 %exitcond, label %outer.for.end, label %outer.for.body, !llvm.loop !2
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00005283
5284 outer.for.end: ; preds = %for.body
5285 ...
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00005286 !0 = !{!1, !2} ; a list of loop identifiers
5287 !1 = !{!1} ; an identifier for the inner loop
5288 !2 = !{!2} ; an identifier for the outer loop
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00005289
Hiroshi Yamauchidce9def2017-11-02 22:26:51 +00005290'``irr_loop``' Metadata
5291^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5292
5293``irr_loop`` metadata may be attached to the terminator instruction of a basic
5294block that's an irreducible loop header (note that an irreducible loop has more
5295than once header basic blocks.) If ``irr_loop`` metadata is attached to the
5296terminator instruction of a basic block that is not really an irreducible loop
5297header, the behavior is undefined. The intent of this metadata is to improve the
5298accuracy of the block frequency propagation. For example, in the code below, the
5299block ``header0`` may have a loop header weight (relative to the other headers of
5300the irreducible loop) of 100:
5301
5302.. code-block:: llvm
5303
5304 header0:
5305 ...
5306 br i1 %cmp, label %t1, label %t2, !irr_loop !0
5307
5308 ...
5309 !0 = !{"loop_header_weight", i64 100}
5310
5311Irreducible loop header weights are typically based on profile data.
5312
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00005313'``invariant.group``' Metadata
5314^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5315
Piotr Padlewski74b155f2018-04-08 13:53:04 +00005316The experimental ``invariant.group`` metadata may be attached to
Piotr Padlewskice358262018-05-18 23:53:46 +00005317``load``/``store`` instructions referencing a single metadata with no entries.
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +00005318The existence of the ``invariant.group`` metadata on the instruction tells
5319the optimizer that every ``load`` and ``store`` to the same pointer operand
Piotr Padlewskice358262018-05-18 23:53:46 +00005320can be assumed to load or store the same
Piotr Padlewski5dde8092018-05-03 11:03:01 +00005321value (but see the ``llvm.launder.invariant.group`` intrinsic which affects
Piotr Padlewskida362152016-12-30 18:45:07 +00005322when two pointers are considered the same). Pointers returned by bitcast or
5323getelementptr with only zero indices are considered the same.
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00005324
5325Examples:
5326
5327.. code-block:: llvm
5328
5329 @unknownPtr = external global i8
5330 ...
5331 %ptr = alloca i8
5332 store i8 42, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0
5333 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +00005334
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00005335 %a = load i8, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can assume that value under %ptr didn't change
5336 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +00005337
5338 %newPtr = call i8* @getPointer(i8* %ptr)
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00005339 %c = load i8, i8* %newPtr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can't assume anything, because we only have information about %ptr
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +00005340
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00005341 %unknownValue = load i8, i8* @unknownPtr
5342 store i8 %unknownValue, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can assume that %unknownValue == 42
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +00005343
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00005344 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
Piotr Padlewski5dde8092018-05-03 11:03:01 +00005345 %newPtr2 = call i8* @llvm.launder.invariant.group(i8* %ptr)
5346 %d = load i8, i8* %newPtr2, !invariant.group !0 ; Can't step through launder.invariant.group to get value of %ptr
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +00005347
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00005348 ...
5349 declare void @foo(i8*)
5350 declare i8* @getPointer(i8*)
Piotr Padlewski5dde8092018-05-03 11:03:01 +00005351 declare i8* @llvm.launder.invariant.group(i8*)
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +00005352
Piotr Padlewskice358262018-05-18 23:53:46 +00005353 !0 = !{}
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00005354
Piotr Padlewskif8486e32017-04-12 07:59:35 +00005355The invariant.group metadata must be dropped when replacing one pointer by
5356another based on aliasing information. This is because invariant.group is tied
5357to the SSA value of the pointer operand.
5358
5359.. code-block:: llvm
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +00005360
Piotr Padlewskif8486e32017-04-12 07:59:35 +00005361 %v = load i8, i8* %x, !invariant.group !0
5362 ; if %x mustalias %y then we can replace the above instruction with
5363 %v = load i8, i8* %y
5364
Piotr Padlewski74b155f2018-04-08 13:53:04 +00005365Note that this is an experimental feature, which means that its semantics might
5366change in the future.
Piotr Padlewskif8486e32017-04-12 07:59:35 +00005367
Peter Collingbournea333db82016-07-26 22:31:30 +00005368'``type``' Metadata
5369^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5370
5371See :doc:`TypeMetadata`.
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00005372
Evgeniy Stepanov51c962f722017-03-17 22:17:24 +00005373'``associated``' Metadata
Evgeniy Stepanov4d490de2017-03-17 22:31:13 +00005374^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Evgeniy Stepanov51c962f722017-03-17 22:17:24 +00005375
5376The ``associated`` metadata may be attached to a global object
5377declaration with a single argument that references another global object.
5378
5379This metadata prevents discarding of the global object in linker GC
5380unless the referenced object is also discarded. The linker support for
5381this feature is spotty. For best compatibility, globals carrying this
5382metadata may also:
5383
5384- Be in a comdat with the referenced global.
5385- Be in @llvm.compiler.used.
5386- Have an explicit section with a name which is a valid C identifier.
5387
5388It does not have any effect on non-ELF targets.
5389
5390Example:
5391
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +00005392.. code-block:: text
Evgeniy Stepanov4d490de2017-03-17 22:31:13 +00005393
Evgeniy Stepanov51c962f722017-03-17 22:17:24 +00005394 $a = comdat any
5395 @a = global i32 1, comdat $a
5396 @b = internal global i32 2, comdat $a, section "abc", !associated !0
5397 !0 = !{i32* @a}
5398
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00005399
Teresa Johnsond72f51c2017-06-15 15:57:12 +00005400'``prof``' Metadata
5401^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5402
5403The ``prof`` metadata is used to record profile data in the IR.
5404The first operand of the metadata node indicates the profile metadata
5405type. There are currently 3 types:
5406:ref:`branch_weights<prof_node_branch_weights>`,
5407:ref:`function_entry_count<prof_node_function_entry_count>`, and
5408:ref:`VP<prof_node_VP>`.
5409
5410.. _prof_node_branch_weights:
5411
5412branch_weights
5413""""""""""""""
5414
5415Branch weight metadata attached to a branch, select, switch or call instruction
5416represents the likeliness of the associated branch being taken.
5417For more information, see :doc:`BranchWeightMetadata`.
5418
5419.. _prof_node_function_entry_count:
5420
5421function_entry_count
5422""""""""""""""""""""
5423
5424Function entry count metadata can be attached to function definitions
5425to record the number of times the function is called. Used with BFI
5426information, it is also used to derive the basic block profile count.
5427For more information, see :doc:`BranchWeightMetadata`.
5428
5429.. _prof_node_VP:
5430
5431VP
5432""
5433
5434VP (value profile) metadata can be attached to instructions that have
5435value profile information. Currently this is indirect calls (where it
5436records the hottest callees) and calls to memory intrinsics such as memcpy,
5437memmove, and memset (where it records the hottest byte lengths).
5438
5439Each VP metadata node contains "VP" string, then a uint32_t value for the value
5440profiling kind, a uint64_t value for the total number of times the instruction
5441is executed, followed by uint64_t value and execution count pairs.
5442The value profiling kind is 0 for indirect call targets and 1 for memory
5443operations. For indirect call targets, each profile value is a hash
5444of the callee function name, and for memory operations each value is the
5445byte length.
5446
5447Note that the value counts do not need to add up to the total count
5448listed in the third operand (in practice only the top hottest values
5449are tracked and reported).
5450
5451Indirect call example:
5452
5453.. code-block:: llvm
5454
5455 call void %f(), !prof !1
5456 !1 = !{!"VP", i32 0, i64 1600, i64 7651369219802541373, i64 1030, i64 -4377547752858689819, i64 410}
5457
5458Note that the VP type is 0 (the second operand), which indicates this is
5459an indirect call value profile data. The third operand indicates that the
5460indirect call executed 1600 times. The 4th and 6th operands give the
5461hashes of the 2 hottest target functions' names (this is the same hash used
5462to represent function names in the profile database), and the 5th and 7th
5463operands give the execution count that each of the respective prior target
5464functions was called.
5465
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005466Module Flags Metadata
5467=====================
5468
5469Information about the module as a whole is difficult to convey to LLVM's
5470subsystems. The LLVM IR isn't sufficient to transmit this information.
5471The ``llvm.module.flags`` named metadata exists in order to facilitate
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00005472this. These flags are in the form of key / value pairs --- much like a
5473dictionary --- making it easy for any subsystem who cares about a flag to
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005474look it up.
5475
5476The ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata contains a list of metadata triplets.
5477Each triplet has the following form:
5478
5479- The first element is a *behavior* flag, which specifies the behavior
5480 when two (or more) modules are merged together, and it encounters two
5481 (or more) metadata with the same ID. The supported behaviors are
5482 described below.
5483- The second element is a metadata string that is a unique ID for the
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00005484 metadata. Each module may only have one flag entry for each unique ID (not
5485 including entries with the **Require** behavior).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005486- The third element is the value of the flag.
5487
5488When two (or more) modules are merged together, the resulting
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00005489``llvm.module.flags`` metadata is the union of the modules' flags. That is, for
5490each unique metadata ID string, there will be exactly one entry in the merged
5491modules ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata table, and the value for that entry will
5492be determined by the merge behavior flag, as described below. The only exception
5493is that entries with the *Require* behavior are always preserved.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005494
5495The following behaviors are supported:
5496
5497.. list-table::
5498 :header-rows: 1
5499 :widths: 10 90
5500
5501 * - Value
5502 - Behavior
5503
5504 * - 1
5505 - **Error**
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00005506 Emits an error if two values disagree, otherwise the resulting value
5507 is that of the operands.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005508
5509 * - 2
5510 - **Warning**
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00005511 Emits a warning if two values disagree. The result value will be the
5512 operand for the flag from the first module being linked.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005513
5514 * - 3
5515 - **Require**
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00005516 Adds a requirement that another module flag be present and have a
5517 specified value after linking is performed. The value must be a
5518 metadata pair, where the first element of the pair is the ID of the
5519 module flag to be restricted, and the second element of the pair is
5520 the value the module flag should be restricted to. This behavior can
5521 be used to restrict the allowable results (via triggering of an
5522 error) of linking IDs with the **Override** behavior.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005523
5524 * - 4
5525 - **Override**
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00005526 Uses the specified value, regardless of the behavior or value of the
5527 other module. If both modules specify **Override**, but the values
5528 differ, an error will be emitted.
5529
Daniel Dunbard77d9fb2013-01-16 21:38:56 +00005530 * - 5
5531 - **Append**
5532 Appends the two values, which are required to be metadata nodes.
5533
5534 * - 6
5535 - **AppendUnique**
5536 Appends the two values, which are required to be metadata
5537 nodes. However, duplicate entries in the second list are dropped
5538 during the append operation.
5539
Steven Wu86a511e2017-08-15 16:16:33 +00005540 * - 7
5541 - **Max**
5542 Takes the max of the two values, which are required to be integers.
5543
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00005544It is an error for a particular unique flag ID to have multiple behaviors,
5545except in the case of **Require** (which adds restrictions on another metadata
5546value) or **Override**.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005547
5548An example of module flags:
5549
5550.. code-block:: llvm
5551
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00005552 !0 = !{ i32 1, !"foo", i32 1 }
5553 !1 = !{ i32 4, !"bar", i32 37 }
5554 !2 = !{ i32 2, !"qux", i32 42 }
5555 !3 = !{ i32 3, !"qux",
5556 !{
5557 !"foo", i32 1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005558 }
5559 }
5560 !llvm.module.flags = !{ !0, !1, !2, !3 }
5561
5562- Metadata ``!0`` has the ID ``!"foo"`` and the value '1'. The behavior
5563 if two or more ``!"foo"`` flags are seen is to emit an error if their
5564 values are not equal.
5565
5566- Metadata ``!1`` has the ID ``!"bar"`` and the value '37'. The
5567 behavior if two or more ``!"bar"`` flags are seen is to use the value
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00005568 '37'.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005569
5570- Metadata ``!2`` has the ID ``!"qux"`` and the value '42'. The
5571 behavior if two or more ``!"qux"`` flags are seen is to emit a
5572 warning if their values are not equal.
5573
5574- Metadata ``!3`` has the ID ``!"qux"`` and the value:
5575
5576 ::
5577
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00005578 !{ !"foo", i32 1 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005579
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00005580 The behavior is to emit an error if the ``llvm.module.flags`` does not
5581 contain a flag with the ID ``!"foo"`` that has the value '1' after linking is
5582 performed.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005583
5584Objective-C Garbage Collection Module Flags Metadata
5585----------------------------------------------------
5586
5587On the Mach-O platform, Objective-C stores metadata about garbage
5588collection in a special section called "image info". The metadata
5589consists of a version number and a bitmask specifying what types of
5590garbage collection are supported (if any) by the file. If two or more
5591modules are linked together their garbage collection metadata needs to
5592be merged rather than appended together.
5593
5594The Objective-C garbage collection module flags metadata consists of the
5595following key-value pairs:
5596
5597.. list-table::
5598 :header-rows: 1
5599 :widths: 30 70
5600
5601 * - Key
5602 - Value
5603
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00005604 * - ``Objective-C Version``
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00005605 - **[Required]** --- The Objective-C ABI version. Valid values are 1 and 2.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005606
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00005607 * - ``Objective-C Image Info Version``
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00005608 - **[Required]** --- The version of the image info section. Currently
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005609 always 0.
5610
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00005611 * - ``Objective-C Image Info Section``
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00005612 - **[Required]** --- The section to place the metadata. Valid values are
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005613 ``"__OBJC, __image_info, regular"`` for Objective-C ABI version 1, and
5614 ``"__DATA,__objc_imageinfo, regular, no_dead_strip"`` for
5615 Objective-C ABI version 2.
5616
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00005617 * - ``Objective-C Garbage Collection``
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00005618 - **[Required]** --- Specifies whether garbage collection is supported or
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005619 not. Valid values are 0, for no garbage collection, and 2, for garbage
5620 collection supported.
5621
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00005622 * - ``Objective-C GC Only``
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00005623 - **[Optional]** --- Specifies that only garbage collection is supported.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005624 If present, its value must be 6. This flag requires that the
5625 ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` flag have the value 2.
5626
5627Some important flag interactions:
5628
5629- If a module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 0 is
5630 merged with a module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to
5631 2, then the resulting module has the
5632 ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` flag set to 0.
5633- A module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 0 cannot be
5634 merged with a module with ``Objective-C GC Only`` set to 6.
5635
Oliver Stannard5dc29342014-06-20 10:08:11 +00005636C type width Module Flags Metadata
5637----------------------------------
5638
5639The ARM backend emits a section into each generated object file describing the
5640options that it was compiled with (in a compiler-independent way) to prevent
5641linking incompatible objects, and to allow automatic library selection. Some
5642of these options are not visible at the IR level, namely wchar_t width and enum
5643width.
5644
5645To pass this information to the backend, these options are encoded in module
5646flags metadata, using the following key-value pairs:
5647
5648.. list-table::
5649 :header-rows: 1
5650 :widths: 30 70
5651
5652 * - Key
5653 - Value
5654
5655 * - short_wchar
5656 - * 0 --- sizeof(wchar_t) == 4
5657 * 1 --- sizeof(wchar_t) == 2
5658
5659 * - short_enum
5660 - * 0 --- Enums are at least as large as an ``int``.
5661 * 1 --- Enums are stored in the smallest integer type which can
5662 represent all of its values.
5663
5664For example, the following metadata section specifies that the module was
5665compiled with a ``wchar_t`` width of 4 bytes, and the underlying type of an
5666enum is the smallest type which can represent all of its values::
5667
5668 !llvm.module.flags = !{!0, !1}
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00005669 !0 = !{i32 1, !"short_wchar", i32 1}
5670 !1 = !{i32 1, !"short_enum", i32 0}
Oliver Stannard5dc29342014-06-20 10:08:11 +00005671
Peter Collingbourne89061b22017-06-12 20:10:48 +00005672Automatic Linker Flags Named Metadata
5673=====================================
5674
5675Some targets support embedding flags to the linker inside individual object
5676files. Typically this is used in conjunction with language extensions which
5677allow source files to explicitly declare the libraries they depend on, and have
5678these automatically be transmitted to the linker via object files.
5679
5680These flags are encoded in the IR using named metadata with the name
5681``!llvm.linker.options``. Each operand is expected to be a metadata node
5682which should be a list of other metadata nodes, each of which should be a
5683list of metadata strings defining linker options.
5684
5685For example, the following metadata section specifies two separate sets of
5686linker options, presumably to link against ``libz`` and the ``Cocoa``
5687framework::
5688
5689 !0 = !{ !"-lz" },
5690 !1 = !{ !"-framework", !"Cocoa" } } }
5691 !llvm.linker.options = !{ !0, !1 }
5692
5693The metadata encoding as lists of lists of options, as opposed to a collapsed
5694list of options, is chosen so that the IR encoding can use multiple option
5695strings to specify e.g., a single library, while still having that specifier be
5696preserved as an atomic element that can be recognized by a target specific
5697assembly writer or object file emitter.
5698
5699Each individual option is required to be either a valid option for the target's
5700linker, or an option that is reserved by the target specific assembly writer or
5701object file emitter. No other aspect of these options is defined by the IR.
5702
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00005703.. _intrinsicglobalvariables:
5704
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005705Intrinsic Global Variables
5706==========================
5707
5708LLVM has a number of "magic" global variables that contain data that
5709affect code generation or other IR semantics. These are documented here.
5710All globals of this sort should have a section specified as
5711"``llvm.metadata``". This section and all globals that start with
5712"``llvm.``" are reserved for use by LLVM.
5713
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00005714.. _gv_llvmused:
5715
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005716The '``llvm.used``' Global Variable
5717-----------------------------------
5718
Rafael Espindola74f2e462013-04-22 14:58:02 +00005719The ``@llvm.used`` global is an array which has
Paul Redmond219ef812013-05-30 17:24:32 +00005720:ref:`appending linkage <linkage_appending>`. This array contains a list of
Rafael Espindola70a729d2013-06-11 13:18:13 +00005721pointers to named global variables, functions and aliases which may optionally
5722have a pointer cast formed of bitcast or getelementptr. For example, a legal
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005723use of it is:
5724
5725.. code-block:: llvm
5726
5727 @X = global i8 4
5728 @Y = global i32 123
5729
5730 @llvm.used = appending global [2 x i8*] [
5731 i8* @X,
5732 i8* bitcast (i32* @Y to i8*)
5733 ], section "llvm.metadata"
5734
Rafael Espindola74f2e462013-04-22 14:58:02 +00005735If a symbol appears in the ``@llvm.used`` list, then the compiler, assembler,
5736and linker are required to treat the symbol as if there is a reference to the
Rafael Espindola70a729d2013-06-11 13:18:13 +00005737symbol that it cannot see (which is why they have to be named). For example, if
5738a variable has internal linkage and no references other than that from the
5739``@llvm.used`` list, it cannot be deleted. This is commonly used to represent
5740references from inline asms and other things the compiler cannot "see", and
5741corresponds to "``attribute((used))``" in GNU C.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005742
5743On some targets, the code generator must emit a directive to the
5744assembler or object file to prevent the assembler and linker from
5745molesting the symbol.
5746
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00005747.. _gv_llvmcompilerused:
5748
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005749The '``llvm.compiler.used``' Global Variable
5750--------------------------------------------
5751
5752The ``@llvm.compiler.used`` directive is the same as the ``@llvm.used``
5753directive, except that it only prevents the compiler from touching the
5754symbol. On targets that support it, this allows an intelligent linker to
5755optimize references to the symbol without being impeded as it would be
5756by ``@llvm.used``.
5757
5758This is a rare construct that should only be used in rare circumstances,
5759and should not be exposed to source languages.
5760
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00005761.. _gv_llvmglobalctors:
5762
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005763The '``llvm.global_ctors``' Global Variable
5764-------------------------------------------
5765
5766.. code-block:: llvm
5767
Reid Klecknerfceb76f2014-05-16 20:39:27 +00005768 %0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* }
5769 @llvm.global_ctors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @ctor, i8* @data }]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005770
5771The ``@llvm.global_ctors`` array contains a list of constructor
Reid Klecknerfceb76f2014-05-16 20:39:27 +00005772functions, priorities, and an optional associated global or function.
5773The functions referenced by this array will be called in ascending order
5774of priority (i.e. lowest first) when the module is loaded. The order of
5775functions with the same priority is not defined.
5776
5777If the third field is present, non-null, and points to a global variable
5778or function, the initializer function will only run if the associated
5779data from the current module is not discarded.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005780
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00005781.. _llvmglobaldtors:
5782
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005783The '``llvm.global_dtors``' Global Variable
5784-------------------------------------------
5785
5786.. code-block:: llvm
5787
Reid Klecknerfceb76f2014-05-16 20:39:27 +00005788 %0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* }
5789 @llvm.global_dtors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @dtor, i8* @data }]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005790
Reid Klecknerfceb76f2014-05-16 20:39:27 +00005791The ``@llvm.global_dtors`` array contains a list of destructor
5792functions, priorities, and an optional associated global or function.
5793The functions referenced by this array will be called in descending
Reid Klecknerbffbcc52014-05-27 21:35:17 +00005794order of priority (i.e. highest first) when the module is unloaded. The
Reid Klecknerfceb76f2014-05-16 20:39:27 +00005795order of functions with the same priority is not defined.
5796
5797If the third field is present, non-null, and points to a global variable
5798or function, the destructor function will only run if the associated
5799data from the current module is not discarded.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005800
5801Instruction Reference
5802=====================
5803
5804The LLVM instruction set consists of several different classifications
5805of instructions: :ref:`terminator instructions <terminators>`, :ref:`binary
5806instructions <binaryops>`, :ref:`bitwise binary
5807instructions <bitwiseops>`, :ref:`memory instructions <memoryops>`, and
5808:ref:`other instructions <otherops>`.
5809
5810.. _terminators:
5811
5812Terminator Instructions
5813-----------------------
5814
5815As mentioned :ref:`previously <functionstructure>`, every basic block in a
5816program ends with a "Terminator" instruction, which indicates which
5817block should be executed after the current block is finished. These
5818terminator instructions typically yield a '``void``' value: they produce
5819control flow, not values (the one exception being the
5820':ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`' instruction).
5821
5822The terminator instructions are: ':ref:`ret <i_ret>`',
5823':ref:`br <i_br>`', ':ref:`switch <i_switch>`',
5824':ref:`indirectbr <i_indirectbr>`', ':ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`',
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005825':ref:`resume <i_resume>`', ':ref:`catchswitch <i_catchswitch>`',
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005826':ref:`catchret <i_catchret>`',
5827':ref:`cleanupret <i_cleanupret>`',
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005828and ':ref:`unreachable <i_unreachable>`'.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005829
5830.. _i_ret:
5831
5832'``ret``' Instruction
5833^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5834
5835Syntax:
5836"""""""
5837
5838::
5839
5840 ret <type> <value> ; Return a value from a non-void function
5841 ret void ; Return from void function
5842
5843Overview:
5844"""""""""
5845
5846The '``ret``' instruction is used to return control flow (and optionally
5847a value) from a function back to the caller.
5848
5849There are two forms of the '``ret``' instruction: one that returns a
5850value and then causes control flow, and one that just causes control
5851flow to occur.
5852
5853Arguments:
5854""""""""""
5855
5856The '``ret``' instruction optionally accepts a single argument, the
5857return value. The type of the return value must be a ':ref:`first
5858class <t_firstclass>`' type.
5859
5860A function is not :ref:`well formed <wellformed>` if it it has a non-void
5861return type and contains a '``ret``' instruction with no return value or
5862a return value with a type that does not match its type, or if it has a
5863void return type and contains a '``ret``' instruction with a return
5864value.
5865
5866Semantics:
5867""""""""""
5868
5869When the '``ret``' instruction is executed, control flow returns back to
5870the calling function's context. If the caller is a
5871":ref:`call <i_call>`" instruction, execution continues at the
5872instruction after the call. If the caller was an
5873":ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`" instruction, execution continues at the
5874beginning of the "normal" destination block. If the instruction returns
5875a value, that value shall set the call or invoke instruction's return
5876value.
5877
5878Example:
5879""""""""
5880
5881.. code-block:: llvm
5882
5883 ret i32 5 ; Return an integer value of 5
5884 ret void ; Return from a void function
5885 ret { i32, i8 } { i32 4, i8 2 } ; Return a struct of values 4 and 2
5886
5887.. _i_br:
5888
5889'``br``' Instruction
5890^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5891
5892Syntax:
5893"""""""
5894
5895::
5896
5897 br i1 <cond>, label <iftrue>, label <iffalse>
5898 br label <dest> ; Unconditional branch
5899
5900Overview:
5901"""""""""
5902
5903The '``br``' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to a
5904different basic block in the current function. There are two forms of
5905this instruction, corresponding to a conditional branch and an
5906unconditional branch.
5907
5908Arguments:
5909""""""""""
5910
5911The conditional branch form of the '``br``' instruction takes a single
5912'``i1``' value and two '``label``' values. The unconditional form of the
5913'``br``' instruction takes a single '``label``' value as a target.
5914
5915Semantics:
5916""""""""""
5917
5918Upon execution of a conditional '``br``' instruction, the '``i1``'
5919argument is evaluated. If the value is ``true``, control flows to the
5920'``iftrue``' ``label`` argument. If "cond" is ``false``, control flows
5921to the '``iffalse``' ``label`` argument.
5922
5923Example:
5924""""""""
5925
5926.. code-block:: llvm
5927
5928 Test:
5929 %cond = icmp eq i32 %a, %b
5930 br i1 %cond, label %IfEqual, label %IfUnequal
5931 IfEqual:
5932 ret i32 1
5933 IfUnequal:
5934 ret i32 0
5935
5936.. _i_switch:
5937
5938'``switch``' Instruction
5939^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5940
5941Syntax:
5942"""""""
5943
5944::
5945
5946 switch <intty> <value>, label <defaultdest> [ <intty> <val>, label <dest> ... ]
5947
5948Overview:
5949"""""""""
5950
5951The '``switch``' instruction is used to transfer control flow to one of
5952several different places. It is a generalization of the '``br``'
5953instruction, allowing a branch to occur to one of many possible
5954destinations.
5955
5956Arguments:
5957""""""""""
5958
5959The '``switch``' instruction uses three parameters: an integer
5960comparison value '``value``', a default '``label``' destination, and an
5961array of pairs of comparison value constants and '``label``'s. The table
5962is not allowed to contain duplicate constant entries.
5963
5964Semantics:
5965""""""""""
5966
5967The ``switch`` instruction specifies a table of values and destinations.
5968When the '``switch``' instruction is executed, this table is searched
5969for the given value. If the value is found, control flow is transferred
5970to the corresponding destination; otherwise, control flow is transferred
5971to the default destination.
5972
5973Implementation:
5974"""""""""""""""
5975
5976Depending on properties of the target machine and the particular
5977``switch`` instruction, this instruction may be code generated in
5978different ways. For example, it could be generated as a series of
5979chained conditional branches or with a lookup table.
5980
5981Example:
5982""""""""
5983
5984.. code-block:: llvm
5985
5986 ; Emulate a conditional br instruction
5987 %Val = zext i1 %value to i32
5988 switch i32 %Val, label %truedest [ i32 0, label %falsedest ]
5989
5990 ; Emulate an unconditional br instruction
5991 switch i32 0, label %dest [ ]
5992
5993 ; Implement a jump table:
5994 switch i32 %val, label %otherwise [ i32 0, label %onzero
5995 i32 1, label %onone
5996 i32 2, label %ontwo ]
5997
5998.. _i_indirectbr:
5999
6000'``indirectbr``' Instruction
6001^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6002
6003Syntax:
6004"""""""
6005
6006::
6007
6008 indirectbr <somety>* <address>, [ label <dest1>, label <dest2>, ... ]
6009
6010Overview:
6011"""""""""
6012
6013The '``indirectbr``' instruction implements an indirect branch to a
6014label within the current function, whose address is specified by
6015"``address``". Address must be derived from a
6016:ref:`blockaddress <blockaddress>` constant.
6017
6018Arguments:
6019""""""""""
6020
6021The '``address``' argument is the address of the label to jump to. The
6022rest of the arguments indicate the full set of possible destinations
6023that the address may point to. Blocks are allowed to occur multiple
6024times in the destination list, though this isn't particularly useful.
6025
6026This destination list is required so that dataflow analysis has an
6027accurate understanding of the CFG.
6028
6029Semantics:
6030""""""""""
6031
6032Control transfers to the block specified in the address argument. All
6033possible destination blocks must be listed in the label list, otherwise
6034this instruction has undefined behavior. This implies that jumps to
6035labels defined in other functions have undefined behavior as well.
6036
6037Implementation:
6038"""""""""""""""
6039
6040This is typically implemented with a jump through a register.
6041
6042Example:
6043""""""""
6044
6045.. code-block:: llvm
6046
6047 indirectbr i8* %Addr, [ label %bb1, label %bb2, label %bb3 ]
6048
6049.. _i_invoke:
6050
6051'``invoke``' Instruction
6052^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6053
6054Syntax:
6055"""""""
6056
6057::
6058
David Blaikieb83cf102016-07-13 17:21:34 +00006059 <result> = invoke [cconv] [ret attrs] <ty>|<fnty> <fnptrval>(<function args>) [fn attrs]
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00006060 [operand bundles] to label <normal label> unwind label <exception label>
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006061
6062Overview:
6063"""""""""
6064
6065The '``invoke``' instruction causes control to transfer to a specified
6066function, with the possibility of control flow transfer to either the
6067'``normal``' label or the '``exception``' label. If the callee function
6068returns with the "``ret``" instruction, control flow will return to the
6069"normal" label. If the callee (or any indirect callees) returns via the
6070":ref:`resume <i_resume>`" instruction or other exception handling
6071mechanism, control is interrupted and continued at the dynamically
6072nearest "exception" label.
6073
6074The '``exception``' label is a `landing
6075pad <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ for the exception. As such,
6076'``exception``' label is required to have the
6077":ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>`" instruction, which contains the
6078information about the behavior of the program after unwinding happens,
6079as its first non-PHI instruction. The restrictions on the
6080"``landingpad``" instruction's tightly couples it to the "``invoke``"
6081instruction, so that the important information contained within the
6082"``landingpad``" instruction can't be lost through normal code motion.
6083
6084Arguments:
6085""""""""""
6086
6087This instruction requires several arguments:
6088
6089#. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling
6090 convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is
6091 specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions.
6092#. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return
6093 values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes
6094 are valid here.
David Blaikieb83cf102016-07-13 17:21:34 +00006095#. '``ty``': the type of the call instruction itself which is also the
6096 type of the return value. Functions that return no value are marked
6097 ``void``.
6098#. '``fnty``': shall be the signature of the function being invoked. The
6099 argument types must match the types implied by this signature. This
6100 type can be omitted if the function is not varargs.
6101#. '``fnptrval``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to
6102 be invoked. In most cases, this is a direct function invocation, but
6103 indirect ``invoke``'s are just as possible, calling an arbitrary pointer
6104 to function value.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006105#. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function
6106 signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must
6107 be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature
6108 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the
6109 extra arguments can be specified.
6110#. '``normal label``': the label reached when the called function
6111 executes a '``ret``' instruction.
6112#. '``exception label``': the label reached when a callee returns via
6113 the :ref:`resume <i_resume>` instruction or other exception handling
6114 mechanism.
George Burgess IV8a464a72017-04-13 05:00:31 +00006115#. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list.
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00006116#. The optional :ref:`operand bundles <opbundles>` list.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006117
6118Semantics:
6119""""""""""
6120
6121This instruction is designed to operate as a standard '``call``'
6122instruction in most regards. The primary difference is that it
6123establishes an association with a label, which is used by the runtime
6124library to unwind the stack.
6125
6126This instruction is used in languages with destructors to ensure that
6127proper cleanup is performed in the case of either a ``longjmp`` or a
6128thrown exception. Additionally, this is important for implementation of
6129'``catch``' clauses in high-level languages that support them.
6130
6131For the purposes of the SSA form, the definition of the value returned
6132by the '``invoke``' instruction is deemed to occur on the edge from the
6133current block to the "normal" label. If the callee unwinds then no
6134return value is available.
6135
6136Example:
6137""""""""
6138
6139.. code-block:: llvm
6140
6141 %retval = invoke i32 @Test(i32 15) to label %Continue
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006142 unwind label %TestCleanup ; i32:retval set
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006143 %retval = invoke coldcc i32 %Testfnptr(i32 15) to label %Continue
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006144 unwind label %TestCleanup ; i32:retval set
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006145
6146.. _i_resume:
6147
6148'``resume``' Instruction
6149^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6150
6151Syntax:
6152"""""""
6153
6154::
6155
6156 resume <type> <value>
6157
6158Overview:
6159"""""""""
6160
6161The '``resume``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has no
6162successors.
6163
6164Arguments:
6165""""""""""
6166
6167The '``resume``' instruction requires one argument, which must have the
6168same type as the result of any '``landingpad``' instruction in the same
6169function.
6170
6171Semantics:
6172""""""""""
6173
6174The '``resume``' instruction resumes propagation of an existing
6175(in-flight) exception whose unwinding was interrupted with a
6176:ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>` instruction.
6177
6178Example:
6179""""""""
6180
6181.. code-block:: llvm
6182
6183 resume { i8*, i32 } %exn
6184
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00006185.. _i_catchswitch:
6186
6187'``catchswitch``' Instruction
Akira Hatanakacedf8e92015-12-14 05:15:40 +00006188^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00006189
6190Syntax:
6191"""""""
6192
6193::
6194
6195 <resultval> = catchswitch within <parent> [ label <handler1>, label <handler2>, ... ] unwind to caller
6196 <resultval> = catchswitch within <parent> [ label <handler1>, label <handler2>, ... ] unwind label <default>
6197
6198Overview:
6199"""""""""
6200
6201The '``catchswitch``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling system
6202<ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to describe the set of possible catch handlers
6203that may be executed by the :ref:`EH personality routine <personalityfn>`.
6204
6205Arguments:
6206""""""""""
6207
6208The ``parent`` argument is the token of the funclet that contains the
6209``catchswitch`` instruction. If the ``catchswitch`` is not inside a funclet,
6210this operand may be the token ``none``.
6211
Joseph Tremoulete28885e2016-01-10 04:28:38 +00006212The ``default`` argument is the label of another basic block beginning with
6213either a ``cleanuppad`` or ``catchswitch`` instruction. This unwind destination
6214must be a legal target with respect to the ``parent`` links, as described in
6215the `exception handling documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_.
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00006216
Joseph Tremoulete28885e2016-01-10 04:28:38 +00006217The ``handlers`` are a nonempty list of successor blocks that each begin with a
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00006218:ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` instruction.
6219
6220Semantics:
6221""""""""""
6222
6223Executing this instruction transfers control to one of the successors in
6224``handlers``, if appropriate, or continues to unwind via the unwind label if
6225present.
6226
6227The ``catchswitch`` is both a terminator and a "pad" instruction, meaning that
6228it must be both the first non-phi instruction and last instruction in the basic
6229block. Therefore, it must be the only non-phi instruction in the block.
6230
6231Example:
6232""""""""
6233
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006234.. code-block:: text
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00006235
6236 dispatch1:
6237 %cs1 = catchswitch within none [label %handler0, label %handler1] unwind to caller
6238 dispatch2:
6239 %cs2 = catchswitch within %parenthandler [label %handler0] unwind label %cleanup
6240
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00006241.. _i_catchret:
6242
6243'``catchret``' Instruction
6244^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6245
6246Syntax:
6247"""""""
6248
6249::
6250
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00006251 catchret from <token> to label <normal>
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00006252
6253Overview:
6254"""""""""
6255
6256The '``catchret``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has a
6257single successor.
6258
6259
6260Arguments:
6261""""""""""
6262
Joseph Tremoulet8220bcc2015-08-23 00:26:33 +00006263The first argument to a '``catchret``' indicates which ``catchpad`` it
6264exits. It must be a :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>`.
6265The second argument to a '``catchret``' specifies where control will
6266transfer to next.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00006267
6268Semantics:
6269""""""""""
6270
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00006271The '``catchret``' instruction ends an existing (in-flight) exception whose
6272unwinding was interrupted with a :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` instruction. The
6273:ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` gets a chance to execute arbitrary
6274code to, for example, destroy the active exception. Control then transfers to
6275``normal``.
Joseph Tremoulet9ce71f72015-09-03 09:09:43 +00006276
Joseph Tremoulete28885e2016-01-10 04:28:38 +00006277The ``token`` argument must be a token produced by a ``catchpad`` instruction.
6278If the specified ``catchpad`` is not the most-recently-entered not-yet-exited
6279funclet pad (as described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
6280the ``catchret``'s behavior is undefined.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00006281
6282Example:
6283""""""""
6284
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006285.. code-block:: text
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00006286
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00006287 catchret from %catch label %continue
Joseph Tremoulet9ce71f72015-09-03 09:09:43 +00006288
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00006289.. _i_cleanupret:
6290
6291'``cleanupret``' Instruction
6292^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6293
6294Syntax:
6295"""""""
6296
6297::
6298
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00006299 cleanupret from <value> unwind label <continue>
6300 cleanupret from <value> unwind to caller
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00006301
6302Overview:
6303"""""""""
6304
6305The '``cleanupret``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has
6306an optional successor.
6307
6308
6309Arguments:
6310""""""""""
6311
Joseph Tremoulet8220bcc2015-08-23 00:26:33 +00006312The '``cleanupret``' instruction requires one argument, which indicates
6313which ``cleanuppad`` it exits, and must be a :ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>`.
Joseph Tremoulete28885e2016-01-10 04:28:38 +00006314If the specified ``cleanuppad`` is not the most-recently-entered not-yet-exited
6315funclet pad (as described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
6316the ``cleanupret``'s behavior is undefined.
6317
6318The '``cleanupret``' instruction also has an optional successor, ``continue``,
6319which must be the label of another basic block beginning with either a
6320``cleanuppad`` or ``catchswitch`` instruction. This unwind destination must
6321be a legal target with respect to the ``parent`` links, as described in the
6322`exception handling documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00006323
6324Semantics:
6325""""""""""
6326
6327The '``cleanupret``' instruction indicates to the
6328:ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` that one
6329:ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>` it transferred control to has ended.
6330It transfers control to ``continue`` or unwinds out of the function.
Joseph Tremoulet9ce71f72015-09-03 09:09:43 +00006331
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00006332Example:
6333""""""""
6334
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006335.. code-block:: text
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00006336
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00006337 cleanupret from %cleanup unwind to caller
6338 cleanupret from %cleanup unwind label %continue
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00006339
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006340.. _i_unreachable:
6341
6342'``unreachable``' Instruction
6343^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6344
6345Syntax:
6346"""""""
6347
6348::
6349
6350 unreachable
6351
6352Overview:
6353"""""""""
6354
6355The '``unreachable``' instruction has no defined semantics. This
6356instruction is used to inform the optimizer that a particular portion of
6357the code is not reachable. This can be used to indicate that the code
6358after a no-return function cannot be reached, and other facts.
6359
6360Semantics:
6361""""""""""
6362
6363The '``unreachable``' instruction has no defined semantics.
6364
6365.. _binaryops:
6366
6367Binary Operations
6368-----------------
6369
6370Binary operators are used to do most of the computation in a program.
6371They require two operands of the same type, execute an operation on
6372them, and produce a single value. The operands might represent multiple
6373data, as is the case with the :ref:`vector <t_vector>` data type. The
6374result value has the same type as its operands.
6375
6376There are several different binary operators:
6377
6378.. _i_add:
6379
6380'``add``' Instruction
6381^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6382
6383Syntax:
6384"""""""
6385
6386::
6387
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006388 <result> = add <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6389 <result> = add nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6390 <result> = add nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6391 <result> = add nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006392
6393Overview:
6394"""""""""
6395
6396The '``add``' instruction returns the sum of its two operands.
6397
6398Arguments:
6399""""""""""
6400
6401The two arguments to the '``add``' instruction must be
6402:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6403arguments must have identical types.
6404
6405Semantics:
6406""""""""""
6407
6408The value produced is the integer sum of the two operands.
6409
6410If the sum has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the
6411mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
6412the result.
6413
6414Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this
6415instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.
6416
6417``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
6418respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
6419result value of the ``add`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
6420unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
6421
6422Example:
6423""""""""
6424
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006425.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006426
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006427 <result> = add i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 + %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006428
6429.. _i_fadd:
6430
6431'``fadd``' Instruction
6432^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6433
6434Syntax:
6435"""""""
6436
6437::
6438
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006439 <result> = fadd [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006440
6441Overview:
6442"""""""""
6443
6444The '``fadd``' instruction returns the sum of its two operands.
6445
6446Arguments:
6447""""""""""
6448
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00006449The two arguments to the '``fadd``' instruction must be
6450:ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
6451floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006452
6453Semantics:
6454""""""""""
6455
Sanjay Patel7b722402018-03-07 17:18:22 +00006456The value produced is the floating-point sum of the two operands.
Sanjay Patelec95e0e2018-03-20 17:05:19 +00006457This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
6458environment <floatenv>`.
Sanjay Patel7b722402018-03-07 17:18:22 +00006459This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
6460flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
6461unsafe floating-point optimizations:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006462
6463Example:
6464""""""""
6465
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006466.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006467
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006468 <result> = fadd float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 + %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006469
6470'``sub``' Instruction
6471^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6472
6473Syntax:
6474"""""""
6475
6476::
6477
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006478 <result> = sub <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6479 <result> = sub nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6480 <result> = sub nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6481 <result> = sub nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006482
6483Overview:
6484"""""""""
6485
6486The '``sub``' instruction returns the difference of its two operands.
6487
6488Note that the '``sub``' instruction is used to represent the '``neg``'
6489instruction present in most other intermediate representations.
6490
6491Arguments:
6492""""""""""
6493
6494The two arguments to the '``sub``' instruction must be
6495:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6496arguments must have identical types.
6497
6498Semantics:
6499""""""""""
6500
6501The value produced is the integer difference of the two operands.
6502
6503If the difference has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the
6504mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
6505the result.
6506
6507Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this
6508instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.
6509
6510``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
6511respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
6512result value of the ``sub`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
6513unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
6514
6515Example:
6516""""""""
6517
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006518.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006519
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006520 <result> = sub i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 - %var
6521 <result> = sub i32 0, %val ; yields i32:result = -%var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006522
6523.. _i_fsub:
6524
6525'``fsub``' Instruction
6526^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6527
6528Syntax:
6529"""""""
6530
6531::
6532
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006533 <result> = fsub [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006534
6535Overview:
6536"""""""""
6537
6538The '``fsub``' instruction returns the difference of its two operands.
6539
6540Note that the '``fsub``' instruction is used to represent the '``fneg``'
6541instruction present in most other intermediate representations.
6542
6543Arguments:
6544""""""""""
6545
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00006546The two arguments to the '``fsub``' instruction must be
6547:ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
6548floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006549
6550Semantics:
6551""""""""""
6552
Sanjay Patel7b722402018-03-07 17:18:22 +00006553The value produced is the floating-point difference of the two operands.
Sanjay Patelec95e0e2018-03-20 17:05:19 +00006554This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
6555environment <floatenv>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006556This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
6557flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
Sanjay Patel7b722402018-03-07 17:18:22 +00006558unsafe floating-point optimizations:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006559
6560Example:
6561""""""""
6562
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006563.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006564
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006565 <result> = fsub float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 - %var
6566 <result> = fsub float -0.0, %val ; yields float:result = -%var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006567
6568'``mul``' Instruction
6569^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6570
6571Syntax:
6572"""""""
6573
6574::
6575
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006576 <result> = mul <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6577 <result> = mul nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6578 <result> = mul nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6579 <result> = mul nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006580
6581Overview:
6582"""""""""
6583
6584The '``mul``' instruction returns the product of its two operands.
6585
6586Arguments:
6587""""""""""
6588
6589The two arguments to the '``mul``' instruction must be
6590:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6591arguments must have identical types.
6592
6593Semantics:
6594""""""""""
6595
6596The value produced is the integer product of the two operands.
6597
6598If the result of the multiplication has unsigned overflow, the result
6599returned is the mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the
6600bit width of the result.
6601
6602Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, and the
6603result is the same width as the operands, this instruction returns the
6604correct result for both signed and unsigned integers. If a full product
6605(e.g. ``i32`` * ``i32`` -> ``i64``) is needed, the operands should be
6606sign-extended or zero-extended as appropriate to the width of the full
6607product.
6608
6609``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
6610respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
6611result value of the ``mul`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
6612unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
6613
6614Example:
6615""""""""
6616
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006617.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006618
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006619 <result> = mul i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 * %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006620
6621.. _i_fmul:
6622
6623'``fmul``' Instruction
6624^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6625
6626Syntax:
6627"""""""
6628
6629::
6630
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006631 <result> = fmul [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006632
6633Overview:
6634"""""""""
6635
6636The '``fmul``' instruction returns the product of its two operands.
6637
6638Arguments:
6639""""""""""
6640
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00006641The two arguments to the '``fmul``' instruction must be
6642:ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
6643floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006644
6645Semantics:
6646""""""""""
6647
Sanjay Patel7b722402018-03-07 17:18:22 +00006648The value produced is the floating-point product of the two operands.
Sanjay Patelec95e0e2018-03-20 17:05:19 +00006649This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
6650environment <floatenv>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006651This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
6652flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
Sanjay Patel7b722402018-03-07 17:18:22 +00006653unsafe floating-point optimizations:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006654
6655Example:
6656""""""""
6657
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006658.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006659
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006660 <result> = fmul float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 * %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006661
6662'``udiv``' Instruction
6663^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6664
6665Syntax:
6666"""""""
6667
6668::
6669
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006670 <result> = udiv <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6671 <result> = udiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006672
6673Overview:
6674"""""""""
6675
6676The '``udiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
6677
6678Arguments:
6679""""""""""
6680
6681The two arguments to the '``udiv``' instruction must be
6682:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6683arguments must have identical types.
6684
6685Semantics:
6686""""""""""
6687
6688The value produced is the unsigned integer quotient of the two operands.
6689
6690Note that unsigned integer division and signed integer division are
6691distinct operations; for signed integer division, use '``sdiv``'.
6692
Sanjay Patel2b1f6f42017-03-09 16:20:52 +00006693Division by zero is undefined behavior. For vectors, if any element
6694of the divisor is zero, the operation has undefined behavior.
6695
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006696
6697If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``udiv`` is
6698a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if %op1 is not a multiple of %op2 (as
6699such, "((a udiv exact b) mul b) == a").
6700
6701Example:
6702""""""""
6703
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006704.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006705
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006706 <result> = udiv i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 / %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006707
6708'``sdiv``' Instruction
6709^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6710
6711Syntax:
6712"""""""
6713
6714::
6715
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006716 <result> = sdiv <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6717 <result> = sdiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006718
6719Overview:
6720"""""""""
6721
6722The '``sdiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
6723
6724Arguments:
6725""""""""""
6726
6727The two arguments to the '``sdiv``' instruction must be
6728:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6729arguments must have identical types.
6730
6731Semantics:
6732""""""""""
6733
6734The value produced is the signed integer quotient of the two operands
6735rounded towards zero.
6736
6737Note that signed integer division and unsigned integer division are
6738distinct operations; for unsigned integer division, use '``udiv``'.
6739
Sanjay Patel2b1f6f42017-03-09 16:20:52 +00006740Division by zero is undefined behavior. For vectors, if any element
6741of the divisor is zero, the operation has undefined behavior.
6742Overflow also leads to undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can
6743occur, for example, by doing a 32-bit division of -2147483648 by -1.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006744
6745If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``sdiv`` is
6746a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if the result would be rounded.
6747
6748Example:
6749""""""""
6750
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006751.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006752
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006753 <result> = sdiv i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 / %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006754
6755.. _i_fdiv:
6756
6757'``fdiv``' Instruction
6758^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6759
6760Syntax:
6761"""""""
6762
6763::
6764
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006765 <result> = fdiv [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006766
6767Overview:
6768"""""""""
6769
6770The '``fdiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
6771
6772Arguments:
6773""""""""""
6774
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00006775The two arguments to the '``fdiv``' instruction must be
6776:ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
6777floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006778
6779Semantics:
6780""""""""""
6781
Sanjay Patel7b722402018-03-07 17:18:22 +00006782The value produced is the floating-point quotient of the two operands.
Sanjay Patelec95e0e2018-03-20 17:05:19 +00006783This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
6784environment <floatenv>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006785This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
6786flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
Sanjay Patel7b722402018-03-07 17:18:22 +00006787unsafe floating-point optimizations:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006788
6789Example:
6790""""""""
6791
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006792.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006793
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006794 <result> = fdiv float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 / %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006795
6796'``urem``' Instruction
6797^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6798
6799Syntax:
6800"""""""
6801
6802::
6803
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006804 <result> = urem <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006805
6806Overview:
6807"""""""""
6808
6809The '``urem``' instruction returns the remainder from the unsigned
6810division of its two arguments.
6811
6812Arguments:
6813""""""""""
6814
6815The two arguments to the '``urem``' instruction must be
6816:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6817arguments must have identical types.
6818
6819Semantics:
6820""""""""""
6821
6822This instruction returns the unsigned integer *remainder* of a division.
6823This instruction always performs an unsigned division to get the
6824remainder.
6825
6826Note that unsigned integer remainder and signed integer remainder are
6827distinct operations; for signed integer remainder, use '``srem``'.
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +00006828
Sanjay Patel2b1f6f42017-03-09 16:20:52 +00006829Taking the remainder of a division by zero is undefined behavior.
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +00006830For vectors, if any element of the divisor is zero, the operation has
Sanjay Patel2b1f6f42017-03-09 16:20:52 +00006831undefined behavior.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006832
6833Example:
6834""""""""
6835
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006836.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006837
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006838 <result> = urem i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 % %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006839
6840'``srem``' Instruction
6841^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6842
6843Syntax:
6844"""""""
6845
6846::
6847
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006848 <result> = srem <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006849
6850Overview:
6851"""""""""
6852
6853The '``srem``' instruction returns the remainder from the signed
6854division of its two operands. This instruction can also take
6855:ref:`vector <t_vector>` versions of the values in which case the elements
6856must be integers.
6857
6858Arguments:
6859""""""""""
6860
6861The two arguments to the '``srem``' instruction must be
6862:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6863arguments must have identical types.
6864
6865Semantics:
6866""""""""""
6867
6868This instruction returns the *remainder* of a division (where the result
6869is either zero or has the same sign as the dividend, ``op1``), not the
6870*modulo* operator (where the result is either zero or has the same sign
6871as the divisor, ``op2``) of a value. For more information about the
6872difference, see `The Math
6873Forum <http://mathforum.org/dr.math/problems/anne.4.28.99.html>`_. For a
6874table of how this is implemented in various languages, please see
6875`Wikipedia: modulo
6876operation <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Modulo_operation>`_.
6877
6878Note that signed integer remainder and unsigned integer remainder are
6879distinct operations; for unsigned integer remainder, use '``urem``'.
6880
Sanjay Patel2b1f6f42017-03-09 16:20:52 +00006881Taking the remainder of a division by zero is undefined behavior.
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +00006882For vectors, if any element of the divisor is zero, the operation has
Sanjay Patel2b1f6f42017-03-09 16:20:52 +00006883undefined behavior.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006884Overflow also leads to undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can
6885occur, for example, by taking the remainder of a 32-bit division of
6886-2147483648 by -1. (The remainder doesn't actually overflow, but this
6887rule lets srem be implemented using instructions that return both the
6888result of the division and the remainder.)
6889
6890Example:
6891""""""""
6892
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006893.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006894
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006895 <result> = srem i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 % %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006896
6897.. _i_frem:
6898
6899'``frem``' Instruction
6900^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6901
6902Syntax:
6903"""""""
6904
6905::
6906
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006907 <result> = frem [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006908
6909Overview:
6910"""""""""
6911
6912The '``frem``' instruction returns the remainder from the division of
6913its two operands.
6914
6915Arguments:
6916""""""""""
6917
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00006918The two arguments to the '``frem``' instruction must be
6919:ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
6920floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006921
6922Semantics:
6923""""""""""
6924
Sanjay Patel7b722402018-03-07 17:18:22 +00006925The value produced is the floating-point remainder of the two operands.
6926This is the same output as a libm '``fmod``' function, but without any
6927possibility of setting ``errno``. The remainder has the same sign as the
6928dividend.
Sanjay Patelec95e0e2018-03-20 17:05:19 +00006929This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
6930environment <floatenv>`.
Sanjay Patel7b722402018-03-07 17:18:22 +00006931This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
6932flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
6933unsafe floating-point optimizations:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006934
6935Example:
6936""""""""
6937
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006938.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006939
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006940 <result> = frem float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 % %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006941
6942.. _bitwiseops:
6943
6944Bitwise Binary Operations
6945-------------------------
6946
6947Bitwise binary operators are used to do various forms of bit-twiddling
6948in a program. They are generally very efficient instructions and can
6949commonly be strength reduced from other instructions. They require two
6950operands of the same type, execute an operation on them, and produce a
6951single value. The resulting value is the same type as its operands.
6952
6953'``shl``' Instruction
6954^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6955
6956Syntax:
6957"""""""
6958
6959::
6960
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006961 <result> = shl <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6962 <result> = shl nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6963 <result> = shl nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6964 <result> = shl nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006965
6966Overview:
6967"""""""""
6968
6969The '``shl``' instruction returns the first operand shifted to the left
6970a specified number of bits.
6971
6972Arguments:
6973""""""""""
6974
6975Both arguments to the '``shl``' instruction must be the same
6976:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
6977'``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
6978
6979Semantics:
6980""""""""""
6981
6982The value produced is ``op1`` \* 2\ :sup:`op2` mod 2\ :sup:`n`,
6983where ``n`` is the width of the result. If ``op2`` is (statically or
Sean Silvab8a108c2015-04-17 21:58:55 +00006984dynamically) equal to or larger than the number of bits in
Nuno Lopesb2781fb2017-06-06 08:28:17 +00006985``op1``, this instruction returns a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
6986If the arguments are vectors, each vector element of ``op1`` is shifted
6987by the corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006988
Nuno Lopesb2781fb2017-06-06 08:28:17 +00006989If the ``nuw`` keyword is present, then the shift produces a poison
6990value if it shifts out any non-zero bits.
6991If the ``nsw`` keyword is present, then the shift produces a poison
6992value it shifts out any bits that disagree with the resultant sign bit.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006993
6994Example:
6995""""""""
6996
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006997.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006998
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006999 <result> = shl i32 4, %var ; yields i32: 4 << %var
7000 <result> = shl i32 4, 2 ; yields i32: 16
7001 <result> = shl i32 1, 10 ; yields i32: 1024
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007002 <result> = shl i32 1, 32 ; undefined
7003 <result> = shl <2 x i32> < i32 1, i32 1>, < i32 1, i32 2> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 2, i32 4>
7004
7005'``lshr``' Instruction
7006^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7007
7008Syntax:
7009"""""""
7010
7011::
7012
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007013 <result> = lshr <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7014 <result> = lshr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007015
7016Overview:
7017"""""""""
7018
7019The '``lshr``' instruction (logical shift right) returns the first
7020operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with zero fill.
7021
7022Arguments:
7023""""""""""
7024
7025Both arguments to the '``lshr``' instruction must be the same
7026:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
7027'``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
7028
7029Semantics:
7030""""""""""
7031
7032This instruction always performs a logical shift right operation. The
7033most significant bits of the result will be filled with zero bits after
7034the shift. If ``op2`` is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger
Nuno Lopesb2781fb2017-06-06 08:28:17 +00007035than the number of bits in ``op1``, this instruction returns a :ref:`poison
7036value <poisonvalues>`. If the arguments are vectors, each vector element
7037of ``op1`` is shifted by the corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007038
7039If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``lshr`` is
Nuno Lopesb2781fb2017-06-06 08:28:17 +00007040a poison value if any of the bits shifted out are non-zero.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007041
7042Example:
7043""""""""
7044
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00007045.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007046
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007047 <result> = lshr i32 4, 1 ; yields i32:result = 2
7048 <result> = lshr i32 4, 2 ; yields i32:result = 1
7049 <result> = lshr i8 4, 3 ; yields i8:result = 0
7050 <result> = lshr i8 -2, 1 ; yields i8:result = 0x7F
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007051 <result> = lshr i32 1, 32 ; undefined
7052 <result> = lshr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 2> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 0x7FFFFFFF, i32 1>
7053
7054'``ashr``' Instruction
7055^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7056
7057Syntax:
7058"""""""
7059
7060::
7061
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007062 <result> = ashr <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7063 <result> = ashr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007064
7065Overview:
7066"""""""""
7067
7068The '``ashr``' instruction (arithmetic shift right) returns the first
7069operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with sign
7070extension.
7071
7072Arguments:
7073""""""""""
7074
7075Both arguments to the '``ashr``' instruction must be the same
7076:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
7077'``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
7078
7079Semantics:
7080""""""""""
7081
7082This instruction always performs an arithmetic shift right operation,
7083The most significant bits of the result will be filled with the sign bit
7084of ``op1``. If ``op2`` is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger
Nuno Lopesb2781fb2017-06-06 08:28:17 +00007085than the number of bits in ``op1``, this instruction returns a :ref:`poison
7086value <poisonvalues>`. If the arguments are vectors, each vector element
7087of ``op1`` is shifted by the corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007088
7089If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``ashr`` is
Nuno Lopesb2781fb2017-06-06 08:28:17 +00007090a poison value if any of the bits shifted out are non-zero.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007091
7092Example:
7093""""""""
7094
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00007095.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007096
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007097 <result> = ashr i32 4, 1 ; yields i32:result = 2
7098 <result> = ashr i32 4, 2 ; yields i32:result = 1
7099 <result> = ashr i8 4, 3 ; yields i8:result = 0
7100 <result> = ashr i8 -2, 1 ; yields i8:result = -1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007101 <result> = ashr i32 1, 32 ; undefined
7102 <result> = ashr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 3> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 -1, i32 0>
7103
7104'``and``' Instruction
7105^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7106
7107Syntax:
7108"""""""
7109
7110::
7111
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007112 <result> = and <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007113
7114Overview:
7115"""""""""
7116
7117The '``and``' instruction returns the bitwise logical and of its two
7118operands.
7119
7120Arguments:
7121""""""""""
7122
7123The two arguments to the '``and``' instruction must be
7124:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7125arguments must have identical types.
7126
7127Semantics:
7128""""""""""
7129
7130The truth table used for the '``and``' instruction is:
7131
7132+-----+-----+-----+
7133| In0 | In1 | Out |
7134+-----+-----+-----+
7135| 0 | 0 | 0 |
7136+-----+-----+-----+
7137| 0 | 1 | 0 |
7138+-----+-----+-----+
7139| 1 | 0 | 0 |
7140+-----+-----+-----+
7141| 1 | 1 | 1 |
7142+-----+-----+-----+
7143
7144Example:
7145""""""""
7146
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00007147.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007148
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007149 <result> = and i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 & %var
7150 <result> = and i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 8
7151 <result> = and i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007152
7153'``or``' Instruction
7154^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7155
7156Syntax:
7157"""""""
7158
7159::
7160
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007161 <result> = or <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007162
7163Overview:
7164"""""""""
7165
7166The '``or``' instruction returns the bitwise logical inclusive or of its
7167two operands.
7168
7169Arguments:
7170""""""""""
7171
7172The two arguments to the '``or``' instruction must be
7173:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7174arguments must have identical types.
7175
7176Semantics:
7177""""""""""
7178
7179The truth table used for the '``or``' instruction is:
7180
7181+-----+-----+-----+
7182| In0 | In1 | Out |
7183+-----+-----+-----+
7184| 0 | 0 | 0 |
7185+-----+-----+-----+
7186| 0 | 1 | 1 |
7187+-----+-----+-----+
7188| 1 | 0 | 1 |
7189+-----+-----+-----+
7190| 1 | 1 | 1 |
7191+-----+-----+-----+
7192
7193Example:
7194""""""""
7195
7196::
7197
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007198 <result> = or i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 | %var
7199 <result> = or i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 47
7200 <result> = or i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 12
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007201
7202'``xor``' Instruction
7203^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7204
7205Syntax:
7206"""""""
7207
7208::
7209
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007210 <result> = xor <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007211
7212Overview:
7213"""""""""
7214
7215The '``xor``' instruction returns the bitwise logical exclusive or of
7216its two operands. The ``xor`` is used to implement the "one's
7217complement" operation, which is the "~" operator in C.
7218
7219Arguments:
7220""""""""""
7221
7222The two arguments to the '``xor``' instruction must be
7223:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7224arguments must have identical types.
7225
7226Semantics:
7227""""""""""
7228
7229The truth table used for the '``xor``' instruction is:
7230
7231+-----+-----+-----+
7232| In0 | In1 | Out |
7233+-----+-----+-----+
7234| 0 | 0 | 0 |
7235+-----+-----+-----+
7236| 0 | 1 | 1 |
7237+-----+-----+-----+
7238| 1 | 0 | 1 |
7239+-----+-----+-----+
7240| 1 | 1 | 0 |
7241+-----+-----+-----+
7242
7243Example:
7244""""""""
7245
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00007246.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007247
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007248 <result> = xor i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 ^ %var
7249 <result> = xor i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 39
7250 <result> = xor i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 12
7251 <result> = xor i32 %V, -1 ; yields i32:result = ~%V
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007252
7253Vector Operations
7254-----------------
7255
7256LLVM supports several instructions to represent vector operations in a
7257target-independent manner. These instructions cover the element-access
7258and vector-specific operations needed to process vectors effectively.
7259While LLVM does directly support these vector operations, many
7260sophisticated algorithms will want to use target-specific intrinsics to
7261take full advantage of a specific target.
7262
7263.. _i_extractelement:
7264
7265'``extractelement``' Instruction
7266^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7267
7268Syntax:
7269"""""""
7270
7271::
7272
Michael J. Spencer1f10c5ea2014-05-01 22:12:39 +00007273 <result> = extractelement <n x <ty>> <val>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <ty>
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007274
7275Overview:
7276"""""""""
7277
7278The '``extractelement``' instruction extracts a single scalar element
7279from a vector at a specified index.
7280
7281Arguments:
7282""""""""""
7283
7284The first operand of an '``extractelement``' instruction is a value of
7285:ref:`vector <t_vector>` type. The second operand is an index indicating
7286the position from which to extract the element. The index may be a
Michael J. Spencer1f10c5ea2014-05-01 22:12:39 +00007287variable of any integer type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007288
7289Semantics:
7290""""""""""
7291
7292The result is a scalar of the same type as the element type of ``val``.
7293Its value is the value at position ``idx`` of ``val``. If ``idx``
7294exceeds the length of ``val``, the results are undefined.
7295
7296Example:
7297""""""""
7298
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00007299.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007300
7301 <result> = extractelement <4 x i32> %vec, i32 0 ; yields i32
7302
7303.. _i_insertelement:
7304
7305'``insertelement``' Instruction
7306^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7307
7308Syntax:
7309"""""""
7310
7311::
7312
Michael J. Spencer1f10c5ea2014-05-01 22:12:39 +00007313 <result> = insertelement <n x <ty>> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <n x <ty>>
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007314
7315Overview:
7316"""""""""
7317
7318The '``insertelement``' instruction inserts a scalar element into a
7319vector at a specified index.
7320
7321Arguments:
7322""""""""""
7323
7324The first operand of an '``insertelement``' instruction is a value of
7325:ref:`vector <t_vector>` type. The second operand is a scalar value whose
7326type must equal the element type of the first operand. The third operand
7327is an index indicating the position at which to insert the value. The
Michael J. Spencer1f10c5ea2014-05-01 22:12:39 +00007328index may be a variable of any integer type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007329
7330Semantics:
7331""""""""""
7332
7333The result is a vector of the same type as ``val``. Its element values
7334are those of ``val`` except at position ``idx``, where it gets the value
7335``elt``. If ``idx`` exceeds the length of ``val``, the results are
7336undefined.
7337
7338Example:
7339""""""""
7340
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00007341.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007342
7343 <result> = insertelement <4 x i32> %vec, i32 1, i32 0 ; yields <4 x i32>
7344
7345.. _i_shufflevector:
7346
7347'``shufflevector``' Instruction
7348^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7349
7350Syntax:
7351"""""""
7352
7353::
7354
7355 <result> = shufflevector <n x <ty>> <v1>, <n x <ty>> <v2>, <m x i32> <mask> ; yields <m x <ty>>
7356
7357Overview:
7358"""""""""
7359
7360The '``shufflevector``' instruction constructs a permutation of elements
7361from two input vectors, returning a vector with the same element type as
7362the input and length that is the same as the shuffle mask.
7363
7364Arguments:
7365""""""""""
7366
7367The first two operands of a '``shufflevector``' instruction are vectors
7368with the same type. The third argument is a shuffle mask whose element
7369type is always 'i32'. The result of the instruction is a vector whose
7370length is the same as the shuffle mask and whose element type is the
7371same as the element type of the first two operands.
7372
7373The shuffle mask operand is required to be a constant vector with either
7374constant integer or undef values.
7375
7376Semantics:
7377""""""""""
7378
7379The elements of the two input vectors are numbered from left to right
7380across both of the vectors. The shuffle mask operand specifies, for each
7381element of the result vector, which element of the two input vectors the
Sanjay Patel6e410182017-04-12 18:39:53 +00007382result element gets. If the shuffle mask is undef, the result vector is
7383undef. If any element of the mask operand is undef, that element of the
7384result is undef. If the shuffle mask selects an undef element from one
7385of the input vectors, the resulting element is undef.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007386
7387Example:
7388""""""""
7389
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00007390.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007391
7392 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2,
7393 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 4, i32 1, i32 5> ; yields <4 x i32>
7394 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> undef,
7395 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3> ; yields <4 x i32> - Identity shuffle.
7396 <result> = shufflevector <8 x i32> %v1, <8 x i32> undef,
7397 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3> ; yields <4 x i32>
7398 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2,
7399 <8 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3, i32 4, i32 5, i32 6, i32 7 > ; yields <8 x i32>
7400
7401Aggregate Operations
7402--------------------
7403
7404LLVM supports several instructions for working with
7405:ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` values.
7406
7407.. _i_extractvalue:
7408
7409'``extractvalue``' Instruction
7410^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7411
7412Syntax:
7413"""""""
7414
7415::
7416
7417 <result> = extractvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <idx>{, <idx>}*
7418
7419Overview:
7420"""""""""
7421
7422The '``extractvalue``' instruction extracts the value of a member field
7423from an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` value.
7424
7425Arguments:
7426""""""""""
7427
7428The first operand of an '``extractvalue``' instruction is a value of
Arch D. Robisona7f8f252015-10-14 19:10:45 +00007429:ref:`struct <t_struct>` or :ref:`array <t_array>` type. The other operands are
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007430constant indices to specify which value to extract in a similar manner
7431as indices in a '``getelementptr``' instruction.
7432
7433The major differences to ``getelementptr`` indexing are:
7434
7435- Since the value being indexed is not a pointer, the first index is
7436 omitted and assumed to be zero.
7437- At least one index must be specified.
7438- Not only struct indices but also array indices must be in bounds.
7439
7440Semantics:
7441""""""""""
7442
7443The result is the value at the position in the aggregate specified by
7444the index operands.
7445
7446Example:
7447""""""""
7448
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00007449.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007450
7451 <result> = extractvalue {i32, float} %agg, 0 ; yields i32
7452
7453.. _i_insertvalue:
7454
7455'``insertvalue``' Instruction
7456^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7457
7458Syntax:
7459"""""""
7460
7461::
7462
7463 <result> = insertvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <idx>{, <idx>}* ; yields <aggregate type>
7464
7465Overview:
7466"""""""""
7467
7468The '``insertvalue``' instruction inserts a value into a member field in
7469an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` value.
7470
7471Arguments:
7472""""""""""
7473
7474The first operand of an '``insertvalue``' instruction is a value of
7475:ref:`struct <t_struct>` or :ref:`array <t_array>` type. The second operand is
7476a first-class value to insert. The following operands are constant
7477indices indicating the position at which to insert the value in a
7478similar manner as indices in a '``extractvalue``' instruction. The value
7479to insert must have the same type as the value identified by the
7480indices.
7481
7482Semantics:
7483""""""""""
7484
7485The result is an aggregate of the same type as ``val``. Its value is
7486that of ``val`` except that the value at the position specified by the
7487indices is that of ``elt``.
7488
7489Example:
7490""""""""
7491
7492.. code-block:: llvm
7493
7494 %agg1 = insertvalue {i32, float} undef, i32 1, 0 ; yields {i32 1, float undef}
7495 %agg2 = insertvalue {i32, float} %agg1, float %val, 1 ; yields {i32 1, float %val}
Dan Liewffcfe7f2014-09-08 21:19:46 +00007496 %agg3 = insertvalue {i32, {float}} undef, float %val, 1, 0 ; yields {i32 undef, {float %val}}
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007497
7498.. _memoryops:
7499
7500Memory Access and Addressing Operations
7501---------------------------------------
7502
7503A key design point of an SSA-based representation is how it represents
7504memory. In LLVM, no memory locations are in SSA form, which makes things
7505very simple. This section describes how to read, write, and allocate
7506memory in LLVM.
7507
7508.. _i_alloca:
7509
7510'``alloca``' Instruction
7511^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7512
7513Syntax:
7514"""""""
7515
7516::
7517
Matt Arsenault3c1fc762017-04-10 22:27:50 +00007518 <result> = alloca [inalloca] <type> [, <ty> <NumElements>] [, align <alignment>] [, addrspace(<num>)] ; yields type addrspace(num)*:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007519
7520Overview:
7521"""""""""
7522
7523The '``alloca``' instruction allocates memory on the stack frame of the
7524currently executing function, to be automatically released when this
7525function returns to its caller. The object is always allocated in the
Matt Arsenault3c1fc762017-04-10 22:27:50 +00007526address space for allocas indicated in the datalayout.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007527
7528Arguments:
7529""""""""""
7530
7531The '``alloca``' instruction allocates ``sizeof(<type>)*NumElements``
7532bytes of memory on the runtime stack, returning a pointer of the
7533appropriate type to the program. If "NumElements" is specified, it is
7534the number of elements allocated, otherwise "NumElements" is defaulted
7535to be one. If a constant alignment is specified, the value result of the
Reid Kleckner15fe7a52014-07-15 01:16:09 +00007536allocation is guaranteed to be aligned to at least that boundary. The
7537alignment may not be greater than ``1 << 29``. If not specified, or if
7538zero, the target can choose to align the allocation on any convenient
7539boundary compatible with the type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007540
7541'``type``' may be any sized type.
7542
7543Semantics:
7544""""""""""
7545
7546Memory is allocated; a pointer is returned. The operation is undefined
7547if there is insufficient stack space for the allocation. '``alloca``'d
7548memory is automatically released when the function returns. The
7549'``alloca``' instruction is commonly used to represent automatic
7550variables that must have an address available. When the function returns
7551(either with the ``ret`` or ``resume`` instructions), the memory is
7552reclaimed. Allocating zero bytes is legal, but the result is undefined.
7553The order in which memory is allocated (ie., which way the stack grows)
7554is not specified.
7555
7556Example:
7557""""""""
7558
7559.. code-block:: llvm
7560
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007561 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
7562 %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4 ; yields i32*:ptr
7563 %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4, align 1024 ; yields i32*:ptr
7564 %ptr = alloca i32, align 1024 ; yields i32*:ptr
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007565
7566.. _i_load:
7567
7568'``load``' Instruction
7569^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7570
7571Syntax:
7572"""""""
7573
7574::
7575
Artur Pilipenkob4d00902015-09-28 17:41:08 +00007576 <result> = load [volatile] <ty>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.load !<index>][, !invariant.group !<index>][, !nonnull !<index>][, !dereferenceable !<deref_bytes_node>][, !dereferenceable_or_null !<deref_bytes_node>][, !align !<align_node>]
Konstantin Zhuravlyovbb80d3e2017-07-11 22:23:00 +00007577 <result> = load atomic [volatile] <ty>, <ty>* <pointer> [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <ordering>, align <alignment> [, !invariant.group !<index>]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007578 !<index> = !{ i32 1 }
Artur Pilipenko253d71e2015-09-18 12:07:10 +00007579 !<deref_bytes_node> = !{i64 <dereferenceable_bytes>}
Artur Pilipenkob4d00902015-09-28 17:41:08 +00007580 !<align_node> = !{ i64 <value_alignment> }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007581
7582Overview:
7583"""""""""
7584
7585The '``load``' instruction is used to read from memory.
7586
7587Arguments:
7588""""""""""
7589
Sanjoy Dasc2cf6ef2016-06-01 16:13:10 +00007590The argument to the ``load`` instruction specifies the memory address from which
7591to load. The type specified must be a :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type of
7592known size (i.e. not containing an :ref:`opaque structural type <t_opaque>`). If
7593the ``load`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not allowed to
7594modify the number or order of execution of this ``load`` with other
7595:ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007596
JF Bastiend1fb5852015-12-17 22:09:19 +00007597If the ``load`` is marked as ``atomic``, it takes an extra :ref:`ordering
Konstantin Zhuravlyovbb80d3e2017-07-11 22:23:00 +00007598<ordering>` and optional ``syncscope("<target-scope>")`` argument. The
7599``release`` and ``acq_rel`` orderings are not valid on ``load`` instructions.
7600Atomic loads produce :ref:`defined <memmodel>` results when they may see
7601multiple atomic stores. The type of the pointee must be an integer, pointer, or
7602floating-point type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to
7603eight and less than or equal to a target-specific size limit. ``align`` must be
7604explicitly specified on atomic loads, and the load has undefined behavior if the
7605alignment is not set to a value which is at least the size in bytes of the
JF Bastiend1fb5852015-12-17 22:09:19 +00007606pointee. ``!nontemporal`` does not have any defined semantics for atomic loads.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007607
7608The optional constant ``align`` argument specifies the alignment of the
7609operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0
Eli Bendersky239a78b2013-04-17 20:17:08 +00007610or an omitted ``align`` argument means that the operation has the ABI
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007611alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter
7612to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
7613alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the alignment
Reid Kleckner15fe7a52014-07-15 01:16:09 +00007614may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always safe. The
Matt Arsenault7020f252016-06-16 16:33:41 +00007615maximum possible alignment is ``1 << 29``. An alignment value higher
7616than the size of the loaded type implies memory up to the alignment
7617value bytes can be safely loaded without trapping in the default
7618address space. Access of the high bytes can interfere with debugging
7619tools, so should not be accessed if the function has the
7620``sanitize_thread`` or ``sanitize_address`` attributes.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007621
7622The optional ``!nontemporal`` metadata must reference a single
Stefanus Du Toit736e2e22013-06-20 14:02:44 +00007623metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007624``i32`` entry of value 1. The existence of the ``!nontemporal``
Stefanus Du Toit736e2e22013-06-20 14:02:44 +00007625metadata on the instruction tells the optimizer and code generator
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007626that this load is not expected to be reused in the cache. The code
7627generator may select special instructions to save cache bandwidth, such
7628as the ``MOVNT`` instruction on x86.
7629
7630The optional ``!invariant.load`` metadata must reference a single
Stefanus Du Toit736e2e22013-06-20 14:02:44 +00007631metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no
Geoff Berry4bda5762016-08-31 17:39:21 +00007632entries. If a load instruction tagged with the ``!invariant.load``
7633metadata is executed, the optimizer may assume the memory location
7634referenced by the load contains the same value at all points in the
7635program where the memory location is known to be dereferenceable.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007636
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00007637The optional ``!invariant.group`` metadata must reference a single metadata name
Piotr Padlewskice358262018-05-18 23:53:46 +00007638 ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no entries.
7639 See ``invariant.group`` metadata.
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00007640
Philip Reamescdb72f32014-10-20 22:40:55 +00007641The optional ``!nonnull`` metadata must reference a single
7642metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no
7643entries. The existence of the ``!nonnull`` metadata on the
7644instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to
Piotr Padlewskid97846e2015-09-02 20:33:16 +00007645never be null. This is analogous to the ``nonnull`` attribute
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00007646on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00007647to loads of a pointer type.
Philip Reamescdb72f32014-10-20 22:40:55 +00007648
Artur Pilipenko253d71e2015-09-18 12:07:10 +00007649The optional ``!dereferenceable`` metadata must reference a single metadata
7650name ``<deref_bytes_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64``
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00007651entry. The existence of the ``!dereferenceable`` metadata on the instruction
Sanjoy Dasf9995472015-05-19 20:10:19 +00007652tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be dereferenceable.
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00007653The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer
7654value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ''dereferenceable''
7655attribute on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
Sanjoy Dasf9995472015-05-19 20:10:19 +00007656to loads of a pointer type.
7657
7658The optional ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata must reference a single
Artur Pilipenko253d71e2015-09-18 12:07:10 +00007659metadata name ``<deref_bytes_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one
7660``i64`` entry. The existence of the ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata on the
Sanjoy Dasf9995472015-05-19 20:10:19 +00007661instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be either
7662dereferenceable or null.
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00007663The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer
7664value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ''dereferenceable_or_null''
7665attribute on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
Sanjoy Dasf9995472015-05-19 20:10:19 +00007666to loads of a pointer type.
7667
Artur Pilipenkob4d00902015-09-28 17:41:08 +00007668The optional ``!align`` metadata must reference a single metadata name
7669``<align_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64`` entry.
7670The existence of the ``!align`` metadata on the instruction tells the
7671optimizer that the value loaded is known to be aligned to a boundary specified
7672by the integer value in the metadata node. The alignment must be a power of 2.
7673This is analogous to the ''align'' attribute on parameters and return values.
7674This metadata can only be applied to loads of a pointer type.
7675
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007676Semantics:
7677""""""""""
7678
7679The location of memory pointed to is loaded. If the value being loaded
7680is of scalar type then the number of bytes read does not exceed the
7681minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For
7682example, loading an ``i24`` reads at most three bytes. When loading a
7683value of a type like ``i20`` with a size that is not an integral number
7684of bytes, the result is undefined if the value was not originally
7685written using a store of the same type.
7686
7687Examples:
7688"""""""""
7689
7690.. code-block:: llvm
7691
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007692 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
7693 store i32 3, i32* %ptr ; yields void
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00007694 %val = load i32, i32* %ptr ; yields i32:val = i32 3
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007695
7696.. _i_store:
7697
7698'``store``' Instruction
7699^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7700
7701Syntax:
7702"""""""
7703
7704::
7705
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00007706 store [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.group !<index>] ; yields void
Konstantin Zhuravlyovbb80d3e2017-07-11 22:23:00 +00007707 store atomic [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer> [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <ordering>, align <alignment> [, !invariant.group !<index>] ; yields void
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007708
7709Overview:
7710"""""""""
7711
7712The '``store``' instruction is used to write to memory.
7713
7714Arguments:
7715""""""""""
7716
Sanjoy Dasc2cf6ef2016-06-01 16:13:10 +00007717There are two arguments to the ``store`` instruction: a value to store and an
7718address at which to store it. The type of the ``<pointer>`` operand must be a
7719pointer to the :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type of the ``<value>``
7720operand. If the ``store`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not
7721allowed to modify the number or order of execution of this ``store`` with other
7722:ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`. Only values of :ref:`first class
7723<t_firstclass>` types of known size (i.e. not containing an :ref:`opaque
7724structural type <t_opaque>`) can be stored.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007725
JF Bastiend1fb5852015-12-17 22:09:19 +00007726If the ``store`` is marked as ``atomic``, it takes an extra :ref:`ordering
Konstantin Zhuravlyovbb80d3e2017-07-11 22:23:00 +00007727<ordering>` and optional ``syncscope("<target-scope>")`` argument. The
7728``acquire`` and ``acq_rel`` orderings aren't valid on ``store`` instructions.
7729Atomic loads produce :ref:`defined <memmodel>` results when they may see
7730multiple atomic stores. The type of the pointee must be an integer, pointer, or
7731floating-point type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to
7732eight and less than or equal to a target-specific size limit. ``align`` must be
7733explicitly specified on atomic stores, and the store has undefined behavior if
7734the alignment is not set to a value which is at least the size in bytes of the
JF Bastiend1fb5852015-12-17 22:09:19 +00007735pointee. ``!nontemporal`` does not have any defined semantics for atomic stores.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007736
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00007737The optional constant ``align`` argument specifies the alignment of the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007738operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00007739or an omitted ``align`` argument means that the operation has the ABI
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007740alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter
7741to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00007742alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007743alignment may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always
Matt Arsenault7020f252016-06-16 16:33:41 +00007744safe. The maximum possible alignment is ``1 << 29``. An alignment
7745value higher than the size of the stored type implies memory up to the
7746alignment value bytes can be stored to without trapping in the default
7747address space. Storing to the higher bytes however may result in data
7748races if another thread can access the same address. Introducing a
7749data race is not allowed. Storing to the extra bytes is not allowed
7750even in situations where a data race is known to not exist if the
7751function has the ``sanitize_address`` attribute.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007752
Stefanus Du Toit736e2e22013-06-20 14:02:44 +00007753The optional ``!nontemporal`` metadata must reference a single metadata
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00007754name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i32`` entry of
Stefanus Du Toit736e2e22013-06-20 14:02:44 +00007755value 1. The existence of the ``!nontemporal`` metadata on the instruction
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007756tells the optimizer and code generator that this load is not expected to
7757be reused in the cache. The code generator may select special
JF Bastiend2d8ffd2016-01-13 04:52:26 +00007758instructions to save cache bandwidth, such as the ``MOVNT`` instruction on
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007759x86.
7760
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +00007761The optional ``!invariant.group`` metadata must reference a
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00007762single metadata name ``<index>``. See ``invariant.group`` metadata.
7763
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007764Semantics:
7765""""""""""
7766
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00007767The contents of memory are updated to contain ``<value>`` at the
7768location specified by the ``<pointer>`` operand. If ``<value>`` is
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007769of scalar type then the number of bytes written does not exceed the
7770minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For
7771example, storing an ``i24`` writes at most three bytes. When writing a
7772value of a type like ``i20`` with a size that is not an integral number
7773of bytes, it is unspecified what happens to the extra bits that do not
7774belong to the type, but they will typically be overwritten.
7775
7776Example:
7777""""""""
7778
7779.. code-block:: llvm
7780
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007781 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
7782 store i32 3, i32* %ptr ; yields void
Nick Lewycky149d04c2015-08-11 01:05:16 +00007783 %val = load i32, i32* %ptr ; yields i32:val = i32 3
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007784
7785.. _i_fence:
7786
7787'``fence``' Instruction
7788^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7789
7790Syntax:
7791"""""""
7792
7793::
7794
Konstantin Zhuravlyovbb80d3e2017-07-11 22:23:00 +00007795 fence [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <ordering> ; yields void
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007796
7797Overview:
7798"""""""""
7799
7800The '``fence``' instruction is used to introduce happens-before edges
7801between operations.
7802
7803Arguments:
7804""""""""""
7805
7806'``fence``' instructions take an :ref:`ordering <ordering>` argument which
7807defines what *synchronizes-with* edges they add. They can only be given
7808``acquire``, ``release``, ``acq_rel``, and ``seq_cst`` orderings.
7809
7810Semantics:
7811""""""""""
7812
7813A fence A which has (at least) ``release`` ordering semantics
7814*synchronizes with* a fence B with (at least) ``acquire`` ordering
7815semantics if and only if there exist atomic operations X and Y, both
7816operating on some atomic object M, such that A is sequenced before X, X
7817modifies M (either directly or through some side effect of a sequence
7818headed by X), Y is sequenced before B, and Y observes M. This provides a
7819*happens-before* dependency between A and B. Rather than an explicit
7820``fence``, one (but not both) of the atomic operations X or Y might
7821provide a ``release`` or ``acquire`` (resp.) ordering constraint and
7822still *synchronize-with* the explicit ``fence`` and establish the
7823*happens-before* edge.
7824
7825A ``fence`` which has ``seq_cst`` ordering, in addition to having both
7826``acquire`` and ``release`` semantics specified above, participates in
7827the global program order of other ``seq_cst`` operations and/or fences.
7828
Konstantin Zhuravlyovbb80d3e2017-07-11 22:23:00 +00007829A ``fence`` instruction can also take an optional
7830":ref:`syncscope <syncscope>`" argument.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007831
7832Example:
7833""""""""
7834
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +00007835.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007836
Konstantin Zhuravlyovbb80d3e2017-07-11 22:23:00 +00007837 fence acquire ; yields void
7838 fence syncscope("singlethread") seq_cst ; yields void
7839 fence syncscope("agent") seq_cst ; yields void
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007840
7841.. _i_cmpxchg:
7842
7843'``cmpxchg``' Instruction
7844^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7845
7846Syntax:
7847"""""""
7848
7849::
7850
Konstantin Zhuravlyovbb80d3e2017-07-11 22:23:00 +00007851 cmpxchg [weak] [volatile] <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <cmp>, <ty> <new> [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <success ordering> <failure ordering> ; yields { ty, i1 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007852
7853Overview:
7854"""""""""
7855
7856The '``cmpxchg``' instruction is used to atomically modify memory. It
7857loads a value in memory and compares it to a given value. If they are
Tim Northover420a2162014-06-13 14:24:07 +00007858equal, it tries to store a new value into the memory.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007859
7860Arguments:
7861""""""""""
7862
7863There are three arguments to the '``cmpxchg``' instruction: an address
7864to operate on, a value to compare to the value currently be at that
7865address, and a new value to place at that address if the compared values
Philip Reames1960cfd2016-02-19 00:06:41 +00007866are equal. The type of '<cmp>' must be an integer or pointer type whose
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +00007867bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to eight and less
Philip Reames1960cfd2016-02-19 00:06:41 +00007868than or equal to a target-specific size limit. '<cmp>' and '<new>' must
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +00007869have the same type, and the type of '<pointer>' must be a pointer to
7870that type. If the ``cmpxchg`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the
Philip Reames1960cfd2016-02-19 00:06:41 +00007871optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or order of execution of
7872this ``cmpxchg`` with other :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007873
Tim Northovere94a5182014-03-11 10:48:52 +00007874The success and failure :ref:`ordering <ordering>` arguments specify how this
Tim Northover1dcc9f92014-06-13 14:24:16 +00007875``cmpxchg`` synchronizes with other atomic operations. Both ordering parameters
7876must be at least ``monotonic``, the ordering constraint on failure must be no
7877stronger than that on success, and the failure ordering cannot be either
7878``release`` or ``acq_rel``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007879
Konstantin Zhuravlyovbb80d3e2017-07-11 22:23:00 +00007880A ``cmpxchg`` instruction can also take an optional
7881":ref:`syncscope <syncscope>`" argument.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007882
7883The pointer passed into cmpxchg must have alignment greater than or
7884equal to the size in memory of the operand.
7885
7886Semantics:
7887""""""""""
7888
Tim Northover420a2162014-06-13 14:24:07 +00007889The contents of memory at the location specified by the '``<pointer>``' operand
Matthias Braun93f2b4b2017-08-09 22:22:04 +00007890is read and compared to '``<cmp>``'; if the values are equal, '``<new>``' is
7891written to the location. The original value at the location is returned,
7892together with a flag indicating success (true) or failure (false).
Tim Northover420a2162014-06-13 14:24:07 +00007893
7894If the cmpxchg operation is marked as ``weak`` then a spurious failure is
7895permitted: the operation may not write ``<new>`` even if the comparison
7896matched.
7897
7898If the cmpxchg operation is strong (the default), the i1 value is 1 if and only
7899if the value loaded equals ``cmp``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007900
Tim Northovere94a5182014-03-11 10:48:52 +00007901A successful ``cmpxchg`` is a read-modify-write instruction for the purpose of
7902identifying release sequences. A failed ``cmpxchg`` is equivalent to an atomic
7903load with an ordering parameter determined the second ordering parameter.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007904
7905Example:
7906""""""""
7907
7908.. code-block:: llvm
7909
7910 entry:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithc917c7a2016-02-07 05:06:35 +00007911 %orig = load atomic i32, i32* %ptr unordered, align 4 ; yields i32
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007912 br label %loop
7913
7914 loop:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithc917c7a2016-02-07 05:06:35 +00007915 %cmp = phi i32 [ %orig, %entry ], [%value_loaded, %loop]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007916 %squared = mul i32 %cmp, %cmp
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007917 %val_success = cmpxchg i32* %ptr, i32 %cmp, i32 %squared acq_rel monotonic ; yields { i32, i1 }
Tim Northover420a2162014-06-13 14:24:07 +00007918 %value_loaded = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 0
7919 %success = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007920 br i1 %success, label %done, label %loop
7921
7922 done:
7923 ...
7924
7925.. _i_atomicrmw:
7926
7927'``atomicrmw``' Instruction
7928^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7929
7930Syntax:
7931"""""""
7932
7933::
7934
Konstantin Zhuravlyovbb80d3e2017-07-11 22:23:00 +00007935 atomicrmw [volatile] <operation> <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <value> [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <ordering> ; yields ty
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007936
7937Overview:
7938"""""""""
7939
7940The '``atomicrmw``' instruction is used to atomically modify memory.
7941
7942Arguments:
7943""""""""""
7944
7945There are three arguments to the '``atomicrmw``' instruction: an
7946operation to apply, an address whose value to modify, an argument to the
7947operation. The operation must be one of the following keywords:
7948
7949- xchg
7950- add
7951- sub
7952- and
7953- nand
7954- or
7955- xor
7956- max
7957- min
7958- umax
7959- umin
7960
7961The type of '<value>' must be an integer type whose bit width is a power
7962of two greater than or equal to eight and less than or equal to a
7963target-specific size limit. The type of the '``<pointer>``' operand must
7964be a pointer to that type. If the ``atomicrmw`` is marked as
7965``volatile``, then the optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or
7966order of execution of this ``atomicrmw`` with other :ref:`volatile
7967operations <volatile>`.
7968
Konstantin Zhuravlyovbb80d3e2017-07-11 22:23:00 +00007969A ``atomicrmw`` instruction can also take an optional
7970":ref:`syncscope <syncscope>`" argument.
7971
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007972Semantics:
7973""""""""""
7974
7975The contents of memory at the location specified by the '``<pointer>``'
7976operand are atomically read, modified, and written back. The original
7977value at the location is returned. The modification is specified by the
7978operation argument:
7979
7980- xchg: ``*ptr = val``
7981- add: ``*ptr = *ptr + val``
7982- sub: ``*ptr = *ptr - val``
7983- and: ``*ptr = *ptr & val``
7984- nand: ``*ptr = ~(*ptr & val)``
7985- or: ``*ptr = *ptr | val``
7986- xor: ``*ptr = *ptr ^ val``
7987- max: ``*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val`` (using a signed comparison)
7988- min: ``*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val`` (using a signed comparison)
7989- umax: ``*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val`` (using an unsigned
7990 comparison)
7991- umin: ``*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val`` (using an unsigned
7992 comparison)
7993
7994Example:
7995""""""""
7996
7997.. code-block:: llvm
7998
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007999 %old = atomicrmw add i32* %ptr, i32 1 acquire ; yields i32
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008000
8001.. _i_getelementptr:
8002
8003'``getelementptr``' Instruction
8004^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8005
8006Syntax:
8007"""""""
8008
8009::
8010
Peter Collingbourned93620b2016-11-10 22:34:55 +00008011 <result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, [inrange] <ty> <idx>}*
8012 <result> = getelementptr inbounds <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, [inrange] <ty> <idx>}*
8013 <result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ptr vector> <ptrval>, [inrange] <vector index type> <idx>
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008014
8015Overview:
8016"""""""""
8017
8018The '``getelementptr``' instruction is used to get the address of a
8019subelement of an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` data structure. It performs
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00008020address calculation only and does not access memory. The instruction can also
8021be used to calculate a vector of such addresses.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008022
8023Arguments:
8024""""""""""
8025
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00008026The first argument is always a type used as the basis for the calculations.
8027The second argument is always a pointer or a vector of pointers, and is the
8028base address to start from. The remaining arguments are indices
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008029that indicate which of the elements of the aggregate object are indexed.
8030The interpretation of each index is dependent on the type being indexed
8031into. The first index always indexes the pointer value given as the
David Blaikief91b0302017-06-19 05:34:21 +00008032second argument, the second index indexes a value of the type pointed to
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008033(not necessarily the value directly pointed to, since the first index
8034can be non-zero), etc. The first type indexed into must be a pointer
8035value, subsequent types can be arrays, vectors, and structs. Note that
8036subsequent types being indexed into can never be pointers, since that
8037would require loading the pointer before continuing calculation.
8038
8039The type of each index argument depends on the type it is indexing into.
8040When indexing into a (optionally packed) structure, only ``i32`` integer
8041**constants** are allowed (when using a vector of indices they must all
8042be the **same** ``i32`` integer constant). When indexing into an array,
8043pointer or vector, integers of any width are allowed, and they are not
8044required to be constant. These integers are treated as signed values
8045where relevant.
8046
8047For example, let's consider a C code fragment and how it gets compiled
8048to LLVM:
8049
8050.. code-block:: c
8051
8052 struct RT {
8053 char A;
8054 int B[10][20];
8055 char C;
8056 };
8057 struct ST {
8058 int X;
8059 double Y;
8060 struct RT Z;
8061 };
8062
8063 int *foo(struct ST *s) {
8064 return &s[1].Z.B[5][13];
8065 }
8066
8067The LLVM code generated by Clang is:
8068
8069.. code-block:: llvm
8070
8071 %struct.RT = type { i8, [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }
8072 %struct.ST = type { i32, double, %struct.RT }
8073
8074 define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) nounwind uwtable readnone optsize ssp {
8075 entry:
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00008076 %arrayidx = getelementptr inbounds %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i64 1, i32 2, i32 1, i64 5, i64 13
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008077 ret i32* %arrayidx
8078 }
8079
8080Semantics:
8081""""""""""
8082
8083In the example above, the first index is indexing into the
8084'``%struct.ST*``' type, which is a pointer, yielding a '``%struct.ST``'
8085= '``{ i32, double, %struct.RT }``' type, a structure. The second index
8086indexes into the third element of the structure, yielding a
8087'``%struct.RT``' = '``{ i8 , [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }``' type, another
8088structure. The third index indexes into the second element of the
8089structure, yielding a '``[10 x [20 x i32]]``' type, an array. The two
8090dimensions of the array are subscripted into, yielding an '``i32``'
8091type. The '``getelementptr``' instruction returns a pointer to this
8092element, thus computing a value of '``i32*``' type.
8093
8094Note that it is perfectly legal to index partially through a structure,
8095returning a pointer to an inner element. Because of this, the LLVM code
8096for the given testcase is equivalent to:
8097
8098.. code-block:: llvm
8099
8100 define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) {
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00008101 %t1 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i32 1 ; yields %struct.ST*:%t1
8102 %t2 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %t1, i32 0, i32 2 ; yields %struct.RT*:%t2
8103 %t3 = getelementptr %struct.RT, %struct.RT* %t2, i32 0, i32 1 ; yields [10 x [20 x i32]]*:%t3
8104 %t4 = getelementptr [10 x [20 x i32]], [10 x [20 x i32]]* %t3, i32 0, i32 5 ; yields [20 x i32]*:%t4
8105 %t5 = getelementptr [20 x i32], [20 x i32]* %t4, i32 0, i32 13 ; yields i32*:%t5
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008106 ret i32* %t5
8107 }
8108
8109If the ``inbounds`` keyword is present, the result value of the
8110``getelementptr`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if the base
8111pointer is not an *in bounds* address of an allocated object, or if any
8112of the addresses that would be formed by successive addition of the
8113offsets implied by the indices to the base address with infinitely
8114precise signed arithmetic are not an *in bounds* address of that
8115allocated object. The *in bounds* addresses for an allocated object are
8116all the addresses that point into the object, plus the address one byte
Eli Friedman13f2e352017-02-23 00:48:18 +00008117past the end. The only *in bounds* address for a null pointer in the
8118default address-space is the null pointer itself. In cases where the
8119base is a vector of pointers the ``inbounds`` keyword applies to each
8120of the computations element-wise.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008121
8122If the ``inbounds`` keyword is not present, the offsets are added to the
8123base address with silently-wrapping two's complement arithmetic. If the
8124offsets have a different width from the pointer, they are sign-extended
8125or truncated to the width of the pointer. The result value of the
8126``getelementptr`` may be outside the object pointed to by the base
8127pointer. The result value may not necessarily be used to access memory
8128though, even if it happens to point into allocated storage. See the
8129:ref:`Pointer Aliasing Rules <pointeraliasing>` section for more
8130information.
8131
Peter Collingbourned93620b2016-11-10 22:34:55 +00008132If the ``inrange`` keyword is present before any index, loading from or
8133storing to any pointer derived from the ``getelementptr`` has undefined
8134behavior if the load or store would access memory outside of the bounds of
8135the element selected by the index marked as ``inrange``. The result of a
8136pointer comparison or ``ptrtoint`` (including ``ptrtoint``-like operations
8137involving memory) involving a pointer derived from a ``getelementptr`` with
8138the ``inrange`` keyword is undefined, with the exception of comparisons
8139in the case where both operands are in the range of the element selected
8140by the ``inrange`` keyword, inclusive of the address one past the end of
8141that element. Note that the ``inrange`` keyword is currently only allowed
8142in constant ``getelementptr`` expressions.
8143
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008144The getelementptr instruction is often confusing. For some more insight
8145into how it works, see :doc:`the getelementptr FAQ <GetElementPtr>`.
8146
8147Example:
8148""""""""
8149
8150.. code-block:: llvm
8151
8152 ; yields [12 x i8]*:aptr
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00008153 %aptr = getelementptr {i32, [12 x i8]}, {i32, [12 x i8]}* %saptr, i64 0, i32 1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008154 ; yields i8*:vptr
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00008155 %vptr = getelementptr {i32, <2 x i8>}, {i32, <2 x i8>}* %svptr, i64 0, i32 1, i32 1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008156 ; yields i8*:eptr
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00008157 %eptr = getelementptr [12 x i8], [12 x i8]* %aptr, i64 0, i32 1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008158 ; yields i32*:iptr
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00008159 %iptr = getelementptr [10 x i32], [10 x i32]* @arr, i16 0, i16 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008160
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00008161Vector of pointers:
8162"""""""""""""""""""
8163
8164The ``getelementptr`` returns a vector of pointers, instead of a single address,
8165when one or more of its arguments is a vector. In such cases, all vector
8166arguments should have the same number of elements, and every scalar argument
8167will be effectively broadcast into a vector during address calculation.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008168
8169.. code-block:: llvm
8170
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00008171 ; All arguments are vectors:
8172 ; A[i] = ptrs[i] + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8)
8173 %A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, <4 x i64> %offsets
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00008174
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00008175 ; Add the same scalar offset to each pointer of a vector:
8176 ; A[i] = ptrs[i] + offset*sizeof(i8)
8177 %A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, i64 %offset
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00008178
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00008179 ; Add distinct offsets to the same pointer:
8180 ; A[i] = ptr + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8)
8181 %A = getelementptr i8, i8* %ptr, <4 x i64> %offsets
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00008182
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00008183 ; In all cases described above the type of the result is <4 x i8*>
8184
8185The two following instructions are equivalent:
8186
8187.. code-block:: llvm
8188
8189 getelementptr %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1,
8190 <4 x i32> <i32 2, i32 2, i32 2, i32 2>,
8191 <4 x i32> <i32 1, i32 1, i32 1, i32 1>,
8192 <4 x i32> %ind4,
8193 <4 x i64> <i64 13, i64 13, i64 13, i64 13>
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00008194
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00008195 getelementptr %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1,
8196 i32 2, i32 1, <4 x i32> %ind4, i64 13
8197
8198Let's look at the C code, where the vector version of ``getelementptr``
8199makes sense:
8200
8201.. code-block:: c
8202
8203 // Let's assume that we vectorize the following loop:
Alexey Baderadec2832017-01-30 07:38:58 +00008204 double *A, *B; int *C;
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00008205 for (int i = 0; i < size; ++i) {
8206 A[i] = B[C[i]];
8207 }
8208
8209.. code-block:: llvm
8210
8211 ; get pointers for 8 elements from array B
8212 %ptrs = getelementptr double, double* %B, <8 x i32> %C
8213 ; load 8 elements from array B into A
Elad Cohenef5798a2017-05-03 12:28:54 +00008214 %A = call <8 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v8f64.v8p0f64(<8 x double*> %ptrs,
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00008215 i32 8, <8 x i1> %mask, <8 x double> %passthru)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008216
8217Conversion Operations
8218---------------------
8219
8220The instructions in this category are the conversion instructions
8221(casting) which all take a single operand and a type. They perform
8222various bit conversions on the operand.
8223
Bjorn Petterssone1285e32017-10-24 11:59:20 +00008224.. _i_trunc:
8225
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008226'``trunc .. to``' Instruction
8227^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8228
8229Syntax:
8230"""""""
8231
8232::
8233
8234 <result> = trunc <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8235
8236Overview:
8237"""""""""
8238
8239The '``trunc``' instruction truncates its operand to the type ``ty2``.
8240
8241Arguments:
8242""""""""""
8243
8244The '``trunc``' instruction takes a value to trunc, and a type to trunc
8245it to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors
8246of the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
8247larger than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``. Equal sized
8248types are not allowed.
8249
8250Semantics:
8251""""""""""
8252
8253The '``trunc``' instruction truncates the high order bits in ``value``
8254and converts the remaining bits to ``ty2``. Since the source size must
8255be larger than the destination size, ``trunc`` cannot be a *no-op cast*.
8256It will always truncate bits.
8257
8258Example:
8259""""""""
8260
8261.. code-block:: llvm
8262
8263 %X = trunc i32 257 to i8 ; yields i8:1
8264 %Y = trunc i32 123 to i1 ; yields i1:true
8265 %Z = trunc i32 122 to i1 ; yields i1:false
8266 %W = trunc <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i8> ; yields <i8 8, i8 7>
8267
Bjorn Petterssone1285e32017-10-24 11:59:20 +00008268.. _i_zext:
8269
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008270'``zext .. to``' Instruction
8271^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8272
8273Syntax:
8274"""""""
8275
8276::
8277
8278 <result> = zext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8279
8280Overview:
8281"""""""""
8282
8283The '``zext``' instruction zero extends its operand to type ``ty2``.
8284
8285Arguments:
8286""""""""""
8287
8288The '``zext``' instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it
8289to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors of
8290the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
8291smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
8292
8293Semantics:
8294""""""""""
8295
8296The ``zext`` fills the high order bits of the ``value`` with zero bits
8297until it reaches the size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
8298
8299When zero extending from i1, the result will always be either 0 or 1.
8300
8301Example:
8302""""""""
8303
8304.. code-block:: llvm
8305
8306 %X = zext i32 257 to i64 ; yields i64:257
8307 %Y = zext i1 true to i32 ; yields i32:1
8308 %Z = zext <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i32> ; yields <i32 8, i32 7>
8309
Bjorn Petterssone1285e32017-10-24 11:59:20 +00008310.. _i_sext:
8311
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008312'``sext .. to``' Instruction
8313^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8314
8315Syntax:
8316"""""""
8317
8318::
8319
8320 <result> = sext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8321
8322Overview:
8323"""""""""
8324
8325The '``sext``' sign extends ``value`` to the type ``ty2``.
8326
8327Arguments:
8328""""""""""
8329
8330The '``sext``' instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it
8331to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors of
8332the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
8333smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
8334
8335Semantics:
8336""""""""""
8337
8338The '``sext``' instruction performs a sign extension by copying the sign
8339bit (highest order bit) of the ``value`` until it reaches the bit size
8340of the type ``ty2``.
8341
8342When sign extending from i1, the extension always results in -1 or 0.
8343
8344Example:
8345""""""""
8346
8347.. code-block:: llvm
8348
8349 %X = sext i8 -1 to i16 ; yields i16 :65535
8350 %Y = sext i1 true to i32 ; yields i32:-1
8351 %Z = sext <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i32> ; yields <i32 8, i32 7>
8352
8353'``fptrunc .. to``' Instruction
8354^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8355
8356Syntax:
8357"""""""
8358
8359::
8360
8361 <result> = fptrunc <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8362
8363Overview:
8364"""""""""
8365
8366The '``fptrunc``' instruction truncates ``value`` to type ``ty2``.
8367
8368Arguments:
8369""""""""""
8370
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008371The '``fptrunc``' instruction takes a :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>`
8372value to cast and a :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type to cast it to.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008373The size of ``value`` must be larger than the size of ``ty2``. This
8374implies that ``fptrunc`` cannot be used to make a *no-op cast*.
8375
8376Semantics:
8377""""""""""
8378
Dan Liew50456fb2015-09-03 18:43:56 +00008379The '``fptrunc``' instruction casts a ``value`` from a larger
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008380:ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type to a smaller :ref:`floating-point
Sanjay Pateld96a3632018-04-03 13:05:20 +00008381<t_floating>` type.
8382This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
8383environment <floatenv>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008384
8385Example:
8386""""""""
8387
8388.. code-block:: llvm
8389
Sanjay Pateld96a3632018-04-03 13:05:20 +00008390 %X = fptrunc double 16777217.0 to float ; yields float:16777216.0
8391 %Y = fptrunc double 1.0E+300 to half ; yields half:+infinity
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008392
8393'``fpext .. to``' Instruction
8394^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8395
8396Syntax:
8397"""""""
8398
8399::
8400
8401 <result> = fpext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8402
8403Overview:
8404"""""""""
8405
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008406The '``fpext``' extends a floating-point ``value`` to a larger floating-point
8407value.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008408
8409Arguments:
8410""""""""""
8411
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008412The '``fpext``' instruction takes a :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>`
8413``value`` to cast, and a :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type to cast it
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008414to. The source type must be smaller than the destination type.
8415
8416Semantics:
8417""""""""""
8418
8419The '``fpext``' instruction extends the ``value`` from a smaller
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008420:ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type to a larger :ref:`floating-point
8421<t_floating>` type. The ``fpext`` cannot be used to make a
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008422*no-op cast* because it always changes bits. Use ``bitcast`` to make a
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008423*no-op cast* for a floating-point cast.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008424
8425Example:
8426""""""""
8427
8428.. code-block:: llvm
8429
8430 %X = fpext float 3.125 to double ; yields double:3.125000e+00
8431 %Y = fpext double %X to fp128 ; yields fp128:0xL00000000000000004000900000000000
8432
8433'``fptoui .. to``' Instruction
8434^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8435
8436Syntax:
8437"""""""
8438
8439::
8440
8441 <result> = fptoui <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8442
8443Overview:
8444"""""""""
8445
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008446The '``fptoui``' converts a floating-point ``value`` to its unsigned
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008447integer equivalent of type ``ty2``.
8448
8449Arguments:
8450""""""""""
8451
8452The '``fptoui``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008453scalar or vector :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` value, and a type to
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008454cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. If
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008455``ty`` is a vector floating-point type, ``ty2`` must be a vector integer
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008456type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
8457
8458Semantics:
8459""""""""""
8460
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008461The '``fptoui``' instruction converts its :ref:`floating-point
8462<t_floating>` operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008463unsigned integer value. If the value cannot fit in ``ty2``, the results
8464are undefined.
8465
8466Example:
8467""""""""
8468
8469.. code-block:: llvm
8470
8471 %X = fptoui double 123.0 to i32 ; yields i32:123
8472 %Y = fptoui float 1.0E+300 to i1 ; yields undefined:1
8473 %Z = fptoui float 1.04E+17 to i8 ; yields undefined:1
8474
8475'``fptosi .. to``' Instruction
8476^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8477
8478Syntax:
8479"""""""
8480
8481::
8482
8483 <result> = fptosi <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8484
8485Overview:
8486"""""""""
8487
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008488The '``fptosi``' instruction converts :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>`
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008489``value`` to type ``ty2``.
8490
8491Arguments:
8492""""""""""
8493
8494The '``fptosi``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008495scalar or vector :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` value, and a type to
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008496cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. If
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008497``ty`` is a vector floating-point type, ``ty2`` must be a vector integer
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008498type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
8499
8500Semantics:
8501""""""""""
8502
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008503The '``fptosi``' instruction converts its :ref:`floating-point
8504<t_floating>` operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008505signed integer value. If the value cannot fit in ``ty2``, the results
8506are undefined.
8507
8508Example:
8509""""""""
8510
8511.. code-block:: llvm
8512
8513 %X = fptosi double -123.0 to i32 ; yields i32:-123
8514 %Y = fptosi float 1.0E-247 to i1 ; yields undefined:1
8515 %Z = fptosi float 1.04E+17 to i8 ; yields undefined:1
8516
8517'``uitofp .. to``' Instruction
8518^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8519
8520Syntax:
8521"""""""
8522
8523::
8524
8525 <result> = uitofp <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8526
8527Overview:
8528"""""""""
8529
8530The '``uitofp``' instruction regards ``value`` as an unsigned integer
8531and converts that value to the ``ty2`` type.
8532
8533Arguments:
8534""""""""""
8535
8536The '``uitofp``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
8537scalar or vector :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value, and a type to cast it to
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008538``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type. If
8539``ty`` is a vector integer type, ``ty2`` must be a vector floating-point
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008540type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
8541
8542Semantics:
8543""""""""""
8544
8545The '``uitofp``' instruction interprets its operand as an unsigned
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008546integer quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating-point
8547value. If the value cannot fit in the floating-point value, the results
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008548are undefined.
8549
8550Example:
8551""""""""
8552
8553.. code-block:: llvm
8554
8555 %X = uitofp i32 257 to float ; yields float:257.0
8556 %Y = uitofp i8 -1 to double ; yields double:255.0
8557
8558'``sitofp .. to``' Instruction
8559^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8560
8561Syntax:
8562"""""""
8563
8564::
8565
8566 <result> = sitofp <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8567
8568Overview:
8569"""""""""
8570
8571The '``sitofp``' instruction regards ``value`` as a signed integer and
8572converts that value to the ``ty2`` type.
8573
8574Arguments:
8575""""""""""
8576
8577The '``sitofp``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
8578scalar or vector :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value, and a type to cast it to
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008579``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type. If
8580``ty`` is a vector integer type, ``ty2`` must be a vector floating-point
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008581type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
8582
8583Semantics:
8584""""""""""
8585
8586The '``sitofp``' instruction interprets its operand as a signed integer
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008587quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating-point value. If
8588the value cannot fit in the floating-point value, the results are
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008589undefined.
8590
8591Example:
8592""""""""
8593
8594.. code-block:: llvm
8595
8596 %X = sitofp i32 257 to float ; yields float:257.0
8597 %Y = sitofp i8 -1 to double ; yields double:-1.0
8598
8599.. _i_ptrtoint:
8600
8601'``ptrtoint .. to``' Instruction
8602^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8603
8604Syntax:
8605"""""""
8606
8607::
8608
8609 <result> = ptrtoint <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8610
8611Overview:
8612"""""""""
8613
8614The '``ptrtoint``' instruction converts the pointer or a vector of
8615pointers ``value`` to the integer (or vector of integers) type ``ty2``.
8616
8617Arguments:
8618""""""""""
8619
8620The '``ptrtoint``' instruction takes a ``value`` to cast, which must be
Ed Maste8ed40ce2015-04-14 20:52:58 +00008621a value of type :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` or a vector of pointers, and a
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008622type to cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or
8623a vector of integers type.
8624
8625Semantics:
8626""""""""""
8627
8628The '``ptrtoint``' instruction converts ``value`` to integer type
8629``ty2`` by interpreting the pointer value as an integer and either
8630truncating or zero extending that value to the size of the integer type.
8631If ``value`` is smaller than ``ty2`` then a zero extension is done. If
8632``value`` is larger than ``ty2`` then a truncation is done. If they are
8633the same size, then nothing is done (*no-op cast*) other than a type
8634change.
8635
8636Example:
8637""""""""
8638
8639.. code-block:: llvm
8640
8641 %X = ptrtoint i32* %P to i8 ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture
8642 %Y = ptrtoint i32* %P to i64 ; yields zero extension on 32-bit architecture
8643 %Z = ptrtoint <4 x i32*> %P to <4 x i64>; yields vector zero extension for a vector of addresses on 32-bit architecture
8644
8645.. _i_inttoptr:
8646
8647'``inttoptr .. to``' Instruction
8648^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8649
8650Syntax:
8651"""""""
8652
8653::
8654
8655 <result> = inttoptr <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8656
8657Overview:
8658"""""""""
8659
8660The '``inttoptr``' instruction converts an integer ``value`` to a
8661pointer type, ``ty2``.
8662
8663Arguments:
8664""""""""""
8665
8666The '``inttoptr``' instruction takes an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value to
8667cast, and a type to cast it to, which must be a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>`
8668type.
8669
8670Semantics:
8671""""""""""
8672
8673The '``inttoptr``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2`` by
8674applying either a zero extension or a truncation depending on the size
8675of the integer ``value``. If ``value`` is larger than the size of a
8676pointer then a truncation is done. If ``value`` is smaller than the size
8677of a pointer then a zero extension is done. If they are the same size,
8678nothing is done (*no-op cast*).
8679
8680Example:
8681""""""""
8682
8683.. code-block:: llvm
8684
8685 %X = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* ; yields zero extension on 64-bit architecture
8686 %Y = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* ; yields no-op on 32-bit architecture
8687 %Z = inttoptr i64 0 to i32* ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture
8688 %Z = inttoptr <4 x i32> %G to <4 x i8*>; yields truncation of vector G to four pointers
8689
8690.. _i_bitcast:
8691
8692'``bitcast .. to``' Instruction
8693^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8694
8695Syntax:
8696"""""""
8697
8698::
8699
8700 <result> = bitcast <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8701
8702Overview:
8703"""""""""
8704
8705The '``bitcast``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2`` without
8706changing any bits.
8707
8708Arguments:
8709""""""""""
8710
8711The '``bitcast``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
8712non-aggregate first class value, and a type to cast it to, which must
Matt Arsenault24b49c42013-07-31 17:49:08 +00008713also be a non-aggregate :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. The
8714bit sizes of ``value`` and the destination type, ``ty2``, must be
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00008715identical. If the source type is a pointer, the destination type must
Matt Arsenault24b49c42013-07-31 17:49:08 +00008716also be a pointer of the same size. This instruction supports bitwise
8717conversion of vectors to integers and to vectors of other types (as
8718long as they have the same size).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008719
8720Semantics:
8721""""""""""
8722
Matt Arsenault24b49c42013-07-31 17:49:08 +00008723The '``bitcast``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2``. It
8724is always a *no-op cast* because no bits change with this
8725conversion. The conversion is done as if the ``value`` had been stored
8726to memory and read back as type ``ty2``. Pointer (or vector of
8727pointers) types may only be converted to other pointer (or vector of
Matt Arsenaultb03bd4d2013-11-15 01:34:59 +00008728pointers) types with the same address space through this instruction.
8729To convert pointers to other types, use the :ref:`inttoptr <i_inttoptr>`
8730or :ref:`ptrtoint <i_ptrtoint>` instructions first.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008731
8732Example:
8733""""""""
8734
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00008735.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008736
8737 %X = bitcast i8 255 to i8 ; yields i8 :-1
8738 %Y = bitcast i32* %x to sint* ; yields sint*:%x
8739 %Z = bitcast <2 x int> %V to i64; ; yields i64: %V
8740 %Z = bitcast <2 x i32*> %V to <2 x i64*> ; yields <2 x i64*>
8741
Matt Arsenaultb03bd4d2013-11-15 01:34:59 +00008742.. _i_addrspacecast:
8743
8744'``addrspacecast .. to``' Instruction
8745^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8746
8747Syntax:
8748"""""""
8749
8750::
8751
8752 <result> = addrspacecast <pty> <ptrval> to <pty2> ; yields pty2
8753
8754Overview:
8755"""""""""
8756
8757The '``addrspacecast``' instruction converts ``ptrval`` from ``pty`` in
8758address space ``n`` to type ``pty2`` in address space ``m``.
8759
8760Arguments:
8761""""""""""
8762
8763The '``addrspacecast``' instruction takes a pointer or vector of pointer value
8764to cast and a pointer type to cast it to, which must have a different
8765address space.
8766
8767Semantics:
8768""""""""""
8769
8770The '``addrspacecast``' instruction converts the pointer value
8771``ptrval`` to type ``pty2``. It can be a *no-op cast* or a complex
Matt Arsenault54a2a172013-11-15 05:44:56 +00008772value modification, depending on the target and the address space
8773pair. Pointer conversions within the same address space must be
8774performed with the ``bitcast`` instruction. Note that if the address space
Matt Arsenaultb03bd4d2013-11-15 01:34:59 +00008775conversion is legal then both result and operand refer to the same memory
8776location.
8777
8778Example:
8779""""""""
8780
8781.. code-block:: llvm
8782
Matt Arsenault9c13dd02013-11-15 22:43:50 +00008783 %X = addrspacecast i32* %x to i32 addrspace(1)* ; yields i32 addrspace(1)*:%x
8784 %Y = addrspacecast i32 addrspace(1)* %y to i64 addrspace(2)* ; yields i64 addrspace(2)*:%y
8785 %Z = addrspacecast <4 x i32*> %z to <4 x float addrspace(3)*> ; yields <4 x float addrspace(3)*>:%z
Matt Arsenaultb03bd4d2013-11-15 01:34:59 +00008786
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008787.. _otherops:
8788
8789Other Operations
8790----------------
8791
8792The instructions in this category are the "miscellaneous" instructions,
8793which defy better classification.
8794
8795.. _i_icmp:
8796
8797'``icmp``' Instruction
8798^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8799
8800Syntax:
8801"""""""
8802
8803::
8804
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00008805 <result> = icmp <cond> <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields i1 or <N x i1>:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008806
8807Overview:
8808"""""""""
8809
8810The '``icmp``' instruction returns a boolean value or a vector of
8811boolean values based on comparison of its two integer, integer vector,
8812pointer, or pointer vector operands.
8813
8814Arguments:
8815""""""""""
8816
8817The '``icmp``' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
8818the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is
Sanjay Patel43d41442016-03-30 21:38:20 +00008819not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition codes are:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008820
8821#. ``eq``: equal
8822#. ``ne``: not equal
8823#. ``ugt``: unsigned greater than
8824#. ``uge``: unsigned greater or equal
8825#. ``ult``: unsigned less than
8826#. ``ule``: unsigned less or equal
8827#. ``sgt``: signed greater than
8828#. ``sge``: signed greater or equal
8829#. ``slt``: signed less than
8830#. ``sle``: signed less or equal
8831
8832The remaining two arguments must be :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or
8833:ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` or integer :ref:`vector <t_vector>` typed. They
8834must also be identical types.
8835
8836Semantics:
8837""""""""""
8838
8839The '``icmp``' compares ``op1`` and ``op2`` according to the condition
8840code given as ``cond``. The comparison performed always yields either an
8841:ref:`i1 <t_integer>` or vector of ``i1`` result, as follows:
8842
8843#. ``eq``: yields ``true`` if the operands are equal, ``false``
8844 otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed.
8845#. ``ne``: yields ``true`` if the operands are unequal, ``false``
8846 otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed.
8847#. ``ugt``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
8848 ``true`` if ``op1`` is greater than ``op2``.
8849#. ``uge``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
8850 ``true`` if ``op1`` is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
8851#. ``ult``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
8852 ``true`` if ``op1`` is less than ``op2``.
8853#. ``ule``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
8854 ``true`` if ``op1`` is less than or equal to ``op2``.
8855#. ``sgt``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
8856 if ``op1`` is greater than ``op2``.
8857#. ``sge``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
8858 if ``op1`` is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
8859#. ``slt``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
8860 if ``op1`` is less than ``op2``.
8861#. ``sle``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
8862 if ``op1`` is less than or equal to ``op2``.
8863
8864If the operands are :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` typed, the pointer values
8865are compared as if they were integers.
8866
8867If the operands are integer vectors, then they are compared element by
8868element. The result is an ``i1`` vector with the same number of elements
8869as the values being compared. Otherwise, the result is an ``i1``.
8870
8871Example:
8872""""""""
8873
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00008874.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008875
8876 <result> = icmp eq i32 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
8877 <result> = icmp ne float* %X, %X ; yields: result=false
8878 <result> = icmp ult i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=true
8879 <result> = icmp sgt i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
8880 <result> = icmp ule i16 -4, 5 ; yields: result=false
8881 <result> = icmp sge i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
8882
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008883.. _i_fcmp:
8884
8885'``fcmp``' Instruction
8886^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8887
8888Syntax:
8889"""""""
8890
8891::
8892
James Molloy88eb5352015-07-10 12:52:00 +00008893 <result> = fcmp [fast-math flags]* <cond> <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields i1 or <N x i1>:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008894
8895Overview:
8896"""""""""
8897
8898The '``fcmp``' instruction returns a boolean value or vector of boolean
8899values based on comparison of its operands.
8900
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008901If the operands are floating-point scalars, then the result type is a
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008902boolean (:ref:`i1 <t_integer>`).
8903
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008904If the operands are floating-point vectors, then the result type is a
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008905vector of boolean with the same number of elements as the operands being
8906compared.
8907
8908Arguments:
8909""""""""""
8910
8911The '``fcmp``' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
8912the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is
Sanjay Patel43d41442016-03-30 21:38:20 +00008913not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition codes are:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008914
8915#. ``false``: no comparison, always returns false
8916#. ``oeq``: ordered and equal
8917#. ``ogt``: ordered and greater than
8918#. ``oge``: ordered and greater than or equal
8919#. ``olt``: ordered and less than
8920#. ``ole``: ordered and less than or equal
8921#. ``one``: ordered and not equal
8922#. ``ord``: ordered (no nans)
8923#. ``ueq``: unordered or equal
8924#. ``ugt``: unordered or greater than
8925#. ``uge``: unordered or greater than or equal
8926#. ``ult``: unordered or less than
8927#. ``ule``: unordered or less than or equal
8928#. ``une``: unordered or not equal
8929#. ``uno``: unordered (either nans)
8930#. ``true``: no comparison, always returns true
8931
8932*Ordered* means that neither operand is a QNAN while *unordered* means
8933that either operand may be a QNAN.
8934
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008935Each of ``val1`` and ``val2`` arguments must be either a :ref:`floating-point
8936<t_floating>` type or a :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating-point type.
8937They must have identical types.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008938
8939Semantics:
8940""""""""""
8941
8942The '``fcmp``' instruction compares ``op1`` and ``op2`` according to the
8943condition code given as ``cond``. If the operands are vectors, then the
8944vectors are compared element by element. Each comparison performed
8945always yields an :ref:`i1 <t_integer>` result, as follows:
8946
8947#. ``false``: always yields ``false``, regardless of operands.
8948#. ``oeq``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
8949 is equal to ``op2``.
8950#. ``ogt``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
8951 is greater than ``op2``.
8952#. ``oge``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
8953 is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
8954#. ``olt``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
8955 is less than ``op2``.
8956#. ``ole``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
8957 is less than or equal to ``op2``.
8958#. ``one``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
8959 is not equal to ``op2``.
8960#. ``ord``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN.
8961#. ``ueq``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
8962 equal to ``op2``.
8963#. ``ugt``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
8964 greater than ``op2``.
8965#. ``uge``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
8966 greater than or equal to ``op2``.
8967#. ``ult``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
8968 less than ``op2``.
8969#. ``ule``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
8970 less than or equal to ``op2``.
8971#. ``une``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
8972 not equal to ``op2``.
8973#. ``uno``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN.
8974#. ``true``: always yields ``true``, regardless of operands.
8975
James Molloy88eb5352015-07-10 12:52:00 +00008976The ``fcmp`` instruction can also optionally take any number of
8977:ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +00008978otherwise unsafe floating-point optimizations.
James Molloy88eb5352015-07-10 12:52:00 +00008979
8980Any set of fast-math flags are legal on an ``fcmp`` instruction, but the
8981only flags that have any effect on its semantics are those that allow
8982assumptions to be made about the values of input arguments; namely
8983``nnan``, ``ninf``, and ``nsz``. See :ref:`fastmath` for more information.
8984
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008985Example:
8986""""""""
8987
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00008988.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008989
8990 <result> = fcmp oeq float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=false
8991 <result> = fcmp one float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=true
8992 <result> = fcmp olt float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=true
8993 <result> = fcmp ueq double 1.0, 2.0 ; yields: result=false
8994
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008995.. _i_phi:
8996
8997'``phi``' Instruction
8998^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8999
9000Syntax:
9001"""""""
9002
9003::
9004
9005 <result> = phi <ty> [ <val0>, <label0>], ...
9006
9007Overview:
9008"""""""""
9009
9010The '``phi``' instruction is used to implement the φ node in the SSA
9011graph representing the function.
9012
9013Arguments:
9014""""""""""
9015
9016The type of the incoming values is specified with the first type field.
9017After this, the '``phi``' instruction takes a list of pairs as
9018arguments, with one pair for each predecessor basic block of the current
9019block. Only values of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type may be used as
9020the value arguments to the PHI node. Only labels may be used as the
9021label arguments.
9022
9023There must be no non-phi instructions between the start of a basic block
9024and the PHI instructions: i.e. PHI instructions must be first in a basic
9025block.
9026
9027For the purposes of the SSA form, the use of each incoming value is
9028deemed to occur on the edge from the corresponding predecessor block to
9029the current block (but after any definition of an '``invoke``'
9030instruction's return value on the same edge).
9031
9032Semantics:
9033""""""""""
9034
9035At runtime, the '``phi``' instruction logically takes on the value
9036specified by the pair corresponding to the predecessor basic block that
9037executed just prior to the current block.
9038
9039Example:
9040""""""""
9041
9042.. code-block:: llvm
9043
9044 Loop: ; Infinite loop that counts from 0 on up...
9045 %indvar = phi i32 [ 0, %LoopHeader ], [ %nextindvar, %Loop ]
9046 %nextindvar = add i32 %indvar, 1
9047 br label %Loop
9048
9049.. _i_select:
9050
9051'``select``' Instruction
9052^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9053
9054Syntax:
9055"""""""
9056
9057::
9058
9059 <result> = select selty <cond>, <ty> <val1>, <ty> <val2> ; yields ty
9060
9061 selty is either i1 or {<N x i1>}
9062
9063Overview:
9064"""""""""
9065
9066The '``select``' instruction is used to choose one value based on a
Joerg Sonnenberger94321ec2014-03-26 15:30:21 +00009067condition, without IR-level branching.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009068
9069Arguments:
9070""""""""""
9071
9072The '``select``' instruction requires an 'i1' value or a vector of 'i1'
9073values indicating the condition, and two values of the same :ref:`first
David Majnemer40a0b592015-03-03 22:45:47 +00009074class <t_firstclass>` type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009075
9076Semantics:
9077""""""""""
9078
9079If the condition is an i1 and it evaluates to 1, the instruction returns
9080the first value argument; otherwise, it returns the second value
9081argument.
9082
9083If the condition is a vector of i1, then the value arguments must be
9084vectors of the same size, and the selection is done element by element.
9085
David Majnemer40a0b592015-03-03 22:45:47 +00009086If the condition is an i1 and the value arguments are vectors of the
9087same size, then an entire vector is selected.
9088
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009089Example:
9090""""""""
9091
9092.. code-block:: llvm
9093
9094 %X = select i1 true, i8 17, i8 42 ; yields i8:17
9095
9096.. _i_call:
9097
9098'``call``' Instruction
9099^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9100
9101Syntax:
9102"""""""
9103
9104::
9105
David Blaikieb83cf102016-07-13 17:21:34 +00009106 <result> = [tail | musttail | notail ] call [fast-math flags] [cconv] [ret attrs] <ty>|<fnty> <fnptrval>(<function args>) [fn attrs]
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00009107 [ operand bundles ]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009108
9109Overview:
9110"""""""""
9111
9112The '``call``' instruction represents a simple function call.
9113
9114Arguments:
9115""""""""""
9116
9117This instruction requires several arguments:
9118
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00009119#. The optional ``tail`` and ``musttail`` markers indicate that the optimizers
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00009120 should perform tail call optimization. The ``tail`` marker is a hint that
9121 `can be ignored <CodeGenerator.html#sibcallopt>`_. The ``musttail`` marker
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00009122 means that the call must be tail call optimized in order for the program to
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00009123 be correct. The ``musttail`` marker provides these guarantees:
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00009124
9125 #. The call will not cause unbounded stack growth if it is part of a
9126 recursive cycle in the call graph.
9127 #. Arguments with the :ref:`inalloca <attr_inalloca>` attribute are
9128 forwarded in place.
9129
Florian Hahnedae5a62018-01-17 23:29:25 +00009130 Both markers imply that the callee does not access allocas from the caller.
9131 The ``tail`` marker additionally implies that the callee does not access
9132 varargs from the caller, while ``musttail`` implies that varargs from the
9133 caller are passed to the callee. Calls marked ``musttail`` must obey the
9134 following additional rules:
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00009135
9136 - The call must immediately precede a :ref:`ret <i_ret>` instruction,
9137 or a pointer bitcast followed by a ret instruction.
9138 - The ret instruction must return the (possibly bitcasted) value
9139 produced by the call or void.
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00009140 - The caller and callee prototypes must match. Pointer types of
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00009141 parameters or return types may differ in pointee type, but not
9142 in address space.
9143 - The calling conventions of the caller and callee must match.
9144 - All ABI-impacting function attributes, such as sret, byval, inreg,
9145 returned, and inalloca, must match.
Reid Kleckner83498642014-08-26 00:33:28 +00009146 - The callee must be varargs iff the caller is varargs. Bitcasting a
9147 non-varargs function to the appropriate varargs type is legal so
9148 long as the non-varargs prefixes obey the other rules.
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00009149
9150 Tail call optimization for calls marked ``tail`` is guaranteed to occur if
9151 the following conditions are met:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009152
9153 - Caller and callee both have the calling convention ``fastcc``.
9154 - The call is in tail position (ret immediately follows call and ret
9155 uses value of call or is void).
9156 - Option ``-tailcallopt`` is enabled, or
9157 ``llvm::GuaranteedTailCallOpt`` is ``true``.
Alp Tokercf218752014-06-30 18:57:16 +00009158 - `Platform-specific constraints are
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009159 met. <CodeGenerator.html#tailcallopt>`_
9160
Akira Hatanaka5cfcce122015-11-06 23:55:38 +00009161#. The optional ``notail`` marker indicates that the optimizers should not add
9162 ``tail`` or ``musttail`` markers to the call. It is used to prevent tail
9163 call optimization from being performed on the call.
9164
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +00009165#. The optional ``fast-math flags`` marker indicates that the call has one or more
Sanjay Patelfa54ace2015-12-14 21:59:03 +00009166 :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable
9167 otherwise unsafe floating-point optimizations. Fast-math flags are only valid
9168 for calls that return a floating-point scalar or vector type.
9169
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009170#. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling
9171 convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is
9172 specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions. The
9173 calling convention of the call must match the calling convention of
9174 the target function, or else the behavior is undefined.
9175#. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return
9176 values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes
9177 are valid here.
9178#. '``ty``': the type of the call instruction itself which is also the
9179 type of the return value. Functions that return no value are marked
9180 ``void``.
David Blaikieb83cf102016-07-13 17:21:34 +00009181#. '``fnty``': shall be the signature of the function being called. The
9182 argument types must match the types implied by this signature. This
9183 type can be omitted if the function is not varargs.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009184#. '``fnptrval``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to
David Blaikieb83cf102016-07-13 17:21:34 +00009185 be called. In most cases, this is a direct function call, but
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009186 indirect ``call``'s are just as possible, calling an arbitrary pointer
9187 to function value.
9188#. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function
9189 signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must
9190 be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature
9191 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the
9192 extra arguments can be specified.
George Burgess IV39c91052017-04-13 04:01:55 +00009193#. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list.
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00009194#. The optional :ref:`operand bundles <opbundles>` list.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009195
9196Semantics:
9197""""""""""
9198
9199The '``call``' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to
9200a specified function, with its incoming arguments bound to the specified
9201values. Upon a '``ret``' instruction in the called function, control
9202flow continues with the instruction after the function call, and the
9203return value of the function is bound to the result argument.
9204
9205Example:
9206""""""""
9207
9208.. code-block:: llvm
9209
9210 %retval = call i32 @test(i32 %argc)
9211 call i32 (i8*, ...)* @printf(i8* %msg, i32 12, i8 42) ; yields i32
9212 %X = tail call i32 @foo() ; yields i32
9213 %Y = tail call fastcc i32 @foo() ; yields i32
9214 call void %foo(i8 97 signext)
9215
9216 %struct.A = type { i32, i8 }
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00009217 %r = call %struct.A @foo() ; yields { i32, i8 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009218 %gr = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 0 ; yields i32
9219 %gr1 = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 1 ; yields i8
9220 %Z = call void @foo() noreturn ; indicates that %foo never returns normally
9221 %ZZ = call zeroext i32 @bar() ; Return value is %zero extended
9222
9223llvm treats calls to some functions with names and arguments that match
9224the standard C99 library as being the C99 library functions, and may
9225perform optimizations or generate code for them under that assumption.
9226This is something we'd like to change in the future to provide better
9227support for freestanding environments and non-C-based languages.
9228
9229.. _i_va_arg:
9230
9231'``va_arg``' Instruction
9232^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9233
9234Syntax:
9235"""""""
9236
9237::
9238
9239 <resultval> = va_arg <va_list*> <arglist>, <argty>
9240
9241Overview:
9242"""""""""
9243
9244The '``va_arg``' instruction is used to access arguments passed through
9245the "variable argument" area of a function call. It is used to implement
9246the ``va_arg`` macro in C.
9247
9248Arguments:
9249""""""""""
9250
9251This instruction takes a ``va_list*`` value and the type of the
9252argument. It returns a value of the specified argument type and
9253increments the ``va_list`` to point to the next argument. The actual
9254type of ``va_list`` is target specific.
9255
9256Semantics:
9257""""""""""
9258
9259The '``va_arg``' instruction loads an argument of the specified type
9260from the specified ``va_list`` and causes the ``va_list`` to point to
9261the next argument. For more information, see the variable argument
9262handling :ref:`Intrinsic Functions <int_varargs>`.
9263
9264It is legal for this instruction to be called in a function which does
9265not take a variable number of arguments, for example, the ``vfprintf``
9266function.
9267
9268``va_arg`` is an LLVM instruction instead of an :ref:`intrinsic
9269function <intrinsics>` because it takes a type as an argument.
9270
9271Example:
9272""""""""
9273
9274See the :ref:`variable argument processing <int_varargs>` section.
9275
9276Note that the code generator does not yet fully support va\_arg on many
9277targets. Also, it does not currently support va\_arg with aggregate
9278types on any target.
9279
9280.. _i_landingpad:
9281
9282'``landingpad``' Instruction
9283^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9284
9285Syntax:
9286"""""""
9287
9288::
9289
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00009290 <resultval> = landingpad <resultty> <clause>+
9291 <resultval> = landingpad <resultty> cleanup <clause>*
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009292
9293 <clause> := catch <type> <value>
9294 <clause> := filter <array constant type> <array constant>
9295
9296Overview:
9297"""""""""
9298
9299The '``landingpad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
9300system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00009301is a landing pad --- one where the exception lands, and corresponds to the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009302code found in the ``catch`` portion of a ``try``/``catch`` sequence. It
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00009303defines values supplied by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009304re-entry to the function. The ``resultval`` has the type ``resultty``.
9305
9306Arguments:
9307""""""""""
9308
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00009309The optional
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009310``cleanup`` flag indicates that the landing pad block is a cleanup.
9311
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00009312A ``clause`` begins with the clause type --- ``catch`` or ``filter`` --- and
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009313contains the global variable representing the "type" that may be caught
9314or filtered respectively. Unlike the ``catch`` clause, the ``filter``
9315clause takes an array constant as its argument. Use
9316"``[0 x i8**] undef``" for a filter which cannot throw. The
9317'``landingpad``' instruction must contain *at least* one ``clause`` or
9318the ``cleanup`` flag.
9319
9320Semantics:
9321""""""""""
9322
9323The '``landingpad``' instruction defines the values which are set by the
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00009324:ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon re-entry to the function, and
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009325therefore the "result type" of the ``landingpad`` instruction. As with
9326calling conventions, how the personality function results are
9327represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
9328
9329The clauses are applied in order from top to bottom. If two
9330``landingpad`` instructions are merged together through inlining, the
9331clauses from the calling function are appended to the list of clauses.
9332When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
9333the exception is compared against each ``clause`` in turn. If it doesn't
9334match any of the clauses, and the ``cleanup`` flag is not set, then
9335unwinding continues further up the call stack.
9336
9337The ``landingpad`` instruction has several restrictions:
9338
9339- A landing pad block is a basic block which is the unwind destination
9340 of an '``invoke``' instruction.
9341- A landing pad block must have a '``landingpad``' instruction as its
9342 first non-PHI instruction.
9343- There can be only one '``landingpad``' instruction within the landing
9344 pad block.
9345- A basic block that is not a landing pad block may not include a
9346 '``landingpad``' instruction.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009347
9348Example:
9349""""""""
9350
9351.. code-block:: llvm
9352
9353 ;; A landing pad which can catch an integer.
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00009354 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009355 catch i8** @_ZTIi
9356 ;; A landing pad that is a cleanup.
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00009357 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009358 cleanup
9359 ;; A landing pad which can catch an integer and can only throw a double.
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00009360 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009361 catch i8** @_ZTIi
9362 filter [1 x i8**] [@_ZTId]
9363
Joseph Tremoulet2adaa982016-01-10 04:46:10 +00009364.. _i_catchpad:
9365
9366'``catchpad``' Instruction
9367^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9368
9369Syntax:
9370"""""""
9371
9372::
9373
9374 <resultval> = catchpad within <catchswitch> [<args>*]
9375
9376Overview:
9377"""""""""
9378
9379The '``catchpad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
9380system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
9381begins a catch handler --- one where a personality routine attempts to transfer
9382control to catch an exception.
9383
9384Arguments:
9385""""""""""
9386
9387The ``catchswitch`` operand must always be a token produced by a
9388:ref:`catchswitch <i_catchswitch>` instruction in a predecessor block. This
9389ensures that each ``catchpad`` has exactly one predecessor block, and it always
9390terminates in a ``catchswitch``.
9391
9392The ``args`` correspond to whatever information the personality routine
9393requires to know if this is an appropriate handler for the exception. Control
9394will transfer to the ``catchpad`` if this is the first appropriate handler for
9395the exception.
9396
9397The ``resultval`` has the type :ref:`token <t_token>` and is used to match the
9398``catchpad`` to corresponding :ref:`catchrets <i_catchret>` and other nested EH
9399pads.
9400
9401Semantics:
9402""""""""""
9403
9404When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown, the
9405exception is compared against the ``args``. If it doesn't match, control will
9406not reach the ``catchpad`` instruction. The representation of ``args`` is
9407entirely target and personality function-specific.
9408
9409Like the :ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>` instruction, the ``catchpad``
9410instruction must be the first non-phi of its parent basic block.
9411
9412The meaning of the tokens produced and consumed by ``catchpad`` and other "pad"
9413instructions is described in the
9414`Windows exception handling documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh>`_.
9415
9416When a ``catchpad`` has been "entered" but not yet "exited" (as
9417described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
9418it is undefined behavior to execute a :ref:`call <i_call>` or :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`
9419that does not carry an appropriate :ref:`"funclet" bundle <ob_funclet>`.
9420
9421Example:
9422""""""""
9423
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00009424.. code-block:: text
Joseph Tremoulet2adaa982016-01-10 04:46:10 +00009425
9426 dispatch:
9427 %cs = catchswitch within none [label %handler0] unwind to caller
9428 ;; A catch block which can catch an integer.
9429 handler0:
9430 %tok = catchpad within %cs [i8** @_ZTIi]
9431
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00009432.. _i_cleanuppad:
9433
9434'``cleanuppad``' Instruction
9435^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9436
9437Syntax:
9438"""""""
9439
9440::
9441
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00009442 <resultval> = cleanuppad within <parent> [<args>*]
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00009443
9444Overview:
9445"""""""""
9446
9447The '``cleanuppad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
9448system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
9449is a cleanup block --- one where a personality routine attempts to
9450transfer control to run cleanup actions.
9451The ``args`` correspond to whatever additional
9452information the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` requires to
9453execute the cleanup.
Joseph Tremoulet8220bcc2015-08-23 00:26:33 +00009454The ``resultval`` has the type :ref:`token <t_token>` and is used to
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00009455match the ``cleanuppad`` to corresponding :ref:`cleanuprets <i_cleanupret>`.
9456The ``parent`` argument is the token of the funclet that contains the
9457``cleanuppad`` instruction. If the ``cleanuppad`` is not inside a funclet,
9458this operand may be the token ``none``.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00009459
9460Arguments:
9461""""""""""
9462
9463The instruction takes a list of arbitrary values which are interpreted
9464by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>`.
9465
9466Semantics:
9467""""""""""
9468
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00009469When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
9470the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` transfers control to the
9471``cleanuppad`` with the aid of the personality-specific arguments.
Joseph Tremoulet9ce71f72015-09-03 09:09:43 +00009472As with calling conventions, how the personality function results are
9473represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00009474
9475The ``cleanuppad`` instruction has several restrictions:
9476
9477- A cleanup block is a basic block which is the unwind destination of
9478 an exceptional instruction.
9479- A cleanup block must have a '``cleanuppad``' instruction as its
9480 first non-PHI instruction.
9481- There can be only one '``cleanuppad``' instruction within the
9482 cleanup block.
9483- A basic block that is not a cleanup block may not include a
9484 '``cleanuppad``' instruction.
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00009485
Joseph Tremoulete28885e2016-01-10 04:28:38 +00009486When a ``cleanuppad`` has been "entered" but not yet "exited" (as
9487described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
9488it is undefined behavior to execute a :ref:`call <i_call>` or :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`
9489that does not carry an appropriate :ref:`"funclet" bundle <ob_funclet>`.
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00009490
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00009491Example:
9492""""""""
9493
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00009494.. code-block:: text
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00009495
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00009496 %tok = cleanuppad within %cs []
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00009497
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009498.. _intrinsics:
9499
9500Intrinsic Functions
9501===================
9502
9503LLVM supports the notion of an "intrinsic function". These functions
9504have well known names and semantics and are required to follow certain
9505restrictions. Overall, these intrinsics represent an extension mechanism
9506for the LLVM language that does not require changing all of the
9507transformations in LLVM when adding to the language (or the bitcode
9508reader/writer, the parser, etc...).
9509
9510Intrinsic function names must all start with an "``llvm.``" prefix. This
9511prefix is reserved in LLVM for intrinsic names; thus, function names may
9512not begin with this prefix. Intrinsic functions must always be external
9513functions: you cannot define the body of intrinsic functions. Intrinsic
9514functions may only be used in call or invoke instructions: it is illegal
9515to take the address of an intrinsic function. Additionally, because
9516intrinsic functions are part of the LLVM language, it is required if any
9517are added that they be documented here.
9518
9519Some intrinsic functions can be overloaded, i.e., the intrinsic
9520represents a family of functions that perform the same operation but on
9521different data types. Because LLVM can represent over 8 million
9522different integer types, overloading is used commonly to allow an
9523intrinsic function to operate on any integer type. One or more of the
9524argument types or the result type can be overloaded to accept any
9525integer type. Argument types may also be defined as exactly matching a
9526previous argument's type or the result type. This allows an intrinsic
9527function which accepts multiple arguments, but needs all of them to be
9528of the same type, to only be overloaded with respect to a single
9529argument or the result.
9530
9531Overloaded intrinsics will have the names of its overloaded argument
9532types encoded into its function name, each preceded by a period. Only
9533those types which are overloaded result in a name suffix. Arguments
9534whose type is matched against another type do not. For example, the
9535``llvm.ctpop`` function can take an integer of any width and returns an
9536integer of exactly the same integer width. This leads to a family of
9537functions such as ``i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 %val)`` and
9538``i29 @llvm.ctpop.i29(i29 %val)``. Only one type, the return type, is
9539overloaded, and only one type suffix is required. Because the argument's
9540type is matched against the return type, it does not require its own
9541name suffix.
9542
9543To learn how to add an intrinsic function, please see the `Extending
9544LLVM Guide <ExtendingLLVM.html>`_.
9545
9546.. _int_varargs:
9547
9548Variable Argument Handling Intrinsics
9549-------------------------------------
9550
9551Variable argument support is defined in LLVM with the
9552:ref:`va_arg <i_va_arg>` instruction and these three intrinsic
9553functions. These functions are related to the similarly named macros
9554defined in the ``<stdarg.h>`` header file.
9555
9556All of these functions operate on arguments that use a target-specific
9557value type "``va_list``". The LLVM assembly language reference manual
9558does not define what this type is, so all transformations should be
9559prepared to handle these functions regardless of the type used.
9560
9561This example shows how the :ref:`va_arg <i_va_arg>` instruction and the
9562variable argument handling intrinsic functions are used.
9563
9564.. code-block:: llvm
9565
Tim Northoverab60bb92014-11-02 01:21:51 +00009566 ; This struct is different for every platform. For most platforms,
9567 ; it is merely an i8*.
9568 %struct.va_list = type { i8* }
9569
9570 ; For Unix x86_64 platforms, va_list is the following struct:
9571 ; %struct.va_list = type { i32, i32, i8*, i8* }
9572
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009573 define i32 @test(i32 %X, ...) {
9574 ; Initialize variable argument processing
Tim Northoverab60bb92014-11-02 01:21:51 +00009575 %ap = alloca %struct.va_list
9576 %ap2 = bitcast %struct.va_list* %ap to i8*
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009577 call void @llvm.va_start(i8* %ap2)
9578
9579 ; Read a single integer argument
Tim Northoverab60bb92014-11-02 01:21:51 +00009580 %tmp = va_arg i8* %ap2, i32
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009581
9582 ; Demonstrate usage of llvm.va_copy and llvm.va_end
9583 %aq = alloca i8*
9584 %aq2 = bitcast i8** %aq to i8*
9585 call void @llvm.va_copy(i8* %aq2, i8* %ap2)
9586 call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %aq2)
9587
9588 ; Stop processing of arguments.
9589 call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %ap2)
9590 ret i32 %tmp
9591 }
9592
9593 declare void @llvm.va_start(i8*)
9594 declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8*, i8*)
9595 declare void @llvm.va_end(i8*)
9596
9597.. _int_va_start:
9598
9599'``llvm.va_start``' Intrinsic
9600^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9601
9602Syntax:
9603"""""""
9604
9605::
9606
Nick Lewycky04f6de02013-09-11 22:04:52 +00009607 declare void @llvm.va_start(i8* <arglist>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009608
9609Overview:
9610"""""""""
9611
9612The '``llvm.va_start``' intrinsic initializes ``*<arglist>`` for
9613subsequent use by ``va_arg``.
9614
9615Arguments:
9616""""""""""
9617
9618The argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to initialize.
9619
9620Semantics:
9621""""""""""
9622
9623The '``llvm.va_start``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_start`` macro
9624available in C. In a target-dependent way, it initializes the
9625``va_list`` element to which the argument points, so that the next call
9626to ``va_arg`` will produce the first variable argument passed to the
9627function. Unlike the C ``va_start`` macro, this intrinsic does not need
9628to know the last argument of the function as the compiler can figure
9629that out.
9630
9631'``llvm.va_end``' Intrinsic
9632^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9633
9634Syntax:
9635"""""""
9636
9637::
9638
9639 declare void @llvm.va_end(i8* <arglist>)
9640
9641Overview:
9642"""""""""
9643
9644The '``llvm.va_end``' intrinsic destroys ``*<arglist>``, which has been
9645initialized previously with ``llvm.va_start`` or ``llvm.va_copy``.
9646
9647Arguments:
9648""""""""""
9649
9650The argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` to destroy.
9651
9652Semantics:
9653""""""""""
9654
9655The '``llvm.va_end``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_end`` macro
9656available in C. In a target-dependent way, it destroys the ``va_list``
9657element to which the argument points. Calls to
9658:ref:`llvm.va_start <int_va_start>` and
9659:ref:`llvm.va_copy <int_va_copy>` must be matched exactly with calls to
9660``llvm.va_end``.
9661
9662.. _int_va_copy:
9663
9664'``llvm.va_copy``' Intrinsic
9665^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9666
9667Syntax:
9668"""""""
9669
9670::
9671
9672 declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8* <destarglist>, i8* <srcarglist>)
9673
9674Overview:
9675"""""""""
9676
9677The '``llvm.va_copy``' intrinsic copies the current argument position
9678from the source argument list to the destination argument list.
9679
9680Arguments:
9681""""""""""
9682
9683The first argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to initialize.
9684The second argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to copy from.
9685
9686Semantics:
9687""""""""""
9688
9689The '``llvm.va_copy``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_copy`` macro
9690available in C. In a target-dependent way, it copies the source
9691``va_list`` element into the destination ``va_list`` element. This
9692intrinsic is necessary because the `` llvm.va_start`` intrinsic may be
9693arbitrarily complex and require, for example, memory allocation.
9694
9695Accurate Garbage Collection Intrinsics
9696--------------------------------------
9697
Philip Reamesc5b0f562015-02-25 23:52:06 +00009698LLVM's support for `Accurate Garbage Collection <GarbageCollection.html>`_
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00009699(GC) requires the frontend to generate code containing appropriate intrinsic
9700calls and select an appropriate GC strategy which knows how to lower these
Philip Reamesc5b0f562015-02-25 23:52:06 +00009701intrinsics in a manner which is appropriate for the target collector.
9702
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009703These intrinsics allow identification of :ref:`GC roots on the
9704stack <int_gcroot>`, as well as garbage collector implementations that
9705require :ref:`read <int_gcread>` and :ref:`write <int_gcwrite>` barriers.
Philip Reamesc5b0f562015-02-25 23:52:06 +00009706Frontends for type-safe garbage collected languages should generate
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009707these intrinsics to make use of the LLVM garbage collectors. For more
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00009708details, see `Garbage Collection with LLVM <GarbageCollection.html>`_.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009709
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00009710Experimental Statepoint Intrinsics
9711^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9712
9713LLVM provides an second experimental set of intrinsics for describing garbage
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00009714collection safepoints in compiled code. These intrinsics are an alternative
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00009715to the ``llvm.gcroot`` intrinsics, but are compatible with the ones for
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00009716:ref:`read <int_gcread>` and :ref:`write <int_gcwrite>` barriers. The
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00009717differences in approach are covered in the `Garbage Collection with LLVM
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00009718<GarbageCollection.html>`_ documentation. The intrinsics themselves are
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00009719described in :doc:`Statepoints`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009720
9721.. _int_gcroot:
9722
9723'``llvm.gcroot``' Intrinsic
9724^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9725
9726Syntax:
9727"""""""
9728
9729::
9730
9731 declare void @llvm.gcroot(i8** %ptrloc, i8* %metadata)
9732
9733Overview:
9734"""""""""
9735
9736The '``llvm.gcroot``' intrinsic declares the existence of a GC root to
9737the code generator, and allows some metadata to be associated with it.
9738
9739Arguments:
9740""""""""""
9741
9742The first argument specifies the address of a stack object that contains
9743the root pointer. The second pointer (which must be either a constant or
9744a global value address) contains the meta-data to be associated with the
9745root.
9746
9747Semantics:
9748""""""""""
9749
9750At runtime, a call to this intrinsic stores a null pointer into the
9751"ptrloc" location. At compile-time, the code generator generates
9752information to allow the runtime to find the pointer at GC safe points.
9753The '``llvm.gcroot``' intrinsic may only be used in a function which
9754:ref:`specifies a GC algorithm <gc>`.
9755
9756.. _int_gcread:
9757
9758'``llvm.gcread``' Intrinsic
9759^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9760
9761Syntax:
9762"""""""
9763
9764::
9765
9766 declare i8* @llvm.gcread(i8* %ObjPtr, i8** %Ptr)
9767
9768Overview:
9769"""""""""
9770
9771The '``llvm.gcread``' intrinsic identifies reads of references from heap
9772locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require read
9773barriers.
9774
9775Arguments:
9776""""""""""
9777
9778The second argument is the address to read from, which should be an
9779address allocated from the garbage collector. The first object is a
9780pointer to the start of the referenced object, if needed by the language
9781runtime (otherwise null).
9782
9783Semantics:
9784""""""""""
9785
9786The '``llvm.gcread``' intrinsic has the same semantics as a load
9787instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by
9788the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '``llvm.gcread``'
9789intrinsic may only be used in a function which :ref:`specifies a GC
9790algorithm <gc>`.
9791
9792.. _int_gcwrite:
9793
9794'``llvm.gcwrite``' Intrinsic
9795^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9796
9797Syntax:
9798"""""""
9799
9800::
9801
9802 declare void @llvm.gcwrite(i8* %P1, i8* %Obj, i8** %P2)
9803
9804Overview:
9805"""""""""
9806
9807The '``llvm.gcwrite``' intrinsic identifies writes of references to heap
9808locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require write
9809barriers (such as generational or reference counting collectors).
9810
9811Arguments:
9812""""""""""
9813
9814The first argument is the reference to store, the second is the start of
9815the object to store it to, and the third is the address of the field of
9816Obj to store to. If the runtime does not require a pointer to the
9817object, Obj may be null.
9818
9819Semantics:
9820""""""""""
9821
9822The '``llvm.gcwrite``' intrinsic has the same semantics as a store
9823instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by
9824the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '``llvm.gcwrite``'
9825intrinsic may only be used in a function which :ref:`specifies a GC
9826algorithm <gc>`.
9827
9828Code Generator Intrinsics
9829-------------------------
9830
9831These intrinsics are provided by LLVM to expose special features that
9832may only be implemented with code generator support.
9833
9834'``llvm.returnaddress``' Intrinsic
9835^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9836
9837Syntax:
9838"""""""
9839
9840::
9841
George Burgess IVfbc34982017-05-20 04:52:29 +00009842 declare i8* @llvm.returnaddress(i32 <level>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009843
9844Overview:
9845"""""""""
9846
9847The '``llvm.returnaddress``' intrinsic attempts to compute a
9848target-specific value indicating the return address of the current
9849function or one of its callers.
9850
9851Arguments:
9852""""""""""
9853
9854The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the
9855address for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates its
9856caller, etc. The argument is **required** to be a constant integer
9857value.
9858
9859Semantics:
9860""""""""""
9861
9862The '``llvm.returnaddress``' intrinsic either returns a pointer
9863indicating the return address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
9864cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to
9865be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be
9866used for debugging purposes.
9867
9868Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
9869other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
9870of the obvious source-language caller.
9871
Albert Gutowski795d7d62016-10-12 22:13:19 +00009872'``llvm.addressofreturnaddress``' Intrinsic
Albert Gutowski57ad5fe2016-10-12 23:10:02 +00009873^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Albert Gutowski795d7d62016-10-12 22:13:19 +00009874
9875Syntax:
9876"""""""
9877
9878::
9879
George Burgess IVfbc34982017-05-20 04:52:29 +00009880 declare i8* @llvm.addressofreturnaddress()
Albert Gutowski795d7d62016-10-12 22:13:19 +00009881
9882Overview:
9883"""""""""
9884
9885The '``llvm.addressofreturnaddress``' intrinsic returns a target-specific
9886pointer to the place in the stack frame where the return address of the
9887current function is stored.
9888
9889Semantics:
9890""""""""""
9891
9892Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
9893other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
9894of the obvious source-language caller.
9895
9896This intrinsic is only implemented for x86.
9897
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009898'``llvm.frameaddress``' Intrinsic
9899^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9900
9901Syntax:
9902"""""""
9903
9904::
9905
9906 declare i8* @llvm.frameaddress(i32 <level>)
9907
9908Overview:
9909"""""""""
9910
9911The '``llvm.frameaddress``' intrinsic attempts to return the
9912target-specific frame pointer value for the specified stack frame.
9913
9914Arguments:
9915""""""""""
9916
9917The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the
9918frame pointer for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates
9919its caller, etc. The argument is **required** to be a constant integer
9920value.
9921
9922Semantics:
9923""""""""""
9924
9925The '``llvm.frameaddress``' intrinsic either returns a pointer
9926indicating the frame address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
9927cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to
9928be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be
9929used for debugging purposes.
9930
9931Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
9932other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
9933of the obvious source-language caller.
9934
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009935'``llvm.localescape``' and '``llvm.localrecover``' Intrinsics
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009936^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9937
9938Syntax:
9939"""""""
9940
9941::
9942
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009943 declare void @llvm.localescape(...)
9944 declare i8* @llvm.localrecover(i8* %func, i8* %fp, i32 %idx)
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009945
9946Overview:
9947"""""""""
9948
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009949The '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic escapes offsets of a collection of static
9950allocas, and the '``llvm.localrecover``' intrinsic applies those offsets to a
Reid Klecknercfb9ce52015-03-05 18:26:34 +00009951live frame pointer to recover the address of the allocation. The offset is
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009952computed during frame layout of the caller of ``llvm.localescape``.
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009953
9954Arguments:
9955""""""""""
9956
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009957All arguments to '``llvm.localescape``' must be pointers to static allocas or
9958casts of static allocas. Each function can only call '``llvm.localescape``'
Reid Klecknercfb9ce52015-03-05 18:26:34 +00009959once, and it can only do so from the entry block.
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009960
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009961The ``func`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' must be a constant
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009962bitcasted pointer to a function defined in the current module. The code
9963generator cannot determine the frame allocation offset of functions defined in
9964other modules.
9965
Reid Klecknerd5afc62f2015-07-07 23:23:03 +00009966The ``fp`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' must be a frame pointer of a
9967call frame that is currently live. The return value of '``llvm.localaddress``'
9968is one way to produce such a value, but various runtimes also expose a suitable
9969pointer in platform-specific ways.
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009970
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009971The ``idx`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' indicates which alloca passed to
9972'``llvm.localescape``' to recover. It is zero-indexed.
Reid Klecknercfb9ce52015-03-05 18:26:34 +00009973
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009974Semantics:
9975""""""""""
9976
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009977These intrinsics allow a group of functions to share access to a set of local
9978stack allocations of a one parent function. The parent function may call the
9979'``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic once from the function entry block, and the
9980child functions can use '``llvm.localrecover``' to access the escaped allocas.
9981The '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic blocks inlining, as inlining changes where
9982the escaped allocas are allocated, which would break attempts to use
9983'``llvm.localrecover``'.
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009984
Renato Golinc7aea402014-05-06 16:51:25 +00009985.. _int_read_register:
9986.. _int_write_register:
9987
9988'``llvm.read_register``' and '``llvm.write_register``' Intrinsics
9989^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9990
9991Syntax:
9992"""""""
9993
9994::
9995
9996 declare i32 @llvm.read_register.i32(metadata)
9997 declare i64 @llvm.read_register.i64(metadata)
9998 declare void @llvm.write_register.i32(metadata, i32 @value)
9999 declare void @llvm.write_register.i64(metadata, i64 @value)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +000010000 !0 = !{!"sp\00"}
Renato Golinc7aea402014-05-06 16:51:25 +000010001
10002Overview:
10003"""""""""
10004
10005The '``llvm.read_register``' and '``llvm.write_register``' intrinsics
10006provides access to the named register. The register must be valid on
10007the architecture being compiled to. The type needs to be compatible
10008with the register being read.
10009
10010Semantics:
10011""""""""""
10012
10013The '``llvm.read_register``' intrinsic returns the current value of the
10014register, where possible. The '``llvm.write_register``' intrinsic sets
10015the current value of the register, where possible.
10016
10017This is useful to implement named register global variables that need
10018to always be mapped to a specific register, as is common practice on
10019bare-metal programs including OS kernels.
10020
10021The compiler doesn't check for register availability or use of the used
10022register in surrounding code, including inline assembly. Because of that,
10023allocatable registers are not supported.
10024
10025Warning: So far it only works with the stack pointer on selected
Tim Northover3b0846e2014-05-24 12:50:23 +000010026architectures (ARM, AArch64, PowerPC and x86_64). Significant amount of
Renato Golinc7aea402014-05-06 16:51:25 +000010027work is needed to support other registers and even more so, allocatable
10028registers.
10029
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010030.. _int_stacksave:
10031
10032'``llvm.stacksave``' Intrinsic
10033^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10034
10035Syntax:
10036"""""""
10037
10038::
10039
10040 declare i8* @llvm.stacksave()
10041
10042Overview:
10043"""""""""
10044
10045The '``llvm.stacksave``' intrinsic is used to remember the current state
10046of the function stack, for use with
10047:ref:`llvm.stackrestore <int_stackrestore>`. This is useful for
10048implementing language features like scoped automatic variable sized
10049arrays in C99.
10050
10051Semantics:
10052""""""""""
10053
10054This intrinsic returns a opaque pointer value that can be passed to
10055:ref:`llvm.stackrestore <int_stackrestore>`. When an
10056``llvm.stackrestore`` intrinsic is executed with a value saved from
10057``llvm.stacksave``, it effectively restores the state of the stack to
10058the state it was in when the ``llvm.stacksave`` intrinsic executed. In
10059practice, this pops any :ref:`alloca <i_alloca>` blocks from the stack that
10060were allocated after the ``llvm.stacksave`` was executed.
10061
10062.. _int_stackrestore:
10063
10064'``llvm.stackrestore``' Intrinsic
10065^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10066
10067Syntax:
10068"""""""
10069
10070::
10071
10072 declare void @llvm.stackrestore(i8* %ptr)
10073
10074Overview:
10075"""""""""
10076
10077The '``llvm.stackrestore``' intrinsic is used to restore the state of
10078the function stack to the state it was in when the corresponding
10079:ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>` intrinsic executed. This is
10080useful for implementing language features like scoped automatic variable
10081sized arrays in C99.
10082
10083Semantics:
10084""""""""""
10085
10086See the description for :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>`.
10087
Yury Gribovd7dbb662015-12-01 11:40:55 +000010088.. _int_get_dynamic_area_offset:
10089
10090'``llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset``' Intrinsic
Yury Gribov81f3f152015-12-01 13:24:48 +000010091^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Yury Gribovd7dbb662015-12-01 11:40:55 +000010092
10093Syntax:
10094"""""""
10095
10096::
10097
10098 declare i32 @llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.i32()
10099 declare i64 @llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.i64()
10100
Lang Hames10239932016-10-08 00:20:42 +000010101Overview:
10102"""""""""
Yury Gribovd7dbb662015-12-01 11:40:55 +000010103
10104 The '``llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.*``' intrinsic family is used to
10105 get the offset from native stack pointer to the address of the most
10106 recent dynamic alloca on the caller's stack. These intrinsics are
10107 intendend for use in combination with
10108 :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>` to get a
10109 pointer to the most recent dynamic alloca. This is useful, for example,
10110 for AddressSanitizer's stack unpoisoning routines.
10111
10112Semantics:
10113""""""""""
10114
10115 These intrinsics return a non-negative integer value that can be used to
10116 get the address of the most recent dynamic alloca, allocated by :ref:`alloca <i_alloca>`
10117 on the caller's stack. In particular, for targets where stack grows downwards,
10118 adding this offset to the native stack pointer would get the address of the most
10119 recent dynamic alloca. For targets where stack grows upwards, the situation is a bit more
Sylvestre Ledru0455cbe2016-07-28 09:28:58 +000010120 complicated, because subtracting this value from stack pointer would get the address
Yury Gribovd7dbb662015-12-01 11:40:55 +000010121 one past the end of the most recent dynamic alloca.
10122
10123 Although for most targets `llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset <int_get_dynamic_area_offset>`
10124 returns just a zero, for others, such as PowerPC and PowerPC64, it returns a
10125 compile-time-known constant value.
10126
10127 The return value type of :ref:`llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset <int_get_dynamic_area_offset>`
Matt Arsenaultc749bdc2017-03-30 23:36:47 +000010128 must match the target's default address space's (address space 0) pointer type.
Yury Gribovd7dbb662015-12-01 11:40:55 +000010129
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010130'``llvm.prefetch``' Intrinsic
10131^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10132
10133Syntax:
10134"""""""
10135
10136::
10137
10138 declare void @llvm.prefetch(i8* <address>, i32 <rw>, i32 <locality>, i32 <cache type>)
10139
10140Overview:
10141"""""""""
10142
10143The '``llvm.prefetch``' intrinsic is a hint to the code generator to
10144insert a prefetch instruction if supported; otherwise, it is a noop.
10145Prefetches have no effect on the behavior of the program but can change
10146its performance characteristics.
10147
10148Arguments:
10149""""""""""
10150
10151``address`` is the address to be prefetched, ``rw`` is the specifier
10152determining if the fetch should be for a read (0) or write (1), and
10153``locality`` is a temporal locality specifier ranging from (0) - no
10154locality, to (3) - extremely local keep in cache. The ``cache type``
10155specifies whether the prefetch is performed on the data (1) or
10156instruction (0) cache. The ``rw``, ``locality`` and ``cache type``
10157arguments must be constant integers.
10158
10159Semantics:
10160""""""""""
10161
10162This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. In
10163particular, prefetches cannot trap and do not produce a value. On
10164targets that support this intrinsic, the prefetch can provide hints to
10165the processor cache for better performance.
10166
10167'``llvm.pcmarker``' Intrinsic
10168^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10169
10170Syntax:
10171"""""""
10172
10173::
10174
10175 declare void @llvm.pcmarker(i32 <id>)
10176
10177Overview:
10178"""""""""
10179
10180The '``llvm.pcmarker``' intrinsic is a method to export a Program
10181Counter (PC) in a region of code to simulators and other tools. The
10182method is target specific, but it is expected that the marker will use
10183exported symbols to transmit the PC of the marker. The marker makes no
10184guarantees that it will remain with any specific instruction after
10185optimizations. It is possible that the presence of a marker will inhibit
10186optimizations. The intended use is to be inserted after optimizations to
10187allow correlations of simulation runs.
10188
10189Arguments:
10190""""""""""
10191
10192``id`` is a numerical id identifying the marker.
10193
10194Semantics:
10195""""""""""
10196
10197This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. Backends
10198that do not support this intrinsic may ignore it.
10199
10200'``llvm.readcyclecounter``' Intrinsic
10201^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10202
10203Syntax:
10204"""""""
10205
10206::
10207
10208 declare i64 @llvm.readcyclecounter()
10209
10210Overview:
10211"""""""""
10212
10213The '``llvm.readcyclecounter``' intrinsic provides access to the cycle
10214counter register (or similar low latency, high accuracy clocks) on those
10215targets that support it. On X86, it should map to RDTSC. On Alpha, it
10216should map to RPCC. As the backing counters overflow quickly (on the
10217order of 9 seconds on alpha), this should only be used for small
10218timings.
10219
10220Semantics:
10221""""""""""
10222
10223When directly supported, reading the cycle counter should not modify any
10224memory. Implementations are allowed to either return a application
10225specific value or a system wide value. On backends without support, this
10226is lowered to a constant 0.
10227
Tim Northoverbc933082013-05-23 19:11:20 +000010228Note that runtime support may be conditional on the privilege-level code is
10229running at and the host platform.
10230
Renato Golinc0a3c1d2014-03-26 12:52:28 +000010231'``llvm.clear_cache``' Intrinsic
10232^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10233
10234Syntax:
10235"""""""
10236
10237::
10238
10239 declare void @llvm.clear_cache(i8*, i8*)
10240
10241Overview:
10242"""""""""
10243
Joerg Sonnenberger03014d62014-03-26 14:35:21 +000010244The '``llvm.clear_cache``' intrinsic ensures visibility of modifications
10245in the specified range to the execution unit of the processor. On
10246targets with non-unified instruction and data cache, the implementation
10247flushes the instruction cache.
Renato Golinc0a3c1d2014-03-26 12:52:28 +000010248
10249Semantics:
10250""""""""""
10251
Joerg Sonnenberger03014d62014-03-26 14:35:21 +000010252On platforms with coherent instruction and data caches (e.g. x86), this
10253intrinsic is a nop. On platforms with non-coherent instruction and data
Alp Toker16f98b22014-04-09 14:47:27 +000010254cache (e.g. ARM, MIPS), the intrinsic is lowered either to appropriate
Joerg Sonnenberger03014d62014-03-26 14:35:21 +000010255instructions or a system call, if cache flushing requires special
10256privileges.
Renato Golinc0a3c1d2014-03-26 12:52:28 +000010257
Sean Silvad02bf3e2014-04-07 22:29:53 +000010258The default behavior is to emit a call to ``__clear_cache`` from the run
Joerg Sonnenberger03014d62014-03-26 14:35:21 +000010259time library.
Renato Golin93010e62014-03-26 14:01:32 +000010260
Joerg Sonnenberger03014d62014-03-26 14:35:21 +000010261This instrinsic does *not* empty the instruction pipeline. Modifications
10262of the current function are outside the scope of the intrinsic.
Renato Golinc0a3c1d2014-03-26 12:52:28 +000010263
Vedant Kumar51ce6682018-01-26 23:54:25 +000010264'``llvm.instrprof.increment``' Intrinsic
Justin Bogner61ba2e32014-12-08 18:02:35 +000010265^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10266
10267Syntax:
10268"""""""
10269
10270::
10271
Vedant Kumar51ce6682018-01-26 23:54:25 +000010272 declare void @llvm.instrprof.increment(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
Justin Bogner61ba2e32014-12-08 18:02:35 +000010273 i32 <num-counters>, i32 <index>)
10274
10275Overview:
10276"""""""""
10277
Vedant Kumar51ce6682018-01-26 23:54:25 +000010278The '``llvm.instrprof.increment``' intrinsic can be emitted by a
Justin Bogner61ba2e32014-12-08 18:02:35 +000010279frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. These will be
10280lowered by the ``-instrprof`` pass to generate execution counts of a
10281program at runtime.
10282
10283Arguments:
10284""""""""""
10285
10286The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the
10287name of the entity being instrumented. This should generally be the
10288(mangled) function name for a set of counters.
10289
10290The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer
10291of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source, and
10292the third is the number of counters associated with ``name``. It is an
10293error if ``hash`` or ``num-counters`` differ between two instances of
Vedant Kumar51ce6682018-01-26 23:54:25 +000010294``instrprof.increment`` that refer to the same name.
Justin Bogner61ba2e32014-12-08 18:02:35 +000010295
10296The last argument refers to which of the counters for ``name`` should
10297be incremented. It should be a value between 0 and ``num-counters``.
10298
10299Semantics:
10300""""""""""
10301
10302This intrinsic represents an increment of a profiling counter. It will
10303cause the ``-instrprof`` pass to generate the appropriate data
10304structures and the code to increment the appropriate value, in a
10305format that can be written out by a compiler runtime and consumed via
10306the ``llvm-profdata`` tool.
10307
Vedant Kumar51ce6682018-01-26 23:54:25 +000010308'``llvm.instrprof.increment.step``' Intrinsic
Xinliang David Lie1117102016-09-18 22:10:19 +000010309^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Xinliang David Li4ca17332016-09-18 18:34:07 +000010310
10311Syntax:
10312"""""""
10313
10314::
10315
Vedant Kumar51ce6682018-01-26 23:54:25 +000010316 declare void @llvm.instrprof.increment.step(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
Xinliang David Li4ca17332016-09-18 18:34:07 +000010317 i32 <num-counters>,
10318 i32 <index>, i64 <step>)
10319
10320Overview:
10321"""""""""
10322
Vedant Kumar51ce6682018-01-26 23:54:25 +000010323The '``llvm.instrprof.increment.step``' intrinsic is an extension to
10324the '``llvm.instrprof.increment``' intrinsic with an additional fifth
Xinliang David Li4ca17332016-09-18 18:34:07 +000010325argument to specify the step of the increment.
10326
10327Arguments:
10328""""""""""
Vedant Kumar51ce6682018-01-26 23:54:25 +000010329The first four arguments are the same as '``llvm.instrprof.increment``'
Pete Couperused9569d2017-08-23 20:58:22 +000010330intrinsic.
Xinliang David Li4ca17332016-09-18 18:34:07 +000010331
10332The last argument specifies the value of the increment of the counter variable.
10333
10334Semantics:
10335""""""""""
Vedant Kumar51ce6682018-01-26 23:54:25 +000010336See description of '``llvm.instrprof.increment``' instrinsic.
Xinliang David Li4ca17332016-09-18 18:34:07 +000010337
10338
Vedant Kumar51ce6682018-01-26 23:54:25 +000010339'``llvm.instrprof.value.profile``' Intrinsic
Betul Buyukkurt6fac1742015-11-18 18:14:55 +000010340^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10341
10342Syntax:
10343"""""""
10344
10345::
10346
Vedant Kumar51ce6682018-01-26 23:54:25 +000010347 declare void @llvm.instrprof.value.profile(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
Betul Buyukkurt6fac1742015-11-18 18:14:55 +000010348 i64 <value>, i32 <value_kind>,
10349 i32 <index>)
10350
10351Overview:
10352"""""""""
10353
Vedant Kumar51ce6682018-01-26 23:54:25 +000010354The '``llvm.instrprof.value.profile``' intrinsic can be emitted by a
Betul Buyukkurt6fac1742015-11-18 18:14:55 +000010355frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. This will be
10356lowered by the ``-instrprof`` pass to find out the target values,
10357instrumented expressions take in a program at runtime.
10358
10359Arguments:
10360""""""""""
10361
10362The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the
10363name of the entity being instrumented. ``name`` should generally be the
10364(mangled) function name for a set of counters.
10365
10366The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer
10367of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source. It
10368is an error if ``hash`` differs between two instances of
Vedant Kumar51ce6682018-01-26 23:54:25 +000010369``llvm.instrprof.*`` that refer to the same name.
Betul Buyukkurt6fac1742015-11-18 18:14:55 +000010370
10371The third argument is the value of the expression being profiled. The profiled
10372expression's value should be representable as an unsigned 64-bit value. The
10373fourth argument represents the kind of value profiling that is being done. The
10374supported value profiling kinds are enumerated through the
10375``InstrProfValueKind`` type declared in the
10376``<include/llvm/ProfileData/InstrProf.h>`` header file. The last argument is the
10377index of the instrumented expression within ``name``. It should be >= 0.
10378
10379Semantics:
10380""""""""""
10381
10382This intrinsic represents the point where a call to a runtime routine
10383should be inserted for value profiling of target expressions. ``-instrprof``
10384pass will generate the appropriate data structures and replace the
Vedant Kumar51ce6682018-01-26 23:54:25 +000010385``llvm.instrprof.value.profile`` intrinsic with the call to the profile
Betul Buyukkurt6fac1742015-11-18 18:14:55 +000010386runtime library with proper arguments.
10387
Marcin Koscielnicki3fdc2572016-04-19 20:51:05 +000010388'``llvm.thread.pointer``' Intrinsic
10389^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10390
10391Syntax:
10392"""""""
10393
10394::
10395
10396 declare i8* @llvm.thread.pointer()
10397
10398Overview:
10399"""""""""
10400
10401The '``llvm.thread.pointer``' intrinsic returns the value of the thread
10402pointer.
10403
10404Semantics:
10405""""""""""
10406
10407The '``llvm.thread.pointer``' intrinsic returns a pointer to the TLS area
10408for the current thread. The exact semantics of this value are target
10409specific: it may point to the start of TLS area, to the end, or somewhere
10410in the middle. Depending on the target, this intrinsic may read a register,
10411call a helper function, read from an alternate memory space, or perform
10412other operations necessary to locate the TLS area. Not all targets support
10413this intrinsic.
10414
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010415Standard C Library Intrinsics
10416-----------------------------
10417
10418LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important standard C library
10419functions. These intrinsics allow source-language front-ends to pass
10420information about the alignment of the pointer arguments to the code
10421generator, providing opportunity for more efficient code generation.
10422
10423.. _int_memcpy:
10424
10425'``llvm.memcpy``' Intrinsic
10426^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10427
10428Syntax:
10429"""""""
10430
10431This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.memcpy`` on any
10432integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
10433support all bit widths however.
10434
10435::
10436
10437 declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
Daniel Neilson1e687242018-01-19 17:13:12 +000010438 i32 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010439 declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
Daniel Neilson1e687242018-01-19 17:13:12 +000010440 i64 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010441
10442Overview:
10443"""""""""
10444
10445The '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
10446source location to the destination location.
10447
10448Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memcpy.*``
Daniel Neilson1e687242018-01-19 17:13:12 +000010449intrinsics do not return a value, takes extra isvolatile
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010450arguments and the pointers can be in specified address spaces.
10451
10452Arguments:
10453""""""""""
10454
10455The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a
10456pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument
Daniel Neilson1e687242018-01-19 17:13:12 +000010457specifying the number of bytes to copy, and the fourth is a
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010458boolean indicating a volatile access.
10459
Daniel Neilson39eb6a52018-01-19 17:24:21 +000010460The :ref:`align <attr_align>` parameter attribute can be provided
Daniel Neilson1e687242018-01-19 17:13:12 +000010461for the first and second arguments.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010462
10463If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memcpy`` call is
10464a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is not
10465very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
10466
10467Semantics:
10468""""""""""
10469
10470The '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
10471source location to the destination location, which are not allowed to
10472overlap. It copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known
10473to be aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth
Bill Wendling61163152013-10-18 23:26:55 +000010474argument, otherwise it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010475
Daniel Neilson57226ef2017-07-12 15:25:26 +000010476.. _int_memmove:
10477
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010478'``llvm.memmove``' Intrinsic
10479^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10480
10481Syntax:
10482"""""""
10483
10484This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memmove on any integer
10485bit width and for different address space. Not all targets support all
10486bit widths however.
10487
10488::
10489
10490 declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
Daniel Neilson1e687242018-01-19 17:13:12 +000010491 i32 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010492 declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
Daniel Neilson1e687242018-01-19 17:13:12 +000010493 i64 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010494
10495Overview:
10496"""""""""
10497
10498The '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsics move a block of memory from the
10499source location to the destination location. It is similar to the
10500'``llvm.memcpy``' intrinsic but allows the two memory locations to
10501overlap.
10502
10503Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memmove.*``
Daniel Neilson1e687242018-01-19 17:13:12 +000010504intrinsics do not return a value, takes an extra isvolatile
10505argument and the pointers can be in specified address spaces.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010506
10507Arguments:
10508""""""""""
10509
10510The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a
10511pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument
Daniel Neilson1e687242018-01-19 17:13:12 +000010512specifying the number of bytes to copy, and the fourth is a
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010513boolean indicating a volatile access.
10514
Daniel Neilsonaac0f8f2018-01-19 17:32:33 +000010515The :ref:`align <attr_align>` parameter attribute can be provided
Daniel Neilson1e687242018-01-19 17:13:12 +000010516for the first and second arguments.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010517
10518If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memmove`` call
10519is a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is
10520not very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
10521
10522Semantics:
10523""""""""""
10524
10525The '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
10526source location to the destination location, which may overlap. It
10527copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known to be
10528aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth argument,
Bill Wendling61163152013-10-18 23:26:55 +000010529otherwise it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010530
Daniel Neilson965613e2017-07-12 21:57:23 +000010531.. _int_memset:
10532
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010533'``llvm.memset.*``' Intrinsics
10534^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10535
10536Syntax:
10537"""""""
10538
10539This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memset on any integer
10540bit width and for different address spaces. However, not all targets
10541support all bit widths.
10542
10543::
10544
10545 declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>,
Daniel Neilson1e687242018-01-19 17:13:12 +000010546 i32 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010547 declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>,
Daniel Neilson1e687242018-01-19 17:13:12 +000010548 i64 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010549
10550Overview:
10551"""""""""
10552
10553The '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsics fill a block of memory with a
10554particular byte value.
10555
10556Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memset``
Daniel Neilson1e687242018-01-19 17:13:12 +000010557intrinsic does not return a value and takes an extra volatile
10558argument. Also, the destination can be in an arbitrary address space.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010559
10560Arguments:
10561""""""""""
10562
10563The first argument is a pointer to the destination to fill, the second
10564is the byte value with which to fill it, the third argument is an
10565integer argument specifying the number of bytes to fill, and the fourth
Daniel Neilson1e687242018-01-19 17:13:12 +000010566is a boolean indicating a volatile access.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010567
Daniel Neilsonaac0f8f2018-01-19 17:32:33 +000010568The :ref:`align <attr_align>` parameter attribute can be provided
Daniel Neilson1e687242018-01-19 17:13:12 +000010569for the first arguments.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010570
10571If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memset`` call is
10572a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is not
10573very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
10574
10575Semantics:
10576""""""""""
10577
10578The '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsics fill "len" bytes of memory starting
Elena Demikhovsky945b7e52018-02-14 06:58:08 +000010579at the destination location.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010580
10581'``llvm.sqrt.*``' Intrinsic
10582^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10583
10584Syntax:
10585"""""""
10586
10587This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sqrt`` on any
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010588floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010589all types however.
10590
10591::
10592
10593 declare float @llvm.sqrt.f32(float %Val)
10594 declare double @llvm.sqrt.f64(double %Val)
10595 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sqrt.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10596 declare fp128 @llvm.sqrt.f128(fp128 %Val)
10597 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sqrt.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10598
10599Overview:
10600"""""""""
10601
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010602The '``llvm.sqrt``' intrinsics return the square root of the specified value.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010603
10604Arguments:
10605""""""""""
10606
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010607The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010608
10609Semantics:
10610""""""""""
10611
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010612Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``sqrt``' function but without
Elena Demikhovsky945b7e52018-02-14 06:58:08 +000010613trapping or setting ``errno``. For types specified by IEEE-754, the result
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010614matches a conforming libm implementation.
10615
Elena Demikhovsky945b7e52018-02-14 06:58:08 +000010616When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010617using a less accurate calculation.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010618
10619'``llvm.powi.*``' Intrinsic
10620^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10621
10622Syntax:
10623"""""""
10624
10625This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.powi`` on any
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000010626floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010627all types however.
10628
10629::
10630
10631 declare float @llvm.powi.f32(float %Val, i32 %power)
10632 declare double @llvm.powi.f64(double %Val, i32 %power)
10633 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.powi.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, i32 %power)
10634 declare fp128 @llvm.powi.f128(fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
10635 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.powi.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
10636
10637Overview:
10638"""""""""
10639
10640The '``llvm.powi.*``' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
10641specified (positive or negative) power. The order of evaluation of
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000010642multiplications is not defined. When a vector of floating-point type is
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010643used, the second argument remains a scalar integer value.
10644
10645Arguments:
10646""""""""""
10647
10648The second argument is an integer power, and the first is a value to
10649raise to that power.
10650
10651Semantics:
10652""""""""""
10653
10654This function returns the first value raised to the second power with an
10655unspecified sequence of rounding operations.
10656
10657'``llvm.sin.*``' Intrinsic
10658^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10659
10660Syntax:
10661"""""""
10662
10663This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sin`` on any
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010664floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010665all types however.
10666
10667::
10668
10669 declare float @llvm.sin.f32(float %Val)
10670 declare double @llvm.sin.f64(double %Val)
10671 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sin.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10672 declare fp128 @llvm.sin.f128(fp128 %Val)
10673 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sin.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10674
10675Overview:
10676"""""""""
10677
10678The '``llvm.sin.*``' intrinsics return the sine of the operand.
10679
10680Arguments:
10681""""""""""
10682
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010683The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010684
10685Semantics:
10686""""""""""
10687
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010688Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``sin``' function but without
10689trapping or setting ``errno``.
10690
Elena Demikhovsky945b7e52018-02-14 06:58:08 +000010691When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010692using a less accurate calculation.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010693
10694'``llvm.cos.*``' Intrinsic
10695^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10696
10697Syntax:
10698"""""""
10699
10700This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.cos`` on any
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010701floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010702all types however.
10703
10704::
10705
10706 declare float @llvm.cos.f32(float %Val)
10707 declare double @llvm.cos.f64(double %Val)
10708 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.cos.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10709 declare fp128 @llvm.cos.f128(fp128 %Val)
10710 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.cos.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10711
10712Overview:
10713"""""""""
10714
10715The '``llvm.cos.*``' intrinsics return the cosine of the operand.
10716
10717Arguments:
10718""""""""""
10719
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010720The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010721
10722Semantics:
10723""""""""""
10724
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010725Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``cos``' function but without
10726trapping or setting ``errno``.
10727
Elena Demikhovsky945b7e52018-02-14 06:58:08 +000010728When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010729using a less accurate calculation.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010730
10731'``llvm.pow.*``' Intrinsic
10732^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10733
10734Syntax:
10735"""""""
10736
10737This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.pow`` on any
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010738floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010739all types however.
10740
10741::
10742
10743 declare float @llvm.pow.f32(float %Val, float %Power)
10744 declare double @llvm.pow.f64(double %Val, double %Power)
10745 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.pow.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, x86_fp80 %Power)
10746 declare fp128 @llvm.pow.f128(fp128 %Val, fp128 %Power)
10747 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.pow.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, ppc_fp128 Power)
10748
10749Overview:
10750"""""""""
10751
10752The '``llvm.pow.*``' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
10753specified (positive or negative) power.
10754
10755Arguments:
10756""""""""""
10757
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010758The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010759
10760Semantics:
10761""""""""""
10762
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010763Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``pow``' function but without
10764trapping or setting ``errno``.
10765
Elena Demikhovsky945b7e52018-02-14 06:58:08 +000010766When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010767using a less accurate calculation.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010768
10769'``llvm.exp.*``' Intrinsic
10770^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10771
10772Syntax:
10773"""""""
10774
10775This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.exp`` on any
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010776floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010777all types however.
10778
10779::
10780
10781 declare float @llvm.exp.f32(float %Val)
10782 declare double @llvm.exp.f64(double %Val)
10783 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.exp.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10784 declare fp128 @llvm.exp.f128(fp128 %Val)
10785 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10786
10787Overview:
10788"""""""""
10789
Andrew Kaylorcaf24d22017-04-11 21:52:40 +000010790The '``llvm.exp.*``' intrinsics compute the base-e exponential of the specified
10791value.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010792
10793Arguments:
10794""""""""""
10795
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010796The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010797
10798Semantics:
10799""""""""""
10800
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010801Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``exp``' function but without
10802trapping or setting ``errno``.
10803
Elena Demikhovsky945b7e52018-02-14 06:58:08 +000010804When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010805using a less accurate calculation.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010806
10807'``llvm.exp2.*``' Intrinsic
10808^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10809
10810Syntax:
10811"""""""
10812
10813This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.exp2`` on any
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010814floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010815all types however.
10816
10817::
10818
10819 declare float @llvm.exp2.f32(float %Val)
10820 declare double @llvm.exp2.f64(double %Val)
10821 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.exp2.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10822 declare fp128 @llvm.exp2.f128(fp128 %Val)
10823 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10824
10825Overview:
10826"""""""""
10827
Andrew Kaylorcaf24d22017-04-11 21:52:40 +000010828The '``llvm.exp2.*``' intrinsics compute the base-2 exponential of the
10829specified value.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010830
10831Arguments:
10832""""""""""
10833
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010834The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010835
10836Semantics:
10837""""""""""
10838
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010839Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``exp2``' function but without
10840trapping or setting ``errno``.
10841
Elena Demikhovsky945b7e52018-02-14 06:58:08 +000010842When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010843using a less accurate calculation.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010844
10845'``llvm.log.*``' Intrinsic
10846^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10847
10848Syntax:
10849"""""""
10850
10851This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log`` on any
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010852floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010853all types however.
10854
10855::
10856
10857 declare float @llvm.log.f32(float %Val)
10858 declare double @llvm.log.f64(double %Val)
10859 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10860 declare fp128 @llvm.log.f128(fp128 %Val)
10861 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10862
10863Overview:
10864"""""""""
10865
Andrew Kaylorcaf24d22017-04-11 21:52:40 +000010866The '``llvm.log.*``' intrinsics compute the base-e logarithm of the specified
10867value.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010868
10869Arguments:
10870""""""""""
10871
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010872The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010873
10874Semantics:
10875""""""""""
10876
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010877Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``log``' function but without
10878trapping or setting ``errno``.
10879
Elena Demikhovsky945b7e52018-02-14 06:58:08 +000010880When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010881using a less accurate calculation.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010882
10883'``llvm.log10.*``' Intrinsic
10884^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10885
10886Syntax:
10887"""""""
10888
10889This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log10`` on any
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010890floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010891all types however.
10892
10893::
10894
10895 declare float @llvm.log10.f32(float %Val)
10896 declare double @llvm.log10.f64(double %Val)
10897 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log10.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10898 declare fp128 @llvm.log10.f128(fp128 %Val)
10899 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log10.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10900
10901Overview:
10902"""""""""
10903
Andrew Kaylorcaf24d22017-04-11 21:52:40 +000010904The '``llvm.log10.*``' intrinsics compute the base-10 logarithm of the
10905specified value.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010906
10907Arguments:
10908""""""""""
10909
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010910The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010911
10912Semantics:
10913""""""""""
10914
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010915Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``log10``' function but without
10916trapping or setting ``errno``.
10917
Elena Demikhovsky945b7e52018-02-14 06:58:08 +000010918When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010919using a less accurate calculation.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010920
10921'``llvm.log2.*``' Intrinsic
10922^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10923
10924Syntax:
10925"""""""
10926
10927This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log2`` on any
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010928floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010929all types however.
10930
10931::
10932
10933 declare float @llvm.log2.f32(float %Val)
10934 declare double @llvm.log2.f64(double %Val)
10935 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log2.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10936 declare fp128 @llvm.log2.f128(fp128 %Val)
10937 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10938
10939Overview:
10940"""""""""
10941
Andrew Kaylorcaf24d22017-04-11 21:52:40 +000010942The '``llvm.log2.*``' intrinsics compute the base-2 logarithm of the specified
10943value.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010944
10945Arguments:
10946""""""""""
10947
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010948The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010949
10950Semantics:
10951""""""""""
10952
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010953Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``log2``' function but without
10954trapping or setting ``errno``.
10955
Elena Demikhovsky945b7e52018-02-14 06:58:08 +000010956When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010957using a less accurate calculation.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010958
10959'``llvm.fma.*``' Intrinsic
10960^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10961
10962Syntax:
10963"""""""
10964
10965This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fma`` on any
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010966floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010967all types however.
10968
10969::
10970
10971 declare float @llvm.fma.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c)
10972 declare double @llvm.fma.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c)
10973 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.fma.f80(x86_fp80 %a, x86_fp80 %b, x86_fp80 %c)
10974 declare fp128 @llvm.fma.f128(fp128 %a, fp128 %b, fp128 %c)
10975 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fma.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %a, ppc_fp128 %b, ppc_fp128 %c)
10976
10977Overview:
10978"""""""""
10979
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010980The '``llvm.fma.*``' intrinsics perform the fused multiply-add operation.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010981
10982Arguments:
10983""""""""""
10984
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010985The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010986
10987Semantics:
10988""""""""""
10989
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010990Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``fma``' function but without
10991trapping or setting ``errno``.
10992
Elena Demikhovsky945b7e52018-02-14 06:58:08 +000010993When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
Sanjay Patel629c4112017-11-06 16:27:15 +000010994using a less accurate calculation.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010995
10996'``llvm.fabs.*``' Intrinsic
10997^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10998
10999Syntax:
11000"""""""
11001
11002This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fabs`` on any
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011003floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011004all types however.
11005
11006::
11007
11008 declare float @llvm.fabs.f32(float %Val)
11009 declare double @llvm.fabs.f64(double %Val)
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000011010 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.fabs.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011011 declare fp128 @llvm.fabs.f128(fp128 %Val)
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000011012 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fabs.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011013
11014Overview:
11015"""""""""
11016
11017The '``llvm.fabs.*``' intrinsics return the absolute value of the
11018operand.
11019
11020Arguments:
11021""""""""""
11022
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011023The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011024type.
11025
11026Semantics:
11027""""""""""
11028
11029This function returns the same values as the libm ``fabs`` functions
11030would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
11031
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000011032'``llvm.minnum.*``' Intrinsic
Matt Arsenault9886b0d2014-10-22 00:15:53 +000011033^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000011034
11035Syntax:
11036"""""""
11037
11038This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.minnum`` on any
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011039floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000011040all types however.
11041
11042::
11043
Matt Arsenault64313c92014-10-22 18:25:02 +000011044 declare float @llvm.minnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1)
11045 declare double @llvm.minnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
11046 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.minnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
11047 declare fp128 @llvm.minnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
11048 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.minnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000011049
11050Overview:
11051"""""""""
11052
11053The '``llvm.minnum.*``' intrinsics return the minimum of the two
11054arguments.
11055
11056
11057Arguments:
11058""""""""""
11059
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011060The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000011061type.
11062
11063Semantics:
11064""""""""""
11065
11066Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for minNum, which also match for libm's
11067fmin.
11068
11069If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns
11070NaN only if both operands are NaN. If the operands compare equal,
11071returns a value that compares equal to both operands. This means that
11072fmin(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could return either -0.0 or 0.0.
11073
11074'``llvm.maxnum.*``' Intrinsic
Matt Arsenault9886b0d2014-10-22 00:15:53 +000011075^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000011076
11077Syntax:
11078"""""""
11079
11080This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.maxnum`` on any
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011081floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000011082all types however.
11083
11084::
11085
Matt Arsenault64313c92014-10-22 18:25:02 +000011086 declare float @llvm.maxnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1l)
11087 declare double @llvm.maxnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
11088 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.maxnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
11089 declare fp128 @llvm.maxnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
11090 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.maxnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000011091
11092Overview:
11093"""""""""
11094
11095The '``llvm.maxnum.*``' intrinsics return the maximum of the two
11096arguments.
11097
11098
11099Arguments:
11100""""""""""
11101
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011102The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000011103type.
11104
11105Semantics:
11106""""""""""
11107Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for maxNum, which also match for libm's
11108fmax.
11109
11110If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns
11111NaN only if both operands are NaN. If the operands compare equal,
11112returns a value that compares equal to both operands. This means that
11113fmax(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could return either -0.0 or 0.0.
11114
Hal Finkel0c5c01aa2013-08-19 23:35:46 +000011115'``llvm.copysign.*``' Intrinsic
11116^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11117
11118Syntax:
11119"""""""
11120
11121This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.copysign`` on any
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011122floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Hal Finkel0c5c01aa2013-08-19 23:35:46 +000011123all types however.
11124
11125::
11126
11127 declare float @llvm.copysign.f32(float %Mag, float %Sgn)
11128 declare double @llvm.copysign.f64(double %Mag, double %Sgn)
11129 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.copysign.f80(x86_fp80 %Mag, x86_fp80 %Sgn)
11130 declare fp128 @llvm.copysign.f128(fp128 %Mag, fp128 %Sgn)
11131 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.copysign.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Mag, ppc_fp128 %Sgn)
11132
11133Overview:
11134"""""""""
11135
11136The '``llvm.copysign.*``' intrinsics return a value with the magnitude of the
11137first operand and the sign of the second operand.
11138
11139Arguments:
11140""""""""""
11141
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011142The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
Hal Finkel0c5c01aa2013-08-19 23:35:46 +000011143type.
11144
11145Semantics:
11146""""""""""
11147
11148This function returns the same values as the libm ``copysign``
11149functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
11150
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011151'``llvm.floor.*``' Intrinsic
11152^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11153
11154Syntax:
11155"""""""
11156
11157This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.floor`` on any
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011158floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011159all types however.
11160
11161::
11162
11163 declare float @llvm.floor.f32(float %Val)
11164 declare double @llvm.floor.f64(double %Val)
11165 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.floor.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11166 declare fp128 @llvm.floor.f128(fp128 %Val)
11167 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.floor.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11168
11169Overview:
11170"""""""""
11171
11172The '``llvm.floor.*``' intrinsics return the floor of the operand.
11173
11174Arguments:
11175""""""""""
11176
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011177The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011178type.
11179
11180Semantics:
11181""""""""""
11182
11183This function returns the same values as the libm ``floor`` functions
11184would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
11185
11186'``llvm.ceil.*``' Intrinsic
11187^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11188
11189Syntax:
11190"""""""
11191
11192This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ceil`` on any
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011193floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011194all types however.
11195
11196::
11197
11198 declare float @llvm.ceil.f32(float %Val)
11199 declare double @llvm.ceil.f64(double %Val)
11200 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.ceil.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11201 declare fp128 @llvm.ceil.f128(fp128 %Val)
11202 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.ceil.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11203
11204Overview:
11205"""""""""
11206
11207The '``llvm.ceil.*``' intrinsics return the ceiling of the operand.
11208
11209Arguments:
11210""""""""""
11211
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011212The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011213type.
11214
11215Semantics:
11216""""""""""
11217
11218This function returns the same values as the libm ``ceil`` functions
11219would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
11220
11221'``llvm.trunc.*``' Intrinsic
11222^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11223
11224Syntax:
11225"""""""
11226
11227This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.trunc`` on any
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011228floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011229all types however.
11230
11231::
11232
11233 declare float @llvm.trunc.f32(float %Val)
11234 declare double @llvm.trunc.f64(double %Val)
11235 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.trunc.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11236 declare fp128 @llvm.trunc.f128(fp128 %Val)
11237 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.trunc.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11238
11239Overview:
11240"""""""""
11241
11242The '``llvm.trunc.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
11243nearest integer not larger in magnitude than the operand.
11244
11245Arguments:
11246""""""""""
11247
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011248The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011249type.
11250
11251Semantics:
11252""""""""""
11253
11254This function returns the same values as the libm ``trunc`` functions
11255would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
11256
11257'``llvm.rint.*``' Intrinsic
11258^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11259
11260Syntax:
11261"""""""
11262
11263This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.rint`` on any
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011264floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011265all types however.
11266
11267::
11268
11269 declare float @llvm.rint.f32(float %Val)
11270 declare double @llvm.rint.f64(double %Val)
11271 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.rint.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11272 declare fp128 @llvm.rint.f128(fp128 %Val)
11273 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.rint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11274
11275Overview:
11276"""""""""
11277
11278The '``llvm.rint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
11279nearest integer. It may raise an inexact floating-point exception if the
11280operand isn't an integer.
11281
11282Arguments:
11283""""""""""
11284
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011285The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011286type.
11287
11288Semantics:
11289""""""""""
11290
11291This function returns the same values as the libm ``rint`` functions
11292would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
11293
11294'``llvm.nearbyint.*``' Intrinsic
11295^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11296
11297Syntax:
11298"""""""
11299
11300This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.nearbyint`` on any
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011301floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011302all types however.
11303
11304::
11305
11306 declare float @llvm.nearbyint.f32(float %Val)
11307 declare double @llvm.nearbyint.f64(double %Val)
11308 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.nearbyint.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11309 declare fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.f128(fp128 %Val)
11310 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11311
11312Overview:
11313"""""""""
11314
11315The '``llvm.nearbyint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
11316nearest integer.
11317
11318Arguments:
11319""""""""""
11320
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011321The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011322type.
11323
11324Semantics:
11325""""""""""
11326
11327This function returns the same values as the libm ``nearbyint``
11328functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
11329
Hal Finkel171817e2013-08-07 22:49:12 +000011330'``llvm.round.*``' Intrinsic
11331^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11332
11333Syntax:
11334"""""""
11335
11336This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.round`` on any
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011337floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
Hal Finkel171817e2013-08-07 22:49:12 +000011338all types however.
11339
11340::
11341
11342 declare float @llvm.round.f32(float %Val)
11343 declare double @llvm.round.f64(double %Val)
11344 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.round.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11345 declare fp128 @llvm.round.f128(fp128 %Val)
11346 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.round.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11347
11348Overview:
11349"""""""""
11350
11351The '``llvm.round.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
11352nearest integer.
11353
11354Arguments:
11355""""""""""
11356
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011357The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
Hal Finkel171817e2013-08-07 22:49:12 +000011358type.
11359
11360Semantics:
11361""""""""""
11362
11363This function returns the same values as the libm ``round``
11364functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
11365
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011366Bit Manipulation Intrinsics
11367---------------------------
11368
11369LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important bit manipulation
11370operations. These allow efficient code generation for some algorithms.
11371
James Molloy90111f72015-11-12 12:29:09 +000011372'``llvm.bitreverse.*``' Intrinsics
Akira Hatanaka7f5562b2015-11-13 21:09:57 +000011373^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
James Molloy90111f72015-11-12 12:29:09 +000011374
11375Syntax:
11376"""""""
11377
11378This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bitreverse on any
11379integer type.
11380
11381::
11382
11383 declare i16 @llvm.bitreverse.i16(i16 <id>)
11384 declare i32 @llvm.bitreverse.i32(i32 <id>)
11385 declare i64 @llvm.bitreverse.i64(i64 <id>)
11386
11387Overview:
11388"""""""""
11389
11390The '``llvm.bitreverse``' family of intrinsics is used to reverse the
Matt Arsenaultde2d6a32016-03-07 21:54:52 +000011391bitpattern of an integer value; for example ``0b10110110`` becomes
11392``0b01101101``.
James Molloy90111f72015-11-12 12:29:09 +000011393
11394Semantics:
11395""""""""""
11396
Yichao Yu5abf14b2016-11-23 16:25:31 +000011397The ``llvm.bitreverse.iN`` intrinsic returns an iN value that has bit
James Molloy90111f72015-11-12 12:29:09 +000011398``M`` in the input moved to bit ``N-M`` in the output.
11399
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011400'``llvm.bswap.*``' Intrinsics
11401^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11402
11403Syntax:
11404"""""""
11405
11406This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bswap on any
11407integer type that is an even number of bytes (i.e. BitWidth % 16 == 0).
11408
11409::
11410
11411 declare i16 @llvm.bswap.i16(i16 <id>)
11412 declare i32 @llvm.bswap.i32(i32 <id>)
11413 declare i64 @llvm.bswap.i64(i64 <id>)
11414
11415Overview:
11416"""""""""
11417
11418The '``llvm.bswap``' family of intrinsics is used to byte swap integer
11419values with an even number of bytes (positive multiple of 16 bits).
11420These are useful for performing operations on data that is not in the
11421target's native byte order.
11422
11423Semantics:
11424""""""""""
11425
11426The ``llvm.bswap.i16`` intrinsic returns an i16 value that has the high
11427and low byte of the input i16 swapped. Similarly, the ``llvm.bswap.i32``
11428intrinsic returns an i32 value that has the four bytes of the input i32
11429swapped, so that if the input bytes are numbered 0, 1, 2, 3 then the
11430returned i32 will have its bytes in 3, 2, 1, 0 order. The
11431``llvm.bswap.i48``, ``llvm.bswap.i64`` and other intrinsics extend this
11432concept to additional even-byte lengths (6 bytes, 8 bytes and more,
11433respectively).
11434
11435'``llvm.ctpop.*``' Intrinsic
11436^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11437
11438Syntax:
11439"""""""
11440
11441This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.ctpop on any integer
11442bit width, or on any vector with integer elements. Not all targets
11443support all bit widths or vector types, however.
11444
11445::
11446
11447 declare i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 <src>)
11448 declare i16 @llvm.ctpop.i16(i16 <src>)
11449 declare i32 @llvm.ctpop.i32(i32 <src>)
11450 declare i64 @llvm.ctpop.i64(i64 <src>)
11451 declare i256 @llvm.ctpop.i256(i256 <src>)
11452 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.ctpop.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>)
11453
11454Overview:
11455"""""""""
11456
11457The '``llvm.ctpop``' family of intrinsics counts the number of bits set
11458in a value.
11459
11460Arguments:
11461""""""""""
11462
11463The only argument is the value to be counted. The argument may be of any
11464integer type, or a vector with integer elements. The return type must
11465match the argument type.
11466
11467Semantics:
11468""""""""""
11469
11470The '``llvm.ctpop``' intrinsic counts the 1's in a variable, or within
11471each element of a vector.
11472
11473'``llvm.ctlz.*``' Intrinsic
11474^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11475
11476Syntax:
11477"""""""
11478
11479This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ctlz`` on any
11480integer bit width, or any vector whose elements are integers. Not all
11481targets support all bit widths or vector types, however.
11482
11483::
11484
11485 declare i8 @llvm.ctlz.i8 (i8 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
11486 declare i16 @llvm.ctlz.i16 (i16 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
11487 declare i32 @llvm.ctlz.i32 (i32 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
11488 declare i64 @llvm.ctlz.i64 (i64 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
11489 declare i256 @llvm.ctlz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
Alexey Samsonovc4b18302016-03-17 23:08:01 +000011490 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.ctlz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011491
11492Overview:
11493"""""""""
11494
11495The '``llvm.ctlz``' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
11496leading zeros in a variable.
11497
11498Arguments:
11499""""""""""
11500
11501The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of
Hal Finkel5dd82782015-01-05 04:05:21 +000011502any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011503type must match the first argument type.
11504
11505The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether
11506the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a
11507defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a
11508defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are
11509now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs.
11510
11511Semantics:
11512""""""""""
11513
11514The '``llvm.ctlz``' intrinsic counts the leading (most significant)
11515zeros in a variable, or within each element of the vector. If
11516``src == 0`` then the result is the size in bits of the type of ``src``
11517if ``is_zero_undef == 0`` and ``undef`` otherwise. For example,
11518``llvm.ctlz(i32 2) = 30``.
11519
11520'``llvm.cttz.*``' Intrinsic
11521^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11522
11523Syntax:
11524"""""""
11525
11526This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.cttz`` on any
11527integer bit width, or any vector of integer elements. Not all targets
11528support all bit widths or vector types, however.
11529
11530::
11531
11532 declare i8 @llvm.cttz.i8 (i8 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
11533 declare i16 @llvm.cttz.i16 (i16 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
11534 declare i32 @llvm.cttz.i32 (i32 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
11535 declare i64 @llvm.cttz.i64 (i64 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
11536 declare i256 @llvm.cttz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
Alexey Samsonovc4b18302016-03-17 23:08:01 +000011537 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.cttz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011538
11539Overview:
11540"""""""""
11541
11542The '``llvm.cttz``' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
11543trailing zeros.
11544
11545Arguments:
11546""""""""""
11547
11548The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of
Hal Finkel5dd82782015-01-05 04:05:21 +000011549any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011550type must match the first argument type.
11551
11552The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether
11553the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a
11554defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a
11555defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are
11556now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs.
11557
11558Semantics:
11559""""""""""
11560
11561The '``llvm.cttz``' intrinsic counts the trailing (least significant)
11562zeros in a variable, or within each element of a vector. If ``src == 0``
11563then the result is the size in bits of the type of ``src`` if
11564``is_zero_undef == 0`` and ``undef`` otherwise. For example,
11565``llvm.cttz(2) = 1``.
11566
Philip Reames34843ae2015-03-05 05:55:55 +000011567.. _int_overflow:
11568
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011569Arithmetic with Overflow Intrinsics
11570-----------------------------------
11571
John Regehr6a493f22016-05-12 20:55:09 +000011572LLVM provides intrinsics for fast arithmetic overflow checking.
11573
11574Each of these intrinsics returns a two-element struct. The first
11575element of this struct contains the result of the corresponding
11576arithmetic operation modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
11577the result. Therefore, for example, the first element of the struct
11578returned by ``llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32`` is always the same as the
11579result of a 32-bit ``add`` instruction with the same operands, where
11580the ``add`` is *not* modified by an ``nsw`` or ``nuw`` flag.
11581
11582The second element of the result is an ``i1`` that is 1 if the
11583arithmetic operation overflowed and 0 otherwise. An operation
11584overflows if, for any values of its operands ``A`` and ``B`` and for
11585any ``N`` larger than the operands' width, ``ext(A op B) to iN`` is
11586not equal to ``(ext(A) to iN) op (ext(B) to iN)`` where ``ext`` is
11587``sext`` for signed overflow and ``zext`` for unsigned overflow, and
11588``op`` is the underlying arithmetic operation.
11589
11590The behavior of these intrinsics is well-defined for all argument
11591values.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011592
11593'``llvm.sadd.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
11594^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11595
11596Syntax:
11597"""""""
11598
11599This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``
11600on any integer bit width.
11601
11602::
11603
11604 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
11605 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11606 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
11607
11608Overview:
11609"""""""""
11610
11611The '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
11612a signed addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether an overflow
11613occurred during the signed summation.
11614
11615Arguments:
11616""""""""""
11617
11618The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
11619may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
11620bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
11621``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
11622addition.
11623
11624Semantics:
11625""""""""""
11626
11627The '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000011628a signed addition of the two variables. They return a structure --- the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011629first element of which is the signed summation, and the second element
11630of which is a bit specifying if the signed summation resulted in an
11631overflow.
11632
11633Examples:
11634"""""""""
11635
11636.. code-block:: llvm
11637
11638 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11639 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
11640 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
11641 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
11642
11643'``llvm.uadd.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
11644^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11645
11646Syntax:
11647"""""""
11648
11649This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``
11650on any integer bit width.
11651
11652::
11653
11654 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
11655 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11656 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
11657
11658Overview:
11659"""""""""
11660
11661The '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
11662an unsigned addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether a carry
11663occurred during the unsigned summation.
11664
11665Arguments:
11666""""""""""
11667
11668The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
11669may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
11670bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
11671``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
11672addition.
11673
11674Semantics:
11675""""""""""
11676
11677The '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000011678an unsigned addition of the two arguments. They return a structure --- the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011679first element of which is the sum, and the second element of which is a
11680bit specifying if the unsigned summation resulted in a carry.
11681
11682Examples:
11683"""""""""
11684
11685.. code-block:: llvm
11686
11687 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11688 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
11689 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
11690 br i1 %obit, label %carry, label %normal
11691
11692'``llvm.ssub.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
11693^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11694
11695Syntax:
11696"""""""
11697
11698This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``
11699on any integer bit width.
11700
11701::
11702
11703 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
11704 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11705 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
11706
11707Overview:
11708"""""""""
11709
11710The '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
11711a signed subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
11712overflow occurred during the signed subtraction.
11713
11714Arguments:
11715""""""""""
11716
11717The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
11718may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
11719bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
11720``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
11721subtraction.
11722
11723Semantics:
11724""""""""""
11725
11726The '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000011727a signed subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure --- the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011728first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
11729which is a bit specifying if the signed subtraction resulted in an
11730overflow.
11731
11732Examples:
11733"""""""""
11734
11735.. code-block:: llvm
11736
11737 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11738 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
11739 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
11740 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
11741
11742'``llvm.usub.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
11743^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11744
11745Syntax:
11746"""""""
11747
11748This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.usub.with.overflow``
11749on any integer bit width.
11750
11751::
11752
11753 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
11754 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11755 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
11756
11757Overview:
11758"""""""""
11759
11760The '``llvm.usub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
11761an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
11762overflow occurred during the unsigned subtraction.
11763
11764Arguments:
11765""""""""""
11766
11767The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
11768may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
11769bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
11770``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
11771subtraction.
11772
11773Semantics:
11774""""""""""
11775
11776The '``llvm.usub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000011777an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011778the first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
11779which is a bit specifying if the unsigned subtraction resulted in an
11780overflow.
11781
11782Examples:
11783"""""""""
11784
11785.. code-block:: llvm
11786
11787 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11788 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
11789 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
11790 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
11791
11792'``llvm.smul.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
11793^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11794
11795Syntax:
11796"""""""
11797
11798This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.smul.with.overflow``
11799on any integer bit width.
11800
11801::
11802
11803 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
11804 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11805 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
11806
11807Overview:
11808"""""""""
11809
11810The '``llvm.smul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
11811a signed multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
11812overflow occurred during the signed multiplication.
11813
11814Arguments:
11815""""""""""
11816
11817The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
11818may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
11819bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
11820``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
11821multiplication.
11822
11823Semantics:
11824""""""""""
11825
11826The '``llvm.smul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000011827a signed multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011828the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second element
11829of which is a bit specifying if the signed multiplication resulted in an
11830overflow.
11831
11832Examples:
11833"""""""""
11834
11835.. code-block:: llvm
11836
11837 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11838 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
11839 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
11840 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
11841
11842'``llvm.umul.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
11843^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11844
11845Syntax:
11846"""""""
11847
11848This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.umul.with.overflow``
11849on any integer bit width.
11850
11851::
11852
11853 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
11854 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11855 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
11856
11857Overview:
11858"""""""""
11859
11860The '``llvm.umul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
11861a unsigned multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
11862overflow occurred during the unsigned multiplication.
11863
11864Arguments:
11865""""""""""
11866
11867The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
11868may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
11869bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
11870``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
11871multiplication.
11872
11873Semantics:
11874""""""""""
11875
11876The '``llvm.umul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000011877an unsigned multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
11878the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011879element of which is a bit specifying if the unsigned multiplication
11880resulted in an overflow.
11881
11882Examples:
11883"""""""""
11884
11885.. code-block:: llvm
11886
11887 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11888 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
11889 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
11890 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
11891
11892Specialised Arithmetic Intrinsics
11893---------------------------------
11894
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011895'``llvm.canonicalize.*``' Intrinsic
11896^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11897
11898Syntax:
11899"""""""
11900
11901::
11902
11903 declare float @llvm.canonicalize.f32(float %a)
11904 declare double @llvm.canonicalize.f64(double %b)
11905
11906Overview:
11907"""""""""
11908
11909The '``llvm.canonicalize.*``' intrinsic returns the platform specific canonical
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011910encoding of a floating-point number. This canonicalization is useful for
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011911implementing certain numeric primitives such as frexp. The canonical encoding is
11912defined by IEEE-754-2008 to be:
11913
11914::
11915
11916 2.1.8 canonical encoding: The preferred encoding of a floating-point
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000011917 representation in a format. Applied to declets, significands of finite
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011918 numbers, infinities, and NaNs, especially in decimal formats.
11919
11920This operation can also be considered equivalent to the IEEE-754-2008
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000011921conversion of a floating-point value to the same format. NaNs are handled
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011922according to section 6.2.
11923
11924Examples of non-canonical encodings:
11925
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000011926- x87 pseudo denormals, pseudo NaNs, pseudo Infinity, Unnormals. These are
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011927 converted to a canonical representation per hardware-specific protocol.
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011928- Many normal decimal floating-point numbers have non-canonical alternative
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011929 encodings.
11930- Some machines, like GPUs or ARMv7 NEON, do not support subnormal values.
Sanjay Patelcc330962016-02-24 23:44:19 +000011931 These are treated as non-canonical encodings of zero and will be flushed to
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011932 a zero of the same sign by this operation.
11933
11934Note that per IEEE-754-2008 6.2, systems that support signaling NaNs with
11935default exception handling must signal an invalid exception, and produce a
11936quiet NaN result.
11937
11938This function should always be implementable as multiplication by 1.0, provided
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000011939that the compiler does not constant fold the operation. Likewise, division by
119401.0 and ``llvm.minnum(x, x)`` are possible implementations. Addition with
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011941-0.0 is also sufficient provided that the rounding mode is not -Infinity.
11942
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000011943``@llvm.canonicalize`` must preserve the equality relation. That is:
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011944
11945- ``(@llvm.canonicalize(x) == x)`` is equivalent to ``(x == x)``
11946- ``(@llvm.canonicalize(x) == @llvm.canonicalize(y))`` is equivalent to
11947 to ``(x == y)``
11948
11949Additionally, the sign of zero must be conserved:
11950``@llvm.canonicalize(-0.0) = -0.0`` and ``@llvm.canonicalize(+0.0) = +0.0``
11951
11952The payload bits of a NaN must be conserved, with two exceptions.
11953First, environments which use only a single canonical representation of NaN
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000011954must perform said canonicalization. Second, SNaNs must be quieted per the
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011955usual methods.
11956
11957The canonicalization operation may be optimized away if:
11958
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000011959- The input is known to be canonical. For example, it was produced by a
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011960 floating-point operation that is required by the standard to be canonical.
11961- The result is consumed only by (or fused with) other floating-point
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000011962 operations. That is, the bits of the floating-point value are not examined.
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011963
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011964'``llvm.fmuladd.*``' Intrinsic
11965^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11966
11967Syntax:
11968"""""""
11969
11970::
11971
11972 declare float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c)
11973 declare double @llvm.fmuladd.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c)
11974
11975Overview:
11976"""""""""
11977
11978The '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' intrinsic functions represent multiply-add
Lang Hames045f4392013-01-17 00:00:49 +000011979expressions that can be fused if the code generator determines that (a) the
11980target instruction set has support for a fused operation, and (b) that the
11981fused operation is more efficient than the equivalent, separate pair of mul
11982and add instructions.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011983
11984Arguments:
11985""""""""""
11986
11987The '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' intrinsics each take three arguments: two
11988multiplicands, a and b, and an addend c.
11989
11990Semantics:
11991""""""""""
11992
11993The expression:
11994
11995::
11996
11997 %0 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(%a, %b, %c)
11998
11999is equivalent to the expression a \* b + c, except that rounding will
12000not be performed between the multiplication and addition steps if the
12001code generator fuses the operations. Fusion is not guaranteed, even if
12002the target platform supports it. If a fused multiply-add is required the
Matt Arsenaultee364ee2014-01-31 00:09:00 +000012003corresponding llvm.fma.\* intrinsic function should be used
12004instead. This never sets errno, just as '``llvm.fma.*``'.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012005
12006Examples:
12007"""""""""
12008
12009.. code-block:: llvm
12010
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +000012011 %r2 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c) ; yields float:r2 = (a * b) + c
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012012
Amara Emersoncf9daa32017-05-09 10:43:25 +000012013
12014Experimental Vector Reduction Intrinsics
12015----------------------------------------
12016
12017Horizontal reductions of vectors can be expressed using the following
12018intrinsics. Each one takes a vector operand as an input and applies its
12019respective operation across all elements of the vector, returning a single
12020scalar result of the same element type.
12021
12022
12023'``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.add.*``' Intrinsic
12024^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12025
12026Syntax:
12027"""""""
12028
12029::
12030
12031 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.add.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
12032 declare i64 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.add.i64.v2i64(<2 x i64> %a)
12033
12034Overview:
12035"""""""""
12036
12037The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.add.*``' intrinsics do an integer ``ADD``
12038reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches
12039the element-type of the vector input.
12040
12041Arguments:
12042""""""""""
12043The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
12044
12045'``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.*``' Intrinsic
12046^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12047
12048Syntax:
12049"""""""
12050
12051::
12052
12053 declare float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.f32.v4f32(float %acc, <4 x float> %a)
12054 declare double @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.f64.v2f64(double %acc, <2 x double> %a)
12055
12056Overview:
12057"""""""""
12058
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012059The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.*``' intrinsics do a floating-point
Amara Emersoncf9daa32017-05-09 10:43:25 +000012060``ADD`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
12061matches the element-type of the vector input.
12062
12063If the intrinsic call has fast-math flags, then the reduction will not preserve
12064the associativity of an equivalent scalarized counterpart. If it does not have
12065fast-math flags, then the reduction will be *ordered*, implying that the
12066operation respects the associativity of a scalarized reduction.
12067
12068
12069Arguments:
12070""""""""""
12071The first argument to this intrinsic is a scalar accumulator value, which is
12072only used when there are no fast-math flags attached. This argument may be undef
12073when fast-math flags are used.
12074
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012075The second argument must be a vector of floating-point values.
Amara Emersoncf9daa32017-05-09 10:43:25 +000012076
12077Examples:
12078"""""""""
12079
12080.. code-block:: llvm
12081
12082 %fast = call fast float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.f32.v4f32(float undef, <4 x float> %input) ; fast reduction
12083 %ord = call float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.f32.v4f32(float %acc, <4 x float> %input) ; ordered reduction
12084
12085
12086'``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.mul.*``' Intrinsic
12087^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12088
12089Syntax:
12090"""""""
12091
12092::
12093
12094 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.mul.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
12095 declare i64 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.mul.i64.v2i64(<2 x i64> %a)
12096
12097Overview:
12098"""""""""
12099
12100The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.mul.*``' intrinsics do an integer ``MUL``
12101reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches
12102the element-type of the vector input.
12103
12104Arguments:
12105""""""""""
12106The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
12107
12108'``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.*``' Intrinsic
12109^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12110
12111Syntax:
12112"""""""
12113
12114::
12115
12116 declare float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.f32.v4f32(float %acc, <4 x float> %a)
12117 declare double @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.f64.v2f64(double %acc, <2 x double> %a)
12118
12119Overview:
12120"""""""""
12121
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012122The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.*``' intrinsics do a floating-point
Amara Emersoncf9daa32017-05-09 10:43:25 +000012123``MUL`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
12124matches the element-type of the vector input.
12125
12126If the intrinsic call has fast-math flags, then the reduction will not preserve
12127the associativity of an equivalent scalarized counterpart. If it does not have
12128fast-math flags, then the reduction will be *ordered*, implying that the
12129operation respects the associativity of a scalarized reduction.
12130
12131
12132Arguments:
12133""""""""""
12134The first argument to this intrinsic is a scalar accumulator value, which is
12135only used when there are no fast-math flags attached. This argument may be undef
12136when fast-math flags are used.
12137
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012138The second argument must be a vector of floating-point values.
Amara Emersoncf9daa32017-05-09 10:43:25 +000012139
12140Examples:
12141"""""""""
12142
12143.. code-block:: llvm
12144
12145 %fast = call fast float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.f32.v4f32(float undef, <4 x float> %input) ; fast reduction
12146 %ord = call float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.f32.v4f32(float %acc, <4 x float> %input) ; ordered reduction
12147
12148'``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.and.*``' Intrinsic
12149^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12150
12151Syntax:
12152"""""""
12153
12154::
12155
12156 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.and.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
12157
12158Overview:
12159"""""""""
12160
12161The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.and.*``' intrinsics do a bitwise ``AND``
12162reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches
12163the element-type of the vector input.
12164
12165Arguments:
12166""""""""""
12167The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
12168
12169'``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.or.*``' Intrinsic
12170^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12171
12172Syntax:
12173"""""""
12174
12175::
12176
12177 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.or.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
12178
12179Overview:
12180"""""""""
12181
12182The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.or.*``' intrinsics do a bitwise ``OR`` reduction
12183of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches the
12184element-type of the vector input.
12185
12186Arguments:
12187""""""""""
12188The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
12189
12190'``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.xor.*``' Intrinsic
12191^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12192
12193Syntax:
12194"""""""
12195
12196::
12197
12198 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.xor.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
12199
12200Overview:
12201"""""""""
12202
12203The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.xor.*``' intrinsics do a bitwise ``XOR``
12204reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches
12205the element-type of the vector input.
12206
12207Arguments:
12208""""""""""
12209The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
12210
12211'``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smax.*``' Intrinsic
12212^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12213
12214Syntax:
12215"""""""
12216
12217::
12218
12219 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smax.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
12220
12221Overview:
12222"""""""""
12223
12224The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smax.*``' intrinsics do a signed integer
12225``MAX`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
12226matches the element-type of the vector input.
12227
12228Arguments:
12229""""""""""
12230The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
12231
12232'``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smin.*``' Intrinsic
12233^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12234
12235Syntax:
12236"""""""
12237
12238::
12239
12240 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smin.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
12241
12242Overview:
12243"""""""""
12244
12245The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smin.*``' intrinsics do a signed integer
12246``MIN`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
12247matches the element-type of the vector input.
12248
12249Arguments:
12250""""""""""
12251The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
12252
12253'``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umax.*``' Intrinsic
12254^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12255
12256Syntax:
12257"""""""
12258
12259::
12260
12261 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umax.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
12262
12263Overview:
12264"""""""""
12265
12266The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umax.*``' intrinsics do an unsigned
12267integer ``MAX`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The
12268return type matches the element-type of the vector input.
12269
12270Arguments:
12271""""""""""
12272The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
12273
12274'``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umin.*``' Intrinsic
12275^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12276
12277Syntax:
12278"""""""
12279
12280::
12281
12282 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umin.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
12283
12284Overview:
12285"""""""""
12286
12287The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umin.*``' intrinsics do an unsigned
12288integer ``MIN`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The
12289return type matches the element-type of the vector input.
12290
12291Arguments:
12292""""""""""
12293The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
12294
12295'``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmax.*``' Intrinsic
12296^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12297
12298Syntax:
12299"""""""
12300
12301::
12302
12303 declare float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmax.f32.v4f32(<4 x float> %a)
12304 declare double @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmax.f64.v2f64(<2 x double> %a)
12305
12306Overview:
12307"""""""""
12308
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012309The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmax.*``' intrinsics do a floating-point
Amara Emersoncf9daa32017-05-09 10:43:25 +000012310``MAX`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
12311matches the element-type of the vector input.
12312
12313If the intrinsic call has the ``nnan`` fast-math flag then the operation can
12314assume that NaNs are not present in the input vector.
12315
12316Arguments:
12317""""""""""
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012318The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of floating-point values.
Amara Emersoncf9daa32017-05-09 10:43:25 +000012319
12320'``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmin.*``' Intrinsic
12321^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12322
12323Syntax:
12324"""""""
12325
12326::
12327
12328 declare float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmin.f32.v4f32(<4 x float> %a)
12329 declare double @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmin.f64.v2f64(<2 x double> %a)
12330
12331Overview:
12332"""""""""
12333
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012334The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmin.*``' intrinsics do a floating-point
Amara Emersoncf9daa32017-05-09 10:43:25 +000012335``MIN`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
12336matches the element-type of the vector input.
12337
12338If the intrinsic call has the ``nnan`` fast-math flag then the operation can
12339assume that NaNs are not present in the input vector.
12340
12341Arguments:
12342""""""""""
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012343The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of floating-point values.
Amara Emersoncf9daa32017-05-09 10:43:25 +000012344
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012345Half Precision Floating-Point Intrinsics
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012346----------------------------------------
12347
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012348For most target platforms, half precision floating-point is a
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012349storage-only format. This means that it is a dense encoding (in memory)
12350but does not support computation in the format.
12351
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012352This means that code must first load the half-precision floating-point
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012353value as an i16, then convert it to float with
12354:ref:`llvm.convert.from.fp16 <int_convert_from_fp16>`. Computation can
12355then be performed on the float value (including extending to double
12356etc). To store the value back to memory, it is first converted to float
12357if needed, then converted to i16 with
12358:ref:`llvm.convert.to.fp16 <int_convert_to_fp16>`, then storing as an
12359i16 value.
12360
12361.. _int_convert_to_fp16:
12362
12363'``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' Intrinsic
12364^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12365
12366Syntax:
12367"""""""
12368
12369::
12370
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000012371 declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a)
12372 declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f64(double %a)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012373
12374Overview:
12375"""""""""
12376
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000012377The '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a conversion from a
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012378conventional floating-point type to half precision floating-point format.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012379
12380Arguments:
12381""""""""""
12382
12383The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be
12384converted.
12385
12386Semantics:
12387""""""""""
12388
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000012389The '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a conversion from a
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012390conventional floating-point format to half precision floating-point format. The
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000012391return value is an ``i16`` which contains the converted number.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012392
12393Examples:
12394"""""""""
12395
12396.. code-block:: llvm
12397
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000012398 %res = call i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012399 store i16 %res, i16* @x, align 2
12400
12401.. _int_convert_from_fp16:
12402
12403'``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' Intrinsic
12404^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12405
12406Syntax:
12407"""""""
12408
12409::
12410
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000012411 declare float @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f32(i16 %a)
12412 declare double @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f64(i16 %a)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012413
12414Overview:
12415"""""""""
12416
12417The '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012418conversion from half precision floating-point format to single precision
12419floating-point format.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012420
12421Arguments:
12422""""""""""
12423
12424The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be
12425converted.
12426
12427Semantics:
12428""""""""""
12429
12430The '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012431conversion from half single precision floating-point format to single
12432precision floating-point format. The input half-float value is
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012433represented by an ``i16`` value.
12434
12435Examples:
12436"""""""""
12437
12438.. code-block:: llvm
12439
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +000012440 %a = load i16, i16* @x, align 2
Matt Arsenault3e3ddda2014-07-10 03:22:16 +000012441 %res = call float @llvm.convert.from.fp16(i16 %a)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012442
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +000012443.. _dbg_intrinsics:
12444
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012445Debugger Intrinsics
12446-------------------
12447
12448The LLVM debugger intrinsics (which all start with ``llvm.dbg.``
12449prefix), are described in the `LLVM Source Level
Hans Wennborg65195622017-09-28 15:16:37 +000012450Debugging <SourceLevelDebugging.html#format-common-intrinsics>`_
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012451document.
12452
12453Exception Handling Intrinsics
12454-----------------------------
12455
12456The LLVM exception handling intrinsics (which all start with
12457``llvm.eh.`` prefix), are described in the `LLVM Exception
Hans Wennborg65195622017-09-28 15:16:37 +000012458Handling <ExceptionHandling.html#format-common-intrinsics>`_ document.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012459
12460.. _int_trampoline:
12461
12462Trampoline Intrinsics
12463---------------------
12464
12465These intrinsics make it possible to excise one parameter, marked with
12466the :ref:`nest <nest>` attribute, from a function. The result is a
12467callable function pointer lacking the nest parameter - the caller does
12468not need to provide a value for it. Instead, the value to use is stored
12469in advance in a "trampoline", a block of memory usually allocated on the
12470stack, which also contains code to splice the nest value into the
12471argument list. This is used to implement the GCC nested function address
12472extension.
12473
12474For example, if the function is ``i32 f(i8* nest %c, i32 %x, i32 %y)``
12475then the resulting function pointer has signature ``i32 (i32, i32)*``.
12476It can be created as follows:
12477
12478.. code-block:: llvm
12479
12480 %tramp = alloca [10 x i8], align 4 ; size and alignment only correct for X86
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +000012481 %tramp1 = getelementptr [10 x i8], [10 x i8]* %tramp, i32 0, i32 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012482 call i8* @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* %tramp1, i8* bitcast (i32 (i8*, i32, i32)* @f to i8*), i8* %nval)
12483 %p = call i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* %tramp1)
12484 %fp = bitcast i8* %p to i32 (i32, i32)*
12485
12486The call ``%val = call i32 %fp(i32 %x, i32 %y)`` is then equivalent to
12487``%val = call i32 %f(i8* %nval, i32 %x, i32 %y)``.
12488
12489.. _int_it:
12490
12491'``llvm.init.trampoline``' Intrinsic
12492^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12493
12494Syntax:
12495"""""""
12496
12497::
12498
12499 declare void @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* <tramp>, i8* <func>, i8* <nval>)
12500
12501Overview:
12502"""""""""
12503
12504This fills the memory pointed to by ``tramp`` with executable code,
12505turning it into a trampoline.
12506
12507Arguments:
12508""""""""""
12509
12510The ``llvm.init.trampoline`` intrinsic takes three arguments, all
12511pointers. The ``tramp`` argument must point to a sufficiently large and
12512sufficiently aligned block of memory; this memory is written to by the
12513intrinsic. Note that the size and the alignment are target-specific -
12514LLVM currently provides no portable way of determining them, so a
12515front-end that generates this intrinsic needs to have some
12516target-specific knowledge. The ``func`` argument must hold a function
12517bitcast to an ``i8*``.
12518
12519Semantics:
12520""""""""""
12521
12522The block of memory pointed to by ``tramp`` is filled with target
12523dependent code, turning it into a function. Then ``tramp`` needs to be
12524passed to :ref:`llvm.adjust.trampoline <int_at>` to get a pointer which can
12525be :ref:`bitcast (to a new function) and called <int_trampoline>`. The new
12526function's signature is the same as that of ``func`` with any arguments
12527marked with the ``nest`` attribute removed. At most one such ``nest``
12528argument is allowed, and it must be of pointer type. Calling the new
12529function is equivalent to calling ``func`` with the same argument list,
12530but with ``nval`` used for the missing ``nest`` argument. If, after
12531calling ``llvm.init.trampoline``, the memory pointed to by ``tramp`` is
12532modified, then the effect of any later call to the returned function
12533pointer is undefined.
12534
12535.. _int_at:
12536
12537'``llvm.adjust.trampoline``' Intrinsic
12538^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12539
12540Syntax:
12541"""""""
12542
12543::
12544
12545 declare i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* <tramp>)
12546
12547Overview:
12548"""""""""
12549
12550This performs any required machine-specific adjustment to the address of
12551a trampoline (passed as ``tramp``).
12552
12553Arguments:
12554""""""""""
12555
12556``tramp`` must point to a block of memory which already has trampoline
12557code filled in by a previous call to
12558:ref:`llvm.init.trampoline <int_it>`.
12559
12560Semantics:
12561""""""""""
12562
12563On some architectures the address of the code to be executed needs to be
Sanjay Patel69bf48e2014-07-04 19:40:43 +000012564different than the address where the trampoline is actually stored. This
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012565intrinsic returns the executable address corresponding to ``tramp``
12566after performing the required machine specific adjustments. The pointer
12567returned can then be :ref:`bitcast and executed <int_trampoline>`.
12568
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000012569.. _int_mload_mstore:
12570
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000012571Masked Vector Load and Store Intrinsics
12572---------------------------------------
12573
12574LLVM provides intrinsics for predicated vector load and store operations. The predicate is specified by a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the "off" lanes are not accessed. When all bits of the mask are on, the intrinsic is identical to a regular vector load or store. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed.
12575
12576.. _int_mload:
12577
12578'``llvm.masked.load.*``' Intrinsics
12579^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12580
12581Syntax:
12582"""""""
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012583This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data is a vector of any integer, floating-point or pointer data type.
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000012584
12585::
12586
Artur Pilipenko7ad95ec2016-06-28 18:27:25 +000012587 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32.p0v16f32 (<16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
12588 declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.load.v2f64.p0v2f64 (<2 x double>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>)
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000012589 ;; The data is a vector of pointers to double
Artur Pilipenko7ad95ec2016-06-28 18:27:25 +000012590 declare <8 x double*> @llvm.masked.load.v8p0f64.p0v8p0f64 (<8 x double*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x double*> <passthru>)
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000012591 ;; The data is a vector of function pointers
Artur Pilipenko7ad95ec2016-06-28 18:27:25 +000012592 declare <8 x i32 ()*> @llvm.masked.load.v8p0f_i32f.p0v8p0f_i32f (<8 x i32 ()*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x i32 ()*> <passthru>)
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000012593
12594Overview:
12595"""""""""
12596
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000012597Reads a vector from memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000012598
12599
12600Arguments:
12601""""""""""
12602
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000012603The first operand is the base pointer for the load. The second operand is the alignment of the source location. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the base pointer and the type of the '``passthru``' operand are the same vector types.
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000012604
12605
12606Semantics:
12607""""""""""
12608
12609The '``llvm.masked.load``' intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked loads and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar load operations.
12610The result of this operation is equivalent to a regular vector load instruction followed by a 'select' between the loaded and the passthru values, predicated on the same mask. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions on memory access to masked-off lanes.
12611
12612
12613::
12614
Artur Pilipenko7ad95ec2016-06-28 18:27:25 +000012615 %res = call <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32.p0v16f32 (<16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1>%mask, <16 x float> %passthru)
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +000012616
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000012617 ;; The result of the two following instructions is identical aside from potential memory access exception
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +000012618 %loadlal = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
Elena Demikhovskye86c8c82014-12-29 09:47:51 +000012619 %res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %loadlal, <16 x float> %passthru
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000012620
12621.. _int_mstore:
12622
12623'``llvm.masked.store.*``' Intrinsics
12624^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12625
12626Syntax:
12627"""""""
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012628This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer, floating-point or pointer data type.
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000012629
12630::
12631
Artur Pilipenko7ad95ec2016-06-28 18:27:25 +000012632 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8i32.p0v8i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, <8 x i32>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
12633 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32.p0v16f32 (<16 x float> <value>, <16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000012634 ;; The data is a vector of pointers to double
Artur Pilipenko7ad95ec2016-06-28 18:27:25 +000012635 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8p0f64.p0v8p0f64 (<8 x double*> <value>, <8 x double*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000012636 ;; The data is a vector of function pointers
Artur Pilipenko7ad95ec2016-06-28 18:27:25 +000012637 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v4p0f_i32f.p0v4p0f_i32f (<4 x i32 ()*> <value>, <4 x i32 ()*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <4 x i1> <mask>)
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000012638
12639Overview:
12640"""""""""
12641
12642Writes a vector to memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes.
12643
12644Arguments:
12645""""""""""
12646
12647The first operand is the vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is the base pointer for the store, it has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is the alignment of the destination location. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements.
12648
12649
12650Semantics:
12651""""""""""
12652
12653The '``llvm.masked.store``' intrinsics is designed for conditional writing of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked store and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
12654The result of this operation is equivalent to a load-modify-store sequence. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions and data races on memory access to masked-off lanes.
12655
12656::
12657
Artur Pilipenko7ad95ec2016-06-28 18:27:25 +000012658 call void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32.p0v16f32(<16 x float> %value, <16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1> %mask)
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +000012659
Elena Demikhovskye86c8c82014-12-29 09:47:51 +000012660 ;; The result of the following instructions is identical aside from potential data races and memory access exceptions
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +000012661 %oldval = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000012662 %res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %value, <16 x float> %oldval
12663 store <16 x float> %res, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
12664
12665
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000012666Masked Vector Gather and Scatter Intrinsics
12667-------------------------------------------
12668
12669LLVM provides intrinsics for vector gather and scatter operations. They are similar to :ref:`Masked Vector Load and Store <int_mload_mstore>`, except they are designed for arbitrary memory accesses, rather than sequential memory accesses. Gather and scatter also employ a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the "off" lanes are not accessed. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed.
12670
12671.. _int_mgather:
12672
12673'``llvm.masked.gather.*``' Intrinsics
12674^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12675
12676Syntax:
12677"""""""
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012678This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data are multiple scalar values of any integer, floating-point or pointer data type gathered together into one vector.
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000012679
12680::
12681
Elad Cohenef5798a2017-05-03 12:28:54 +000012682 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.gather.v16f32.v16p0f32 (<16 x float*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
12683 declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v2f64.v2p1f64 (<2 x double addrspace(1)*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>)
12684 declare <8 x float*> @llvm.masked.gather.v8p0f32.v8p0p0f32 (<8 x float**> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x float*> <passthru>)
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000012685
12686Overview:
12687"""""""""
12688
12689Reads scalar values from arbitrary memory locations and gathers them into one vector. The memory locations are provided in the vector of pointers '``ptrs``'. The memory is accessed according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
12690
12691
12692Arguments:
12693""""""""""
12694
12695The first operand is a vector of pointers which holds all memory addresses to read. The second operand is an alignment of the source addresses. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the vector of pointers and the type of the '``passthru``' operand are the same vector types.
12696
12697
12698Semantics:
12699""""""""""
12700
12701The '``llvm.masked.gather``' intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of multiple scalar values from arbitrary memory locations in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked gathers and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of scalar load operations.
12702The semantics of this operation are equivalent to a sequence of conditional scalar loads with subsequent gathering all loaded values into a single vector. The mask restricts memory access to certain lanes and facilitates vectorization of predicated basic blocks.
12703
12704
12705::
12706
Elad Cohenef5798a2017-05-03 12:28:54 +000012707 %res = call <4 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v4f64.v4p0f64 (<4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 8, <4 x i1> <i1 true, i1 true, i1 true, i1 true>, <4 x double> undef)
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000012708
12709 ;; The gather with all-true mask is equivalent to the following instruction sequence
12710 %ptr0 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 0
12711 %ptr1 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 1
12712 %ptr2 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 2
12713 %ptr3 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 3
12714
12715 %val0 = load double, double* %ptr0, align 8
12716 %val1 = load double, double* %ptr1, align 8
12717 %val2 = load double, double* %ptr2, align 8
12718 %val3 = load double, double* %ptr3, align 8
12719
12720 %vec0 = insertelement <4 x double>undef, %val0, 0
12721 %vec01 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec0, %val1, 1
12722 %vec012 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec01, %val2, 2
12723 %vec0123 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec012, %val3, 3
12724
12725.. _int_mscatter:
12726
12727'``llvm.masked.scatter.*``' Intrinsics
12728^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12729
12730Syntax:
12731"""""""
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012732This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer, floating-point or pointer data type. Each vector element is stored in an arbitrary memory address. Scatter with overlapping addresses is guaranteed to be ordered from least-significant to most-significant element.
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000012733
12734::
12735
Elad Cohenef5798a2017-05-03 12:28:54 +000012736 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32.v8p0i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, <8 x i32*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
12737 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v16f32.v16p1f32 (<16 x float> <value>, <16 x float addrspace(1)*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
12738 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v4p0f64.v4p0p0f64 (<4 x double*> <value>, <4 x double**> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <4 x i1> <mask>)
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000012739
12740Overview:
12741"""""""""
12742
12743Writes each element from the value vector to the corresponding memory address. The memory addresses are represented as a vector of pointers. Writing is done according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes.
12744
12745Arguments:
12746""""""""""
12747
12748The first operand is a vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is a vector of pointers, pointing to where the value elements should be stored. It has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is an alignment of the destination addresses. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements.
12749
12750
12751Semantics:
12752""""""""""
12753
Bruce Mitchenere9ffb452015-09-12 01:17:08 +000012754The '``llvm.masked.scatter``' intrinsics is designed for writing selected vector elements to arbitrary memory addresses in a single IR operation. The operation may be conditional, when not all bits in the mask are switched on. It is useful for targets that support vector masked scatter and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000012755
12756::
12757
Sylvestre Ledru84666a12016-02-14 20:16:22 +000012758 ;; This instruction unconditionally stores data vector in multiple addresses
Elad Cohenef5798a2017-05-03 12:28:54 +000012759 call @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32.v8p0i32 (<8 x i32> %value, <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 4, <8 x i1> <true, true, .. true>)
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000012760
12761 ;; It is equivalent to a list of scalar stores
12762 %val0 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 0
12763 %val1 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 1
12764 ..
12765 %val7 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 7
12766 %ptr0 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 0
12767 %ptr1 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 1
12768 ..
12769 %ptr7 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 7
12770 ;; Note: the order of the following stores is important when they overlap:
12771 store i32 %val0, i32* %ptr0, align 4
12772 store i32 %val1, i32* %ptr1, align 4
12773 ..
12774 store i32 %val7, i32* %ptr7, align 4
12775
12776
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012777Memory Use Markers
12778------------------
12779
Sanjay Patel69bf48e2014-07-04 19:40:43 +000012780This class of intrinsics provides information about the lifetime of
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012781memory objects and ranges where variables are immutable.
12782
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +000012783.. _int_lifestart:
12784
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012785'``llvm.lifetime.start``' Intrinsic
12786^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12787
12788Syntax:
12789"""""""
12790
12791::
12792
12793 declare void @llvm.lifetime.start(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
12794
12795Overview:
12796"""""""""
12797
12798The '``llvm.lifetime.start``' intrinsic specifies the start of a memory
12799object's lifetime.
12800
12801Arguments:
12802""""""""""
12803
12804The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
12805object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
12806to the object.
12807
12808Semantics:
12809""""""""""
12810
12811This intrinsic indicates that before this point in the code, the value
12812of the memory pointed to by ``ptr`` is dead. This means that it is known
12813to never be used and has an undefined value. A load from the pointer
12814that precedes this intrinsic can be replaced with ``'undef'``.
12815
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +000012816.. _int_lifeend:
12817
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012818'``llvm.lifetime.end``' Intrinsic
12819^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12820
12821Syntax:
12822"""""""
12823
12824::
12825
12826 declare void @llvm.lifetime.end(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
12827
12828Overview:
12829"""""""""
12830
12831The '``llvm.lifetime.end``' intrinsic specifies the end of a memory
12832object's lifetime.
12833
12834Arguments:
12835""""""""""
12836
12837The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
12838object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
12839to the object.
12840
12841Semantics:
12842""""""""""
12843
12844This intrinsic indicates that after this point in the code, the value of
12845the memory pointed to by ``ptr`` is dead. This means that it is known to
12846never be used and has an undefined value. Any stores into the memory
12847object following this intrinsic may be removed as dead.
12848
12849'``llvm.invariant.start``' Intrinsic
12850^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12851
12852Syntax:
12853"""""""
Mehdi Amini8c629ec2016-08-13 23:31:24 +000012854This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address space.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012855
12856::
12857
Mehdi Amini8c629ec2016-08-13 23:31:24 +000012858 declare {}* @llvm.invariant.start.p0i8(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012859
12860Overview:
12861"""""""""
12862
12863The '``llvm.invariant.start``' intrinsic specifies that the contents of
12864a memory object will not change.
12865
12866Arguments:
12867""""""""""
12868
12869The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
12870object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
12871to the object.
12872
12873Semantics:
12874""""""""""
12875
12876This intrinsic indicates that until an ``llvm.invariant.end`` that uses
12877the return value, the referenced memory location is constant and
12878unchanging.
12879
12880'``llvm.invariant.end``' Intrinsic
12881^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12882
12883Syntax:
12884"""""""
Mehdi Amini8c629ec2016-08-13 23:31:24 +000012885This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address space.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012886
12887::
12888
Mehdi Amini8c629ec2016-08-13 23:31:24 +000012889 declare void @llvm.invariant.end.p0i8({}* <start>, i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012890
12891Overview:
12892"""""""""
12893
12894The '``llvm.invariant.end``' intrinsic specifies that the contents of a
12895memory object are mutable.
12896
12897Arguments:
12898""""""""""
12899
12900The first argument is the matching ``llvm.invariant.start`` intrinsic.
12901The second argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
12902object, or -1 if it is variable sized and the third argument is a
12903pointer to the object.
12904
12905Semantics:
12906""""""""""
12907
12908This intrinsic indicates that the memory is mutable again.
12909
Piotr Padlewski5dde8092018-05-03 11:03:01 +000012910'``llvm.launder.invariant.group``' Intrinsic
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +000012911^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12912
12913Syntax:
12914"""""""
Yaxun Liu407ca362017-11-16 16:32:16 +000012915This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address
12916space. The returned pointer must belong to the same address space as the
12917argument.
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +000012918
12919::
12920
Piotr Padlewski5dde8092018-05-03 11:03:01 +000012921 declare i8* @llvm.launder.invariant.group.p0i8(i8* <ptr>)
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +000012922
12923Overview:
12924"""""""""
12925
Piotr Padlewski5dde8092018-05-03 11:03:01 +000012926The '``llvm.launder.invariant.group``' intrinsic can be used when an invariant
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +000012927established by invariant.group metadata no longer holds, to obtain a new pointer
Piotr Padlewski74b155f2018-04-08 13:53:04 +000012928value that does not carry the invariant information. It is an experimental
12929intrinsic, which means that its semantics might change in the future.
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +000012930
12931
12932Arguments:
12933""""""""""
12934
Piotr Padlewski5dde8092018-05-03 11:03:01 +000012935The ``llvm.launder.invariant.group`` takes only one argument, which is
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +000012936the pointer to the memory for which the ``invariant.group`` no longer holds.
12937
12938Semantics:
12939""""""""""
12940
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000012941Returns another pointer that aliases its argument but which is considered different
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +000012942for the purposes of ``load``/``store`` ``invariant.group`` metadata.
Piotr Padlewski5dde8092018-05-03 11:03:01 +000012943It does not read any accessible memory and the execution can be speculated.
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +000012944
Sanjay Patel54b161e2018-03-20 16:38:22 +000012945.. _constrainedfp:
12946
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012947Constrained Floating-Point Intrinsics
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000012948-------------------------------------
12949
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012950These intrinsics are used to provide special handling of floating-point
12951operations when specific rounding mode or floating-point exception behavior is
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000012952required. By default, LLVM optimization passes assume that the rounding mode is
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012953round-to-nearest and that floating-point exceptions will not be monitored.
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000012954Constrained FP intrinsics are used to support non-default rounding modes and
12955accurately preserve exception behavior without compromising LLVM's ability to
12956optimize FP code when the default behavior is used.
12957
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012958Each of these intrinsics corresponds to a normal floating-point operation. The
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000012959first two arguments and the return value are the same as the corresponding FP
12960operation.
12961
12962The third argument is a metadata argument specifying the rounding mode to be
12963assumed. This argument must be one of the following strings:
12964
12965::
Andrew Kaylor73b4a9a2017-04-20 18:18:36 +000012966
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000012967 "round.dynamic"
12968 "round.tonearest"
12969 "round.downward"
12970 "round.upward"
12971 "round.towardzero"
12972
12973If this argument is "round.dynamic" optimization passes must assume that the
12974rounding mode is unknown and may change at runtime. No transformations that
12975depend on rounding mode may be performed in this case.
12976
12977The other possible values for the rounding mode argument correspond to the
12978similarly named IEEE rounding modes. If the argument is any of these values
12979optimization passes may perform transformations as long as they are consistent
12980with the specified rounding mode.
12981
12982For example, 'x-0'->'x' is not a valid transformation if the rounding mode is
12983"round.downward" or "round.dynamic" because if the value of 'x' is +0 then
12984'x-0' should evaluate to '-0' when rounding downward. However, this
12985transformation is legal for all other rounding modes.
12986
12987For values other than "round.dynamic" optimization passes may assume that the
12988actual runtime rounding mode (as defined in a target-specific manner) matches
12989the specified rounding mode, but this is not guaranteed. Using a specific
12990non-dynamic rounding mode which does not match the actual rounding mode at
12991runtime results in undefined behavior.
12992
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000012993The fourth argument to the constrained floating-point intrinsics specifies the
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000012994required exception behavior. This argument must be one of the following
12995strings:
12996
12997::
Andrew Kaylor73b4a9a2017-04-20 18:18:36 +000012998
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000012999 "fpexcept.ignore"
13000 "fpexcept.maytrap"
13001 "fpexcept.strict"
13002
13003If this argument is "fpexcept.ignore" optimization passes may assume that the
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013004exception status flags will not be read and that floating-point exceptions will
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013005be masked. This allows transformations to be performed that may change the
13006exception semantics of the original code. For example, FP operations may be
13007speculatively executed in this case whereas they must not be for either of the
13008other possible values of this argument.
13009
13010If the exception behavior argument is "fpexcept.maytrap" optimization passes
13011must avoid transformations that may raise exceptions that would not have been
13012raised by the original code (such as speculatively executing FP operations), but
13013passes are not required to preserve all exceptions that are implied by the
13014original code. For example, exceptions may be potentially hidden by constant
13015folding.
13016
13017If the exception behavior argument is "fpexcept.strict" all transformations must
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013018strictly preserve the floating-point exception semantics of the original code.
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013019Any FP exception that would have been raised by the original code must be raised
13020by the transformed code, and the transformed code must not raise any FP
13021exceptions that would not have been raised by the original code. This is the
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000013022exception behavior argument that will be used if the code being compiled reads
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013023the FP exception status flags, but this mode can also be used with code that
13024unmasks FP exceptions.
13025
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013026The number and order of floating-point exceptions is NOT guaranteed. For
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013027example, a series of FP operations that each may raise exceptions may be
13028vectorized into a single instruction that raises each unique exception a single
13029time.
13030
13031
13032'``llvm.experimental.constrained.fadd``' Intrinsic
13033^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13034
13035Syntax:
13036"""""""
13037
13038::
13039
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000013040 declare <type>
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013041 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fadd(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
13042 metadata <rounding mode>,
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013043 metadata <exception behavior>)
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013044
13045Overview:
13046"""""""""
13047
13048The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fadd``' intrinsic returns the sum of its
13049two operands.
13050
13051
13052Arguments:
13053""""""""""
13054
13055The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fadd``'
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013056intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
13057of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013058
13059The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13060behavior as described above.
13061
13062Semantics:
13063""""""""""
13064
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013065The value produced is the floating-point sum of the two value operands and has
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013066the same type as the operands.
13067
13068
13069'``llvm.experimental.constrained.fsub``' Intrinsic
13070^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13071
13072Syntax:
13073"""""""
13074
13075::
13076
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000013077 declare <type>
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013078 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fsub(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
13079 metadata <rounding mode>,
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013080 metadata <exception behavior>)
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013081
13082Overview:
13083"""""""""
13084
13085The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fsub``' intrinsic returns the difference
13086of its two operands.
13087
13088
13089Arguments:
13090""""""""""
13091
13092The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fsub``'
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013093intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
13094of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013095
13096The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13097behavior as described above.
13098
13099Semantics:
13100""""""""""
13101
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013102The value produced is the floating-point difference of the two value operands
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013103and has the same type as the operands.
13104
13105
13106'``llvm.experimental.constrained.fmul``' Intrinsic
13107^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13108
13109Syntax:
13110"""""""
13111
13112::
13113
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000013114 declare <type>
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013115 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fmul(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
13116 metadata <rounding mode>,
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013117 metadata <exception behavior>)
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013118
13119Overview:
13120"""""""""
13121
13122The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fmul``' intrinsic returns the product of
13123its two operands.
13124
13125
13126Arguments:
13127""""""""""
13128
13129The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fmul``'
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013130intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
13131of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013132
13133The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13134behavior as described above.
13135
13136Semantics:
13137""""""""""
13138
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013139The value produced is the floating-point product of the two value operands and
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013140has the same type as the operands.
13141
13142
13143'``llvm.experimental.constrained.fdiv``' Intrinsic
13144^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13145
13146Syntax:
13147"""""""
13148
13149::
13150
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000013151 declare <type>
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013152 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fdiv(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
13153 metadata <rounding mode>,
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013154 metadata <exception behavior>)
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013155
13156Overview:
13157"""""""""
13158
13159The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fdiv``' intrinsic returns the quotient of
13160its two operands.
13161
13162
13163Arguments:
13164""""""""""
13165
13166The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fdiv``'
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013167intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
13168of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013169
13170The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13171behavior as described above.
13172
13173Semantics:
13174""""""""""
13175
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013176The value produced is the floating-point quotient of the two value operands and
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013177has the same type as the operands.
13178
13179
13180'``llvm.experimental.constrained.frem``' Intrinsic
13181^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13182
13183Syntax:
13184"""""""
13185
13186::
13187
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000013188 declare <type>
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013189 @llvm.experimental.constrained.frem(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
13190 metadata <rounding mode>,
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013191 metadata <exception behavior>)
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013192
13193Overview:
13194"""""""""
13195
13196The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.frem``' intrinsic returns the remainder
13197from the division of its two operands.
13198
13199
13200Arguments:
13201""""""""""
13202
13203The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.frem``'
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013204intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
13205of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013206
13207The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13208behavior as described above. The rounding mode argument has no effect, since
13209the result of frem is never rounded, but the argument is included for
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013210consistency with the other constrained floating-point intrinsics.
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013211
13212Semantics:
13213""""""""""
13214
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013215The value produced is the floating-point remainder from the division of the two
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013216value operands and has the same type as the operands. The remainder has the
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000013217same sign as the dividend.
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013218
Wei Dinga131d3f2017-08-24 04:18:24 +000013219'``llvm.experimental.constrained.fma``' Intrinsic
13220^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13221
13222Syntax:
13223"""""""
13224
13225::
13226
13227 declare <type>
13228 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fma(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>, <type> <op3>,
13229 metadata <rounding mode>,
13230 metadata <exception behavior>)
13231
13232Overview:
13233"""""""""
13234
13235The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fma``' intrinsic returns the result of a
13236fused-multiply-add operation on its operands.
13237
13238Arguments:
13239""""""""""
13240
13241The first three arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fma``'
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013242intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector
13243<t_vector>` of floating-point values. All arguments must have identical types.
Wei Dinga131d3f2017-08-24 04:18:24 +000013244
13245The fourth and fifth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception behavior
13246as described above.
13247
13248Semantics:
13249""""""""""
13250
13251The result produced is the product of the first two operands added to the third
13252operand computed with infinite precision, and then rounded to the target
13253precision.
Andrew Kaylora0a11642017-01-26 23:27:59 +000013254
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013255Constrained libm-equivalent Intrinsics
13256--------------------------------------
13257
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013258In addition to the basic floating-point operations for which constrained
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013259intrinsics are described above, there are constrained versions of various
13260operations which provide equivalent behavior to a corresponding libm function.
13261These intrinsics allow the precise behavior of these operations with respect to
13262rounding mode and exception behavior to be controlled.
13263
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013264As with the basic constrained floating-point intrinsics, the rounding mode
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013265and exception behavior arguments only control the behavior of the optimizer.
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013266They do not change the runtime floating-point environment.
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013267
13268
13269'``llvm.experimental.constrained.sqrt``' Intrinsic
13270^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13271
13272Syntax:
13273"""""""
13274
13275::
13276
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000013277 declare <type>
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013278 @llvm.experimental.constrained.sqrt(<type> <op1>,
13279 metadata <rounding mode>,
13280 metadata <exception behavior>)
13281
13282Overview:
13283"""""""""
13284
13285The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.sqrt``' intrinsic returns the square root
13286of the specified value, returning the same value as the libm '``sqrt``'
13287functions would, but without setting ``errno``.
13288
13289Arguments:
13290""""""""""
13291
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013292The first argument and the return type are floating-point numbers of the same
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013293type.
13294
13295The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13296behavior as described above.
13297
13298Semantics:
13299""""""""""
13300
13301This function returns the nonnegative square root of the specified value.
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013302If the value is less than negative zero, a floating-point exception occurs
Hiroshi Inoue760c0c92018-01-16 13:19:48 +000013303and the return value is architecture specific.
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013304
13305
13306'``llvm.experimental.constrained.pow``' Intrinsic
13307^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13308
13309Syntax:
13310"""""""
13311
13312::
13313
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000013314 declare <type>
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013315 @llvm.experimental.constrained.pow(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
13316 metadata <rounding mode>,
13317 metadata <exception behavior>)
13318
13319Overview:
13320"""""""""
13321
13322The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.pow``' intrinsic returns the first operand
13323raised to the (positive or negative) power specified by the second operand.
13324
13325Arguments:
13326""""""""""
13327
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013328The first two arguments and the return value are floating-point numbers of the
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013329same type. The second argument specifies the power to which the first argument
13330should be raised.
13331
13332The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13333behavior as described above.
13334
13335Semantics:
13336""""""""""
13337
13338This function returns the first value raised to the second power,
13339returning the same values as the libm ``pow`` functions would, and
13340handles error conditions in the same way.
13341
13342
13343'``llvm.experimental.constrained.powi``' Intrinsic
13344^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13345
13346Syntax:
13347"""""""
13348
13349::
13350
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000013351 declare <type>
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013352 @llvm.experimental.constrained.powi(<type> <op1>, i32 <op2>,
13353 metadata <rounding mode>,
13354 metadata <exception behavior>)
13355
13356Overview:
13357"""""""""
13358
13359The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.powi``' intrinsic returns the first operand
13360raised to the (positive or negative) power specified by the second operand. The
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013361order of evaluation of multiplications is not defined. When a vector of
13362floating-point type is used, the second argument remains a scalar integer value.
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013363
13364
13365Arguments:
13366""""""""""
13367
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013368The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013369type. The second argument is a 32-bit signed integer specifying the power to
13370which the first argument should be raised.
13371
13372The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13373behavior as described above.
13374
13375Semantics:
13376""""""""""
13377
13378This function returns the first value raised to the second power with an
13379unspecified sequence of rounding operations.
13380
13381
13382'``llvm.experimental.constrained.sin``' Intrinsic
13383^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13384
13385Syntax:
13386"""""""
13387
13388::
13389
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000013390 declare <type>
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013391 @llvm.experimental.constrained.sin(<type> <op1>,
13392 metadata <rounding mode>,
13393 metadata <exception behavior>)
13394
13395Overview:
13396"""""""""
13397
13398The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.sin``' intrinsic returns the sine of the
13399first operand.
13400
13401Arguments:
13402""""""""""
13403
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013404The first argument and the return type are floating-point numbers of the same
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013405type.
13406
13407The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13408behavior as described above.
13409
13410Semantics:
13411""""""""""
13412
13413This function returns the sine of the specified operand, returning the
13414same values as the libm ``sin`` functions would, and handles error
13415conditions in the same way.
13416
13417
13418'``llvm.experimental.constrained.cos``' Intrinsic
13419^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13420
13421Syntax:
13422"""""""
13423
13424::
13425
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000013426 declare <type>
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013427 @llvm.experimental.constrained.cos(<type> <op1>,
13428 metadata <rounding mode>,
13429 metadata <exception behavior>)
13430
13431Overview:
13432"""""""""
13433
13434The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.cos``' intrinsic returns the cosine of the
13435first operand.
13436
13437Arguments:
13438""""""""""
13439
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013440The first argument and the return type are floating-point numbers of the same
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013441type.
13442
13443The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13444behavior as described above.
13445
13446Semantics:
13447""""""""""
13448
13449This function returns the cosine of the specified operand, returning the
13450same values as the libm ``cos`` functions would, and handles error
13451conditions in the same way.
13452
13453
13454'``llvm.experimental.constrained.exp``' Intrinsic
13455^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13456
13457Syntax:
13458"""""""
13459
13460::
13461
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000013462 declare <type>
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013463 @llvm.experimental.constrained.exp(<type> <op1>,
13464 metadata <rounding mode>,
13465 metadata <exception behavior>)
13466
13467Overview:
13468"""""""""
13469
13470The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.exp``' intrinsic computes the base-e
13471exponential of the specified value.
13472
13473Arguments:
13474""""""""""
13475
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013476The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013477type.
13478
13479The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13480behavior as described above.
13481
13482Semantics:
13483""""""""""
13484
13485This function returns the same values as the libm ``exp`` functions
13486would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
13487
13488
13489'``llvm.experimental.constrained.exp2``' Intrinsic
13490^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13491
13492Syntax:
13493"""""""
13494
13495::
13496
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000013497 declare <type>
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013498 @llvm.experimental.constrained.exp2(<type> <op1>,
13499 metadata <rounding mode>,
13500 metadata <exception behavior>)
13501
13502Overview:
13503"""""""""
13504
13505The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.exp2``' intrinsic computes the base-2
13506exponential of the specified value.
13507
13508
13509Arguments:
13510""""""""""
13511
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013512The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013513type.
13514
13515The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13516behavior as described above.
13517
13518Semantics:
13519""""""""""
13520
13521This function returns the same values as the libm ``exp2`` functions
13522would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
13523
13524
13525'``llvm.experimental.constrained.log``' Intrinsic
13526^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13527
13528Syntax:
13529"""""""
13530
13531::
13532
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000013533 declare <type>
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013534 @llvm.experimental.constrained.log(<type> <op1>,
13535 metadata <rounding mode>,
13536 metadata <exception behavior>)
13537
13538Overview:
13539"""""""""
13540
13541The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log``' intrinsic computes the base-e
13542logarithm of the specified value.
13543
13544Arguments:
13545""""""""""
13546
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013547The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013548type.
13549
13550The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13551behavior as described above.
13552
13553
13554Semantics:
13555""""""""""
13556
13557This function returns the same values as the libm ``log`` functions
13558would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
13559
13560
13561'``llvm.experimental.constrained.log10``' Intrinsic
13562^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13563
13564Syntax:
13565"""""""
13566
13567::
13568
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000013569 declare <type>
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013570 @llvm.experimental.constrained.log10(<type> <op1>,
13571 metadata <rounding mode>,
13572 metadata <exception behavior>)
13573
13574Overview:
13575"""""""""
13576
13577The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log10``' intrinsic computes the base-10
13578logarithm of the specified value.
13579
13580Arguments:
13581""""""""""
13582
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013583The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013584type.
13585
13586The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13587behavior as described above.
13588
13589Semantics:
13590""""""""""
13591
13592This function returns the same values as the libm ``log10`` functions
13593would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
13594
13595
13596'``llvm.experimental.constrained.log2``' Intrinsic
13597^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13598
13599Syntax:
13600"""""""
13601
13602::
13603
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000013604 declare <type>
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013605 @llvm.experimental.constrained.log2(<type> <op1>,
13606 metadata <rounding mode>,
13607 metadata <exception behavior>)
13608
13609Overview:
13610"""""""""
13611
13612The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log2``' intrinsic computes the base-2
13613logarithm of the specified value.
13614
13615Arguments:
13616""""""""""
13617
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013618The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013619type.
13620
13621The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13622behavior as described above.
13623
13624Semantics:
13625""""""""""
13626
13627This function returns the same values as the libm ``log2`` functions
13628would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
13629
13630
13631'``llvm.experimental.constrained.rint``' Intrinsic
13632^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13633
13634Syntax:
13635"""""""
13636
13637::
13638
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000013639 declare <type>
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013640 @llvm.experimental.constrained.rint(<type> <op1>,
13641 metadata <rounding mode>,
13642 metadata <exception behavior>)
13643
13644Overview:
13645"""""""""
13646
13647The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.rint``' intrinsic returns the first
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013648operand rounded to the nearest integer. It may raise an inexact floating-point
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013649exception if the operand is not an integer.
13650
13651Arguments:
13652""""""""""
13653
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013654The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013655type.
13656
13657The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13658behavior as described above.
13659
13660Semantics:
13661""""""""""
13662
13663This function returns the same values as the libm ``rint`` functions
13664would, and handles error conditions in the same way. The rounding mode is
13665described, not determined, by the rounding mode argument. The actual rounding
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013666mode is determined by the runtime floating-point environment. The rounding
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013667mode argument is only intended as information to the compiler.
13668
13669
13670'``llvm.experimental.constrained.nearbyint``' Intrinsic
13671^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13672
13673Syntax:
13674"""""""
13675
13676::
13677
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000013678 declare <type>
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013679 @llvm.experimental.constrained.nearbyint(<type> <op1>,
13680 metadata <rounding mode>,
13681 metadata <exception behavior>)
13682
13683Overview:
13684"""""""""
13685
13686The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.nearbyint``' intrinsic returns the first
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013687operand rounded to the nearest integer. It will not raise an inexact
13688floating-point exception if the operand is not an integer.
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013689
13690
13691Arguments:
13692""""""""""
13693
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013694The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013695type.
13696
13697The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13698behavior as described above.
13699
13700Semantics:
13701""""""""""
13702
13703This function returns the same values as the libm ``nearbyint`` functions
13704would, and handles error conditions in the same way. The rounding mode is
13705described, not determined, by the rounding mode argument. The actual rounding
Sanjay Patel85fa9ef2018-03-21 14:15:33 +000013706mode is determined by the runtime floating-point environment. The rounding
Andrew Kaylorf4660012017-05-25 21:31:00 +000013707mode argument is only intended as information to the compiler.
13708
13709
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000013710General Intrinsics
13711------------------
13712
13713This class of intrinsics is designed to be generic and has no specific
13714purpose.
13715
13716'``llvm.var.annotation``' Intrinsic
13717^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13718
13719Syntax:
13720"""""""
13721
13722::
13723
13724 declare void @llvm.var.annotation(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
13725
13726Overview:
13727"""""""""
13728
13729The '``llvm.var.annotation``' intrinsic.
13730
13731Arguments:
13732""""""""""
13733
13734The first argument is a pointer to a value, the second is a pointer to a
13735global string, the third is a pointer to a global string which is the
13736source file name, and the last argument is the line number.
13737
13738Semantics:
13739""""""""""
13740
13741This intrinsic allows annotation of local variables with arbitrary
13742strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want
13743to look for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are
13744ignored by code generation and optimization.
13745
Michael Gottesman88d18832013-03-26 00:34:27 +000013746'``llvm.ptr.annotation.*``' Intrinsic
13747^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13748
13749Syntax:
13750"""""""
13751
13752This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '``llvm.ptr.annotation``' on a
13753pointer to an integer of any width. *NOTE* you must specify an address space for
13754the pointer. The identifier for the default address space is the integer
13755'``0``'.
13756
13757::
13758
13759 declare i8* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i8(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
13760 declare i16* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i16(i16* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
13761 declare i32* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i32(i32* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
13762 declare i64* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i64(i64* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
13763 declare i256* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i256(i256* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
13764
13765Overview:
13766"""""""""
13767
13768The '``llvm.ptr.annotation``' intrinsic.
13769
13770Arguments:
13771""""""""""
13772
13773The first argument is a pointer to an integer value of arbitrary bitwidth
13774(result of some expression), the second is a pointer to a global string, the
13775third is a pointer to a global string which is the source file name, and the
13776last argument is the line number. It returns the value of the first argument.
13777
13778Semantics:
13779""""""""""
13780
13781This intrinsic allows annotation of a pointer to an integer with arbitrary
13782strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want to look
13783for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are ignored by code
13784generation and optimization.
13785
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000013786'``llvm.annotation.*``' Intrinsic
13787^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13788
13789Syntax:
13790"""""""
13791
13792This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '``llvm.annotation``' on
13793any integer bit width.
13794
13795::
13796
13797 declare i8 @llvm.annotation.i8(i8 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
13798 declare i16 @llvm.annotation.i16(i16 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
13799 declare i32 @llvm.annotation.i32(i32 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
13800 declare i64 @llvm.annotation.i64(i64 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
13801 declare i256 @llvm.annotation.i256(i256 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
13802
13803Overview:
13804"""""""""
13805
13806The '``llvm.annotation``' intrinsic.
13807
13808Arguments:
13809""""""""""
13810
13811The first argument is an integer value (result of some expression), the
13812second is a pointer to a global string, the third is a pointer to a
13813global string which is the source file name, and the last argument is
13814the line number. It returns the value of the first argument.
13815
13816Semantics:
13817""""""""""
13818
13819This intrinsic allows annotations to be put on arbitrary expressions
13820with arbitrary strings. This can be useful for special purpose
13821optimizations that want to look for these annotations. These have no
13822other defined use; they are ignored by code generation and optimization.
13823
Reid Klecknere33c94f2017-09-05 20:14:58 +000013824'``llvm.codeview.annotation``' Intrinsic
Reid Klecknerd4523682017-09-05 20:26:25 +000013825^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Reid Klecknere33c94f2017-09-05 20:14:58 +000013826
13827Syntax:
13828"""""""
13829
13830This annotation emits a label at its program point and an associated
13831``S_ANNOTATION`` codeview record with some additional string metadata. This is
13832used to implement MSVC's ``__annotation`` intrinsic. It is marked
13833``noduplicate``, so calls to this intrinsic prevent inlining and should be
13834considered expensive.
13835
13836::
13837
13838 declare void @llvm.codeview.annotation(metadata)
13839
13840Arguments:
13841""""""""""
13842
13843The argument should be an MDTuple containing any number of MDStrings.
13844
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000013845'``llvm.trap``' Intrinsic
13846^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13847
13848Syntax:
13849"""""""
13850
13851::
13852
13853 declare void @llvm.trap() noreturn nounwind
13854
13855Overview:
13856"""""""""
13857
13858The '``llvm.trap``' intrinsic.
13859
13860Arguments:
13861""""""""""
13862
13863None.
13864
13865Semantics:
13866""""""""""
13867
13868This intrinsic is lowered to the target dependent trap instruction. If
13869the target does not have a trap instruction, this intrinsic will be
13870lowered to a call of the ``abort()`` function.
13871
13872'``llvm.debugtrap``' Intrinsic
13873^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13874
13875Syntax:
13876"""""""
13877
13878::
13879
13880 declare void @llvm.debugtrap() nounwind
13881
13882Overview:
13883"""""""""
13884
13885The '``llvm.debugtrap``' intrinsic.
13886
13887Arguments:
13888""""""""""
13889
13890None.
13891
13892Semantics:
13893""""""""""
13894
13895This intrinsic is lowered to code which is intended to cause an
13896execution trap with the intention of requesting the attention of a
13897debugger.
13898
13899'``llvm.stackprotector``' Intrinsic
13900^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13901
13902Syntax:
13903"""""""
13904
13905::
13906
13907 declare void @llvm.stackprotector(i8* <guard>, i8** <slot>)
13908
13909Overview:
13910"""""""""
13911
13912The ``llvm.stackprotector`` intrinsic takes the ``guard`` and stores it
13913onto the stack at ``slot``. The stack slot is adjusted to ensure that it
13914is placed on the stack before local variables.
13915
13916Arguments:
13917""""""""""
13918
13919The ``llvm.stackprotector`` intrinsic requires two pointer arguments.
13920The first argument is the value loaded from the stack guard
13921``@__stack_chk_guard``. The second variable is an ``alloca`` that has
13922enough space to hold the value of the guard.
13923
13924Semantics:
13925""""""""""
13926
Michael Gottesmandafc7d92013-08-12 18:35:32 +000013927This intrinsic causes the prologue/epilogue inserter to force the position of
13928the ``AllocaInst`` stack slot to be before local variables on the stack. This is
13929to ensure that if a local variable on the stack is overwritten, it will destroy
13930the value of the guard. When the function exits, the guard on the stack is
13931checked against the original guard by ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck``. If they are
13932different, then ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck`` causes the program to abort by
13933calling the ``__stack_chk_fail()`` function.
13934
Tim Shene885d5e2016-04-19 19:40:37 +000013935'``llvm.stackguard``' Intrinsic
13936^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13937
13938Syntax:
13939"""""""
13940
13941::
13942
13943 declare i8* @llvm.stackguard()
13944
13945Overview:
13946"""""""""
13947
13948The ``llvm.stackguard`` intrinsic returns the system stack guard value.
13949
13950It should not be generated by frontends, since it is only for internal usage.
13951The reason why we create this intrinsic is that we still support IR form Stack
13952Protector in FastISel.
13953
13954Arguments:
13955""""""""""
13956
13957None.
13958
13959Semantics:
13960""""""""""
13961
13962On some platforms, the value returned by this intrinsic remains unchanged
13963between loads in the same thread. On other platforms, it returns the same
13964global variable value, if any, e.g. ``@__stack_chk_guard``.
13965
13966Currently some platforms have IR-level customized stack guard loading (e.g.
13967X86 Linux) that is not handled by ``llvm.stackguard()``, while they should be
13968in the future.
13969
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000013970'``llvm.objectsize``' Intrinsic
13971^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13972
13973Syntax:
13974"""""""
13975
13976::
13977
George Burgess IV56c7e882017-03-21 20:08:59 +000013978 declare i32 @llvm.objectsize.i32(i8* <object>, i1 <min>, i1 <nullunknown>)
13979 declare i64 @llvm.objectsize.i64(i8* <object>, i1 <min>, i1 <nullunknown>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000013980
13981Overview:
13982"""""""""
13983
13984The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic is designed to provide information to
13985the optimizers to determine at compile time whether a) an operation
13986(like memcpy) will overflow a buffer that corresponds to an object, or
13987b) that a runtime check for overflow isn't necessary. An object in this
13988context means an allocation of a specific class, structure, array, or
13989other object.
13990
13991Arguments:
13992""""""""""
13993
George Burgess IV56c7e882017-03-21 20:08:59 +000013994The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic takes three arguments. The first argument is
13995a pointer to or into the ``object``. The second argument determines whether
13996``llvm.objectsize`` returns 0 (if true) or -1 (if false) when the object size
13997is unknown. The third argument controls how ``llvm.objectsize`` acts when
13998``null`` is used as its pointer argument. If it's true and the pointer is in
13999address space 0, ``null`` is treated as an opaque value with an unknown number
14000of bytes. Otherwise, ``llvm.objectsize`` reports 0 bytes available when given
14001``null``.
14002
14003The second and third arguments only accept constants.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000014004
14005Semantics:
14006""""""""""
14007
14008The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic is lowered to a constant representing
14009the size of the object concerned. If the size cannot be determined at
14010compile time, ``llvm.objectsize`` returns ``i32/i64 -1 or 0`` (depending
14011on the ``min`` argument).
14012
14013'``llvm.expect``' Intrinsic
14014^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14015
14016Syntax:
14017"""""""
14018
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith1ff08e32014-02-02 22:43:55 +000014019This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.expect`` on any
14020integer bit width.
14021
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000014022::
14023
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith1ff08e32014-02-02 22:43:55 +000014024 declare i1 @llvm.expect.i1(i1 <val>, i1 <expected_val>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000014025 declare i32 @llvm.expect.i32(i32 <val>, i32 <expected_val>)
14026 declare i64 @llvm.expect.i64(i64 <val>, i64 <expected_val>)
14027
14028Overview:
14029"""""""""
14030
14031The ``llvm.expect`` intrinsic provides information about expected (the
14032most probable) value of ``val``, which can be used by optimizers.
14033
14034Arguments:
14035""""""""""
14036
14037The ``llvm.expect`` intrinsic takes two arguments. The first argument is
14038a value. The second argument is an expected value, this needs to be a
14039constant value, variables are not allowed.
14040
14041Semantics:
14042""""""""""
14043
14044This intrinsic is lowered to the ``val``.
14045
Philip Reamese0e90832015-04-26 22:23:12 +000014046.. _int_assume:
14047
Hal Finkel93046912014-07-25 21:13:35 +000014048'``llvm.assume``' Intrinsic
14049^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14050
14051Syntax:
14052"""""""
14053
14054::
14055
14056 declare void @llvm.assume(i1 %cond)
14057
14058Overview:
14059"""""""""
14060
14061The ``llvm.assume`` allows the optimizer to assume that the provided
14062condition is true. This information can then be used in simplifying other parts
14063of the code.
14064
14065Arguments:
14066""""""""""
14067
14068The condition which the optimizer may assume is always true.
14069
14070Semantics:
14071""""""""""
14072
14073The intrinsic allows the optimizer to assume that the provided condition is
14074always true whenever the control flow reaches the intrinsic call. No code is
14075generated for this intrinsic, and instructions that contribute only to the
14076provided condition are not used for code generation. If the condition is
14077violated during execution, the behavior is undefined.
14078
Sanjay Patel1ed2bb52015-01-14 16:03:58 +000014079Note that the optimizer might limit the transformations performed on values
Hal Finkel93046912014-07-25 21:13:35 +000014080used by the ``llvm.assume`` intrinsic in order to preserve the instructions
14081only used to form the intrinsic's input argument. This might prove undesirable
Sanjay Patel1ed2bb52015-01-14 16:03:58 +000014082if the extra information provided by the ``llvm.assume`` intrinsic does not cause
Hal Finkel93046912014-07-25 21:13:35 +000014083sufficient overall improvement in code quality. For this reason,
14084``llvm.assume`` should not be used to document basic mathematical invariants
14085that the optimizer can otherwise deduce or facts that are of little use to the
14086optimizer.
14087
Daniel Berlin2c438a32017-02-07 19:29:25 +000014088.. _int_ssa_copy:
14089
14090'``llvm.ssa_copy``' Intrinsic
14091^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14092
14093Syntax:
14094"""""""
14095
14096::
14097
14098 declare type @llvm.ssa_copy(type %operand) returned(1) readnone
14099
14100Arguments:
14101""""""""""
14102
14103The first argument is an operand which is used as the returned value.
14104
14105Overview:
14106""""""""""
14107
14108The ``llvm.ssa_copy`` intrinsic can be used to attach information to
14109operations by copying them and giving them new names. For example,
14110the PredicateInfo utility uses it to build Extended SSA form, and
14111attach various forms of information to operands that dominate specific
14112uses. It is not meant for general use, only for building temporary
14113renaming forms that require value splits at certain points.
14114
Peter Collingbourne7efd7502016-06-24 21:21:32 +000014115.. _type.test:
Peter Collingbournee6909c82015-02-20 20:30:47 +000014116
Peter Collingbourne7efd7502016-06-24 21:21:32 +000014117'``llvm.type.test``' Intrinsic
Peter Collingbournee6909c82015-02-20 20:30:47 +000014118^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14119
14120Syntax:
14121"""""""
14122
14123::
14124
Peter Collingbourne7efd7502016-06-24 21:21:32 +000014125 declare i1 @llvm.type.test(i8* %ptr, metadata %type) nounwind readnone
Peter Collingbournee6909c82015-02-20 20:30:47 +000014126
14127
14128Arguments:
14129""""""""""
14130
14131The first argument is a pointer to be tested. The second argument is a
Peter Collingbourne7efd7502016-06-24 21:21:32 +000014132metadata object representing a :doc:`type identifier <TypeMetadata>`.
Peter Collingbournee6909c82015-02-20 20:30:47 +000014133
14134Overview:
14135"""""""""
14136
Peter Collingbourne7efd7502016-06-24 21:21:32 +000014137The ``llvm.type.test`` intrinsic tests whether the given pointer is associated
14138with the given type identifier.
Peter Collingbournee6909c82015-02-20 20:30:47 +000014139
Peter Collingbourne0312f612016-06-25 00:23:04 +000014140'``llvm.type.checked.load``' Intrinsic
14141^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14142
14143Syntax:
14144"""""""
14145
14146::
14147
14148 declare {i8*, i1} @llvm.type.checked.load(i8* %ptr, i32 %offset, metadata %type) argmemonly nounwind readonly
14149
14150
14151Arguments:
14152""""""""""
14153
14154The first argument is a pointer from which to load a function pointer. The
14155second argument is the byte offset from which to load the function pointer. The
14156third argument is a metadata object representing a :doc:`type identifier
14157<TypeMetadata>`.
14158
14159Overview:
14160"""""""""
14161
14162The ``llvm.type.checked.load`` intrinsic safely loads a function pointer from a
14163virtual table pointer using type metadata. This intrinsic is used to implement
14164control flow integrity in conjunction with virtual call optimization. The
14165virtual call optimization pass will optimize away ``llvm.type.checked.load``
14166intrinsics associated with devirtualized calls, thereby removing the type
14167check in cases where it is not needed to enforce the control flow integrity
14168constraint.
14169
14170If the given pointer is associated with a type metadata identifier, this
14171function returns true as the second element of its return value. (Note that
14172the function may also return true if the given pointer is not associated
14173with a type metadata identifier.) If the function's return value's second
14174element is true, the following rules apply to the first element:
14175
14176- If the given pointer is associated with the given type metadata identifier,
14177 it is the function pointer loaded from the given byte offset from the given
14178 pointer.
14179
14180- If the given pointer is not associated with the given type metadata
14181 identifier, it is one of the following (the choice of which is unspecified):
14182
14183 1. The function pointer that would have been loaded from an arbitrarily chosen
14184 (through an unspecified mechanism) pointer associated with the type
14185 metadata.
14186
14187 2. If the function has a non-void return type, a pointer to a function that
14188 returns an unspecified value without causing side effects.
14189
14190If the function's return value's second element is false, the value of the
14191first element is undefined.
14192
14193
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000014194'``llvm.donothing``' Intrinsic
14195^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14196
14197Syntax:
14198"""""""
14199
14200::
14201
14202 declare void @llvm.donothing() nounwind readnone
14203
14204Overview:
14205"""""""""
14206
Juergen Ributzkac9161192014-10-23 22:36:13 +000014207The ``llvm.donothing`` intrinsic doesn't perform any operation. It's one of only
Sanjoy Das7a4c94d2016-02-26 03:33:59 +000014208three intrinsics (besides ``llvm.experimental.patchpoint`` and
14209``llvm.experimental.gc.statepoint``) that can be called with an invoke
14210instruction.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000014211
14212Arguments:
14213""""""""""
14214
14215None.
14216
14217Semantics:
14218""""""""""
14219
14220This intrinsic does nothing, and it's removed by optimizers and ignored
14221by codegen.
Andrew Trick5e029ce2013-12-24 02:57:25 +000014222
Sanjoy Dasb51325d2016-03-11 19:08:34 +000014223'``llvm.experimental.deoptimize``' Intrinsic
14224^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14225
14226Syntax:
14227"""""""
14228
14229::
14230
14231 declare type @llvm.experimental.deoptimize(...) [ "deopt"(...) ]
14232
14233Overview:
14234"""""""""
14235
14236This intrinsic, together with :ref:`deoptimization operand bundles
14237<deopt_opbundles>`, allow frontends to express transfer of control and
14238frame-local state from the currently executing (typically more specialized,
14239hence faster) version of a function into another (typically more generic, hence
14240slower) version.
14241
14242In languages with a fully integrated managed runtime like Java and JavaScript
14243this intrinsic can be used to implement "uncommon trap" or "side exit" like
14244functionality. In unmanaged languages like C and C++, this intrinsic can be
14245used to represent the slow paths of specialized functions.
14246
14247
14248Arguments:
14249""""""""""
14250
14251The intrinsic takes an arbitrary number of arguments, whose meaning is
14252decided by the :ref:`lowering strategy<deoptimize_lowering>`.
14253
14254Semantics:
14255""""""""""
14256
14257The ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` intrinsic executes an attached
14258deoptimization continuation (denoted using a :ref:`deoptimization
14259operand bundle <deopt_opbundles>`) and returns the value returned by
14260the deoptimization continuation. Defining the semantic properties of
14261the continuation itself is out of scope of the language reference --
14262as far as LLVM is concerned, the deoptimization continuation can
14263invoke arbitrary side effects, including reading from and writing to
14264the entire heap.
14265
14266Deoptimization continuations expressed using ``"deopt"`` operand bundles always
14267continue execution to the end of the physical frame containing them, so all
14268calls to ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` must be in "tail position":
14269
14270 - ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` cannot be invoked.
14271 - The call must immediately precede a :ref:`ret <i_ret>` instruction.
14272 - The ``ret`` instruction must return the value produced by the
14273 ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` call if there is one, or void.
14274
14275Note that the above restrictions imply that the return type for a call to
14276``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` will match the return type of its immediate
14277caller.
14278
14279The inliner composes the ``"deopt"`` continuations of the caller into the
14280``"deopt"`` continuations present in the inlinee, and also updates calls to this
14281intrinsic to return directly from the frame of the function it inlined into.
14282
Sanjoy Dase0aa4142016-05-12 01:17:38 +000014283All declarations of ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` must share the
14284same calling convention.
14285
Sanjoy Dasb51325d2016-03-11 19:08:34 +000014286.. _deoptimize_lowering:
14287
14288Lowering:
14289"""""""""
14290
Sanjoy Dasdf9ae702016-03-24 20:23:29 +000014291Calls to ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` are lowered to calls to the
14292symbol ``__llvm_deoptimize`` (it is the frontend's responsibility to
14293ensure that this symbol is defined). The call arguments to
14294``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` are lowered as if they were formal
14295arguments of the specified types, and not as varargs.
14296
Sanjoy Dasb51325d2016-03-11 19:08:34 +000014297
Sanjoy Das021de052016-03-31 00:18:46 +000014298'``llvm.experimental.guard``' Intrinsic
14299^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14300
14301Syntax:
14302"""""""
14303
14304::
14305
14306 declare void @llvm.experimental.guard(i1, ...) [ "deopt"(...) ]
14307
14308Overview:
14309"""""""""
14310
14311This intrinsic, together with :ref:`deoptimization operand bundles
14312<deopt_opbundles>`, allows frontends to express guards or checks on
14313optimistic assumptions made during compilation. The semantics of
14314``@llvm.experimental.guard`` is defined in terms of
14315``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` -- its body is defined to be
14316equivalent to:
14317
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +000014318.. code-block:: text
Sanjoy Das021de052016-03-31 00:18:46 +000014319
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +000014320 define void @llvm.experimental.guard(i1 %pred, <args...>) {
14321 %realPred = and i1 %pred, undef
14322 br i1 %realPred, label %continue, label %leave [, !make.implicit !{}]
Sanjoy Das021de052016-03-31 00:18:46 +000014323
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +000014324 leave:
14325 call void @llvm.experimental.deoptimize(<args...>) [ "deopt"() ]
14326 ret void
Sanjoy Das021de052016-03-31 00:18:46 +000014327
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +000014328 continue:
14329 ret void
14330 }
Sanjoy Das021de052016-03-31 00:18:46 +000014331
Sanjoy Das47cf2af2016-04-30 00:55:59 +000014332
14333with the optional ``[, !make.implicit !{}]`` present if and only if it
14334is present on the call site. For more details on ``!make.implicit``,
14335see :doc:`FaultMaps`.
14336
Sanjoy Das021de052016-03-31 00:18:46 +000014337In words, ``@llvm.experimental.guard`` executes the attached
14338``"deopt"`` continuation if (but **not** only if) its first argument
14339is ``false``. Since the optimizer is allowed to replace the ``undef``
14340with an arbitrary value, it can optimize guard to fail "spuriously",
14341i.e. without the original condition being false (hence the "not only
14342if"); and this allows for "check widening" type optimizations.
14343
14344``@llvm.experimental.guard`` cannot be invoked.
14345
14346
Peter Collingbourne7dd8dbf2016-04-22 21:18:02 +000014347'``llvm.load.relative``' Intrinsic
14348^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14349
14350Syntax:
14351"""""""
14352
14353::
14354
14355 declare i8* @llvm.load.relative.iN(i8* %ptr, iN %offset) argmemonly nounwind readonly
14356
14357Overview:
14358"""""""""
14359
14360This intrinsic loads a 32-bit value from the address ``%ptr + %offset``,
14361adds ``%ptr`` to that value and returns it. The constant folder specifically
14362recognizes the form of this intrinsic and the constant initializers it may
14363load from; if a loaded constant initializer is known to have the form
14364``i32 trunc(x - %ptr)``, the intrinsic call is folded to ``x``.
14365
14366LLVM provides that the calculation of such a constant initializer will
14367not overflow at link time under the medium code model if ``x`` is an
14368``unnamed_addr`` function. However, it does not provide this guarantee for
14369a constant initializer folded into a function body. This intrinsic can be
14370used to avoid the possibility of overflows when loading from such a constant.
14371
Dan Gohman2c74fe92017-11-08 21:59:51 +000014372'``llvm.sideeffect``' Intrinsic
14373^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14374
14375Syntax:
14376"""""""
14377
14378::
14379
14380 declare void @llvm.sideeffect() inaccessiblememonly nounwind
14381
14382Overview:
14383"""""""""
14384
14385The ``llvm.sideeffect`` intrinsic doesn't perform any operation. Optimizers
14386treat it as having side effects, so it can be inserted into a loop to
14387indicate that the loop shouldn't be assumed to terminate (which could
14388potentially lead to the loop being optimized away entirely), even if it's
14389an infinite loop with no other side effects.
14390
14391Arguments:
14392""""""""""
14393
14394None.
14395
14396Semantics:
14397""""""""""
14398
14399This intrinsic actually does nothing, but optimizers must assume that it
14400has externally observable side effects.
14401
Andrew Trick5e029ce2013-12-24 02:57:25 +000014402Stack Map Intrinsics
14403--------------------
14404
14405LLVM provides experimental intrinsics to support runtime patching
14406mechanisms commonly desired in dynamic language JITs. These intrinsics
14407are described in :doc:`StackMaps`.
Igor Laevsky4f31e522016-12-29 14:31:07 +000014408
14409Element Wise Atomic Memory Intrinsics
Igor Laevskyfedab152016-12-29 15:08:57 +000014410-------------------------------------
Igor Laevsky4f31e522016-12-29 14:31:07 +000014411
14412These intrinsics are similar to the standard library memory intrinsics except
14413that they perform memory transfer as a sequence of atomic memory accesses.
14414
Daniel Neilson3faabbb2017-06-16 14:43:59 +000014415.. _int_memcpy_element_unordered_atomic:
Igor Laevsky4f31e522016-12-29 14:31:07 +000014416
Daniel Neilson3faabbb2017-06-16 14:43:59 +000014417'``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic``' Intrinsic
14418^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Igor Laevsky4f31e522016-12-29 14:31:07 +000014419
14420Syntax:
14421"""""""
14422
Daniel Neilson3faabbb2017-06-16 14:43:59 +000014423This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic`` on
Igor Laevsky4f31e522016-12-29 14:31:07 +000014424any integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
14425support all bit widths however.
14426
14427::
14428
Daniel Neilson3faabbb2017-06-16 14:43:59 +000014429 declare void @llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>,
14430 i8* <src>,
14431 i32 <len>,
14432 i32 <element_size>)
14433 declare void @llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>,
14434 i8* <src>,
14435 i64 <len>,
14436 i32 <element_size>)
Igor Laevsky4f31e522016-12-29 14:31:07 +000014437
14438Overview:
14439"""""""""
14440
Daniel Neilson3faabbb2017-06-16 14:43:59 +000014441The '``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic is a specialization of the
14442'``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsic. It differs in that the ``dest`` and ``src`` are treated
14443as arrays with elements that are exactly ``element_size`` bytes, and the copy between
14444buffers uses a sequence of :ref:`unordered atomic <ordering>` load/store operations
14445that are a positive integer multiple of the ``element_size`` in size.
Igor Laevsky4f31e522016-12-29 14:31:07 +000014446
14447Arguments:
14448""""""""""
14449
Daniel Neilson3faabbb2017-06-16 14:43:59 +000014450The first three arguments are the same as they are in the :ref:`@llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`
14451intrinsic, with the added constraint that ``len`` is required to be a positive integer
14452multiple of the ``element_size``. If ``len`` is not a positive integer multiple of
14453``element_size``, then the behaviour of the intrinsic is undefined.
Igor Laevsky4f31e522016-12-29 14:31:07 +000014454
Daniel Neilson3faabbb2017-06-16 14:43:59 +000014455``element_size`` must be a compile-time constant positive power of two no greater than
14456target-specific atomic access size limit.
Igor Laevsky4f31e522016-12-29 14:31:07 +000014457
Daniel Neilson3faabbb2017-06-16 14:43:59 +000014458For each of the input pointers ``align`` parameter attribute must be specified. It
14459must be a power of two no less than the ``element_size``. Caller guarantees that
14460both the source and destination pointers are aligned to that boundary.
Igor Laevsky4f31e522016-12-29 14:31:07 +000014461
14462Semantics:
14463""""""""""
14464
Daniel Neilson3faabbb2017-06-16 14:43:59 +000014465The '``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic copies ``len`` bytes of
14466memory from the source location to the destination location. These locations are not
14467allowed to overlap. The memory copy is performed as a sequence of load/store operations
14468where each access is guaranteed to be a multiple of ``element_size`` bytes wide and
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000014469aligned at an ``element_size`` boundary.
Igor Laevsky4f31e522016-12-29 14:31:07 +000014470
14471The order of the copy is unspecified. The same value may be read from the source
14472buffer many times, but only one write is issued to the destination buffer per
Daniel Neilson3faabbb2017-06-16 14:43:59 +000014473element. It is well defined to have concurrent reads and writes to both source and
14474destination provided those reads and writes are unordered atomic when specified.
Igor Laevsky4f31e522016-12-29 14:31:07 +000014475
14476This intrinsic does not provide any additional ordering guarantees over those
14477provided by a set of unordered loads from the source location and stores to the
14478destination.
14479
14480Lowering:
Igor Laevskyfedab152016-12-29 15:08:57 +000014481"""""""""
Igor Laevsky4f31e522016-12-29 14:31:07 +000014482
Daniel Neilson3faabbb2017-06-16 14:43:59 +000014483In the most general case call to the '``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.*``' is
14484lowered to a call to the symbol ``__llvm_memcpy_element_unordered_atomic_*``. Where '*'
14485is replaced with an actual element size.
Igor Laevsky4f31e522016-12-29 14:31:07 +000014486
Daniel Neilson57226ef2017-07-12 15:25:26 +000014487Optimizer is allowed to inline memory copy when it's profitable to do so.
14488
14489'``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic``' Intrinsic
14490^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14491
14492Syntax:
14493"""""""
14494
14495This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use
14496``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic`` on any integer bit width and for
14497different address spaces. Not all targets support all bit widths however.
14498
14499::
14500
14501 declare void @llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>,
14502 i8* <src>,
14503 i32 <len>,
14504 i32 <element_size>)
14505 declare void @llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>,
14506 i8* <src>,
14507 i64 <len>,
14508 i32 <element_size>)
14509
14510Overview:
14511"""""""""
14512
14513The '``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic is a specialization
14514of the '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsic. It differs in that the ``dest`` and
14515``src`` are treated as arrays with elements that are exactly ``element_size``
14516bytes, and the copy between buffers uses a sequence of
14517:ref:`unordered atomic <ordering>` load/store operations that are a positive
14518integer multiple of the ``element_size`` in size.
14519
14520Arguments:
14521""""""""""
14522
14523The first three arguments are the same as they are in the
14524:ref:`@llvm.memmove <int_memmove>` intrinsic, with the added constraint that
14525``len`` is required to be a positive integer multiple of the ``element_size``.
14526If ``len`` is not a positive integer multiple of ``element_size``, then the
14527behaviour of the intrinsic is undefined.
14528
14529``element_size`` must be a compile-time constant positive power of two no
14530greater than a target-specific atomic access size limit.
14531
14532For each of the input pointers the ``align`` parameter attribute must be
14533specified. It must be a power of two no less than the ``element_size``. Caller
14534guarantees that both the source and destination pointers are aligned to that
14535boundary.
14536
14537Semantics:
14538""""""""""
14539
14540The '``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic copies ``len`` bytes
14541of memory from the source location to the destination location. These locations
14542are allowed to overlap. The memory copy is performed as a sequence of load/store
14543operations where each access is guaranteed to be a multiple of ``element_size``
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000014544bytes wide and aligned at an ``element_size`` boundary.
Daniel Neilson57226ef2017-07-12 15:25:26 +000014545
14546The order of the copy is unspecified. The same value may be read from the source
14547buffer many times, but only one write is issued to the destination buffer per
14548element. It is well defined to have concurrent reads and writes to both source
14549and destination provided those reads and writes are unordered atomic when
14550specified.
14551
14552This intrinsic does not provide any additional ordering guarantees over those
14553provided by a set of unordered loads from the source location and stores to the
14554destination.
14555
14556Lowering:
14557"""""""""
14558
14559In the most general case call to the
14560'``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.*``' is lowered to a call to the symbol
14561``__llvm_memmove_element_unordered_atomic_*``. Where '*' is replaced with an
14562actual element size.
14563
Daniel Neilson3faabbb2017-06-16 14:43:59 +000014564The optimizer is allowed to inline the memory copy when it's profitable to do so.
Daniel Neilson965613e2017-07-12 21:57:23 +000014565
14566.. _int_memset_element_unordered_atomic:
14567
14568'``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic``' Intrinsic
14569^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14570
14571Syntax:
14572"""""""
14573
14574This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic`` on
14575any integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
14576support all bit widths however.
14577
14578::
14579
14580 declare void @llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>,
14581 i8 <value>,
14582 i32 <len>,
14583 i32 <element_size>)
14584 declare void @llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>,
14585 i8 <value>,
14586 i64 <len>,
14587 i32 <element_size>)
14588
14589Overview:
14590"""""""""
14591
14592The '``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic is a specialization of the
14593'``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsic. It differs in that the ``dest`` is treated as an array
14594with elements that are exactly ``element_size`` bytes, and the assignment to that array
14595uses uses a sequence of :ref:`unordered atomic <ordering>` store operations
14596that are a positive integer multiple of the ``element_size`` in size.
14597
14598Arguments:
14599""""""""""
14600
14601The first three arguments are the same as they are in the :ref:`@llvm.memset <int_memset>`
14602intrinsic, with the added constraint that ``len`` is required to be a positive integer
14603multiple of the ``element_size``. If ``len`` is not a positive integer multiple of
14604``element_size``, then the behaviour of the intrinsic is undefined.
14605
14606``element_size`` must be a compile-time constant positive power of two no greater than
14607target-specific atomic access size limit.
14608
14609The ``dest`` input pointer must have the ``align`` parameter attribute specified. It
14610must be a power of two no less than the ``element_size``. Caller guarantees that
14611the destination pointer is aligned to that boundary.
14612
14613Semantics:
14614""""""""""
14615
14616The '``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic sets the ``len`` bytes of
14617memory starting at the destination location to the given ``value``. The memory is
14618set with a sequence of store operations where each access is guaranteed to be a
Jonas Devlieghereaaecdc42017-11-06 11:47:24 +000014619multiple of ``element_size`` bytes wide and aligned at an ``element_size`` boundary.
Daniel Neilson965613e2017-07-12 21:57:23 +000014620
14621The order of the assignment is unspecified. Only one write is issued to the
14622destination buffer per element. It is well defined to have concurrent reads and
14623writes to the destination provided those reads and writes are unordered atomic
14624when specified.
14625
14626This intrinsic does not provide any additional ordering guarantees over those
14627provided by a set of unordered stores to the destination.
14628
14629Lowering:
14630"""""""""
14631
14632In the most general case call to the '``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.*``' is
14633lowered to a call to the symbol ``__llvm_memset_element_unordered_atomic_*``. Where '*'
14634is replaced with an actual element size.
14635
14636The optimizer is allowed to inline the memory assignment when it's profitable to do so.